diff options
Diffstat (limited to 'src/lib/libc/stdlib')
94 files changed, 13986 insertions, 0 deletions
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/Makefile.inc b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/Makefile.inc new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..74f8ff5e7a --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/Makefile.inc | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,68 @@ | |||
| 1 | # $OpenBDS: Makefile.inc,v 1.6 1996/08/21 03:47:21 tholo Exp $ | ||
| 2 | |||
| 3 | # stdlib sources | ||
| 4 | .PATH: ${LIBCSRCDIR}/arch/${MACHINE_ARCH}/stdlib ${LIBCSRCDIR}/stdlib | ||
| 5 | |||
| 6 | SRCS+= a64l.c abort.c atexit.c atoi.c atof.c atol.c atoll.c bsearch.c \ | ||
| 7 | calloc.c cfree.c exit.c ecvt.c gcvt.c getenv.c getopt_long.c \ | ||
| 8 | getsubopt.c heapsort.c l64a.c llabs.c lsearch.c malloc.c merge.c \ | ||
| 9 | multibyte.c putenv.c qsort.c radixsort.c rand.c random.c realpath.c \ | ||
| 10 | setenv.c strtod.c strtol.c strtoll.c strtoul.c strtoull.c system.c \ | ||
| 11 | tfind.c tsearch.c _rand48.c drand48.c erand48.c jrand48.c lcong48.c \ | ||
| 12 | lrand48.c mrand48.c nrand48.c seed48.c srand48.c qabs.c qdiv.c | ||
| 13 | |||
| 14 | .if (${MACHINE_ARCH} == "m68k") | ||
| 15 | SRCS+= abs.S div.c labs.c ldiv.c | ||
| 16 | LSRCS+= abs.c | ||
| 17 | .elif (${MACHINE_ARCH} == "i386") | ||
| 18 | SRCS+= abs.S div.S labs.S ldiv.S | ||
| 19 | LSRCS+= abs.c div.c labs.c ldiv.c | ||
| 20 | .elif (${MACHINE_ARCH} == "ns32k") | ||
| 21 | SRCS+= abs.S div.c labs.c ldiv.c | ||
| 22 | LSRCS+= abs.c | ||
| 23 | .elif (${MACHINE_ARCH} == "tahoe") | ||
| 24 | SRCS+= abs.S div.c labs.c ldiv.c | ||
| 25 | LSRCS+= abs.c | ||
| 26 | .elif (${MACHINE_ARCH} == "vax") | ||
| 27 | SRCS+= abs.c div.c labs.c ldiv.c | ||
| 28 | .elif (${MACHINE_ARCH} == "alpha") | ||
| 29 | # XXX should be .S's | ||
| 30 | SRCS+= abs.c div.c labs.c ldiv.c | ||
| 31 | .else | ||
| 32 | SRCS+= abs.c div.c labs.c ldiv.c | ||
| 33 | .endif | ||
| 34 | |||
| 35 | .if (${MACHINE_ARCH} == "vax") || (${MACHINE_ARCH} == "m68k") | ||
| 36 | SRCS+= insque.S remque.S | ||
| 37 | .else | ||
| 38 | SRCS+= insque.c remque.c | ||
| 39 | .endif | ||
| 40 | |||
| 41 | MAN+= a64l.3 abort.3 abs.3 alloca.3 atexit.3 atof.3 atoi.3 atol.3 atoll.3 \ | ||
| 42 | bsearch.3 div.3 ecvt.3 exit.3 getenv.3 getopt.3 getopt_long.3 \ | ||
| 43 | getsubopt.3 insque.3 labs.3 ldiv.3 lsearch.3 malloc.3 qabs.3 \ | ||
| 44 | qdiv.3 qsort.3 radixsort.3 rand48.3 rand.3 random.3 realpath.3 \ | ||
| 45 | strtod.3 strtol.3 strtoul.3 system.3 tsearch.3 | ||
| 46 | |||
| 47 | MLINKS+=ecvt.3 fcvt.3 ecvt.3 gcvt.3 | ||
| 48 | MLINKS+=getenv.3 setenv.3 getenv.3 unsetenv.3 getenv.3 putenv.3 | ||
| 49 | MLINKS+=getopt_long.3 getopt_long_only.3 | ||
| 50 | MLINKS+=insque.3 remque.3 | ||
| 51 | MLINKS+=labs.3 llabs.3 | ||
| 52 | MLINKS+=lsearch.3 lfind.3 | ||
| 53 | MLINKS+=malloc.3 free.3 malloc.3 realloc.3 malloc.3 calloc.3 | ||
| 54 | MLINKS+=malloc.3 cfree.3 malloc.3 malloc.conf.5 | ||
| 55 | MLINKS+=qsort.3 heapsort.3 qsort.3 mergesort.3 | ||
| 56 | MLINKS+=radixsort.3 sradixsort.3 | ||
| 57 | MLINKS+=rand.3 srand.3 rand.3 rand_r.3 | ||
| 58 | MLINKS+=random.3 initstate.3 random.3 setstate.3 | ||
| 59 | MLINKS+=random.3 srandom.3 random.3 srandomdev.3 | ||
| 60 | MLINKS+=rand48.3 drand48.3 rand48.3 erand48.3 rand48.3 lrand48.3 | ||
| 61 | MLINKS+=rand48.3 mrand48.3 rand48.3 nrand48.3 rand48.3 jrand48.3 | ||
| 62 | MLINKS+=rand48.3 srand48.3 rand48.3 seed48.3 rand48.3 lcong48.3 | ||
| 63 | MLINKS+=strtol.3 strtoll.3 strtol.3 strtoq.3 | ||
| 64 | MLINKS+=strtoul.3 strtoull.3 strtoul.3 strtouq.3 | ||
| 65 | MLINKS+=tsearch.3 tfind.3 | ||
| 66 | MLINKS+=tsearch.3 tdelete.3 | ||
| 67 | MLINKS+=tsearch.3 twalk.3 | ||
| 68 | MLINKS+=a64l.3 l64a.3 | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/_rand48.c b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/_rand48.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..fed7372f68 --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/_rand48.c | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,50 @@ | |||
| 1 | /* | ||
| 2 | * Copyright (c) 1993 Martin Birgmeier | ||
| 3 | * All rights reserved. | ||
| 4 | * | ||
| 5 | * You may redistribute unmodified or modified versions of this source | ||
| 6 | * code provided that the above copyright notice and this and the | ||
| 7 | * following conditions are retained. | ||
| 8 | * | ||
| 9 | * This software is provided ``as is'', and comes with no warranties | ||
| 10 | * of any kind. I shall in no event be liable for anything that happens | ||
| 11 | * to anyone/anything when using this software. | ||
| 12 | */ | ||
| 13 | |||
| 14 | #if defined(LIBC_SCCS) && !defined(lint) | ||
| 15 | static char rcsid[] = "$OpenBSD: _rand48.c,v 1.2 1996/08/19 08:33:19 tholo Exp $"; | ||
| 16 | #endif /* LIBC_SCCS and not lint */ | ||
| 17 | |||
| 18 | #include "rand48.h" | ||
| 19 | |||
| 20 | unsigned short __rand48_seed[3] = { | ||
| 21 | RAND48_SEED_0, | ||
| 22 | RAND48_SEED_1, | ||
| 23 | RAND48_SEED_2 | ||
| 24 | }; | ||
| 25 | unsigned short __rand48_mult[3] = { | ||
| 26 | RAND48_MULT_0, | ||
| 27 | RAND48_MULT_1, | ||
| 28 | RAND48_MULT_2 | ||
| 29 | }; | ||
| 30 | unsigned short __rand48_add = RAND48_ADD; | ||
| 31 | |||
| 32 | void | ||
| 33 | __dorand48(unsigned short xseed[3]) | ||
| 34 | { | ||
| 35 | unsigned long accu; | ||
| 36 | unsigned short temp[2]; | ||
| 37 | |||
| 38 | accu = (unsigned long) __rand48_mult[0] * (unsigned long) xseed[0] + | ||
| 39 | (unsigned long) __rand48_add; | ||
| 40 | temp[0] = (unsigned short) accu; /* lower 16 bits */ | ||
| 41 | accu >>= sizeof(unsigned short) * 8; | ||
| 42 | accu += (unsigned long) __rand48_mult[0] * (unsigned long) xseed[1] + | ||
| 43 | (unsigned long) __rand48_mult[1] * (unsigned long) xseed[0]; | ||
| 44 | temp[1] = (unsigned short) accu; /* middle 16 bits */ | ||
| 45 | accu >>= sizeof(unsigned short) * 8; | ||
| 46 | accu += __rand48_mult[0] * xseed[2] + __rand48_mult[1] * xseed[1] + __rand48_mult[2] * xseed[0]; | ||
| 47 | xseed[0] = temp[0]; | ||
| 48 | xseed[1] = temp[1]; | ||
| 49 | xseed[2] = (unsigned short) accu; | ||
| 50 | } | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/a64l.3 b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/a64l.3 new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..de70d0af71 --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/a64l.3 | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,133 @@ | |||
| 1 | .\" $OpenBSD: a64l.3,v 1.8 2003/06/17 21:56:24 millert Exp $ | ||
| 2 | .\" | ||
| 3 | .\" Copyright (c) 1997 Todd C. Miller <Todd.Miller@courtesan.com> | ||
| 4 | .\" | ||
| 5 | .\" Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software for any | ||
| 6 | .\" purpose with or without fee is hereby granted, provided that the above | ||
| 7 | .\" copyright notice and this permission notice appear in all copies. | ||
| 8 | .\" | ||
| 9 | .\" THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS" AND THE AUTHOR DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES | ||
| 10 | .\" WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF | ||
| 11 | .\" MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR | ||
| 12 | .\" ANY SPECIAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES | ||
| 13 | .\" WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN AN | ||
| 14 | .\" ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING OUT OF | ||
| 15 | .\" OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE. | ||
| 16 | .\" | ||
| 17 | .Dd August 17, 1997 | ||
| 18 | .Dt A64L 3 | ||
| 19 | .Os | ||
| 20 | .Sh NAME | ||
| 21 | .Nm a64l , | ||
| 22 | .Nm l64a | ||
| 23 | .Nd convert between 32-bit integer and radix-64 ASCII string | ||
| 24 | .Sh SYNOPSIS | ||
| 25 | .Fd #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 26 | .Ft long | ||
| 27 | .Fn a64l "const char *s" | ||
| 28 | .Ft char * | ||
| 29 | .Fn l64a "long l" | ||
| 30 | .Sh DESCRIPTION | ||
| 31 | The | ||
| 32 | .Fn a64l | ||
| 33 | and | ||
| 34 | .Fn l64a | ||
| 35 | functions are used to maintain numbers stored in radix-64 | ||
| 36 | .Tn ASCII | ||
| 37 | characters. | ||
| 38 | This is a notation by which 32-bit integers | ||
| 39 | can be represented by up to six characters; each character represents a | ||
| 40 | .Dq digit | ||
| 41 | in a radix-64 notation. | ||
| 42 | .Pp | ||
| 43 | The characters used to represent digits are | ||
| 44 | .Ql \&. | ||
| 45 | for 0, | ||
| 46 | .Ql / | ||
| 47 | for 1, | ||
| 48 | .Ql 0 | ||
| 49 | through | ||
| 50 | .Ql 9 | ||
| 51 | for 2-11, | ||
| 52 | .Ql A | ||
| 53 | through | ||
| 54 | .Ql Z | ||
| 55 | for 12-37, and | ||
| 56 | .Ql a | ||
| 57 | through | ||
| 58 | .Ql z | ||
| 59 | for 38-63. | ||
| 60 | .Pp | ||
| 61 | The | ||
| 62 | .Fn a64l | ||
| 63 | function takes a pointer to a null-terminated radix-64 representation | ||
| 64 | and returns a corresponding 32-bit value. | ||
| 65 | If the string pointed to by | ||
| 66 | .Fa s | ||
| 67 | contains more than six characters, | ||
| 68 | .Fn a64l | ||
| 69 | will use the first six. | ||
| 70 | .Fn a64l | ||
| 71 | scans the character string from left to right, decoding | ||
| 72 | each character as a 6-bit radix-64 number. | ||
| 73 | If a long integer is | ||
| 74 | larger than 32 bits, the return value will be sign-extended. | ||
| 75 | .Pp | ||
| 76 | .Fn l64a | ||
| 77 | takes a long integer argument | ||
| 78 | .Fa l | ||
| 79 | and returns a pointer to the corresponding radix-64 representation. | ||
| 80 | .Sh RETURN VALUES | ||
| 81 | On success, | ||
| 82 | .Fn a64l | ||
| 83 | returns a 32-bit representation of | ||
| 84 | .Fa s . | ||
| 85 | If | ||
| 86 | .Fa s | ||
| 87 | is a null pointer or if it contains digits other than those described above, | ||
| 88 | .Fn a64l | ||
| 89 | returns \-1 and sets the global variable | ||
| 90 | .Va errno | ||
| 91 | to | ||
| 92 | .Er EINVAL . | ||
| 93 | .Pp | ||
| 94 | On success, | ||
| 95 | .Fn l64a | ||
| 96 | returns a pointer to a string containing the radix-64 representation of | ||
| 97 | .Fa l . | ||
| 98 | If | ||
| 99 | .Fa l | ||
| 100 | is 0, | ||
| 101 | .Fn l64a | ||
| 102 | returns a pointer to the empty string. | ||
| 103 | If | ||
| 104 | .Fa l | ||
| 105 | is negative, | ||
| 106 | .Fn l64a | ||
| 107 | returns a null pointer and sets the global variable | ||
| 108 | .Va errno | ||
| 109 | to | ||
| 110 | .Er EINVAL . | ||
| 111 | .Sh WARNINGS | ||
| 112 | The value returned by | ||
| 113 | .Fn l64a | ||
| 114 | is a pointer into a static buffer, the contents of which | ||
| 115 | will be overwritten by subsequent calls. | ||
| 116 | .Pp | ||
| 117 | The value returned by | ||
| 118 | .Fn a64l | ||
| 119 | may be incorrect if the value is too large; for that reason, only strings | ||
| 120 | that resulted from a call to | ||
| 121 | .Fn l64a | ||
| 122 | should be used to call | ||
| 123 | .Fn a64l . | ||
| 124 | .Pp | ||
| 125 | If a long integer is larger than 32 bits, only the low-order | ||
| 126 | 32 bits are used. | ||
| 127 | .Sh STANDARDS | ||
| 128 | The | ||
| 129 | .Fn a64l | ||
| 130 | and | ||
| 131 | .Fn l64a | ||
| 132 | functions conform to | ||
| 133 | .St -xpg4.2 . | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/a64l.c b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/a64l.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..a68f0a6dcd --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/a64l.c | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,46 @@ | |||
| 1 | /* | ||
| 2 | * Written by J.T. Conklin <jtc@netbsd.org>. | ||
| 3 | * Public domain. | ||
| 4 | */ | ||
| 5 | |||
| 6 | #if defined(LIBC_SCCS) && !defined(lint) | ||
| 7 | static char *rcsid = "$OpenBSD: a64l.c,v 1.3 1997/08/17 22:58:34 millert Exp $"; | ||
| 8 | #endif /* LIBC_SCCS and not lint */ | ||
| 9 | |||
| 10 | #include <errno.h> | ||
| 11 | #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 12 | |||
| 13 | long | ||
| 14 | a64l(s) | ||
| 15 | const char *s; | ||
| 16 | { | ||
| 17 | long value, digit, shift; | ||
| 18 | int i; | ||
| 19 | |||
| 20 | if (s == NULL) { | ||
| 21 | errno = EINVAL; | ||
| 22 | return(-1L); | ||
| 23 | } | ||
| 24 | |||
| 25 | value = 0; | ||
| 26 | shift = 0; | ||
| 27 | for (i = 0; *s && i < 6; i++, s++) { | ||
| 28 | if (*s >= '.' && *s <= '/') | ||
| 29 | digit = *s - '.'; | ||
| 30 | else if (*s >= '0' && *s <= '9') | ||
| 31 | digit = *s - '0' + 2; | ||
| 32 | else if (*s >= 'A' && *s <= 'Z') | ||
| 33 | digit = *s - 'A' + 12; | ||
| 34 | else if (*s >= 'a' && *s <= 'z') | ||
| 35 | digit = *s - 'a' + 38; | ||
| 36 | else { | ||
| 37 | errno = EINVAL; | ||
| 38 | return(-1L); | ||
| 39 | } | ||
| 40 | |||
| 41 | value |= digit << shift; | ||
| 42 | shift += 6; | ||
| 43 | } | ||
| 44 | |||
| 45 | return(value); | ||
| 46 | } | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/abort.3 b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/abort.3 new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..d411b859eb --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/abort.3 | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,63 @@ | |||
| 1 | .\" Copyright (c) 1990, 1991 The Regents of the University of California. | ||
| 2 | .\" All rights reserved. | ||
| 3 | .\" | ||
| 4 | .\" This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by | ||
| 5 | .\" the American National Standards Committee X3, on Information | ||
| 6 | .\" Processing Systems. | ||
| 7 | .\" | ||
| 8 | .\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without | ||
| 9 | .\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions | ||
| 10 | .\" are met: | ||
| 11 | .\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright | ||
| 12 | .\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. | ||
| 13 | .\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright | ||
| 14 | .\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the | ||
| 15 | .\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. | ||
| 16 | .\" 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors | ||
| 17 | .\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software | ||
| 18 | .\" without specific prior written permission. | ||
| 19 | .\" | ||
| 20 | .\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND | ||
| 21 | .\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE | ||
| 22 | .\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE | ||
| 23 | .\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE | ||
| 24 | .\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL | ||
| 25 | .\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS | ||
| 26 | .\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) | ||
| 27 | .\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT | ||
| 28 | .\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY | ||
| 29 | .\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF | ||
| 30 | .\" SUCH DAMAGE. | ||
| 31 | .\" | ||
| 32 | .\" $OpenBSD: abort.3,v 1.7 2003/06/02 20:18:37 millert Exp $ | ||
| 33 | .\" | ||
| 34 | .Dd June 29, 1991 | ||
| 35 | .Dt ABORT 3 | ||
| 36 | .Os | ||
| 37 | .Sh NAME | ||
| 38 | .Nm abort | ||
| 39 | .Nd cause abnormal program termination | ||
| 40 | .Sh SYNOPSIS | ||
| 41 | .Fd #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 42 | .Ft void | ||
| 43 | .Fn abort void | ||
| 44 | .Sh DESCRIPTION | ||
| 45 | The | ||
| 46 | .Fn abort | ||
| 47 | function causes abnormal program termination to occur, unless the signal | ||
| 48 | .Dv SIGABRT | ||
| 49 | is being caught and the signal handler does not return. | ||
| 50 | .Pp | ||
| 51 | Any open streams are flushed and closed. | ||
| 52 | .Sh RETURN VALUES | ||
| 53 | The | ||
| 54 | .Fn abort | ||
| 55 | function never returns. | ||
| 56 | .Sh SEE ALSO | ||
| 57 | .Xr sigaction 2 , | ||
| 58 | .Xr exit 3 | ||
| 59 | .Sh STANDARDS | ||
| 60 | The | ||
| 61 | .Fn abort | ||
| 62 | function conforms to | ||
| 63 | .St -p1003.1-90 . | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/abort.c b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/abort.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..2430c124f9 --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/abort.c | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,78 @@ | |||
| 1 | /* | ||
| 2 | * Copyright (c) 1985 Regents of the University of California. | ||
| 3 | * All rights reserved. | ||
| 4 | * | ||
| 5 | * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without | ||
| 6 | * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions | ||
| 7 | * are met: | ||
| 8 | * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright | ||
| 9 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. | ||
| 10 | * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright | ||
| 11 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the | ||
| 12 | * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. | ||
| 13 | * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors | ||
| 14 | * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software | ||
| 15 | * without specific prior written permission. | ||
| 16 | * | ||
| 17 | * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND | ||
| 18 | * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE | ||
| 19 | * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE | ||
| 20 | * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE | ||
| 21 | * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL | ||
| 22 | * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS | ||
| 23 | * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) | ||
| 24 | * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT | ||
| 25 | * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY | ||
| 26 | * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF | ||
| 27 | * SUCH DAMAGE. | ||
| 28 | */ | ||
| 29 | |||
| 30 | #if defined(LIBC_SCCS) && !defined(lint) | ||
| 31 | static char *rcsid = "$OpenBSD: abort.c,v 1.13 2004/01/20 19:35:17 millert Exp $"; | ||
| 32 | #endif /* LIBC_SCCS and not lint */ | ||
| 33 | |||
| 34 | #include <signal.h> | ||
| 35 | #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 36 | #include <unistd.h> | ||
| 37 | #include "thread_private.h" | ||
| 38 | #include "atexit.h" | ||
| 39 | |||
| 40 | void | ||
| 41 | abort(void) | ||
| 42 | { | ||
| 43 | struct atexit *p = __atexit; | ||
| 44 | static int cleanup_called = 0; | ||
| 45 | sigset_t mask; | ||
| 46 | |||
| 47 | |||
| 48 | sigfillset(&mask); | ||
| 49 | /* | ||
| 50 | * don't block SIGABRT to give any handler a chance; we ignore | ||
| 51 | * any errors -- X311J doesn't allow abort to return anyway. | ||
| 52 | */ | ||
| 53 | sigdelset(&mask, SIGABRT); | ||
| 54 | (void)_thread_sys_sigprocmask(SIG_SETMASK, &mask, (sigset_t *)NULL); | ||
| 55 | |||
| 56 | /* | ||
| 57 | * POSIX requires we flush stdio buffers on abort | ||
| 58 | */ | ||
| 59 | if (cleanup_called == 0) { | ||
| 60 | while (p != NULL && p->next != NULL) | ||
| 61 | p = p->next; | ||
| 62 | if (p != NULL && p->fns[0] != NULL) { | ||
| 63 | cleanup_called = 1; | ||
| 64 | (*p->fns[0])(); | ||
| 65 | } | ||
| 66 | } | ||
| 67 | |||
| 68 | (void)kill(getpid(), SIGABRT); | ||
| 69 | |||
| 70 | /* | ||
| 71 | * if SIGABRT ignored, or caught and the handler returns, do | ||
| 72 | * it again, only harder. | ||
| 73 | */ | ||
| 74 | (void)signal(SIGABRT, SIG_DFL); | ||
| 75 | (void)_thread_sys_sigprocmask(SIG_SETMASK, &mask, (sigset_t *)NULL); | ||
| 76 | (void)kill(getpid(), SIGABRT); | ||
| 77 | _exit(1); | ||
| 78 | } | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/abs.3 b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/abs.3 new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f0a6b8a23a --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/abs.3 | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,65 @@ | |||
| 1 | .\" Copyright (c) 1990, 1991 The Regents of the University of California. | ||
| 2 | .\" All rights reserved. | ||
| 3 | .\" | ||
| 4 | .\" This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by | ||
| 5 | .\" the American National Standards Committee X3, on Information | ||
| 6 | .\" Processing Systems. | ||
| 7 | .\" | ||
| 8 | .\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without | ||
| 9 | .\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions | ||
| 10 | .\" are met: | ||
| 11 | .\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright | ||
| 12 | .\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. | ||
| 13 | .\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright | ||
| 14 | .\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the | ||
| 15 | .\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. | ||
| 16 | .\" 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors | ||
| 17 | .\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software | ||
| 18 | .\" without specific prior written permission. | ||
| 19 | .\" | ||
| 20 | .\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND | ||
| 21 | .\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE | ||
| 22 | .\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE | ||
| 23 | .\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE | ||
| 24 | .\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL | ||
| 25 | .\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS | ||
| 26 | .\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) | ||
| 27 | .\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT | ||
| 28 | .\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY | ||
| 29 | .\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF | ||
| 30 | .\" SUCH DAMAGE. | ||
| 31 | .\" | ||
| 32 | .\" $OpenBSD: abs.3,v 1.6 2003/06/02 20:18:37 millert Exp $ | ||
| 33 | .\" | ||
| 34 | .Dd June 29, 1991 | ||
| 35 | .Dt ABS 3 | ||
| 36 | .Os | ||
| 37 | .Sh NAME | ||
| 38 | .Nm abs | ||
| 39 | .Nd integer absolute value function | ||
| 40 | .Sh SYNOPSIS | ||
| 41 | .Fd #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 42 | .Ft int | ||
| 43 | .Fn abs "int j" | ||
| 44 | .Sh DESCRIPTION | ||
| 45 | The | ||
| 46 | .Fn abs | ||
| 47 | function computes the absolute value of the integer | ||
| 48 | .Fa j . | ||
| 49 | .Sh RETURN VALUES | ||
| 50 | The | ||
| 51 | .Fn abs | ||
| 52 | function returns the absolute value. | ||
| 53 | .Sh SEE ALSO | ||
| 54 | .Xr cabs 3 , | ||
| 55 | .Xr floor 3 , | ||
| 56 | .Xr hypot 3 , | ||
| 57 | .Xr labs 3 , | ||
| 58 | .Xr math 3 | ||
| 59 | .Sh STANDARDS | ||
| 60 | The | ||
| 61 | .Fn abs | ||
| 62 | function conforms to | ||
| 63 | .St -ansiC . | ||
| 64 | .Sh BUGS | ||
| 65 | The absolute value of the most negative integer remains negative. | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/abs.c b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/abs.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..c67ad9494f --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/abs.c | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,41 @@ | |||
| 1 | /*- | ||
| 2 | * Copyright (c) 1990 The Regents of the University of California. | ||
| 3 | * All rights reserved. | ||
| 4 | * | ||
| 5 | * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without | ||
| 6 | * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions | ||
| 7 | * are met: | ||
| 8 | * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright | ||
| 9 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. | ||
| 10 | * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright | ||
| 11 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the | ||
| 12 | * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. | ||
| 13 | * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors | ||
| 14 | * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software | ||
| 15 | * without specific prior written permission. | ||
| 16 | * | ||
| 17 | * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND | ||
| 18 | * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE | ||
| 19 | * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE | ||
| 20 | * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE | ||
| 21 | * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL | ||
| 22 | * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS | ||
| 23 | * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) | ||
| 24 | * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT | ||
| 25 | * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY | ||
| 26 | * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF | ||
| 27 | * SUCH DAMAGE. | ||
| 28 | */ | ||
| 29 | |||
| 30 | #if defined(LIBC_SCCS) && !defined(lint) | ||
| 31 | static char *rcsid = "$OpenBSD: abs.c,v 1.3 2003/06/02 20:18:37 millert Exp $"; | ||
| 32 | #endif /* LIBC_SCCS and not lint */ | ||
| 33 | |||
| 34 | #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 35 | |||
| 36 | int | ||
| 37 | abs(j) | ||
| 38 | int j; | ||
| 39 | { | ||
| 40 | return(j < 0 ? -j : j); | ||
| 41 | } | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/alloca.3 b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/alloca.3 new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..4136dc405c --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/alloca.3 | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,80 @@ | |||
| 1 | .\" Copyright (c) 1980, 1991 Regents of the University of California. | ||
| 2 | .\" All rights reserved. | ||
| 3 | .\" | ||
| 4 | .\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without | ||
| 5 | .\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions | ||
| 6 | .\" are met: | ||
| 7 | .\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright | ||
| 8 | .\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. | ||
| 9 | .\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright | ||
| 10 | .\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the | ||
| 11 | .\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. | ||
| 12 | .\" 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors | ||
| 13 | .\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software | ||
| 14 | .\" without specific prior written permission. | ||
| 15 | .\" | ||
| 16 | .\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND | ||
| 17 | .\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE | ||
| 18 | .\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE | ||
| 19 | .\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE | ||
| 20 | .\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL | ||
| 21 | .\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS | ||
| 22 | .\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) | ||
| 23 | .\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT | ||
| 24 | .\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY | ||
| 25 | .\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF | ||
| 26 | .\" SUCH DAMAGE. | ||
| 27 | .\" | ||
| 28 | .\" $OpenBSD: alloca.3,v 1.10 2003/06/02 20:18:37 millert Exp $ | ||
| 29 | .\" | ||
| 30 | .Dd May 2, 1991 | ||
| 31 | .Dt ALLOCA 3 | ||
| 32 | .Os | ||
| 33 | .Sh NAME | ||
| 34 | .Nm alloca | ||
| 35 | .Nd memory allocator | ||
| 36 | .Sh SYNOPSIS | ||
| 37 | .Fd #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 38 | .Ft void * | ||
| 39 | .Fn alloca "size_t size" | ||
| 40 | .Sh DESCRIPTION | ||
| 41 | The | ||
| 42 | .Fn alloca | ||
| 43 | function allocates | ||
| 44 | .Fa size | ||
| 45 | bytes of space in the stack frame of the caller. | ||
| 46 | This temporary space is automatically freed on return. | ||
| 47 | .Sh RETURN VALUES | ||
| 48 | The | ||
| 49 | .Fn alloca | ||
| 50 | function returns a pointer to the beginning of the allocated space. | ||
| 51 | .Sh SEE ALSO | ||
| 52 | .Xr pagesize 1 , | ||
| 53 | .Xr brk 2 , | ||
| 54 | .Xr calloc 3 , | ||
| 55 | .Xr malloc 3 , | ||
| 56 | .Xr realloc 3 | ||
| 57 | .Sh BUGS | ||
| 58 | The | ||
| 59 | .Fn alloca | ||
| 60 | function is machine dependent; its use is discouraged. | ||
| 61 | .\" .Sh HISTORY | ||
| 62 | .\" The | ||
| 63 | .\" .Fn alloca | ||
| 64 | .\" function appeared in | ||
| 65 | .\" .Bx ?? . | ||
| 66 | .\" The function appeared in 32v, pwb and pwb.2 and in 3bsd 4bsd | ||
| 67 | .\" The first man page (or link to a man page that I can find at the | ||
| 68 | .\" moment is 4.3... | ||
| 69 | .Pp | ||
| 70 | The | ||
| 71 | .Fn alloca | ||
| 72 | function is slightly unsafe because it cannot ensure that the pointer | ||
| 73 | returned points to a valid and usable block of memory. | ||
| 74 | The allocation made may exceed the bounds of the stack, or even go | ||
| 75 | further into other objects in memory, and | ||
| 76 | .Fn alloca | ||
| 77 | cannot determine such an error. | ||
| 78 | Avoid | ||
| 79 | .Fn alloca | ||
| 80 | with large unbounded allocations. | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/atexit.3 b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/atexit.3 new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..c8d4ce63d5 --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/atexit.3 | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,71 @@ | |||
| 1 | .\" Copyright (c) 1990, 1991 The Regents of the University of California. | ||
| 2 | .\" All rights reserved. | ||
| 3 | .\" | ||
| 4 | .\" This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by | ||
| 5 | .\" Chris Torek and the American National Standards Committee X3, | ||
| 6 | .\" on Information Processing Systems. | ||
| 7 | .\" | ||
| 8 | .\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without | ||
| 9 | .\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions | ||
| 10 | .\" are met: | ||
| 11 | .\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright | ||
| 12 | .\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. | ||
| 13 | .\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright | ||
| 14 | .\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the | ||
| 15 | .\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. | ||
| 16 | .\" 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors | ||
| 17 | .\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software | ||
| 18 | .\" without specific prior written permission. | ||
| 19 | .\" | ||
| 20 | .\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND | ||
| 21 | .\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE | ||
| 22 | .\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE | ||
| 23 | .\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE | ||
| 24 | .\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL | ||
| 25 | .\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS | ||
| 26 | .\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) | ||
| 27 | .\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT | ||
| 28 | .\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY | ||
| 29 | .\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF | ||
| 30 | .\" SUCH DAMAGE. | ||
| 31 | .\" | ||
| 32 | .\" $OpenBSD: atexit.3,v 1.5 2003/06/02 20:18:37 millert Exp $ | ||
| 33 | .\" | ||
| 34 | .Dd June 29, 1991 | ||
| 35 | .Dt ATEXIT 3 | ||
| 36 | .Os | ||
| 37 | .Sh NAME | ||
| 38 | .Nm atexit | ||
| 39 | .Nd register a function to be called on exit | ||
| 40 | .Sh SYNOPSIS | ||
| 41 | .Fd #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 42 | .Ft int | ||
| 43 | .Fn atexit "void (*function)(void)" | ||
| 44 | .Sh DESCRIPTION | ||
| 45 | The | ||
| 46 | .Fn atexit | ||
| 47 | function registers the given | ||
| 48 | .Fa function | ||
| 49 | to be called at program exit, whether via | ||
| 50 | .Xr exit 3 | ||
| 51 | or via return from the program's | ||
| 52 | .Fn main . | ||
| 53 | Functions so registered are called in reverse order; | ||
| 54 | no arguments are passed. | ||
| 55 | At least 32 functions can always be registered, | ||
| 56 | and more are allowed as long as sufficient memory can be allocated. | ||
| 57 | .Sh RETURN VALUES | ||
| 58 | .Rv -std atexit | ||
| 59 | .Sh ERRORS | ||
| 60 | .Bl -tag -width Er | ||
| 61 | .It Bq Er ENOMEM | ||
| 62 | No memory was available to add the function to the list. | ||
| 63 | The existing list of functions is unmodified. | ||
| 64 | .El | ||
| 65 | .Sh SEE ALSO | ||
| 66 | .Xr exit 3 | ||
| 67 | .Sh STANDARDS | ||
| 68 | The | ||
| 69 | .Fn atexit | ||
| 70 | function conforms to | ||
| 71 | .St -ansiC . | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/atexit.c b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/atexit.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..98564d0dd3 --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/atexit.c | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,135 @@ | |||
| 1 | /* | ||
| 2 | * Copyright (c) 2002 Daniel Hartmeier | ||
| 3 | * All rights reserved. | ||
| 4 | * | ||
| 5 | * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without | ||
| 6 | * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions | ||
| 7 | * are met: | ||
| 8 | * | ||
| 9 | * - Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright | ||
| 10 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. | ||
| 11 | * - Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above | ||
| 12 | * copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following | ||
| 13 | * disclaimer in the documentation and/or other materials provided | ||
| 14 | * with the distribution. | ||
| 15 | * | ||
| 16 | * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS | ||
| 17 | * "AS IS" AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT | ||
| 18 | * LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS | ||
| 19 | * FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE | ||
| 20 | * COPYRIGHT HOLDERS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, | ||
| 21 | * INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, | ||
| 22 | * BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; | ||
| 23 | * LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER | ||
| 24 | * CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT | ||
| 25 | * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN | ||
| 26 | * ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE | ||
| 27 | * POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. | ||
| 28 | * | ||
| 29 | */ | ||
| 30 | |||
| 31 | #if defined(LIBC_SCCS) && !defined(lint) | ||
| 32 | static char *rcsid = "$OpenBSD: atexit.c,v 1.7 2002/09/14 22:03:14 dhartmei Exp $"; | ||
| 33 | #endif /* LIBC_SCCS and not lint */ | ||
| 34 | |||
| 35 | #include <sys/types.h> | ||
| 36 | #include <sys/mman.h> | ||
| 37 | #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 38 | #include <unistd.h> | ||
| 39 | #include "atexit.h" | ||
| 40 | |||
| 41 | int __atexit_invalid = 1; | ||
| 42 | struct atexit *__atexit; | ||
| 43 | |||
| 44 | /* | ||
| 45 | * Function pointers are stored in a linked list of pages. The list | ||
| 46 | * is initially empty, and pages are allocated on demand. The first | ||
| 47 | * function pointer in the first allocated page (the last one in | ||
| 48 | * the linked list) is reserved for the cleanup function. | ||
| 49 | * | ||
| 50 | * Outside the following two functions, all pages are mprotect()'ed | ||
| 51 | * to prevent unintentional/malicious corruption. | ||
| 52 | * | ||
| 53 | * The free(malloc(1)) is a workaround causing malloc_init() to | ||
| 54 | * ensure that malloc.c gets the first mmap() call for its sbrk() | ||
| 55 | * games. | ||
| 56 | */ | ||
| 57 | |||
| 58 | /* | ||
| 59 | * Register a function to be performed at exit. | ||
| 60 | */ | ||
| 61 | int | ||
| 62 | atexit(fn) | ||
| 63 | void (*fn)(); | ||
| 64 | { | ||
| 65 | register struct atexit *p = __atexit; | ||
| 66 | register int pgsize = getpagesize(); | ||
| 67 | |||
| 68 | if (pgsize < sizeof(*p)) | ||
| 69 | return (-1); | ||
| 70 | if (p != NULL) { | ||
| 71 | if (p->ind + 1 >= p->max) | ||
| 72 | p = NULL; | ||
| 73 | else if (mprotect(p, pgsize, PROT_READ | PROT_WRITE)) | ||
| 74 | return (-1); | ||
| 75 | } | ||
| 76 | if (p == NULL) { | ||
| 77 | if (__atexit_invalid) { | ||
| 78 | free(malloc(1)); | ||
| 79 | __atexit_invalid = 0; | ||
| 80 | } | ||
| 81 | p = mmap(NULL, pgsize, PROT_READ | PROT_WRITE, | ||
| 82 | MAP_ANON | MAP_PRIVATE, -1, 0); | ||
| 83 | if (p == MAP_FAILED) | ||
| 84 | return (-1); | ||
| 85 | if (__atexit == NULL) { | ||
| 86 | p->fns[0] = NULL; | ||
| 87 | p->ind = 1; | ||
| 88 | } else | ||
| 89 | p->ind = 0; | ||
| 90 | p->max = (pgsize - ((char *)&p->fns[0] - (char *)p)) / | ||
| 91 | sizeof(p->fns[0]); | ||
| 92 | p->next = __atexit; | ||
| 93 | __atexit = p; | ||
| 94 | } | ||
| 95 | p->fns[p->ind++] = fn; | ||
| 96 | if (mprotect(p, pgsize, PROT_READ)) | ||
| 97 | return (-1); | ||
| 98 | return (0); | ||
| 99 | } | ||
| 100 | |||
| 101 | /* | ||
| 102 | * Register the cleanup function | ||
| 103 | */ | ||
| 104 | void | ||
| 105 | __atexit_register_cleanup(fn) | ||
| 106 | void (*fn)(); | ||
| 107 | { | ||
| 108 | register struct atexit *p = __atexit; | ||
| 109 | register int pgsize = getpagesize(); | ||
| 110 | |||
| 111 | if (pgsize < sizeof(*p)) | ||
| 112 | return; | ||
| 113 | while (p != NULL && p->next != NULL) | ||
| 114 | p = p->next; | ||
| 115 | if (p == NULL) { | ||
| 116 | if (__atexit_invalid) { | ||
| 117 | free(malloc(1)); | ||
| 118 | __atexit_invalid = 0; | ||
| 119 | } | ||
| 120 | p = mmap(NULL, pgsize, PROT_READ | PROT_WRITE, | ||
| 121 | MAP_ANON | MAP_PRIVATE, -1, 0); | ||
| 122 | if (p == MAP_FAILED) | ||
| 123 | return; | ||
| 124 | p->ind = 1; | ||
| 125 | p->max = (pgsize - ((char *)&p->fns[0] - (char *)p)) / | ||
| 126 | sizeof(p->fns[0]); | ||
| 127 | p->next = NULL; | ||
| 128 | __atexit = p; | ||
| 129 | } else { | ||
| 130 | if (mprotect(p, pgsize, PROT_READ | PROT_WRITE)) | ||
| 131 | return; | ||
| 132 | } | ||
| 133 | p->fns[0] = fn; | ||
| 134 | mprotect(p, pgsize, PROT_READ); | ||
| 135 | } | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/atexit.h b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/atexit.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..21b0c2e532 --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/atexit.h | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,41 @@ | |||
| 1 | /* $OpenBSD: atexit.h,v 1.6 2003/07/31 07:08:42 deraadt Exp $ */ | ||
| 2 | |||
| 3 | /* | ||
| 4 | * Copyright (c) 2002 Daniel Hartmeier | ||
| 5 | * All rights reserved. | ||
| 6 | * | ||
| 7 | * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without | ||
| 8 | * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions | ||
| 9 | * are met: | ||
| 10 | * | ||
| 11 | * - Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright | ||
| 12 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. | ||
| 13 | * - Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above | ||
| 14 | * copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following | ||
| 15 | * disclaimer in the documentation and/or other materials provided | ||
| 16 | * with the distribution. | ||
| 17 | * | ||
| 18 | * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS | ||
| 19 | * "AS IS" AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT | ||
| 20 | * LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS | ||
| 21 | * FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE | ||
| 22 | * COPYRIGHT HOLDERS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, | ||
| 23 | * INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, | ||
| 24 | * BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; | ||
| 25 | * LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER | ||
| 26 | * CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT | ||
| 27 | * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN | ||
| 28 | * ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE | ||
| 29 | * POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. | ||
| 30 | * | ||
| 31 | */ | ||
| 32 | |||
| 33 | struct atexit { | ||
| 34 | struct atexit *next; /* next in list */ | ||
| 35 | int ind; /* next index in this table */ | ||
| 36 | int max; /* max entries >= ATEXIT_SIZE */ | ||
| 37 | void (*fns[1])(void); /* the table itself */ | ||
| 38 | }; | ||
| 39 | |||
| 40 | extern int __atexit_invalid; | ||
| 41 | extern struct atexit *__atexit; /* points to head of LIFO stack */ | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/atof.3 b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/atof.3 new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..c60b9e9fd7 --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/atof.3 | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,69 @@ | |||
| 1 | .\" Copyright (c) 1991 The Regents of the University of California. | ||
| 2 | .\" All rights reserved. | ||
| 3 | .\" | ||
| 4 | .\" This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by | ||
| 5 | .\" the American National Standards Committee X3, on Information | ||
| 6 | .\" Processing Systems. | ||
| 7 | .\" | ||
| 8 | .\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without | ||
| 9 | .\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions | ||
| 10 | .\" are met: | ||
| 11 | .\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright | ||
| 12 | .\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. | ||
| 13 | .\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright | ||
| 14 | .\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the | ||
| 15 | .\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. | ||
| 16 | .\" 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors | ||
| 17 | .\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software | ||
| 18 | .\" without specific prior written permission. | ||
| 19 | .\" | ||
| 20 | .\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND | ||
| 21 | .\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE | ||
| 22 | .\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE | ||
| 23 | .\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE | ||
| 24 | .\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL | ||
| 25 | .\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS | ||
| 26 | .\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) | ||
| 27 | .\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT | ||
| 28 | .\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY | ||
| 29 | .\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF | ||
| 30 | .\" SUCH DAMAGE. | ||
| 31 | .\" | ||
| 32 | .\" $OpenBSD: atof.3,v 1.4 2003/06/02 20:18:37 millert Exp $ | ||
| 33 | .\" | ||
| 34 | .Dd June 29, 1991 | ||
| 35 | .Dt ATOF 3 | ||
| 36 | .Os | ||
| 37 | .Sh NAME | ||
| 38 | .Nm atof | ||
| 39 | .Nd convert | ||
| 40 | .Tn ASCII | ||
| 41 | string to double | ||
| 42 | .Sh SYNOPSIS | ||
| 43 | .Fd #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 44 | .Ft double | ||
| 45 | .Fn atof "const char *nptr" | ||
| 46 | .Sh DESCRIPTION | ||
| 47 | The | ||
| 48 | .Fn atof | ||
| 49 | function converts the initial portion of the string pointed to by | ||
| 50 | .Fa nptr | ||
| 51 | to | ||
| 52 | .Li double | ||
| 53 | representation. | ||
| 54 | .Pp | ||
| 55 | It is equivalent to: | ||
| 56 | .Bd -literal -offset indent | ||
| 57 | strtod(nptr, (char **)NULL); | ||
| 58 | .Ed | ||
| 59 | .Sh SEE ALSO | ||
| 60 | .Xr atoi 3 , | ||
| 61 | .Xr atol 3 , | ||
| 62 | .Xr strtod 3 , | ||
| 63 | .Xr strtol 3 , | ||
| 64 | .Xr strtoul 3 | ||
| 65 | .Sh STANDARDS | ||
| 66 | The | ||
| 67 | .Fn atof | ||
| 68 | function conforms to | ||
| 69 | .St -ansiC . | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/atof.c b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/atof.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..dad2b77bfd --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/atof.c | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,41 @@ | |||
| 1 | /* | ||
| 2 | * Copyright (c) 1988 The Regents of the University of California. | ||
| 3 | * All rights reserved. | ||
| 4 | * | ||
| 5 | * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without | ||
| 6 | * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions | ||
| 7 | * are met: | ||
| 8 | * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright | ||
| 9 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. | ||
| 10 | * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright | ||
| 11 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the | ||
| 12 | * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. | ||
| 13 | * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors | ||
| 14 | * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software | ||
| 15 | * without specific prior written permission. | ||
| 16 | * | ||
| 17 | * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND | ||
| 18 | * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE | ||
| 19 | * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE | ||
| 20 | * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE | ||
| 21 | * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL | ||
| 22 | * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS | ||
| 23 | * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) | ||
| 24 | * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT | ||
| 25 | * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY | ||
| 26 | * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF | ||
| 27 | * SUCH DAMAGE. | ||
| 28 | */ | ||
| 29 | |||
| 30 | #if defined(LIBC_SCCS) && !defined(lint) | ||
| 31 | static char *rcsid = "$OpenBSD: atof.c,v 1.3 2003/06/02 20:18:37 millert Exp $"; | ||
| 32 | #endif /* LIBC_SCCS and not lint */ | ||
| 33 | |||
| 34 | #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 35 | |||
| 36 | double | ||
| 37 | atof(ascii) | ||
| 38 | const char *ascii; | ||
| 39 | { | ||
| 40 | return(strtod(ascii, (char **)NULL)); | ||
| 41 | } | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/atoi.3 b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/atoi.3 new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..070344a810 --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/atoi.3 | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,81 @@ | |||
| 1 | .\" Copyright (c) 1990, 1991, 1993 | ||
| 2 | .\" The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved. | ||
| 3 | .\" | ||
| 4 | .\" This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by | ||
| 5 | .\" the American National Standards Committee X3, on Information | ||
| 6 | .\" Processing Systems. | ||
| 7 | .\" | ||
| 8 | .\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without | ||
| 9 | .\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions | ||
| 10 | .\" are met: | ||
| 11 | .\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright | ||
| 12 | .\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. | ||
| 13 | .\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright | ||
| 14 | .\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the | ||
| 15 | .\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. | ||
| 16 | .\" 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors | ||
| 17 | .\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software | ||
| 18 | .\" without specific prior written permission. | ||
| 19 | .\" | ||
| 20 | .\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND | ||
| 21 | .\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE | ||
| 22 | .\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE | ||
| 23 | .\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE | ||
| 24 | .\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL | ||
| 25 | .\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS | ||
| 26 | .\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) | ||
| 27 | .\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT | ||
| 28 | .\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY | ||
| 29 | .\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF | ||
| 30 | .\" SUCH DAMAGE. | ||
| 31 | .\" | ||
| 32 | .\" $OpenBSD: atoi.3,v 1.7 2003/06/02 20:18:37 millert Exp $ | ||
| 33 | .\" | ||
| 34 | .Dd June 4, 1993 | ||
| 35 | .Dt ATOI 3 | ||
| 36 | .Os | ||
| 37 | .Sh NAME | ||
| 38 | .Nm atoi | ||
| 39 | .Nd convert | ||
| 40 | .Tn ASCII | ||
| 41 | string to integer | ||
| 42 | .Sh SYNOPSIS | ||
| 43 | .Fd #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 44 | .Ft int | ||
| 45 | .Fn atoi "const char *nptr" | ||
| 46 | .Sh DESCRIPTION | ||
| 47 | The | ||
| 48 | .Fn atoi | ||
| 49 | function converts the initial portion of the string pointed to by | ||
| 50 | .Fa nptr | ||
| 51 | to | ||
| 52 | .Li integer | ||
| 53 | representation. | ||
| 54 | .Pp | ||
| 55 | It is equivalent to: | ||
| 56 | .Bd -literal -offset indent | ||
| 57 | (int)strtol(nptr, (char **)NULL, 10); | ||
| 58 | .Ed | ||
| 59 | .Sh SEE ALSO | ||
| 60 | .Xr atof 3 , | ||
| 61 | .Xr atol 3 , | ||
| 62 | .Xr strtod 3 , | ||
| 63 | .Xr strtol 3 , | ||
| 64 | .Xr strtoul 3 | ||
| 65 | .Sh STANDARDS | ||
| 66 | The | ||
| 67 | .Fn atoi | ||
| 68 | function conforms to | ||
| 69 | .St -ansiC . | ||
| 70 | .Sh CAVEATS | ||
| 71 | .Nm | ||
| 72 | does no overflow checking, handles unsigned numbers poorly, | ||
| 73 | and handles strings containing trailing extra characters | ||
| 74 | (like | ||
| 75 | .Dq "123abc" ) | ||
| 76 | poorly. | ||
| 77 | Careful use of | ||
| 78 | .Xr strtol 3 | ||
| 79 | and | ||
| 80 | .Xr strtoul 3 | ||
| 81 | can alleviate these problems. | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/atoi.c b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/atoi.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b1fe789fd5 --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/atoi.c | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,41 @@ | |||
| 1 | /* | ||
| 2 | * Copyright (c) 1988 Regents of the University of California. | ||
| 3 | * All rights reserved. | ||
| 4 | * | ||
| 5 | * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without | ||
| 6 | * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions | ||
| 7 | * are met: | ||
| 8 | * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright | ||
| 9 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. | ||
| 10 | * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright | ||
| 11 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the | ||
| 12 | * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. | ||
| 13 | * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors | ||
| 14 | * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software | ||
| 15 | * without specific prior written permission. | ||
| 16 | * | ||
| 17 | * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND | ||
| 18 | * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE | ||
| 19 | * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE | ||
| 20 | * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE | ||
| 21 | * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL | ||
| 22 | * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS | ||
| 23 | * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) | ||
| 24 | * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT | ||
| 25 | * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY | ||
| 26 | * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF | ||
| 27 | * SUCH DAMAGE. | ||
| 28 | */ | ||
| 29 | |||
| 30 | #if defined(LIBC_SCCS) && !defined(lint) | ||
| 31 | static char *rcsid = "$OpenBSD: atoi.c,v 1.3 2003/06/02 20:18:37 millert Exp $"; | ||
| 32 | #endif /* LIBC_SCCS and not lint */ | ||
| 33 | |||
| 34 | #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 35 | |||
| 36 | int | ||
| 37 | atoi(str) | ||
| 38 | const char *str; | ||
| 39 | { | ||
| 40 | return((int)strtol(str, (char **)NULL, 10)); | ||
| 41 | } | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/atol.3 b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/atol.3 new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..80e54c892d --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/atol.3 | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,70 @@ | |||
| 1 | .\" Copyright (c) 1990, 1991 The Regents of the University of California. | ||
| 2 | .\" All rights reserved. | ||
| 3 | .\" | ||
| 4 | .\" This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by | ||
| 5 | .\" the American National Standards Committee X3, on Information | ||
| 6 | .\" Processing Systems. | ||
| 7 | .\" | ||
| 8 | .\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without | ||
| 9 | .\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions | ||
| 10 | .\" are met: | ||
| 11 | .\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright | ||
| 12 | .\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. | ||
| 13 | .\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright | ||
| 14 | .\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the | ||
| 15 | .\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. | ||
| 16 | .\" 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors | ||
| 17 | .\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software | ||
| 18 | .\" without specific prior written permission. | ||
| 19 | .\" | ||
| 20 | .\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND | ||
| 21 | .\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE | ||
| 22 | .\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE | ||
| 23 | .\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE | ||
| 24 | .\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL | ||
| 25 | .\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS | ||
| 26 | .\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) | ||
| 27 | .\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT | ||
| 28 | .\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY | ||
| 29 | .\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF | ||
| 30 | .\" SUCH DAMAGE. | ||
| 31 | .\" | ||
| 32 | .\" $OpenBSD: atol.3,v 1.6 2003/06/02 20:18:37 millert Exp $ | ||
| 33 | .\" | ||
| 34 | .Dd June 29, 1991 | ||
| 35 | .Dt ATOL 3 | ||
| 36 | .Os | ||
| 37 | .Sh NAME | ||
| 38 | .Nm atol | ||
| 39 | .Nd convert | ||
| 40 | .Tn ASCII | ||
| 41 | string to long integer | ||
| 42 | .Sh SYNOPSIS | ||
| 43 | .Fd #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 44 | .Ft long | ||
| 45 | .Fn atol "const char *nptr" | ||
| 46 | .Sh DESCRIPTION | ||
| 47 | The | ||
| 48 | .Fn atol | ||
| 49 | function converts the initial portion of the string pointed to by | ||
| 50 | .Fa nptr | ||
| 51 | to | ||
| 52 | .Li long integer | ||
| 53 | representation. | ||
| 54 | .Pp | ||
| 55 | It is equivalent to: | ||
| 56 | .Bd -literal -offset indent | ||
| 57 | strtol(nptr, (char **)NULL, 10); | ||
| 58 | .Ed | ||
| 59 | .Sh SEE ALSO | ||
| 60 | .Xr atof 3 , | ||
| 61 | .Xr atoi 3 , | ||
| 62 | .Xr atoll 3 , | ||
| 63 | .Xr strtod 3 , | ||
| 64 | .Xr strtol 3 , | ||
| 65 | .Xr strtoul 3 | ||
| 66 | .Sh STANDARDS | ||
| 67 | The | ||
| 68 | .Fn atol | ||
| 69 | function conforms to | ||
| 70 | .St -ansiC-99 . | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/atol.c b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/atol.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..83adad3eae --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/atol.c | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,41 @@ | |||
| 1 | /* | ||
| 2 | * Copyright (c) 1988 Regents of the University of California. | ||
| 3 | * All rights reserved. | ||
| 4 | * | ||
| 5 | * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without | ||
| 6 | * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions | ||
| 7 | * are met: | ||
| 8 | * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright | ||
| 9 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. | ||
| 10 | * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright | ||
| 11 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the | ||
| 12 | * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. | ||
| 13 | * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors | ||
| 14 | * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software | ||
| 15 | * without specific prior written permission. | ||
| 16 | * | ||
| 17 | * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND | ||
| 18 | * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE | ||
| 19 | * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE | ||
| 20 | * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE | ||
| 21 | * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL | ||
| 22 | * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS | ||
| 23 | * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) | ||
| 24 | * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT | ||
| 25 | * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY | ||
| 26 | * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF | ||
| 27 | * SUCH DAMAGE. | ||
| 28 | */ | ||
| 29 | |||
| 30 | #if defined(LIBC_SCCS) && !defined(lint) | ||
| 31 | static char *rcsid = "$OpenBSD: atol.c,v 1.3 2003/06/02 20:18:37 millert Exp $"; | ||
| 32 | #endif /* LIBC_SCCS and not lint */ | ||
| 33 | |||
| 34 | #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 35 | |||
| 36 | long | ||
| 37 | atol(str) | ||
| 38 | const char *str; | ||
| 39 | { | ||
| 40 | return(strtol(str, (char **)NULL, 10)); | ||
| 41 | } | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/atoll.3 b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/atoll.3 new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..40584e9d47 --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/atoll.3 | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,70 @@ | |||
| 1 | .\" Copyright (c) 1990, 1991 The Regents of the University of California. | ||
| 2 | .\" All rights reserved. | ||
| 3 | .\" | ||
| 4 | .\" This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by | ||
| 5 | .\" the American National Standards Committee X3, on Information | ||
| 6 | .\" Processing Systems. | ||
| 7 | .\" | ||
| 8 | .\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without | ||
| 9 | .\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions | ||
| 10 | .\" are met: | ||
| 11 | .\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright | ||
| 12 | .\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. | ||
| 13 | .\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright | ||
| 14 | .\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the | ||
| 15 | .\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. | ||
| 16 | .\" 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors | ||
| 17 | .\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software | ||
| 18 | .\" without specific prior written permission. | ||
| 19 | .\" | ||
| 20 | .\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND | ||
| 21 | .\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE | ||
| 22 | .\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE | ||
| 23 | .\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE | ||
| 24 | .\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL | ||
| 25 | .\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS | ||
| 26 | .\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) | ||
| 27 | .\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT | ||
| 28 | .\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY | ||
| 29 | .\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF | ||
| 30 | .\" SUCH DAMAGE. | ||
| 31 | .\" | ||
| 32 | .\" $OpenBSD: atoll.3,v 1.3 2003/06/02 20:18:37 millert Exp $ | ||
| 33 | .\" | ||
| 34 | .Dd June 29, 1991 | ||
| 35 | .Dt ATOLL 3 | ||
| 36 | .Os | ||
| 37 | .Sh NAME | ||
| 38 | .Nm atoll | ||
| 39 | .Nd convert | ||
| 40 | .Tn ASCII | ||
| 41 | string to long long integer | ||
| 42 | .Sh SYNOPSIS | ||
| 43 | .Fd #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 44 | .Ft long long | ||
| 45 | .Fn atoll "const char *nptr" | ||
| 46 | .Sh DESCRIPTION | ||
| 47 | The | ||
| 48 | .Fn atoll | ||
| 49 | function converts the initial portion of the string pointed to by | ||
| 50 | .Fa nptr | ||
| 51 | to | ||
| 52 | .Li long integer | ||
| 53 | representation. | ||
| 54 | .Pp | ||
| 55 | It is equivalent to: | ||
| 56 | .Bd -literal -offset indent | ||
| 57 | strtoll(nptr, (char **)NULL, 10); | ||
| 58 | .Ed | ||
| 59 | .Sh SEE ALSO | ||
| 60 | .Xr atof 3 , | ||
| 61 | .Xr atoi 3 , | ||
| 62 | .Xr atol 3 , | ||
| 63 | .Xr strtod 3 , | ||
| 64 | .Xr strtol 3 , | ||
| 65 | .Xr strtoul 3 | ||
| 66 | .Sh STANDARDS | ||
| 67 | The | ||
| 68 | .Fn atoll | ||
| 69 | function conforms to | ||
| 70 | .St -ansiC-99 . | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/atoll.c b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/atoll.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..6786b62e1a --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/atoll.c | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,41 @@ | |||
| 1 | /* | ||
| 2 | * Copyright (c) 1988 Regents of the University of California. | ||
| 3 | * All rights reserved. | ||
| 4 | * | ||
| 5 | * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without | ||
| 6 | * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions | ||
| 7 | * are met: | ||
| 8 | * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright | ||
| 9 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. | ||
| 10 | * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright | ||
| 11 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the | ||
| 12 | * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. | ||
| 13 | * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors | ||
| 14 | * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software | ||
| 15 | * without specific prior written permission. | ||
| 16 | * | ||
| 17 | * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND | ||
| 18 | * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE | ||
| 19 | * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE | ||
| 20 | * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE | ||
| 21 | * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL | ||
| 22 | * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS | ||
| 23 | * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) | ||
| 24 | * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT | ||
| 25 | * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY | ||
| 26 | * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF | ||
| 27 | * SUCH DAMAGE. | ||
| 28 | */ | ||
| 29 | |||
| 30 | #if defined(LIBC_SCCS) && !defined(lint) | ||
| 31 | static char *rcsid = "$OpenBSD: atoll.c,v 1.2 2003/06/02 20:18:37 millert Exp $"; | ||
| 32 | #endif /* LIBC_SCCS and not lint */ | ||
| 33 | |||
| 34 | #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 35 | |||
| 36 | long long | ||
| 37 | atoll(str) | ||
| 38 | const char *str; | ||
| 39 | { | ||
| 40 | return(strtoll(str, (char **)NULL, 10)); | ||
| 41 | } | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/bsearch.3 b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/bsearch.3 new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..d1dd9173db --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/bsearch.3 | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,84 @@ | |||
| 1 | .\" Copyright (c) 1990, 1991, 1993, 1994 | ||
| 2 | .\" The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved. | ||
| 3 | .\" | ||
| 4 | .\" This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by | ||
| 5 | .\" the American National Standards Committee X3, on Information | ||
| 6 | .\" Processing Systems. | ||
| 7 | .\" | ||
| 8 | .\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without | ||
| 9 | .\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions | ||
| 10 | .\" are met: | ||
| 11 | .\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright | ||
| 12 | .\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. | ||
| 13 | .\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright | ||
| 14 | .\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the | ||
| 15 | .\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. | ||
| 16 | .\" 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors | ||
| 17 | .\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software | ||
| 18 | .\" without specific prior written permission. | ||
| 19 | .\" | ||
| 20 | .\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND | ||
| 21 | .\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE | ||
| 22 | .\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE | ||
| 23 | .\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE | ||
| 24 | .\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL | ||
| 25 | .\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS | ||
| 26 | .\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) | ||
| 27 | .\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT | ||
| 28 | .\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY | ||
| 29 | .\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF | ||
| 30 | .\" SUCH DAMAGE. | ||
| 31 | .\" | ||
| 32 | .\" $OpenBSD: bsearch.3,v 1.6 2003/06/02 20:18:37 millert Exp $ | ||
| 33 | .\" | ||
| 34 | .Dd April 19, 1994 | ||
| 35 | .Dt BSEARCH 3 | ||
| 36 | .Os | ||
| 37 | .Sh NAME | ||
| 38 | .Nm bsearch | ||
| 39 | .Nd binary search of a sorted table | ||
| 40 | .Sh SYNOPSIS | ||
| 41 | .Fd #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 42 | .Ft void * | ||
| 43 | .Fn bsearch "const void *key" "const void *base" "size_t nmemb" "size_t size" "int (*compar) (const void *, const void *)" | ||
| 44 | .Sh DESCRIPTION | ||
| 45 | The | ||
| 46 | .Fn bsearch | ||
| 47 | function searches an array of | ||
| 48 | .Fa nmemb | ||
| 49 | objects, the initial member of which is | ||
| 50 | pointed to by | ||
| 51 | .Fa base , | ||
| 52 | for a member that matches the object pointed to by | ||
| 53 | .Fa key . | ||
| 54 | The size of each member of the array is specified by | ||
| 55 | .Fa size . | ||
| 56 | .Pp | ||
| 57 | The contents of the array should be in ascending sorted order according | ||
| 58 | to the comparison function referenced by | ||
| 59 | .Fa compar . | ||
| 60 | The | ||
| 61 | .Fa compar | ||
| 62 | routine is expected to have two arguments which point to the | ||
| 63 | .Fa key | ||
| 64 | object and to an array member, in that order, and should return an integer | ||
| 65 | less than, equal to, or greater than zero if the | ||
| 66 | .Fa key | ||
| 67 | object is found, respectively, to be less than, to match, or be | ||
| 68 | greater than the array member. | ||
| 69 | .Sh RETURN VALUES | ||
| 70 | The | ||
| 71 | .Fn bsearch | ||
| 72 | function returns a pointer to a matching member of the array, or a null | ||
| 73 | pointer if no match is found. | ||
| 74 | If two members compare as equal, which member is matched is unspecified. | ||
| 75 | .Sh SEE ALSO | ||
| 76 | .Xr db 3 , | ||
| 77 | .Xr lsearch 3 , | ||
| 78 | .Xr qsort 3 , | ||
| 79 | .Xr tsearch 3 | ||
| 80 | .Sh STANDARDS | ||
| 81 | The | ||
| 82 | .Fn bsearch | ||
| 83 | function conforms to | ||
| 84 | .St -ansiC . | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/bsearch.c b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/bsearch.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..9bfbf64256 --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/bsearch.c | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,75 @@ | |||
| 1 | /* | ||
| 2 | * Copyright (c) 1990 Regents of the University of California. | ||
| 3 | * All rights reserved. | ||
| 4 | * | ||
| 5 | * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without | ||
| 6 | * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions | ||
| 7 | * are met: | ||
| 8 | * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright | ||
| 9 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. | ||
| 10 | * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright | ||
| 11 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the | ||
| 12 | * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. | ||
| 13 | * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors | ||
| 14 | * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software | ||
| 15 | * without specific prior written permission. | ||
| 16 | * | ||
| 17 | * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND | ||
| 18 | * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE | ||
| 19 | * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE | ||
| 20 | * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE | ||
| 21 | * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL | ||
| 22 | * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS | ||
| 23 | * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) | ||
| 24 | * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT | ||
| 25 | * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY | ||
| 26 | * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF | ||
| 27 | * SUCH DAMAGE. | ||
| 28 | */ | ||
| 29 | |||
| 30 | #if defined(LIBC_SCCS) && !defined(lint) | ||
| 31 | static char *rcsid = "$OpenBSD: bsearch.c,v 1.4 2003/06/02 20:18:37 millert Exp $"; | ||
| 32 | #endif /* LIBC_SCCS and not lint */ | ||
| 33 | |||
| 34 | #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 35 | |||
| 36 | /* | ||
| 37 | * Perform a binary search. | ||
| 38 | * | ||
| 39 | * The code below is a bit sneaky. After a comparison fails, we | ||
| 40 | * divide the work in half by moving either left or right. If lim | ||
| 41 | * is odd, moving left simply involves halving lim: e.g., when lim | ||
| 42 | * is 5 we look at item 2, so we change lim to 2 so that we will | ||
| 43 | * look at items 0 & 1. If lim is even, the same applies. If lim | ||
| 44 | * is odd, moving right again involes halving lim, this time moving | ||
| 45 | * the base up one item past p: e.g., when lim is 5 we change base | ||
| 46 | * to item 3 and make lim 2 so that we will look at items 3 and 4. | ||
| 47 | * If lim is even, however, we have to shrink it by one before | ||
| 48 | * halving: e.g., when lim is 4, we still looked at item 2, so we | ||
| 49 | * have to make lim 3, then halve, obtaining 1, so that we will only | ||
| 50 | * look at item 3. | ||
| 51 | */ | ||
| 52 | void * | ||
| 53 | bsearch(key, base0, nmemb, size, compar) | ||
| 54 | register const void *key; | ||
| 55 | const void *base0; | ||
| 56 | size_t nmemb; | ||
| 57 | register size_t size; | ||
| 58 | register int (*compar)(const void *, const void *); | ||
| 59 | { | ||
| 60 | register const char *base = base0; | ||
| 61 | register int lim, cmp; | ||
| 62 | register const void *p; | ||
| 63 | |||
| 64 | for (lim = nmemb; lim != 0; lim >>= 1) { | ||
| 65 | p = base + (lim >> 1) * size; | ||
| 66 | cmp = (*compar)(key, p); | ||
| 67 | if (cmp == 0) | ||
| 68 | return ((void *)p); | ||
| 69 | if (cmp > 0) { /* key > p: move right */ | ||
| 70 | base = (char *)p + size; | ||
| 71 | lim--; | ||
| 72 | } /* else move left */ | ||
| 73 | } | ||
| 74 | return (NULL); | ||
| 75 | } | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/calloc.c b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/calloc.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b0703cc884 --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/calloc.c | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,55 @@ | |||
| 1 | /*- | ||
| 2 | * Copyright (c) 1990 The Regents of the University of California. | ||
| 3 | * All rights reserved. | ||
| 4 | * | ||
| 5 | * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without | ||
| 6 | * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions | ||
| 7 | * are met: | ||
| 8 | * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright | ||
| 9 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. | ||
| 10 | * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright | ||
| 11 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the | ||
| 12 | * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. | ||
| 13 | * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors | ||
| 14 | * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software | ||
| 15 | * without specific prior written permission. | ||
| 16 | * | ||
| 17 | * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND | ||
| 18 | * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE | ||
| 19 | * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE | ||
| 20 | * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE | ||
| 21 | * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL | ||
| 22 | * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS | ||
| 23 | * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) | ||
| 24 | * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT | ||
| 25 | * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY | ||
| 26 | * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF | ||
| 27 | * SUCH DAMAGE. | ||
| 28 | */ | ||
| 29 | |||
| 30 | #if defined(LIBC_SCCS) && !defined(lint) | ||
| 31 | static char *rcsid = "$OpenBSD: calloc.c,v 1.8 2003/06/02 20:18:37 millert Exp $"; | ||
| 32 | #endif /* LIBC_SCCS and not lint */ | ||
| 33 | |||
| 34 | #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 35 | #include <string.h> | ||
| 36 | #include <limits.h> | ||
| 37 | #include <errno.h> | ||
| 38 | |||
| 39 | void * | ||
| 40 | calloc(num, size) | ||
| 41 | size_t num; | ||
| 42 | register size_t size; | ||
| 43 | { | ||
| 44 | register void *p; | ||
| 45 | |||
| 46 | if (num && size && SIZE_T_MAX / num < size) { | ||
| 47 | errno = ENOMEM; | ||
| 48 | return NULL; | ||
| 49 | } | ||
| 50 | size *= num; | ||
| 51 | p = malloc(size); | ||
| 52 | if (p) | ||
| 53 | memset(p, 0, size); | ||
| 54 | return(p); | ||
| 55 | } | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/cfree.c b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/cfree.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..ecbc11d6c3 --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/cfree.c | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,45 @@ | |||
| 1 | /* $OpenBSD: cfree.c,v 1.3 2003/07/18 23:05:13 david Exp $ */ | ||
| 2 | |||
| 3 | /* | ||
| 4 | * Copyright (c) 1996 SigmaSoft, Th. Lockert <tholo@sigmasoft.com> | ||
| 5 | * All rights reserved. | ||
| 6 | * | ||
| 7 | * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without | ||
| 8 | * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions | ||
| 9 | * are met: | ||
| 10 | * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright | ||
| 11 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. | ||
| 12 | * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright | ||
| 13 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the | ||
| 14 | * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. | ||
| 15 | * | ||
| 16 | * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, | ||
| 17 | * INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY | ||
| 18 | * AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL | ||
| 19 | * THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, | ||
| 20 | * EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, | ||
| 21 | * PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; | ||
| 22 | * OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, | ||
| 23 | * WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR | ||
| 24 | * OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF | ||
| 25 | * ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. | ||
| 26 | */ | ||
| 27 | |||
| 28 | #if defined(LIBC_SCCS) && !defined(lint) | ||
| 29 | static char rcsid[] = "$OpenBSD: cfree.c,v 1.3 2003/07/18 23:05:13 david Exp $"; | ||
| 30 | #endif /* LIBC_SCCS and not lint */ | ||
| 31 | |||
| 32 | #include <sys/cdefs.h> | ||
| 33 | #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 34 | |||
| 35 | #ifdef __indr_reference | ||
| 36 | __indr_reference(free, cfree); | ||
| 37 | #else | ||
| 38 | |||
| 39 | void | ||
| 40 | cfree(p) | ||
| 41 | void *p; | ||
| 42 | { | ||
| 43 | free(p); | ||
| 44 | } | ||
| 45 | #endif | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/div.3 b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/div.3 new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..a75614310e --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/div.3 | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,63 @@ | |||
| 1 | .\" Copyright (c) 1990, 1991 The Regents of the University of California. | ||
| 2 | .\" All rights reserved. | ||
| 3 | .\" | ||
| 4 | .\" This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by | ||
| 5 | .\" Chris Torek. | ||
| 6 | .\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without | ||
| 7 | .\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions | ||
| 8 | .\" are met: | ||
| 9 | .\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright | ||
| 10 | .\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. | ||
| 11 | .\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright | ||
| 12 | .\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the | ||
| 13 | .\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. | ||
| 14 | .\" 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors | ||
| 15 | .\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software | ||
| 16 | .\" without specific prior written permission. | ||
| 17 | .\" | ||
| 18 | .\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND | ||
| 19 | .\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE | ||
| 20 | .\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE | ||
| 21 | .\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE | ||
| 22 | .\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL | ||
| 23 | .\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS | ||
| 24 | .\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) | ||
| 25 | .\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT | ||
| 26 | .\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY | ||
| 27 | .\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF | ||
| 28 | .\" SUCH DAMAGE. | ||
| 29 | .\" | ||
| 30 | .\" $OpenBSD: div.3,v 1.7 2004/01/23 23:08:46 jmc Exp $ | ||
| 31 | .\" | ||
| 32 | .Dd April 19, 1991 | ||
| 33 | .Dt DIV 3 | ||
| 34 | .Os | ||
| 35 | .Sh NAME | ||
| 36 | .Nm div | ||
| 37 | .Nd return quotient and remainder from division | ||
| 38 | .Sh SYNOPSIS | ||
| 39 | .Fd #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 40 | .Ft div_t | ||
| 41 | .Fn div "int num" "int denom" | ||
| 42 | .Sh DESCRIPTION | ||
| 43 | The | ||
| 44 | .Fn div | ||
| 45 | function computes the value | ||
| 46 | .Fa num Ns / Ns Fa denom | ||
| 47 | and returns the quotient and remainder in a structure named | ||
| 48 | .Fa div_t | ||
| 49 | that contains two | ||
| 50 | .Li int | ||
| 51 | members named | ||
| 52 | .Fa quot | ||
| 53 | and | ||
| 54 | .Fa rem . | ||
| 55 | .Sh SEE ALSO | ||
| 56 | .Xr ldiv 3 , | ||
| 57 | .Xr math 3 , | ||
| 58 | .Xr qdiv 3 | ||
| 59 | .Sh STANDARDS | ||
| 60 | The | ||
| 61 | .Fn div | ||
| 62 | function conforms to | ||
| 63 | .St -ansiC . | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/div.c b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/div.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..9e070dcd64 --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/div.c | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,75 @@ | |||
| 1 | /* | ||
| 2 | * Copyright (c) 1990 Regents of the University of California. | ||
| 3 | * All rights reserved. | ||
| 4 | * | ||
| 5 | * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by | ||
| 6 | * Chris Torek. | ||
| 7 | * | ||
| 8 | * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without | ||
| 9 | * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions | ||
| 10 | * are met: | ||
| 11 | * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright | ||
| 12 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. | ||
| 13 | * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright | ||
| 14 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the | ||
| 15 | * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. | ||
| 16 | * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors | ||
| 17 | * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software | ||
| 18 | * without specific prior written permission. | ||
| 19 | * | ||
| 20 | * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND | ||
| 21 | * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE | ||
| 22 | * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE | ||
| 23 | * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE | ||
| 24 | * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL | ||
| 25 | * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS | ||
| 26 | * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) | ||
| 27 | * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT | ||
| 28 | * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY | ||
| 29 | * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF | ||
| 30 | * SUCH DAMAGE. | ||
| 31 | */ | ||
| 32 | |||
| 33 | #if defined(LIBC_SCCS) && !defined(lint) | ||
| 34 | static char *rcsid = "$OpenBSD: div.c,v 1.3 2003/06/02 20:18:37 millert Exp $"; | ||
| 35 | #endif /* LIBC_SCCS and not lint */ | ||
| 36 | |||
| 37 | #include <stdlib.h> /* div_t */ | ||
| 38 | |||
| 39 | div_t | ||
| 40 | div(num, denom) | ||
| 41 | int num, denom; | ||
| 42 | { | ||
| 43 | div_t r; | ||
| 44 | |||
| 45 | r.quot = num / denom; | ||
| 46 | r.rem = num % denom; | ||
| 47 | /* | ||
| 48 | * The ANSI standard says that |r.quot| <= |n/d|, where | ||
| 49 | * n/d is to be computed in infinite precision. In other | ||
| 50 | * words, we should always truncate the quotient towards | ||
| 51 | * 0, never -infinity. | ||
| 52 | * | ||
| 53 | * Machine division and remainer may work either way when | ||
| 54 | * one or both of n or d is negative. If only one is | ||
| 55 | * negative and r.quot has been truncated towards -inf, | ||
| 56 | * r.rem will have the same sign as denom and the opposite | ||
| 57 | * sign of num; if both are negative and r.quot has been | ||
| 58 | * truncated towards -inf, r.rem will be positive (will | ||
| 59 | * have the opposite sign of num). These are considered | ||
| 60 | * `wrong'. | ||
| 61 | * | ||
| 62 | * If both are num and denom are positive, r will always | ||
| 63 | * be positive. | ||
| 64 | * | ||
| 65 | * This all boils down to: | ||
| 66 | * if num >= 0, but r.rem < 0, we got the wrong answer. | ||
| 67 | * In that case, to get the right answer, add 1 to r.quot and | ||
| 68 | * subtract denom from r.rem. | ||
| 69 | */ | ||
| 70 | if (num >= 0 && r.rem < 0) { | ||
| 71 | r.quot++; | ||
| 72 | r.rem -= denom; | ||
| 73 | } | ||
| 74 | return (r); | ||
| 75 | } | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/drand48.c b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/drand48.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..02886d5b62 --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/drand48.c | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,26 @@ | |||
| 1 | /* | ||
| 2 | * Copyright (c) 1993 Martin Birgmeier | ||
| 3 | * All rights reserved. | ||
| 4 | * | ||
| 5 | * You may redistribute unmodified or modified versions of this source | ||
| 6 | * code provided that the above copyright notice and this and the | ||
| 7 | * following conditions are retained. | ||
| 8 | * | ||
| 9 | * This software is provided ``as is'', and comes with no warranties | ||
| 10 | * of any kind. I shall in no event be liable for anything that happens | ||
| 11 | * to anyone/anything when using this software. | ||
| 12 | */ | ||
| 13 | |||
| 14 | #if defined(LIBC_SCCS) && !defined(lint) | ||
| 15 | static char rcsid[] = "$OpenBSD: drand48.c,v 1.2 1996/08/19 08:33:29 tholo Exp $"; | ||
| 16 | #endif /* LIBC_SCCS and not lint */ | ||
| 17 | |||
| 18 | #include "rand48.h" | ||
| 19 | |||
| 20 | extern unsigned short __rand48_seed[3]; | ||
| 21 | |||
| 22 | double | ||
| 23 | drand48(void) | ||
| 24 | { | ||
| 25 | return erand48(__rand48_seed); | ||
| 26 | } | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/ecvt.3 b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/ecvt.3 new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..689cb1c6f9 --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/ecvt.3 | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,165 @@ | |||
| 1 | .\" $OpenBSD: ecvt.3,v 1.7 2004/01/25 14:48:32 jmc Exp $ | ||
| 2 | .\" | ||
| 3 | .\" Copyright (c) 2002 Todd C. Miller <Todd.Miller@courtesan.com> | ||
| 4 | .\" | ||
| 5 | .\" Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software for any | ||
| 6 | .\" purpose with or without fee is hereby granted, provided that the above | ||
| 7 | .\" copyright notice and this permission notice appear in all copies. | ||
| 8 | .\" | ||
| 9 | .\" THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS" AND THE AUTHOR DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES | ||
| 10 | .\" WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF | ||
| 11 | .\" MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR | ||
| 12 | .\" ANY SPECIAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES | ||
| 13 | .\" WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN AN | ||
| 14 | .\" ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING OUT OF | ||
| 15 | .\" OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE. | ||
| 16 | .\" | ||
| 17 | .\" Sponsored in part by the Defense Advanced Research Projects | ||
| 18 | .\" Agency (DARPA) and Air Force Research Laboratory, Air Force | ||
| 19 | .\" Materiel Command, USAF, under agreement number F39502-99-1-0512. | ||
| 20 | .\" | ||
| 21 | .Dd December 1, 2002 | ||
| 22 | .Dt ECVT 3 | ||
| 23 | .Os | ||
| 24 | .Sh NAME | ||
| 25 | .Nm ecvt , | ||
| 26 | .Nm fcvt , | ||
| 27 | .Nm gcvt | ||
| 28 | .Nd convert double to | ||
| 29 | .Tn ASCII | ||
| 30 | string | ||
| 31 | .Sh SYNOPSIS | ||
| 32 | .Fd #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 33 | .Ft char * | ||
| 34 | .Fn ecvt "double value" "int ndigit" "int *decpt" "int *sign" | ||
| 35 | .Ft char * | ||
| 36 | .Fn fcvt "double value" "int ndigit" "int *decpt" "int *sign" | ||
| 37 | .Ft char * | ||
| 38 | .Fn gcvt "double value" "int ndigit" "char *buf" | ||
| 39 | .Sh DESCRIPTION | ||
| 40 | .Bf -symbolic | ||
| 41 | These functions are provided for compatibility with legacy code. | ||
| 42 | New code should use the | ||
| 43 | .Xr snprintf 3 | ||
| 44 | function for improved safety and portability. | ||
| 45 | .Ef | ||
| 46 | .Pp | ||
| 47 | The | ||
| 48 | .Fn ecvt , | ||
| 49 | .Fn fcvt | ||
| 50 | and | ||
| 51 | .Fn gcvt | ||
| 52 | functions convert the double precision floating-point number | ||
| 53 | .Fa value | ||
| 54 | to a NUL-terminated | ||
| 55 | .Tn ASCII | ||
| 56 | string. | ||
| 57 | .Pp | ||
| 58 | The | ||
| 59 | .Fn ecvt | ||
| 60 | function converts | ||
| 61 | .Fa value | ||
| 62 | to a NUL-terminated string of exactly | ||
| 63 | .Fa ndigit | ||
| 64 | digits and returns a pointer to that string. | ||
| 65 | The result is padded with zeroes from left to right as needed. | ||
| 66 | There are no leading zeroes unless | ||
| 67 | .Fa value | ||
| 68 | itself is 0. | ||
| 69 | The least significant digit is rounded in an implementation-dependent manner. | ||
| 70 | The position of the decimal point relative to the beginning of the string | ||
| 71 | is stored in | ||
| 72 | .Fa decpt . | ||
| 73 | A negative value indicates that the decimal point is located | ||
| 74 | to the left of the returned digits (this occurs when there is no | ||
| 75 | whole number component to | ||
| 76 | .Fa value ) . | ||
| 77 | If | ||
| 78 | .Fa value | ||
| 79 | is zero, it is unspecified whether the integer pointed to by | ||
| 80 | .Fa decpt | ||
| 81 | will be 0 or 1. | ||
| 82 | The decimal point itself is not included in the returned string. | ||
| 83 | If the sign of the result is negative, the integer pointed to by | ||
| 84 | .Fa sign | ||
| 85 | is non-zero; otherwise, it is 0. | ||
| 86 | .Pp | ||
| 87 | If the converted value is out of range or is not representable, | ||
| 88 | the contents of the returned string are unspecified. | ||
| 89 | .Pp | ||
| 90 | The | ||
| 91 | .Fn fcvt | ||
| 92 | function is identical to | ||
| 93 | .Fn ecvt | ||
| 94 | with the exception that | ||
| 95 | .Fa ndigit | ||
| 96 | specifies the number of digits after the decimal point (zero-padded as | ||
| 97 | needed). | ||
| 98 | .Pp | ||
| 99 | The | ||
| 100 | .Fn gcvt | ||
| 101 | function converts | ||
| 102 | .Fa value | ||
| 103 | to a NUL-terminated string similar to the %g | ||
| 104 | .Xr printf 3 | ||
| 105 | format specifier and stores the result in | ||
| 106 | .Fa buf . | ||
| 107 | It produces | ||
| 108 | .Fa ndigit | ||
| 109 | significant digits similar to the %f | ||
| 110 | .Xr printf 3 | ||
| 111 | format specifier where possible. | ||
| 112 | If | ||
| 113 | .Fa ndigit | ||
| 114 | does allow sufficient precision, the result is stored in | ||
| 115 | exponential notation similar to the %e | ||
| 116 | .Xr printf 3 | ||
| 117 | format specifier. | ||
| 118 | If | ||
| 119 | .Fa value | ||
| 120 | is less than zero, | ||
| 121 | .Fa buf | ||
| 122 | will be prefixed with a minus sign. | ||
| 123 | A decimal point is included in the returned string if | ||
| 124 | .Fa value | ||
| 125 | is not a whole number. | ||
| 126 | Unlike the | ||
| 127 | .Fn ecvt | ||
| 128 | and | ||
| 129 | .Fn fcvt | ||
| 130 | functions, | ||
| 131 | .Fa buf | ||
| 132 | is not zero-padded. | ||
| 133 | .Sh RETURN VALUES | ||
| 134 | The | ||
| 135 | .Fn ecvt , | ||
| 136 | .Fn fcvt | ||
| 137 | and | ||
| 138 | .Fn gcvt | ||
| 139 | functions return a NUL-terminated string representation of | ||
| 140 | .Fa value . | ||
| 141 | .Sh WARNINGS | ||
| 142 | The | ||
| 143 | .Fn ecvt | ||
| 144 | and | ||
| 145 | .Fn fcvt | ||
| 146 | functions return a pointer to internal storage space that will be | ||
| 147 | overwritten by subsequent calls to either function. | ||
| 148 | .Pp | ||
| 149 | The maximum possible precision of the return value is limited by the | ||
| 150 | precision of a double and may not be the same on all architectures. | ||
| 151 | .Pp | ||
| 152 | The | ||
| 153 | .Xr snprintf 3 | ||
| 154 | function is preferred over these functions for new code. | ||
| 155 | .Sh SEE ALSO | ||
| 156 | .Xr printf 3 , | ||
| 157 | .Xr strtod 3 | ||
| 158 | .Sh STANDARDS | ||
| 159 | The | ||
| 160 | .Fn ecvt , | ||
| 161 | .Fn fcvt | ||
| 162 | and | ||
| 163 | .Fn gcvt | ||
| 164 | functions conform to | ||
| 165 | .St -p1003.1-2001 . | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/ecvt.c b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/ecvt.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..657c531808 --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/ecvt.c | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,103 @@ | |||
| 1 | /* $OpenBSD: ecvt.c,v 1.3 2003/06/17 21:56:24 millert Exp $ */ | ||
| 2 | |||
| 3 | /* | ||
| 4 | * Copyright (c) 2002 Todd C. Miller <Todd.Miller@courtesan.com> | ||
| 5 | * | ||
| 6 | * Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software for any | ||
| 7 | * purpose with or without fee is hereby granted, provided that the above | ||
| 8 | * copyright notice and this permission notice appear in all copies. | ||
| 9 | * | ||
| 10 | * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS" AND THE AUTHOR DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES | ||
| 11 | * WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF | ||
| 12 | * MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR | ||
| 13 | * ANY SPECIAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES | ||
| 14 | * WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN AN | ||
| 15 | * ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING OUT OF | ||
| 16 | * OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE. | ||
| 17 | * | ||
| 18 | * Sponsored in part by the Defense Advanced Research Projects | ||
| 19 | * Agency (DARPA) and Air Force Research Laboratory, Air Force | ||
| 20 | * Materiel Command, USAF, under agreement number F39502-99-1-0512. | ||
| 21 | */ | ||
| 22 | |||
| 23 | #if defined(LIBC_SCCS) && !defined(lint) | ||
| 24 | static char rcsid[] = "$OpenBSD: ecvt.c,v 1.3 2003/06/17 21:56:24 millert Exp $"; | ||
| 25 | #endif /* LIBC_SCCS and not lint */ | ||
| 26 | |||
| 27 | #include <stdio.h> | ||
| 28 | #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 29 | #include <string.h> | ||
| 30 | |||
| 31 | extern char *__dtoa(double, int, int, int *, int *, char **); | ||
| 32 | static char *__cvt(double, int, int *, int *, int, int); | ||
| 33 | |||
| 34 | static char * | ||
| 35 | __cvt(double value, int ndigit, int *decpt, int *sign, int fmode, int pad) | ||
| 36 | { | ||
| 37 | static char *s; | ||
| 38 | char *p, *rve; | ||
| 39 | size_t siz; | ||
| 40 | |||
| 41 | if (ndigit == 0) { | ||
| 42 | *sign = value < 0.0; | ||
| 43 | *decpt = 0; | ||
| 44 | return (""); | ||
| 45 | } | ||
| 46 | |||
| 47 | if (s) { | ||
| 48 | free(s); | ||
| 49 | s = NULL; | ||
| 50 | } | ||
| 51 | |||
| 52 | if (ndigit < 0) | ||
| 53 | siz = -ndigit + 1; | ||
| 54 | else | ||
| 55 | siz = ndigit + 1; | ||
| 56 | |||
| 57 | |||
| 58 | /* __dtoa() doesn't allocate space for 0 so we do it by hand */ | ||
| 59 | if (value == 0.0) { | ||
| 60 | *decpt = 1 - fmode; /* 1 for 'e', 0 for 'f' */ | ||
| 61 | *sign = 0; | ||
| 62 | if ((rve = s = (char *)malloc(siz)) == NULL) | ||
| 63 | return(NULL); | ||
| 64 | *rve++ = '0'; | ||
| 65 | *rve = '\0'; | ||
| 66 | } else { | ||
| 67 | p = __dtoa(value, fmode + 2, ndigit, decpt, sign, &rve); | ||
| 68 | if (*decpt == 9999) { | ||
| 69 | /* Nan or Infinity */ | ||
| 70 | *decpt = 0; | ||
| 71 | return(p); | ||
| 72 | } | ||
| 73 | /* make a local copy and adjust rve to be in terms of s */ | ||
| 74 | if (pad && fmode) | ||
| 75 | siz += *decpt; | ||
| 76 | if ((s = (char *)malloc(siz)) == NULL) | ||
| 77 | return(NULL); | ||
| 78 | (void) strlcpy(s, p, siz); | ||
| 79 | rve = s + (rve - p); | ||
| 80 | } | ||
| 81 | |||
| 82 | /* Add trailing zeros (unless we got NaN or Inf) */ | ||
| 83 | if (pad && *decpt != 9999) { | ||
| 84 | siz -= rve - s; | ||
| 85 | while (--siz) | ||
| 86 | *rve++ = '0'; | ||
| 87 | *rve = '\0'; | ||
| 88 | } | ||
| 89 | |||
| 90 | return(s); | ||
| 91 | } | ||
| 92 | |||
| 93 | char * | ||
| 94 | ecvt(double value, int ndigit, int *decpt, int *sign) | ||
| 95 | { | ||
| 96 | return(__cvt(value, ndigit, decpt, sign, 0, 1)); | ||
| 97 | } | ||
| 98 | |||
| 99 | char * | ||
| 100 | fcvt(double value, int ndigit, int *decpt, int *sign) | ||
| 101 | { | ||
| 102 | return(__cvt(value, ndigit, decpt, sign, 1, 1)); | ||
| 103 | } | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/erand48.c b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/erand48.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b92dacffcc --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/erand48.c | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,27 @@ | |||
| 1 | /* | ||
| 2 | * Copyright (c) 1993 Martin Birgmeier | ||
| 3 | * All rights reserved. | ||
| 4 | * | ||
| 5 | * You may redistribute unmodified or modified versions of this source | ||
| 6 | * code provided that the above copyright notice and this and the | ||
| 7 | * following conditions are retained. | ||
| 8 | * | ||
| 9 | * This software is provided ``as is'', and comes with no warranties | ||
| 10 | * of any kind. I shall in no event be liable for anything that happens | ||
| 11 | * to anyone/anything when using this software. | ||
| 12 | */ | ||
| 13 | |||
| 14 | #if defined(LIBC_SCCS) && !defined(lint) | ||
| 15 | static char rcsid[] = "$OpenBSD: erand48.c,v 1.2 1996/08/19 08:33:29 tholo Exp $"; | ||
| 16 | #endif /* LIBC_SCCS and not lint */ | ||
| 17 | |||
| 18 | #include "rand48.h" | ||
| 19 | |||
| 20 | double | ||
| 21 | erand48(unsigned short xseed[3]) | ||
| 22 | { | ||
| 23 | __dorand48(xseed); | ||
| 24 | return ldexp((double) xseed[0], -48) + | ||
| 25 | ldexp((double) xseed[1], -32) + | ||
| 26 | ldexp((double) xseed[2], -16); | ||
| 27 | } | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/exit.3 b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/exit.3 new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..8c4b2eed2c --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/exit.3 | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,89 @@ | |||
| 1 | .\" Copyright (c) 1990, 1991 The Regents of the University of California. | ||
| 2 | .\" All rights reserved. | ||
| 3 | .\" | ||
| 4 | .\" This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by | ||
| 5 | .\" the American National Standards Committee X3, on Information | ||
| 6 | .\" Processing Systems. | ||
| 7 | .\" | ||
| 8 | .\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without | ||
| 9 | .\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions | ||
| 10 | .\" are met: | ||
| 11 | .\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright | ||
| 12 | .\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. | ||
| 13 | .\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright | ||
| 14 | .\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the | ||
| 15 | .\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. | ||
| 16 | .\" 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors | ||
| 17 | .\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software | ||
| 18 | .\" without specific prior written permission. | ||
| 19 | .\" | ||
| 20 | .\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND | ||
| 21 | .\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE | ||
| 22 | .\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE | ||
| 23 | .\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE | ||
| 24 | .\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL | ||
| 25 | .\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS | ||
| 26 | .\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) | ||
| 27 | .\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT | ||
| 28 | .\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY | ||
| 29 | .\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF | ||
| 30 | .\" SUCH DAMAGE. | ||
| 31 | .\" | ||
| 32 | .\" $OpenBSD: exit.3,v 1.9 2003/06/02 20:18:37 millert Exp $ | ||
| 33 | .\" | ||
| 34 | .Dd June 29, 1991 | ||
| 35 | .Dt EXIT 3 | ||
| 36 | .Os | ||
| 37 | .Sh NAME | ||
| 38 | .Nm exit | ||
| 39 | .Nd perform normal program termination | ||
| 40 | .Sh SYNOPSIS | ||
| 41 | .Fd #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 42 | .Ft void | ||
| 43 | .Fn exit "int status" | ||
| 44 | .Sh DESCRIPTION | ||
| 45 | The | ||
| 46 | .Fn exit | ||
| 47 | function terminates a process. | ||
| 48 | .Pp | ||
| 49 | Before termination it performs the following functions in the | ||
| 50 | order listed: | ||
| 51 | .Bl -enum -offset indent | ||
| 52 | .It | ||
| 53 | Call the functions registered with the | ||
| 54 | .Xr atexit 3 | ||
| 55 | function, in the reverse order of their registration. | ||
| 56 | .It | ||
| 57 | Flush all open output streams. | ||
| 58 | .It | ||
| 59 | Close all open streams. | ||
| 60 | .It | ||
| 61 | Unlink all files created with the | ||
| 62 | .Xr tmpfile 3 | ||
| 63 | function. | ||
| 64 | .El | ||
| 65 | .Pp | ||
| 66 | Following this, | ||
| 67 | .Fn exit | ||
| 68 | calls | ||
| 69 | .Xr _exit 2 . | ||
| 70 | Note that typically | ||
| 71 | .Xr _exit 2 | ||
| 72 | only passes the lower 8 bits of | ||
| 73 | .Fa status | ||
| 74 | on to the parent, thus negative values have less meaning. | ||
| 75 | .Sh RETURN VALUES | ||
| 76 | The | ||
| 77 | .Fn exit | ||
| 78 | function never returns. | ||
| 79 | .Sh SEE ALSO | ||
| 80 | .Xr _exit 2 , | ||
| 81 | .Xr atexit 3 , | ||
| 82 | .Xr intro 3 , | ||
| 83 | .Xr sysexits 3 , | ||
| 84 | .Xr tmpfile 3 | ||
| 85 | .Sh STANDARDS | ||
| 86 | The | ||
| 87 | .Fn exit | ||
| 88 | function conforms to | ||
| 89 | .St -ansiC . | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/exit.c b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/exit.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..a75b32abeb --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/exit.c | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,73 @@ | |||
| 1 | /*- | ||
| 2 | * Copyright (c) 1990 The Regents of the University of California. | ||
| 3 | * All rights reserved. | ||
| 4 | * | ||
| 5 | * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without | ||
| 6 | * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions | ||
| 7 | * are met: | ||
| 8 | * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright | ||
| 9 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. | ||
| 10 | * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright | ||
| 11 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the | ||
| 12 | * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. | ||
| 13 | * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors | ||
| 14 | * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software | ||
| 15 | * without specific prior written permission. | ||
| 16 | * | ||
| 17 | * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND | ||
| 18 | * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE | ||
| 19 | * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE | ||
| 20 | * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE | ||
| 21 | * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL | ||
| 22 | * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS | ||
| 23 | * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) | ||
| 24 | * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT | ||
| 25 | * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY | ||
| 26 | * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF | ||
| 27 | * SUCH DAMAGE. | ||
| 28 | */ | ||
| 29 | |||
| 30 | #if defined(LIBC_SCCS) && !defined(lint) | ||
| 31 | static char *rcsid = "$OpenBSD: exit.c,v 1.9 2003/06/02 20:18:37 millert Exp $"; | ||
| 32 | #endif /* LIBC_SCCS and not lint */ | ||
| 33 | |||
| 34 | #include <sys/types.h> | ||
| 35 | #include <sys/mman.h> | ||
| 36 | #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 37 | #include <unistd.h> | ||
| 38 | #include "atexit.h" | ||
| 39 | #include "thread_private.h" | ||
| 40 | |||
| 41 | /* | ||
| 42 | * This variable is zero until a process has created a thread. | ||
| 43 | * It is used to avoid calling locking functions in libc when they | ||
| 44 | * are not required. By default, libc is intended to be(come) | ||
| 45 | * thread-safe, but without a (significant) penalty to non-threaded | ||
| 46 | * processes. | ||
| 47 | */ | ||
| 48 | int __isthreaded = 0; | ||
| 49 | |||
| 50 | /* | ||
| 51 | * Exit, flushing stdio buffers if necessary. | ||
| 52 | */ | ||
| 53 | void | ||
| 54 | exit(status) | ||
| 55 | int status; | ||
| 56 | { | ||
| 57 | register struct atexit *p, *q; | ||
| 58 | register int n, pgsize = getpagesize(); | ||
| 59 | |||
| 60 | if (!__atexit_invalid) { | ||
| 61 | p = __atexit; | ||
| 62 | while (p != NULL) { | ||
| 63 | for (n = p->ind; --n >= 0;) | ||
| 64 | if (p->fns[n] != NULL) | ||
| 65 | (*p->fns[n])(); | ||
| 66 | q = p; | ||
| 67 | p = p->next; | ||
| 68 | munmap(q, pgsize); | ||
| 69 | } | ||
| 70 | } | ||
| 71 | /* cleanup, if registered, was called through fns[0] in the last page */ | ||
| 72 | _exit(status); | ||
| 73 | } | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/gcvt.c b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/gcvt.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..9fd664b346 --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/gcvt.c | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,99 @@ | |||
| 1 | /* $OpenBSD: gcvt.c,v 1.5 2003/06/17 21:56:24 millert Exp $ */ | ||
| 2 | |||
| 3 | /* | ||
| 4 | * Copyright (c) 2002, 2003 Todd C. Miller <Todd.Miller@courtesan.com> | ||
| 5 | * | ||
| 6 | * Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software for any | ||
| 7 | * purpose with or without fee is hereby granted, provided that the above | ||
| 8 | * copyright notice and this permission notice appear in all copies. | ||
| 9 | * | ||
| 10 | * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS" AND THE AUTHOR DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES | ||
| 11 | * WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF | ||
| 12 | * MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR | ||
| 13 | * ANY SPECIAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES | ||
| 14 | * WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN AN | ||
| 15 | * ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING OUT OF | ||
| 16 | * OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE. | ||
| 17 | * | ||
| 18 | * Sponsored in part by the Defense Advanced Research Projects | ||
| 19 | * Agency (DARPA) and Air Force Research Laboratory, Air Force | ||
| 20 | * Materiel Command, USAF, under agreement number F39502-99-1-0512. | ||
| 21 | */ | ||
| 22 | |||
| 23 | #if defined(LIBC_SCCS) && !defined(lint) | ||
| 24 | static char rcsid[] = "$OpenBSD: gcvt.c,v 1.5 2003/06/17 21:56:24 millert Exp $"; | ||
| 25 | #endif /* LIBC_SCCS and not lint */ | ||
| 26 | |||
| 27 | #include <stdio.h> | ||
| 28 | #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 29 | #include <string.h> | ||
| 30 | |||
| 31 | extern char *__dtoa(double, int, int, int *, int *, char **); | ||
| 32 | |||
| 33 | char * | ||
| 34 | gcvt(double value, int ndigit, char *buf) | ||
| 35 | { | ||
| 36 | char *digits, *dst, *src; | ||
| 37 | int i, decpt, sign; | ||
| 38 | |||
| 39 | if (ndigit == 0) { | ||
| 40 | buf[0] = '\0'; | ||
| 41 | return (buf); | ||
| 42 | } | ||
| 43 | |||
| 44 | digits = __dtoa(value, 2, ndigit, &decpt, &sign, NULL); | ||
| 45 | if (decpt == 9999) { | ||
| 46 | /* Infinity or NaN, assume buffer is at least ndigit long. */ | ||
| 47 | strlcpy(buf, digits, ndigit + 1); | ||
| 48 | return (buf); | ||
| 49 | } | ||
| 50 | |||
| 51 | dst = buf; | ||
| 52 | if (sign) | ||
| 53 | *dst++ = '-'; | ||
| 54 | |||
| 55 | if (decpt < 0 || decpt > ndigit) { | ||
| 56 | /* exponential format */ | ||
| 57 | if (--decpt < 0) { | ||
| 58 | sign = 1; | ||
| 59 | decpt = -decpt; | ||
| 60 | } else | ||
| 61 | sign = 0; | ||
| 62 | for (src = digits; *src != '\0'; ) | ||
| 63 | *dst++ = *src++; | ||
| 64 | *dst++ = 'e'; | ||
| 65 | if (sign) | ||
| 66 | *dst++ = '-'; | ||
| 67 | else | ||
| 68 | *dst++ = '+'; | ||
| 69 | if (decpt < 10) { | ||
| 70 | *dst++ = '0'; | ||
| 71 | *dst++ = '0' + decpt; | ||
| 72 | *dst = '\0'; | ||
| 73 | } else { | ||
| 74 | /* XXX - optimize */ | ||
| 75 | for (sign = decpt, i = 0; (sign /= 10) != 0; i++) | ||
| 76 | sign /= 10; | ||
| 77 | while (decpt != 0) { | ||
| 78 | dst[i--] = '0' + decpt % 10; | ||
| 79 | decpt /= 10; | ||
| 80 | } | ||
| 81 | } | ||
| 82 | } else { | ||
| 83 | /* standard format */ | ||
| 84 | for (i = 0, src = digits; i < decpt; i++) { | ||
| 85 | if (*src != '\0') | ||
| 86 | *dst++ = *src++; | ||
| 87 | else | ||
| 88 | *dst++ = '0'; | ||
| 89 | } | ||
| 90 | if (*src != '\0') { | ||
| 91 | *dst++ = '.'; /* XXX - locale-specific (LC_NUMERIC) */ | ||
| 92 | for (i = decpt; digits[i] != '\0'; i++) { | ||
| 93 | *dst++ = digits[i]; | ||
| 94 | } | ||
| 95 | } | ||
| 96 | *dst = '\0'; | ||
| 97 | } | ||
| 98 | return (buf); | ||
| 99 | } | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/getenv.3 b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/getenv.3 new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..054004e1d8 --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/getenv.3 | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,142 @@ | |||
| 1 | .\" Copyright (c) 1988, 1991, 1993 | ||
| 2 | .\" The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved. | ||
| 3 | .\" | ||
| 4 | .\" This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by | ||
| 5 | .\" the American National Standards Committee X3, on Information | ||
| 6 | .\" Processing Systems. | ||
| 7 | .\" | ||
| 8 | .\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without | ||
| 9 | .\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions | ||
| 10 | .\" are met: | ||
| 11 | .\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright | ||
| 12 | .\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. | ||
| 13 | .\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright | ||
| 14 | .\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the | ||
| 15 | .\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. | ||
| 16 | .\" 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors | ||
| 17 | .\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software | ||
| 18 | .\" without specific prior written permission. | ||
| 19 | .\" | ||
| 20 | .\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND | ||
| 21 | .\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE | ||
| 22 | .\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE | ||
| 23 | .\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE | ||
| 24 | .\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL | ||
| 25 | .\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS | ||
| 26 | .\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) | ||
| 27 | .\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT | ||
| 28 | .\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY | ||
| 29 | .\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF | ||
| 30 | .\" SUCH DAMAGE. | ||
| 31 | .\" | ||
| 32 | .\" $OpenBSD: getenv.3,v 1.9 2004/01/23 23:08:46 jmc Exp $ | ||
| 33 | .\" | ||
| 34 | .Dd December 11, 1993 | ||
| 35 | .Dt GETENV 3 | ||
| 36 | .Os | ||
| 37 | .Sh NAME | ||
| 38 | .Nm getenv , | ||
| 39 | .Nm putenv , | ||
| 40 | .Nm setenv , | ||
| 41 | .Nm unsetenv | ||
| 42 | .Nd environment variable functions | ||
| 43 | .Sh SYNOPSIS | ||
| 44 | .Fd #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 45 | .Ft char * | ||
| 46 | .Fn getenv "const char *name" | ||
| 47 | .Ft int | ||
| 48 | .Fn setenv "const char *name" "const char *value" "int overwrite" | ||
| 49 | .Ft int | ||
| 50 | .Fn putenv "const char *string" | ||
| 51 | .Ft void | ||
| 52 | .Fn unsetenv "const char *name" | ||
| 53 | .Sh DESCRIPTION | ||
| 54 | These functions set, unset, and fetch environment variables from the host | ||
| 55 | .Em environment list . | ||
| 56 | For compatibility with differing environment conventions, the given arguments | ||
| 57 | .Fa name | ||
| 58 | and | ||
| 59 | .Fa value | ||
| 60 | may be appended and prepended, respectively, with an equal sign | ||
| 61 | .Dq Li \&= . | ||
| 62 | .Pp | ||
| 63 | The | ||
| 64 | .Fn getenv | ||
| 65 | function obtains the current value of the environment variable, | ||
| 66 | .Fa name . | ||
| 67 | If the variable | ||
| 68 | .Fa name | ||
| 69 | is not in the current environment, a null pointer is returned. | ||
| 70 | .Pp | ||
| 71 | The | ||
| 72 | .Fn setenv | ||
| 73 | function inserts or resets the environment variable | ||
| 74 | .Fa name | ||
| 75 | in the current environment list. | ||
| 76 | If the variable | ||
| 77 | .Fa name | ||
| 78 | does not exist in the list, it is inserted with the given | ||
| 79 | .Fa value . | ||
| 80 | If the variable does exist, the argument | ||
| 81 | .Fa overwrite | ||
| 82 | is tested; if | ||
| 83 | .Fa overwrite | ||
| 84 | is zero, the variable is not reset, otherwise it is reset to the given | ||
| 85 | .Fa value . | ||
| 86 | .Pp | ||
| 87 | The | ||
| 88 | .Fn putenv | ||
| 89 | function takes an argument of the form | ||
| 90 | .Ar name Ns = Ns Ar value | ||
| 91 | and is equivalent to: | ||
| 92 | .Bd -literal -offset indent | ||
| 93 | setenv(name, value, 1); | ||
| 94 | .Ed | ||
| 95 | .Pp | ||
| 96 | The | ||
| 97 | .Fn unsetenv | ||
| 98 | function deletes all instances of the variable name pointed to by | ||
| 99 | .Fa name | ||
| 100 | from the list. | ||
| 101 | .Sh RETURN VALUES | ||
| 102 | The functions | ||
| 103 | .Fn setenv | ||
| 104 | and | ||
| 105 | .Fn putenv | ||
| 106 | return zero if successful; otherwise the global variable | ||
| 107 | .Va errno | ||
| 108 | is set to indicate the error and \-1 is returned. | ||
| 109 | .Pp | ||
| 110 | If | ||
| 111 | .Fn getenv | ||
| 112 | is successful, the string returned should be considered read-only. | ||
| 113 | .Sh ERRORS | ||
| 114 | .Bl -tag -width [ENOMEM] | ||
| 115 | .It Bq Er ENOMEM | ||
| 116 | The function | ||
| 117 | .Fn setenv | ||
| 118 | or | ||
| 119 | .Fn putenv | ||
| 120 | failed because they were unable to allocate memory for the environment. | ||
| 121 | .El | ||
| 122 | .Sh SEE ALSO | ||
| 123 | .Xr csh 1 , | ||
| 124 | .Xr sh 1 , | ||
| 125 | .Xr execve 2 , | ||
| 126 | .Xr environ 7 | ||
| 127 | .Sh STANDARDS | ||
| 128 | The | ||
| 129 | .Fn getenv | ||
| 130 | function conforms to | ||
| 131 | .St -ansiC . | ||
| 132 | .Sh HISTORY | ||
| 133 | The functions | ||
| 134 | .Fn setenv | ||
| 135 | and | ||
| 136 | .Fn unsetenv | ||
| 137 | appeared in | ||
| 138 | .At v7 . | ||
| 139 | The | ||
| 140 | .Fn putenv | ||
| 141 | function appeared in | ||
| 142 | .Bx 4.3 Reno . | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/getenv.c b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/getenv.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..c597e468a9 --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/getenv.c | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,84 @@ | |||
| 1 | /* | ||
| 2 | * Copyright (c) 1987, 1993 | ||
| 3 | * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved. | ||
| 4 | * | ||
| 5 | * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without | ||
| 6 | * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions | ||
| 7 | * are met: | ||
| 8 | * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright | ||
| 9 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. | ||
| 10 | * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright | ||
| 11 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the | ||
| 12 | * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. | ||
| 13 | * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors | ||
| 14 | * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software | ||
| 15 | * without specific prior written permission. | ||
| 16 | * | ||
| 17 | * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND | ||
| 18 | * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE | ||
| 19 | * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE | ||
| 20 | * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE | ||
| 21 | * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL | ||
| 22 | * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS | ||
| 23 | * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) | ||
| 24 | * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT | ||
| 25 | * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY | ||
| 26 | * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF | ||
| 27 | * SUCH DAMAGE. | ||
| 28 | */ | ||
| 29 | |||
| 30 | #if defined(LIBC_SCCS) && !defined(lint) | ||
| 31 | static char *rcsid = "$OpenBSD: getenv.c,v 1.6 2003/06/02 20:18:37 millert Exp $"; | ||
| 32 | #endif /* LIBC_SCCS and not lint */ | ||
| 33 | |||
| 34 | #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 35 | #include <string.h> | ||
| 36 | |||
| 37 | char *__findenv(const char *name, int *offset); | ||
| 38 | |||
| 39 | /* | ||
| 40 | * __findenv -- | ||
| 41 | * Returns pointer to value associated with name, if any, else NULL. | ||
| 42 | * Sets offset to be the offset of the name/value combination in the | ||
| 43 | * environmental array, for use by setenv(3) and unsetenv(3). | ||
| 44 | * Explicitly removes '=' in argument name. | ||
| 45 | * | ||
| 46 | * This routine *should* be a static; don't use it. | ||
| 47 | */ | ||
| 48 | char * | ||
| 49 | __findenv(const char *name, int *offset) | ||
| 50 | { | ||
| 51 | extern char **environ; | ||
| 52 | register int len, i; | ||
| 53 | register const char *np; | ||
| 54 | register char **p, *cp; | ||
| 55 | |||
| 56 | if (name == NULL || environ == NULL) | ||
| 57 | return (NULL); | ||
| 58 | for (np = name; *np && *np != '='; ++np) | ||
| 59 | ; | ||
| 60 | len = np - name; | ||
| 61 | for (p = environ; (cp = *p) != NULL; ++p) { | ||
| 62 | for (np = name, i = len; i && *cp; i--) | ||
| 63 | if (*cp++ != *np++) | ||
| 64 | break; | ||
| 65 | if (i == 0 && *cp++ == '=') { | ||
| 66 | *offset = p - environ; | ||
| 67 | return (cp); | ||
| 68 | } | ||
| 69 | } | ||
| 70 | return (NULL); | ||
| 71 | } | ||
| 72 | |||
| 73 | /* | ||
| 74 | * getenv -- | ||
| 75 | * Returns ptr to value associated with name, if any, else NULL. | ||
| 76 | */ | ||
| 77 | char * | ||
| 78 | getenv(name) | ||
| 79 | const char *name; | ||
| 80 | { | ||
| 81 | int offset; | ||
| 82 | |||
| 83 | return (__findenv(name, &offset)); | ||
| 84 | } | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/getopt.3 b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/getopt.3 new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..d210852c6b --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/getopt.3 | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,340 @@ | |||
| 1 | .\" Copyright (c) 1988, 1991, 1993 | ||
| 2 | .\" The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved. | ||
| 3 | .\" | ||
| 4 | .\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without | ||
| 5 | .\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions | ||
| 6 | .\" are met: | ||
| 7 | .\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright | ||
| 8 | .\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. | ||
| 9 | .\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright | ||
| 10 | .\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the | ||
| 11 | .\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. | ||
| 12 | .\" 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors | ||
| 13 | .\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software | ||
| 14 | .\" without specific prior written permission. | ||
| 15 | .\" | ||
| 16 | .\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND | ||
| 17 | .\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE | ||
| 18 | .\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE | ||
| 19 | .\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE | ||
| 20 | .\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL | ||
| 21 | .\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS | ||
| 22 | .\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) | ||
| 23 | .\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT | ||
| 24 | .\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY | ||
| 25 | .\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF | ||
| 26 | .\" SUCH DAMAGE. | ||
| 27 | .\" | ||
| 28 | .\" $OpenBSD: getopt.3,v 1.28 2003/09/22 23:47:26 millert Exp $ | ||
| 29 | .\" | ||
| 30 | .Dd December 17, 2002 | ||
| 31 | .Dt GETOPT 3 | ||
| 32 | .Os | ||
| 33 | .Sh NAME | ||
| 34 | .Nm getopt | ||
| 35 | .Nd get option character from command line argument list | ||
| 36 | .Sh SYNOPSIS | ||
| 37 | .Fd #include <unistd.h> | ||
| 38 | .Vt extern char *optarg; | ||
| 39 | .Vt extern int optind; | ||
| 40 | .Vt extern int optopt; | ||
| 41 | .Vt extern int opterr; | ||
| 42 | .Vt extern int optreset; | ||
| 43 | .Ft int | ||
| 44 | .Fn getopt "int argc" "char * const *argv" "const char *optstring" | ||
| 45 | .Sh DESCRIPTION | ||
| 46 | The | ||
| 47 | .Fn getopt | ||
| 48 | function incrementally parses a command line argument list | ||
| 49 | .Fa argv | ||
| 50 | and returns the next | ||
| 51 | .Em known | ||
| 52 | option character. | ||
| 53 | An option character is | ||
| 54 | .Em known | ||
| 55 | if it has been specified in the string of accepted option characters, | ||
| 56 | .Fa optstring . | ||
| 57 | .Pp | ||
| 58 | The option string | ||
| 59 | .Fa optstring | ||
| 60 | may contain the following elements: individual characters, | ||
| 61 | characters followed by a colon, and characters followed by two colons. | ||
| 62 | A character followed by a single colon indicates that an argument | ||
| 63 | is to follow the option on the command line. | ||
| 64 | Two colons indicates that the argument is optional--this is an | ||
| 65 | extension not covered by | ||
| 66 | .Px . | ||
| 67 | For example, an option string | ||
| 68 | .Qq x | ||
| 69 | recognizes an option | ||
| 70 | .Fl x , | ||
| 71 | and an option string | ||
| 72 | .Qq Li x: | ||
| 73 | recognizes an option and argument | ||
| 74 | .Fl x Ar argument . | ||
| 75 | It does not matter to | ||
| 76 | .Fn getopt | ||
| 77 | if a following argument has leading whitespace. | ||
| 78 | .Pp | ||
| 79 | On return from | ||
| 80 | .Fn getopt , | ||
| 81 | .Va optarg | ||
| 82 | points to an option argument, if it is anticipated, | ||
| 83 | and the variable | ||
| 84 | .Va optind | ||
| 85 | contains the index to the next | ||
| 86 | .Fa argv | ||
| 87 | argument for a subsequent call | ||
| 88 | to | ||
| 89 | .Fn getopt . | ||
| 90 | .Pp | ||
| 91 | The variables | ||
| 92 | .Va opterr | ||
| 93 | and | ||
| 94 | .Va optind | ||
| 95 | are both initialized to 1. | ||
| 96 | The | ||
| 97 | .Va optind | ||
| 98 | variable may be set to another value before a set of calls to | ||
| 99 | .Fn getopt | ||
| 100 | in order to skip over more or less argv entries. | ||
| 101 | .Pp | ||
| 102 | In order to use | ||
| 103 | .Fn getopt | ||
| 104 | to evaluate multiple sets of arguments, or to evaluate a single set of | ||
| 105 | arguments multiple times, | ||
| 106 | the variable | ||
| 107 | .Va optreset | ||
| 108 | must be set to 1 before the second and each additional set of calls to | ||
| 109 | .Fn getopt , | ||
| 110 | and the variable | ||
| 111 | .Va optind | ||
| 112 | must be reinitialized. | ||
| 113 | .Pp | ||
| 114 | The | ||
| 115 | .Fn getopt | ||
| 116 | function returns \-1 when the argument list is exhausted. | ||
| 117 | The interpretation of options in the argument list may be cancelled | ||
| 118 | by the option | ||
| 119 | .Ql -- | ||
| 120 | (double dash) which causes | ||
| 121 | .Fn getopt | ||
| 122 | to signal the end of argument processing and return \-1. | ||
| 123 | When all options have been processed (i.e., up to the first non-option | ||
| 124 | argument), | ||
| 125 | .Fn getopt | ||
| 126 | returns \-1. | ||
| 127 | .Sh RETURN VALUES | ||
| 128 | The | ||
| 129 | .Fn getopt | ||
| 130 | function returns the next known option character in | ||
| 131 | .Fa optstring . | ||
| 132 | If | ||
| 133 | .Fn getopt | ||
| 134 | encounters a character not found in | ||
| 135 | .Fa optstring | ||
| 136 | or if it detects a missing option argument, | ||
| 137 | it returns | ||
| 138 | .Sq \&? | ||
| 139 | (question mark). | ||
| 140 | If | ||
| 141 | .Fa optstring | ||
| 142 | has a leading | ||
| 143 | .Sq \&: | ||
| 144 | then a missing option argument causes | ||
| 145 | .Sq \&: | ||
| 146 | to be returned instead of | ||
| 147 | .Sq \&? . | ||
| 148 | In either case, the variable | ||
| 149 | .Va optopt | ||
| 150 | is set to the character that caused the error. | ||
| 151 | The | ||
| 152 | .Fn getopt | ||
| 153 | function returns \-1 when the argument list is exhausted. | ||
| 154 | .Sh ENVIRONMENT | ||
| 155 | .Bl -tag -width POSIXLY_CORRECTXX | ||
| 156 | .It Ev POSIXLY_CORRECT | ||
| 157 | If set, a leading | ||
| 158 | .Sq - | ||
| 159 | in | ||
| 160 | .Ar optstring | ||
| 161 | is ignored. | ||
| 162 | .El | ||
| 163 | .Sh EXAMPLES | ||
| 164 | .Bd -literal -compact | ||
| 165 | extern char *optarg; | ||
| 166 | extern int optind; | ||
| 167 | int bflag, ch, fd; | ||
| 168 | |||
| 169 | bflag = 0; | ||
| 170 | while ((ch = getopt(argc, argv, "bf:")) != -1) { | ||
| 171 | switch (ch) { | ||
| 172 | case 'b': | ||
| 173 | bflag = 1; | ||
| 174 | break; | ||
| 175 | case 'f': | ||
| 176 | if ((fd = open(optarg, O_RDONLY, 0)) < 0) { | ||
| 177 | (void)fprintf(stderr, | ||
| 178 | "myname: %s: %s\en", optarg, strerror(errno)); | ||
| 179 | exit(1); | ||
| 180 | } | ||
| 181 | break; | ||
| 182 | case '?': | ||
| 183 | default: | ||
| 184 | usage(); | ||
| 185 | } | ||
| 186 | } | ||
| 187 | argc -= optind; | ||
| 188 | argv += optind; | ||
| 189 | .Ed | ||
| 190 | .Sh DIAGNOSTICS | ||
| 191 | If the | ||
| 192 | .Fn getopt | ||
| 193 | function encounters a character not found in the string | ||
| 194 | .Fa optstring | ||
| 195 | or detects | ||
| 196 | a missing option argument it writes an error message to | ||
| 197 | .Em stderr | ||
| 198 | and returns | ||
| 199 | .Ql \&? . | ||
| 200 | Setting | ||
| 201 | .Va opterr | ||
| 202 | to a zero will disable these error messages. | ||
| 203 | If | ||
| 204 | .Fa optstring | ||
| 205 | has a leading | ||
| 206 | .Ql \&: | ||
| 207 | then a missing option argument causes a | ||
| 208 | .Ql \&: | ||
| 209 | to be returned in addition to suppressing any error messages. | ||
| 210 | .Pp | ||
| 211 | Option arguments are allowed to begin with | ||
| 212 | .Ql - ; | ||
| 213 | this is reasonable but reduces the amount of error checking possible. | ||
| 214 | .Sh SEE ALSO | ||
| 215 | .Xr getopt 1 , | ||
| 216 | .Xr getopt_long 3 , | ||
| 217 | .Xr getsubopt 3 | ||
| 218 | .Sh STANDARDS | ||
| 219 | The | ||
| 220 | .Fn getopt | ||
| 221 | function implements a superset of the functionality specified by | ||
| 222 | .St -p1003.1 . | ||
| 223 | .Pp | ||
| 224 | The following extensions are supported: | ||
| 225 | .Bl -tag -width "xxx" | ||
| 226 | .It Li o | ||
| 227 | The | ||
| 228 | .Va optreset | ||
| 229 | variable was added to make it possible to call the | ||
| 230 | .Fn getopt | ||
| 231 | function multiple times. | ||
| 232 | .It Li o | ||
| 233 | If the first character of | ||
| 234 | .Fa optstring | ||
| 235 | is a plus sign | ||
| 236 | .Pq Ql + , | ||
| 237 | it will be ignored. | ||
| 238 | This is for compatibility with | ||
| 239 | .Tn GNU | ||
| 240 | .Fn getopt . | ||
| 241 | .It Li o | ||
| 242 | If the first character of | ||
| 243 | .Fa optstring | ||
| 244 | is a dash | ||
| 245 | .Pq Ql - , | ||
| 246 | non-options will be returned as arguments to the option character | ||
| 247 | .Ql \e1 . | ||
| 248 | This is for compatibility with | ||
| 249 | .Tn GNU | ||
| 250 | .Fn getopt . | ||
| 251 | .It Li o | ||
| 252 | A single dash | ||
| 253 | .Pq Ql - | ||
| 254 | may be specified as a character in | ||
| 255 | .Fa optstring , | ||
| 256 | however it should | ||
| 257 | .Em never | ||
| 258 | have an argument associated with it. | ||
| 259 | This allows | ||
| 260 | .Fn getopt | ||
| 261 | to be used with programs that expect | ||
| 262 | .Ql - | ||
| 263 | as an option flag. | ||
| 264 | This practice is wrong, and should not be used in any current development. | ||
| 265 | It is provided for backward compatibility | ||
| 266 | .Em only . | ||
| 267 | Care should be taken not to use | ||
| 268 | .Ql - | ||
| 269 | as the first character in | ||
| 270 | .Fa optstring | ||
| 271 | to avoid a semantic conflict with | ||
| 272 | .Tn GNU | ||
| 273 | .Fn getopt | ||
| 274 | semantics (see above). | ||
| 275 | By default, a single dash causes | ||
| 276 | .Fn getopt | ||
| 277 | to return \-1. | ||
| 278 | .El | ||
| 279 | .Pp | ||
| 280 | Unlike | ||
| 281 | .Tn GNU | ||
| 282 | .Fn getopt , | ||
| 283 | .Ox | ||
| 284 | does not permute the argument vector to allow non-options to be | ||
| 285 | interspersed with options on the command line. | ||
| 286 | Programs requiring this behavior should use | ||
| 287 | .Xr getopt_long 3 | ||
| 288 | instead. | ||
| 289 | Because of this (and unlike | ||
| 290 | .Tn GNU ) , | ||
| 291 | the | ||
| 292 | .Ox | ||
| 293 | .Fn getopt | ||
| 294 | supports optional arguments separated by whitespace. | ||
| 295 | .Sh HISTORY | ||
| 296 | The | ||
| 297 | .Fn getopt | ||
| 298 | function appeared in | ||
| 299 | .Bx 4.3 . | ||
| 300 | .Sh BUGS | ||
| 301 | The | ||
| 302 | .Fn getopt | ||
| 303 | function was once specified to return | ||
| 304 | .Dv EOF | ||
| 305 | instead of \-1. | ||
| 306 | This was changed by | ||
| 307 | .St -p1003.2-92 | ||
| 308 | to decouple | ||
| 309 | .Fn getopt | ||
| 310 | from | ||
| 311 | .Aq Pa stdio.h . | ||
| 312 | .Pp | ||
| 313 | It is possible to handle digits as option letters. | ||
| 314 | This allows | ||
| 315 | .Fn getopt | ||
| 316 | to be used with programs that expect a number | ||
| 317 | .Pq Dq Li \-3 | ||
| 318 | as an option. | ||
| 319 | This practice is wrong, and should not be used in any current development. | ||
| 320 | It is provided for backward compatibility | ||
| 321 | .Em only . | ||
| 322 | The following code fragment works in most cases. | ||
| 323 | .Bd -literal -offset indent | ||
| 324 | int ch; | ||
| 325 | long length; | ||
| 326 | char *p; | ||
| 327 | |||
| 328 | while ((ch = getopt(argc, argv, "0123456789")) != -1) { | ||
| 329 | switch (ch) { | ||
| 330 | case '0': case '1': case '2': case '3': case '4': | ||
| 331 | case '5': case '6': case '7': case '8': case '9': | ||
| 332 | p = argv[optind - 1]; | ||
| 333 | if (p[0] == '-' && p[1] == ch && !p[2]) | ||
| 334 | length = ch - '0'; | ||
| 335 | else | ||
| 336 | length = strtol(argv[optind] + 1, NULL, 10); | ||
| 337 | break; | ||
| 338 | } | ||
| 339 | } | ||
| 340 | .Ed | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/getopt_long.3 b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/getopt_long.3 new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..978583ef96 --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/getopt_long.3 | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,377 @@ | |||
| 1 | .\" $OpenBSD: getopt_long.3,v 1.10 2004/01/06 23:44:28 fgsch Exp $ | ||
| 2 | .\" $NetBSD: getopt_long.3,v 1.11 2002/10/02 10:54:19 wiz Exp $ | ||
| 3 | .\" | ||
| 4 | .\" Copyright (c) 1988, 1991, 1993 | ||
| 5 | .\" The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved. | ||
| 6 | .\" | ||
| 7 | .\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without | ||
| 8 | .\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions | ||
| 9 | .\" are met: | ||
| 10 | .\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright | ||
| 11 | .\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. | ||
| 12 | .\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright | ||
| 13 | .\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the | ||
| 14 | .\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. | ||
| 15 | .\" 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors | ||
| 16 | .\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software | ||
| 17 | .\" without specific prior written permission. | ||
| 18 | .\" | ||
| 19 | .\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND | ||
| 20 | .\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE | ||
| 21 | .\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE | ||
| 22 | .\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE | ||
| 23 | .\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL | ||
| 24 | .\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS | ||
| 25 | .\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) | ||
| 26 | .\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT | ||
| 27 | .\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY | ||
| 28 | .\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF | ||
| 29 | .\" SUCH DAMAGE. | ||
| 30 | .\" | ||
| 31 | .\" @(#)getopt.3 8.5 (Berkeley) 4/27/95 | ||
| 32 | .\" | ||
| 33 | .Dd April 1, 2000 | ||
| 34 | .Dt GETOPT_LONG 3 | ||
| 35 | .Os | ||
| 36 | .Sh NAME | ||
| 37 | .Nm getopt_long , | ||
| 38 | .Nm getopt_long_only | ||
| 39 | .Nd get long options from command line argument list | ||
| 40 | .Sh SYNOPSIS | ||
| 41 | .Fd #include <getopt.h> | ||
| 42 | .Vt extern char *optarg; | ||
| 43 | .Vt extern int optind; | ||
| 44 | .Vt extern int optopt; | ||
| 45 | .Vt extern int opterr; | ||
| 46 | .Vt extern int optreset; | ||
| 47 | .Ft int | ||
| 48 | .Fn getopt_long "int argc" "char * const *argv" "const char *optstring" "const struct option *longopts" "int *longindex" | ||
| 49 | .Ft int | ||
| 50 | .Fn getopt_long_only "int argc" "char * const *argv" "const char *optstring" "const struct option *longopts" "int *longindex" | ||
| 51 | .Sh DESCRIPTION | ||
| 52 | The | ||
| 53 | .Fn getopt_long | ||
| 54 | function is similar to | ||
| 55 | .Xr getopt 3 | ||
| 56 | but it accepts options in two forms: words and characters. | ||
| 57 | The | ||
| 58 | .Fn getopt_long | ||
| 59 | function provides a superset of the functionality of | ||
| 60 | .Xr getopt 3 . | ||
| 61 | .Fn getopt_long | ||
| 62 | can be used in two ways. | ||
| 63 | In the first way, every long option understood by the program has a | ||
| 64 | corresponding short option, and the option structure is only used to | ||
| 65 | translate from long options to short options. | ||
| 66 | When used in this fashion, | ||
| 67 | .Fn getopt_long | ||
| 68 | behaves identically to | ||
| 69 | .Xr getopt 3 . | ||
| 70 | This is a good way to add long option processing to an existing program | ||
| 71 | with the minimum of rewriting. | ||
| 72 | .Pp | ||
| 73 | In the second mechanism, a long option sets a flag in the | ||
| 74 | .Fa option | ||
| 75 | structure passed, or will store a pointer to the command line argument | ||
| 76 | in the | ||
| 77 | .Fa option | ||
| 78 | structure passed to it for options that take arguments. | ||
| 79 | Additionally, the long option's argument may be specified as a single | ||
| 80 | argument with an equal sign, e.g. | ||
| 81 | .Bd -literal | ||
| 82 | myprogram --myoption=somevalue | ||
| 83 | .Ed | ||
| 84 | .Pp | ||
| 85 | When a long option is processed the call to | ||
| 86 | .Fn getopt_long | ||
| 87 | will return 0. | ||
| 88 | For this reason, long option processing without | ||
| 89 | shortcuts is not backwards compatible with | ||
| 90 | .Xr getopt 3 . | ||
| 91 | .Pp | ||
| 92 | It is possible to combine these methods, providing for long options | ||
| 93 | processing with short option equivalents for some options. | ||
| 94 | Less frequently used options would be processed as long options only. | ||
| 95 | .Pp | ||
| 96 | The | ||
| 97 | .Fn getopt_long | ||
| 98 | call requires a structure to be initialized describing the long | ||
| 99 | options. | ||
| 100 | The structure is: | ||
| 101 | .Bd -literal | ||
| 102 | struct option { | ||
| 103 | char *name; | ||
| 104 | int has_arg; | ||
| 105 | int *flag; | ||
| 106 | int val; | ||
| 107 | }; | ||
| 108 | .Ed | ||
| 109 | .Pp | ||
| 110 | The | ||
| 111 | .Fa name | ||
| 112 | field should contain the option name without the leading double dash. | ||
| 113 | .Pp | ||
| 114 | The | ||
| 115 | .Fa has_arg | ||
| 116 | field should be one of: | ||
| 117 | .Bl -tag -width "optional_argument" | ||
| 118 | .It Li no_argument | ||
| 119 | no argument to the option is expect. | ||
| 120 | .It Li required_argument | ||
| 121 | an argument to the option is required. | ||
| 122 | .It Li optional_argument | ||
| 123 | an argument to the option may be presented. | ||
| 124 | .El | ||
| 125 | .Pp | ||
| 126 | If | ||
| 127 | .Fa flag | ||
| 128 | is not | ||
| 129 | .Dv NULL , | ||
| 130 | then the integer pointed to by it will be set to the value in the | ||
| 131 | .Fa val | ||
| 132 | field. | ||
| 133 | If the | ||
| 134 | .Fa flag | ||
| 135 | field is | ||
| 136 | .Dv NULL , | ||
| 137 | then the | ||
| 138 | .Fa val | ||
| 139 | field will be returned. | ||
| 140 | Setting | ||
| 141 | .Fa flag | ||
| 142 | to | ||
| 143 | .Dv NULL | ||
| 144 | and setting | ||
| 145 | .Fa val | ||
| 146 | to the corresponding short option will make this function act just | ||
| 147 | like | ||
| 148 | .Xr getopt 3 . | ||
| 149 | .Pp | ||
| 150 | If the | ||
| 151 | .Fa longindex | ||
| 152 | field is not | ||
| 153 | .Dv NULL , | ||
| 154 | then the integer pointed to by it will be set to the index of the long | ||
| 155 | option relative to | ||
| 156 | .Fa longopts . | ||
| 157 | .Pp | ||
| 158 | The last element of the | ||
| 159 | .Fa longopts | ||
| 160 | array has to be filled with zeroes. | ||
| 161 | .Pp | ||
| 162 | The | ||
| 163 | .Fn getopt_long_only | ||
| 164 | function behaves identically to | ||
| 165 | .Fn getopt_long | ||
| 166 | with the exception that long options may start with | ||
| 167 | .Sq - | ||
| 168 | in addition to | ||
| 169 | .Sq -- . | ||
| 170 | If an option starting with | ||
| 171 | .Sq - | ||
| 172 | does not match a long option but does match a single-character option, | ||
| 173 | the single-character option is returned. | ||
| 174 | .Sh RETURN VALUES | ||
| 175 | If the | ||
| 176 | .Fa flag | ||
| 177 | field in | ||
| 178 | .Li struct option | ||
| 179 | is | ||
| 180 | .Dv NULL , | ||
| 181 | .Fn getopt_long | ||
| 182 | and | ||
| 183 | .Fn getopt_long_only | ||
| 184 | return the value specified in the | ||
| 185 | .Fa val | ||
| 186 | field, which is usually just the corresponding short option. | ||
| 187 | If | ||
| 188 | .Fa flag | ||
| 189 | is not | ||
| 190 | .Dv NULL , | ||
| 191 | these functions return 0 and store | ||
| 192 | .Fa val | ||
| 193 | in the location pointed to by | ||
| 194 | .Fa flag . | ||
| 195 | These functions return | ||
| 196 | .Sq \: | ||
| 197 | if there was a missing option argument, | ||
| 198 | .Sq \&? | ||
| 199 | if the user specified an unknown or ambiguous option, and | ||
| 200 | \-1 when the argument list has been exhausted. | ||
| 201 | .Sh EXAMPLES | ||
| 202 | .Bd -literal -compact | ||
| 203 | int bflag, ch, fd; | ||
| 204 | int daggerset; | ||
| 205 | |||
| 206 | /* options descriptor */ | ||
| 207 | static struct option longopts[] = { | ||
| 208 | { "buffy", no_argument, NULL, 'b' }, | ||
| 209 | { "fluoride", required_argument, NULL, 'f' }, | ||
| 210 | { "daggerset", no_argument, &daggerset, 1 }, | ||
| 211 | { NULL, 0, NULL, 0 } | ||
| 212 | }; | ||
| 213 | |||
| 214 | bflag = 0; | ||
| 215 | while ((ch = getopt_long(argc, argv, "bf:", longopts, NULL)) != -1) | ||
| 216 | switch (ch) { | ||
| 217 | case 'b': | ||
| 218 | bflag = 1; | ||
| 219 | break; | ||
| 220 | case 'f': | ||
| 221 | if ((fd = open(optarg, O_RDONLY, 0)) == -1) | ||
| 222 | err(1, "unable to open %s", optarg); | ||
| 223 | break; | ||
| 224 | case 0: | ||
| 225 | if (daggerset) { | ||
| 226 | fprintf(stderr,"Buffy will use her dagger to " | ||
| 227 | "apply fluoride to dracula's teeth\en"); | ||
| 228 | } | ||
| 229 | break; | ||
| 230 | default: | ||
| 231 | usage(); | ||
| 232 | } | ||
| 233 | argc -= optind; | ||
| 234 | argv += optind; | ||
| 235 | .Ed | ||
| 236 | .Sh IMPLEMENTATION DIFFERENCES | ||
| 237 | This section describes differences to the GNU implementation | ||
| 238 | found in glibc-2.1.3: | ||
| 239 | .Bl -tag -width "xxx" | ||
| 240 | .It Li o | ||
| 241 | handling of - as first char of option string in presence of | ||
| 242 | environment variable POSIXLY_CORRECT: | ||
| 243 | .Bl -tag -width "OpenBSD" | ||
| 244 | .It Li GNU | ||
| 245 | ignores POSIXLY_CORRECT and returns non-options as | ||
| 246 | arguments to option '\e1'. | ||
| 247 | .It Li OpenBSD | ||
| 248 | honors POSIXLY_CORRECT and stops at the first non-option. | ||
| 249 | .El | ||
| 250 | .It Li o | ||
| 251 | handling of - within the option string (not the first character): | ||
| 252 | .Bl -tag -width "OpenBSD" | ||
| 253 | .It Li GNU | ||
| 254 | treats a | ||
| 255 | .Ql - | ||
| 256 | on the command line as a non-argument. | ||
| 257 | .It Li OpenBSD | ||
| 258 | a | ||
| 259 | .Ql - | ||
| 260 | within the option string matches a | ||
| 261 | .Ql - | ||
| 262 | (single dash) on the command line. | ||
| 263 | This functionality is provided for backward compatibility with | ||
| 264 | programs, such as | ||
| 265 | .Xr su 1 , | ||
| 266 | that use | ||
| 267 | .Ql - | ||
| 268 | as an option flag. | ||
| 269 | This practice is wrong, and should not be used in any current development. | ||
| 270 | .El | ||
| 271 | .It Li o | ||
| 272 | handling of :: in options string in presence of POSIXLY_CORRECT: | ||
| 273 | .Bl -tag -width "OpenBSD" | ||
| 274 | .It Li Both | ||
| 275 | GNU and OpenBSD ignore POSIXLY_CORRECT here and take :: to | ||
| 276 | mean the preceding option takes an optional argument. | ||
| 277 | .El | ||
| 278 | .It Li o | ||
| 279 | return value in case of missing argument if first character | ||
| 280 | (after + or -) in option string is not ':': | ||
| 281 | .Bl -tag -width "OpenBSD" | ||
| 282 | .It Li GNU | ||
| 283 | returns '?' | ||
| 284 | .It OpenBSD | ||
| 285 | returns ':' (since OpenBSD's getopt does). | ||
| 286 | .El | ||
| 287 | .It Li o | ||
| 288 | handling of --a in getopt: | ||
| 289 | .Bl -tag -width "OpenBSD" | ||
| 290 | .It Li GNU | ||
| 291 | parses this as option '-', option 'a'. | ||
| 292 | .It Li OpenBSD | ||
| 293 | parses this as '--', and returns \-1 (ignoring the a). | ||
| 294 | (Because the original getopt does.) | ||
| 295 | .El | ||
| 296 | .It Li o | ||
| 297 | setting of optopt for long options with flag != | ||
| 298 | .Dv NULL : | ||
| 299 | .Bl -tag -width "OpenBSD" | ||
| 300 | .It Li GNU | ||
| 301 | sets optopt to val. | ||
| 302 | .It Li OpenBSD | ||
| 303 | sets optopt to 0 (since val would never be returned). | ||
| 304 | .El | ||
| 305 | .It Li o | ||
| 306 | handling of -W with W; in option string in getopt (not getopt_long): | ||
| 307 | .Bl -tag -width "OpenBSD" | ||
| 308 | .It Li GNU | ||
| 309 | causes a segfault. | ||
| 310 | .It Li OpenBSD | ||
| 311 | no special handling is done; | ||
| 312 | .Dq W; | ||
| 313 | is interpreted as two separate options, neither of which take an argument. | ||
| 314 | .El | ||
| 315 | .It Li o | ||
| 316 | setting of optarg for long options without an argument that are | ||
| 317 | invoked via -W (W; in option string): | ||
| 318 | .Bl -tag -width "OpenBSD" | ||
| 319 | .It Li GNU | ||
| 320 | sets optarg to the option name (the argument of -W). | ||
| 321 | .It Li OpenBSD | ||
| 322 | sets optarg to | ||
| 323 | .Dv NULL | ||
| 324 | (the argument of the long option). | ||
| 325 | .El | ||
| 326 | .It Li o | ||
| 327 | handling of -W with an argument that is not (a prefix to) a known | ||
| 328 | long option (W; in option string): | ||
| 329 | .Bl -tag -width "OpenBSD" | ||
| 330 | .It Li GNU | ||
| 331 | returns -W with optarg set to the unknown option. | ||
| 332 | .It Li OpenBSD | ||
| 333 | treats this as an error (unknown option) and returns '?' with | ||
| 334 | optopt set to 0 and optarg set to | ||
| 335 | .Dv NULL | ||
| 336 | (as GNU's man page documents). | ||
| 337 | .El | ||
| 338 | .It Li o | ||
| 339 | The error messages are different. | ||
| 340 | .It Li o | ||
| 341 | OpenBSD does not permute the argument vector at the same points in | ||
| 342 | the calling sequence as GNU does. | ||
| 343 | The aspects normally used by the caller | ||
| 344 | (ordering after \-1 is returned, value of optind relative | ||
| 345 | to current positions) are the same, though. | ||
| 346 | (We do fewer variable swaps.) | ||
| 347 | .El | ||
| 348 | .Sh ENVIRONMENT | ||
| 349 | .Bl -tag -width POSIXLY_CORRECT | ||
| 350 | .It Ev POSIXLY_CORRECT | ||
| 351 | If set, option processing stops when the first non-option is found and | ||
| 352 | a leading | ||
| 353 | .Sq - | ||
| 354 | or | ||
| 355 | .Sq + | ||
| 356 | in the | ||
| 357 | .Ar optstring | ||
| 358 | is ignored. | ||
| 359 | .El | ||
| 360 | .Sh SEE ALSO | ||
| 361 | .Xr getopt 3 | ||
| 362 | .Sh HISTORY | ||
| 363 | The | ||
| 364 | .Fn getopt_long | ||
| 365 | and | ||
| 366 | .Fn getopt_long_only | ||
| 367 | functions first appeared in GNU libiberty. | ||
| 368 | This implementation first appeared in | ||
| 369 | .Ox 3.3 . | ||
| 370 | .Sh BUGS | ||
| 371 | The | ||
| 372 | .Ar argv | ||
| 373 | argument is not really | ||
| 374 | .Dv const | ||
| 375 | as its elements may be permuted (unless | ||
| 376 | .Ev POSIXLY_CORRECT | ||
| 377 | is set). | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/getopt_long.c b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/getopt_long.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..6079ce3503 --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/getopt_long.c | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,544 @@ | |||
| 1 | /* $OpenBSD: getopt_long.c,v 1.16 2004/02/04 18:17:25 millert Exp $ */ | ||
| 2 | /* $NetBSD: getopt_long.c,v 1.15 2002/01/31 22:43:40 tv Exp $ */ | ||
| 3 | |||
| 4 | /* | ||
| 5 | * Copyright (c) 2002 Todd C. Miller <Todd.Miller@courtesan.com> | ||
| 6 | * | ||
| 7 | * Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software for any | ||
| 8 | * purpose with or without fee is hereby granted, provided that the above | ||
| 9 | * copyright notice and this permission notice appear in all copies. | ||
| 10 | * | ||
| 11 | * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS" AND THE AUTHOR DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES | ||
| 12 | * WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF | ||
| 13 | * MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR | ||
| 14 | * ANY SPECIAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES | ||
| 15 | * WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN AN | ||
| 16 | * ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING OUT OF | ||
| 17 | * OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE. | ||
| 18 | * | ||
| 19 | * Sponsored in part by the Defense Advanced Research Projects | ||
| 20 | * Agency (DARPA) and Air Force Research Laboratory, Air Force | ||
| 21 | * Materiel Command, USAF, under agreement number F39502-99-1-0512. | ||
| 22 | */ | ||
| 23 | /*- | ||
| 24 | * Copyright (c) 2000 The NetBSD Foundation, Inc. | ||
| 25 | * All rights reserved. | ||
| 26 | * | ||
| 27 | * This code is derived from software contributed to The NetBSD Foundation | ||
| 28 | * by Dieter Baron and Thomas Klausner. | ||
| 29 | * | ||
| 30 | * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without | ||
| 31 | * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions | ||
| 32 | * are met: | ||
| 33 | * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright | ||
| 34 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. | ||
| 35 | * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright | ||
| 36 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the | ||
| 37 | * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. | ||
| 38 | * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software | ||
| 39 | * must display the following acknowledgement: | ||
| 40 | * This product includes software developed by the NetBSD | ||
| 41 | * Foundation, Inc. and its contributors. | ||
| 42 | * 4. Neither the name of The NetBSD Foundation nor the names of its | ||
| 43 | * contributors may be used to endorse or promote products derived | ||
| 44 | * from this software without specific prior written permission. | ||
| 45 | * | ||
| 46 | * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE NETBSD FOUNDATION, INC. AND CONTRIBUTORS | ||
| 47 | * ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED | ||
| 48 | * TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR | ||
| 49 | * PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE FOUNDATION OR CONTRIBUTORS | ||
| 50 | * BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR | ||
| 51 | * CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF | ||
| 52 | * SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS | ||
| 53 | * INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN | ||
| 54 | * CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) | ||
| 55 | * ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE | ||
| 56 | * POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. | ||
| 57 | */ | ||
| 58 | |||
| 59 | #if defined(LIBC_SCCS) && !defined(lint) | ||
| 60 | static char *rcsid = "$OpenBSD: getopt_long.c,v 1.16 2004/02/04 18:17:25 millert Exp $"; | ||
| 61 | #endif /* LIBC_SCCS and not lint */ | ||
| 62 | |||
| 63 | #include <err.h> | ||
| 64 | #include <errno.h> | ||
| 65 | #include <getopt.h> | ||
| 66 | #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 67 | #include <string.h> | ||
| 68 | |||
| 69 | #define REPLACE_GETOPT /* use this getopt as the system getopt(3) */ | ||
| 70 | |||
| 71 | #ifdef REPLACE_GETOPT | ||
| 72 | int opterr = 1; /* if error message should be printed */ | ||
| 73 | int optind = 1; /* index into parent argv vector */ | ||
| 74 | int optopt = '?'; /* character checked for validity */ | ||
| 75 | int optreset; /* reset getopt */ | ||
| 76 | char *optarg; /* argument associated with option */ | ||
| 77 | #endif | ||
| 78 | |||
| 79 | #define PRINT_ERROR ((opterr) && (*options != ':')) | ||
| 80 | |||
| 81 | #define FLAG_PERMUTE 0x01 /* permute non-options to the end of argv */ | ||
| 82 | #define FLAG_ALLARGS 0x02 /* treat non-options as args to option "-1" */ | ||
| 83 | #define FLAG_LONGONLY 0x04 /* operate as getopt_long_only */ | ||
| 84 | |||
| 85 | /* return values */ | ||
| 86 | #define BADCH (int)'?' | ||
| 87 | #define BADARG ((*options == ':') ? (int)':' : (int)'?') | ||
| 88 | #define INORDER (int)1 | ||
| 89 | |||
| 90 | #define EMSG "" | ||
| 91 | |||
| 92 | static int getopt_internal(int, char * const *, const char *, | ||
| 93 | const struct option *, int *, int); | ||
| 94 | static int parse_long_options(char * const *, const char *, | ||
| 95 | const struct option *, int *, int); | ||
| 96 | static int gcd(int, int); | ||
| 97 | static void permute_args(int, int, int, char * const *); | ||
| 98 | |||
| 99 | static char *place = EMSG; /* option letter processing */ | ||
| 100 | |||
| 101 | /* XXX: set optreset to 1 rather than these two */ | ||
| 102 | static int nonopt_start = -1; /* first non option argument (for permute) */ | ||
| 103 | static int nonopt_end = -1; /* first option after non options (for permute) */ | ||
| 104 | |||
| 105 | /* Error messages */ | ||
| 106 | static const char recargchar[] = "option requires an argument -- %c"; | ||
| 107 | static const char recargstring[] = "option requires an argument -- %s"; | ||
| 108 | static const char ambig[] = "ambiguous option -- %.*s"; | ||
| 109 | static const char noarg[] = "option doesn't take an argument -- %.*s"; | ||
| 110 | static const char illoptchar[] = "unknown option -- %c"; | ||
| 111 | static const char illoptstring[] = "unknown option -- %s"; | ||
| 112 | |||
| 113 | /* | ||
| 114 | * Compute the greatest common divisor of a and b. | ||
| 115 | */ | ||
| 116 | static int | ||
| 117 | gcd(int a, int b) | ||
| 118 | { | ||
| 119 | int c; | ||
| 120 | |||
| 121 | c = a % b; | ||
| 122 | while (c != 0) { | ||
| 123 | a = b; | ||
| 124 | b = c; | ||
| 125 | c = a % b; | ||
| 126 | } | ||
| 127 | |||
| 128 | return (b); | ||
| 129 | } | ||
| 130 | |||
| 131 | /* | ||
| 132 | * Exchange the block from nonopt_start to nonopt_end with the block | ||
| 133 | * from nonopt_end to opt_end (keeping the same order of arguments | ||
| 134 | * in each block). | ||
| 135 | */ | ||
| 136 | static void | ||
| 137 | permute_args(int panonopt_start, int panonopt_end, int opt_end, | ||
| 138 | char * const *nargv) | ||
| 139 | { | ||
| 140 | int cstart, cyclelen, i, j, ncycle, nnonopts, nopts, pos; | ||
| 141 | char *swap; | ||
| 142 | |||
| 143 | /* | ||
| 144 | * compute lengths of blocks and number and size of cycles | ||
| 145 | */ | ||
| 146 | nnonopts = panonopt_end - panonopt_start; | ||
| 147 | nopts = opt_end - panonopt_end; | ||
| 148 | ncycle = gcd(nnonopts, nopts); | ||
| 149 | cyclelen = (opt_end - panonopt_start) / ncycle; | ||
| 150 | |||
| 151 | for (i = 0; i < ncycle; i++) { | ||
| 152 | cstart = panonopt_end+i; | ||
| 153 | pos = cstart; | ||
| 154 | for (j = 0; j < cyclelen; j++) { | ||
| 155 | if (pos >= panonopt_end) | ||
| 156 | pos -= nnonopts; | ||
| 157 | else | ||
| 158 | pos += nopts; | ||
| 159 | swap = nargv[pos]; | ||
| 160 | /* LINTED const cast */ | ||
| 161 | ((char **) nargv)[pos] = nargv[cstart]; | ||
| 162 | /* LINTED const cast */ | ||
| 163 | ((char **)nargv)[cstart] = swap; | ||
| 164 | } | ||
| 165 | } | ||
| 166 | } | ||
| 167 | |||
| 168 | /* | ||
| 169 | * parse_long_options -- | ||
| 170 | * Parse long options in argc/argv argument vector. | ||
| 171 | * Returns -1 if short_too is set and the option does not match long_options. | ||
| 172 | */ | ||
| 173 | static int | ||
| 174 | parse_long_options(char * const *nargv, const char *options, | ||
| 175 | const struct option *long_options, int *idx, int short_too) | ||
| 176 | { | ||
| 177 | char *current_argv, *has_equal; | ||
| 178 | size_t current_argv_len; | ||
| 179 | int i, match; | ||
| 180 | |||
| 181 | current_argv = place; | ||
| 182 | match = -1; | ||
| 183 | |||
| 184 | optind++; | ||
| 185 | |||
| 186 | if ((has_equal = strchr(current_argv, '=')) != NULL) { | ||
| 187 | /* argument found (--option=arg) */ | ||
| 188 | current_argv_len = has_equal - current_argv; | ||
| 189 | has_equal++; | ||
| 190 | } else | ||
| 191 | current_argv_len = strlen(current_argv); | ||
| 192 | |||
| 193 | for (i = 0; long_options[i].name; i++) { | ||
| 194 | /* find matching long option */ | ||
| 195 | if (strncmp(current_argv, long_options[i].name, | ||
| 196 | current_argv_len)) | ||
| 197 | continue; | ||
| 198 | |||
| 199 | if (strlen(long_options[i].name) == current_argv_len) { | ||
| 200 | /* exact match */ | ||
| 201 | match = i; | ||
| 202 | break; | ||
| 203 | } | ||
| 204 | /* | ||
| 205 | * If this is a known short option, don't allow | ||
| 206 | * a partial match of a single character. | ||
| 207 | */ | ||
| 208 | if (short_too && current_argv_len == 1) | ||
| 209 | continue; | ||
| 210 | |||
| 211 | if (match == -1) /* partial match */ | ||
| 212 | match = i; | ||
| 213 | else { | ||
| 214 | /* ambiguous abbreviation */ | ||
| 215 | if (PRINT_ERROR) | ||
| 216 | warnx(ambig, (int)current_argv_len, | ||
| 217 | current_argv); | ||
| 218 | optopt = 0; | ||
| 219 | return (BADCH); | ||
| 220 | } | ||
| 221 | } | ||
| 222 | if (match != -1) { /* option found */ | ||
| 223 | if (long_options[match].has_arg == no_argument | ||
| 224 | && has_equal) { | ||
| 225 | if (PRINT_ERROR) | ||
| 226 | warnx(noarg, (int)current_argv_len, | ||
| 227 | current_argv); | ||
| 228 | /* | ||
| 229 | * XXX: GNU sets optopt to val regardless of flag | ||
| 230 | */ | ||
| 231 | if (long_options[match].flag == NULL) | ||
| 232 | optopt = long_options[match].val; | ||
| 233 | else | ||
| 234 | optopt = 0; | ||
| 235 | return (BADARG); | ||
| 236 | } | ||
| 237 | if (long_options[match].has_arg == required_argument || | ||
| 238 | long_options[match].has_arg == optional_argument) { | ||
| 239 | if (has_equal) | ||
| 240 | optarg = has_equal; | ||
| 241 | else if (long_options[match].has_arg == | ||
| 242 | required_argument) { | ||
| 243 | /* | ||
| 244 | * optional argument doesn't use next nargv | ||
| 245 | */ | ||
| 246 | optarg = nargv[optind++]; | ||
| 247 | } | ||
| 248 | } | ||
| 249 | if ((long_options[match].has_arg == required_argument) | ||
| 250 | && (optarg == NULL)) { | ||
| 251 | /* | ||
| 252 | * Missing argument; leading ':' indicates no error | ||
| 253 | * should be generated. | ||
| 254 | */ | ||
| 255 | if (PRINT_ERROR) | ||
| 256 | warnx(recargstring, | ||
| 257 | current_argv); | ||
| 258 | /* | ||
| 259 | * XXX: GNU sets optopt to val regardless of flag | ||
| 260 | */ | ||
| 261 | if (long_options[match].flag == NULL) | ||
| 262 | optopt = long_options[match].val; | ||
| 263 | else | ||
| 264 | optopt = 0; | ||
| 265 | --optind; | ||
| 266 | return (BADARG); | ||
| 267 | } | ||
| 268 | } else { /* unknown option */ | ||
| 269 | if (short_too) { | ||
| 270 | --optind; | ||
| 271 | return (-1); | ||
| 272 | } | ||
| 273 | if (PRINT_ERROR) | ||
| 274 | warnx(illoptstring, current_argv); | ||
| 275 | optopt = 0; | ||
| 276 | return (BADCH); | ||
| 277 | } | ||
| 278 | if (idx) | ||
| 279 | *idx = match; | ||
| 280 | if (long_options[match].flag) { | ||
| 281 | *long_options[match].flag = long_options[match].val; | ||
| 282 | return (0); | ||
| 283 | } else | ||
| 284 | return (long_options[match].val); | ||
| 285 | } | ||
| 286 | |||
| 287 | /* | ||
| 288 | * getopt_internal -- | ||
| 289 | * Parse argc/argv argument vector. Called by user level routines. | ||
| 290 | */ | ||
| 291 | static int | ||
| 292 | getopt_internal(int nargc, char * const *nargv, const char *options, | ||
| 293 | const struct option *long_options, int *idx, int flags) | ||
| 294 | { | ||
| 295 | char *oli; /* option letter list index */ | ||
| 296 | int optchar, short_too; | ||
| 297 | static int posixly_correct = -1; | ||
| 298 | |||
| 299 | if (options == NULL) | ||
| 300 | return (-1); | ||
| 301 | |||
| 302 | /* | ||
| 303 | * Disable GNU extensions if POSIXLY_CORRECT is set or options | ||
| 304 | * string begins with a '+'. | ||
| 305 | */ | ||
| 306 | if (posixly_correct == -1) | ||
| 307 | posixly_correct = (getenv("POSIXLY_CORRECT") != NULL); | ||
| 308 | if (posixly_correct || *options == '+') | ||
| 309 | flags &= ~FLAG_PERMUTE; | ||
| 310 | else if (*options == '-') | ||
| 311 | flags |= FLAG_ALLARGS; | ||
| 312 | if (*options == '+' || *options == '-') | ||
| 313 | options++; | ||
| 314 | |||
| 315 | /* | ||
| 316 | * XXX Some GNU programs (like cvs) set optind to 0 instead of | ||
| 317 | * XXX using optreset. Work around this braindamage. | ||
| 318 | */ | ||
| 319 | if (optind == 0) | ||
| 320 | optind = optreset = 1; | ||
| 321 | |||
| 322 | optarg = NULL; | ||
| 323 | if (optreset) | ||
| 324 | nonopt_start = nonopt_end = -1; | ||
| 325 | start: | ||
| 326 | if (optreset || !*place) { /* update scanning pointer */ | ||
| 327 | optreset = 0; | ||
| 328 | if (optind >= nargc) { /* end of argument vector */ | ||
| 329 | place = EMSG; | ||
| 330 | if (nonopt_end != -1) { | ||
| 331 | /* do permutation, if we have to */ | ||
| 332 | permute_args(nonopt_start, nonopt_end, | ||
| 333 | optind, nargv); | ||
| 334 | optind -= nonopt_end - nonopt_start; | ||
| 335 | } | ||
| 336 | else if (nonopt_start != -1) { | ||
| 337 | /* | ||
| 338 | * If we skipped non-options, set optind | ||
| 339 | * to the first of them. | ||
| 340 | */ | ||
| 341 | optind = nonopt_start; | ||
| 342 | } | ||
| 343 | nonopt_start = nonopt_end = -1; | ||
| 344 | return (-1); | ||
| 345 | } | ||
| 346 | if (*(place = nargv[optind]) != '-' || | ||
| 347 | (place[1] == '\0' && strchr(options, '-') == NULL)) { | ||
| 348 | place = EMSG; /* found non-option */ | ||
| 349 | if (flags & FLAG_ALLARGS) { | ||
| 350 | /* | ||
| 351 | * GNU extension: | ||
| 352 | * return non-option as argument to option 1 | ||
| 353 | */ | ||
| 354 | optarg = nargv[optind++]; | ||
| 355 | return (INORDER); | ||
| 356 | } | ||
| 357 | if (!(flags & FLAG_PERMUTE)) { | ||
| 358 | /* | ||
| 359 | * If no permutation wanted, stop parsing | ||
| 360 | * at first non-option. | ||
| 361 | */ | ||
| 362 | return (-1); | ||
| 363 | } | ||
| 364 | /* do permutation */ | ||
| 365 | if (nonopt_start == -1) | ||
| 366 | nonopt_start = optind; | ||
| 367 | else if (nonopt_end != -1) { | ||
| 368 | permute_args(nonopt_start, nonopt_end, | ||
| 369 | optind, nargv); | ||
| 370 | nonopt_start = optind - | ||
| 371 | (nonopt_end - nonopt_start); | ||
| 372 | nonopt_end = -1; | ||
| 373 | } | ||
| 374 | optind++; | ||
| 375 | /* process next argument */ | ||
| 376 | goto start; | ||
| 377 | } | ||
| 378 | if (nonopt_start != -1 && nonopt_end == -1) | ||
| 379 | nonopt_end = optind; | ||
| 380 | |||
| 381 | /* | ||
| 382 | * If we have "-" do nothing, if "--" we are done. | ||
| 383 | */ | ||
| 384 | if (place[1] != '\0' && *++place == '-' && place[1] == '\0') { | ||
| 385 | optind++; | ||
| 386 | place = EMSG; | ||
| 387 | /* | ||
| 388 | * We found an option (--), so if we skipped | ||
| 389 | * non-options, we have to permute. | ||
| 390 | */ | ||
| 391 | if (nonopt_end != -1) { | ||
| 392 | permute_args(nonopt_start, nonopt_end, | ||
| 393 | optind, nargv); | ||
| 394 | optind -= nonopt_end - nonopt_start; | ||
| 395 | } | ||
| 396 | nonopt_start = nonopt_end = -1; | ||
| 397 | return (-1); | ||
| 398 | } | ||
| 399 | } | ||
| 400 | |||
| 401 | /* | ||
| 402 | * Check long options if: | ||
| 403 | * 1) we were passed some | ||
| 404 | * 2) the arg is not just "-" | ||
| 405 | * 3) either the arg starts with -- we are getopt_long_only() | ||
| 406 | */ | ||
| 407 | if (long_options != NULL && place != nargv[optind] && | ||
| 408 | (*place == '-' || (flags & FLAG_LONGONLY))) { | ||
| 409 | short_too = 0; | ||
| 410 | if (*place == '-') | ||
| 411 | place++; /* --foo long option */ | ||
| 412 | else if (*place != ':' && strchr(options, *place) != NULL) | ||
| 413 | short_too = 1; /* could be short option too */ | ||
| 414 | |||
| 415 | optchar = parse_long_options(nargv, options, long_options, | ||
| 416 | idx, short_too); | ||
| 417 | if (optchar != -1) { | ||
| 418 | place = EMSG; | ||
| 419 | return (optchar); | ||
| 420 | } | ||
| 421 | } | ||
| 422 | |||
| 423 | if ((optchar = (int)*place++) == (int)':' || | ||
| 424 | optchar == (int)'-' && *place != '\0' || | ||
| 425 | (oli = strchr(options, optchar)) == NULL) { | ||
| 426 | /* | ||
| 427 | * If the user specified "-" and '-' isn't listed in | ||
| 428 | * options, return -1 (non-option) as per POSIX. | ||
| 429 | * Otherwise, it is an unknown option character (or ':'). | ||
| 430 | */ | ||
| 431 | if (optchar == (int)'-' && *place == '\0') | ||
| 432 | return (-1); | ||
| 433 | if (!*place) | ||
| 434 | ++optind; | ||
| 435 | if (PRINT_ERROR) | ||
| 436 | warnx(illoptchar, optchar); | ||
| 437 | optopt = optchar; | ||
| 438 | return (BADCH); | ||
| 439 | } | ||
| 440 | if (long_options != NULL && optchar == 'W' && oli[1] == ';') { | ||
| 441 | /* -W long-option */ | ||
| 442 | if (*place) /* no space */ | ||
| 443 | /* NOTHING */; | ||
| 444 | else if (++optind >= nargc) { /* no arg */ | ||
| 445 | place = EMSG; | ||
| 446 | if (PRINT_ERROR) | ||
| 447 | warnx(recargchar, optchar); | ||
| 448 | optopt = optchar; | ||
| 449 | return (BADARG); | ||
| 450 | } else /* white space */ | ||
| 451 | place = nargv[optind]; | ||
| 452 | optchar = parse_long_options(nargv, options, long_options, | ||
| 453 | idx, 0); | ||
| 454 | place = EMSG; | ||
| 455 | return (optchar); | ||
| 456 | } | ||
| 457 | if (*++oli != ':') { /* doesn't take argument */ | ||
| 458 | if (!*place) | ||
| 459 | ++optind; | ||
| 460 | } else { /* takes (optional) argument */ | ||
| 461 | optarg = NULL; | ||
| 462 | if (*place) /* no white space */ | ||
| 463 | optarg = place; | ||
| 464 | /* XXX: disable test for :: if PC? (GNU doesn't) */ | ||
| 465 | else if (oli[1] != ':') { /* arg not optional */ | ||
| 466 | if (++optind >= nargc) { /* no arg */ | ||
| 467 | place = EMSG; | ||
| 468 | if (PRINT_ERROR) | ||
| 469 | warnx(recargchar, optchar); | ||
| 470 | optopt = optchar; | ||
| 471 | return (BADARG); | ||
| 472 | } else | ||
| 473 | optarg = nargv[optind]; | ||
| 474 | } else if (!(flags & FLAG_PERMUTE)) { | ||
| 475 | /* | ||
| 476 | * If permutation is disabled, we can accept an | ||
| 477 | * optional arg separated by whitespace. | ||
| 478 | */ | ||
| 479 | if (optind + 1 < nargc) | ||
| 480 | optarg = nargv[++optind]; | ||
| 481 | } | ||
| 482 | place = EMSG; | ||
| 483 | ++optind; | ||
| 484 | } | ||
| 485 | /* dump back option letter */ | ||
| 486 | return (optchar); | ||
| 487 | } | ||
| 488 | |||
| 489 | #ifdef REPLACE_GETOPT | ||
| 490 | /* | ||
| 491 | * getopt -- | ||
| 492 | * Parse argc/argv argument vector. | ||
| 493 | * | ||
| 494 | * [eventually this will replace the BSD getopt] | ||
| 495 | */ | ||
| 496 | int | ||
| 497 | getopt(int nargc, char * const *nargv, const char *options) | ||
| 498 | { | ||
| 499 | |||
| 500 | /* | ||
| 501 | * We dont' pass FLAG_PERMUTE to getopt_internal() since | ||
| 502 | * the BSD getopt(3) (unlike GNU) has never done this. | ||
| 503 | * | ||
| 504 | * Furthermore, since many privileged programs call getopt() | ||
| 505 | * before dropping privileges it makes sense to keep things | ||
| 506 | * as simple (and bug-free) as possible. | ||
| 507 | */ | ||
| 508 | return (getopt_internal(nargc, nargv, options, NULL, NULL, 0)); | ||
| 509 | } | ||
| 510 | #endif /* REPLACE_GETOPT */ | ||
| 511 | |||
| 512 | /* | ||
| 513 | * getopt_long -- | ||
| 514 | * Parse argc/argv argument vector. | ||
| 515 | */ | ||
| 516 | int | ||
| 517 | getopt_long(nargc, nargv, options, long_options, idx) | ||
| 518 | int nargc; | ||
| 519 | char * const *nargv; | ||
| 520 | const char *options; | ||
| 521 | const struct option *long_options; | ||
| 522 | int *idx; | ||
| 523 | { | ||
| 524 | |||
| 525 | return (getopt_internal(nargc, nargv, options, long_options, idx, | ||
| 526 | FLAG_PERMUTE)); | ||
| 527 | } | ||
| 528 | |||
| 529 | /* | ||
| 530 | * getopt_long_only -- | ||
| 531 | * Parse argc/argv argument vector. | ||
| 532 | */ | ||
| 533 | int | ||
| 534 | getopt_long_only(nargc, nargv, options, long_options, idx) | ||
| 535 | int nargc; | ||
| 536 | char * const *nargv; | ||
| 537 | const char *options; | ||
| 538 | const struct option *long_options; | ||
| 539 | int *idx; | ||
| 540 | { | ||
| 541 | |||
| 542 | return (getopt_internal(nargc, nargv, options, long_options, idx, | ||
| 543 | FLAG_PERMUTE|FLAG_LONGONLY)); | ||
| 544 | } | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/getsubopt.3 b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/getsubopt.3 new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..8513cfb66a --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/getsubopt.3 | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,143 @@ | |||
| 1 | .\" $OpenBSD: getsubopt.3,v 1.8 2004/01/23 23:08:46 jmc Exp $ | ||
| 2 | .\" | ||
| 3 | .\" Copyright (c) 1990, 1991, 1993 | ||
| 4 | .\" The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved. | ||
| 5 | .\" | ||
| 6 | .\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without | ||
| 7 | .\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions | ||
| 8 | .\" are met: | ||
| 9 | .\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright | ||
| 10 | .\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. | ||
| 11 | .\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright | ||
| 12 | .\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the | ||
| 13 | .\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. | ||
| 14 | .\" 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors | ||
| 15 | .\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software | ||
| 16 | .\" without specific prior written permission. | ||
| 17 | .\" | ||
| 18 | .\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND | ||
| 19 | .\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE | ||
| 20 | .\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE | ||
| 21 | .\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE | ||
| 22 | .\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL | ||
| 23 | .\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS | ||
| 24 | .\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) | ||
| 25 | .\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT | ||
| 26 | .\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY | ||
| 27 | .\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF | ||
| 28 | .\" SUCH DAMAGE. | ||
| 29 | .\" | ||
| 30 | .\" @(#)getsubopt.3 8.1 (Berkeley) 6/9/93 | ||
| 31 | .\" | ||
| 32 | .Dd June 9, 1993 | ||
| 33 | .Dt GETSUBOPT 3 | ||
| 34 | .Os | ||
| 35 | .Sh NAME | ||
| 36 | .Nm getsubopt | ||
| 37 | .Nd get sub options from an argument | ||
| 38 | .Sh SYNOPSIS | ||
| 39 | .Fd #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 40 | .Vt extern char *suboptarg; | ||
| 41 | .Ft int | ||
| 42 | .Fn getsubopt "char **optionp" "char * const *tokens" "char **valuep" | ||
| 43 | .Sh DESCRIPTION | ||
| 44 | The | ||
| 45 | .Fn getsubopt | ||
| 46 | function parses a string containing tokens delimited by one or more | ||
| 47 | tab, space or comma | ||
| 48 | .Pq Ql \&, | ||
| 49 | characters. | ||
| 50 | It is intended for use in parsing groups of option arguments provided | ||
| 51 | as part of a utility command line. | ||
| 52 | .Pp | ||
| 53 | The argument | ||
| 54 | .Fa optionp | ||
| 55 | is a pointer to a pointer to the string. | ||
| 56 | The argument | ||
| 57 | .Fa tokens | ||
| 58 | is a pointer to a null-terminated array of pointers to strings. | ||
| 59 | .Pp | ||
| 60 | The | ||
| 61 | .Fn getsubopt | ||
| 62 | function returns the zero-based offset of the pointer in the | ||
| 63 | .Fa tokens | ||
| 64 | array referencing a string which matches the first token | ||
| 65 | in the string, or \-1 if the string contains no tokens or | ||
| 66 | .Fa tokens | ||
| 67 | does not contain a matching string. | ||
| 68 | .Pp | ||
| 69 | If the token is of the form | ||
| 70 | .Ar name Ns = Ns Ar value , | ||
| 71 | the location referenced by | ||
| 72 | .Fa valuep | ||
| 73 | will be set to point to the start of the | ||
| 74 | .Dq value | ||
| 75 | portion of the token. | ||
| 76 | .Pp | ||
| 77 | On return from | ||
| 78 | .Fn getsubopt , | ||
| 79 | .Fa optionp | ||
| 80 | will be set to point to the start of the next token in the string, | ||
| 81 | or the null at the end of the string if no more tokens are present. | ||
| 82 | The external variable | ||
| 83 | .Fa suboptarg | ||
| 84 | will be set to point to the start of the current token, or | ||
| 85 | .Dv NULL | ||
| 86 | if no tokens were present. | ||
| 87 | The argument | ||
| 88 | .Fa valuep | ||
| 89 | will be set to point to the value portion of the token, or | ||
| 90 | .Dv NULL | ||
| 91 | if no value portion was present. | ||
| 92 | .Sh EXAMPLES | ||
| 93 | .Bd -literal -compact | ||
| 94 | char *tokens[] = { | ||
| 95 | #define ONE 0 | ||
| 96 | "one", | ||
| 97 | #define TWO 1 | ||
| 98 | "two", | ||
| 99 | NULL | ||
| 100 | }; | ||
| 101 | |||
| 102 | \&... | ||
| 103 | |||
| 104 | extern char *optarg, *suboptarg; | ||
| 105 | char *options, *value; | ||
| 106 | |||
| 107 | while ((ch = getopt(argc, argv, "ab:")) != \-1) { | ||
| 108 | switch(ch) { | ||
| 109 | case 'a': | ||
| 110 | /* process ``a'' option */ | ||
| 111 | break; | ||
| 112 | case 'b': | ||
| 113 | options = optarg; | ||
| 114 | while (*options) { | ||
| 115 | switch(getsubopt(&options, tokens, &value)) { | ||
| 116 | case ONE: | ||
| 117 | /* process ``one'' sub option */ | ||
| 118 | break; | ||
| 119 | case TWO: | ||
| 120 | /* process ``two'' sub option */ | ||
| 121 | if (!value) | ||
| 122 | error("no value for two"); | ||
| 123 | i = atoi(value); | ||
| 124 | break; | ||
| 125 | case \-1: | ||
| 126 | if (suboptarg) | ||
| 127 | error("illegal sub option %s", | ||
| 128 | suboptarg); | ||
| 129 | else | ||
| 130 | error("missing sub option"); | ||
| 131 | break; | ||
| 132 | } | ||
| 133 | break; | ||
| 134 | } | ||
| 135 | .Ed | ||
| 136 | .Sh SEE ALSO | ||
| 137 | .Xr getopt 3 , | ||
| 138 | .Xr strsep 3 | ||
| 139 | .Sh HISTORY | ||
| 140 | The | ||
| 141 | .Fn getsubopt | ||
| 142 | function first appeared in | ||
| 143 | .Bx 4.4 . | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/getsubopt.c b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/getsubopt.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..308458ea75 --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/getsubopt.c | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,102 @@ | |||
| 1 | /* $OpenBSD: getsubopt.c,v 1.2 2003/06/02 20:18:37 millert Exp $ */ | ||
| 2 | |||
| 3 | /*- | ||
| 4 | * Copyright (c) 1990, 1993 | ||
| 5 | * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved. | ||
| 6 | * | ||
| 7 | * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without | ||
| 8 | * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions | ||
| 9 | * are met: | ||
| 10 | * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright | ||
| 11 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. | ||
| 12 | * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright | ||
| 13 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the | ||
| 14 | * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. | ||
| 15 | * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors | ||
| 16 | * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software | ||
| 17 | * without specific prior written permission. | ||
| 18 | * | ||
| 19 | * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND | ||
| 20 | * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE | ||
| 21 | * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE | ||
| 22 | * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE | ||
| 23 | * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL | ||
| 24 | * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS | ||
| 25 | * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) | ||
| 26 | * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT | ||
| 27 | * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY | ||
| 28 | * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF | ||
| 29 | * SUCH DAMAGE. | ||
| 30 | */ | ||
| 31 | |||
| 32 | #ifndef lint | ||
| 33 | #if 0 | ||
| 34 | static char sccsid[] = "@(#)getsubopt.c 8.1 (Berkeley) 6/4/93"; | ||
| 35 | #else | ||
| 36 | static char rcsid[] = "$OpenBSD: getsubopt.c,v 1.2 2003/06/02 20:18:37 millert Exp $"; | ||
| 37 | #endif | ||
| 38 | #endif /* not lint */ | ||
| 39 | |||
| 40 | #include <unistd.h> | ||
| 41 | #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 42 | #include <string.h> | ||
| 43 | |||
| 44 | /* | ||
| 45 | * The SVID interface to getsubopt provides no way of figuring out which | ||
| 46 | * part of the suboptions list wasn't matched. This makes error messages | ||
| 47 | * tricky... The extern variable suboptarg is a pointer to the token | ||
| 48 | * which didn't match. | ||
| 49 | */ | ||
| 50 | char *suboptarg; | ||
| 51 | |||
| 52 | int | ||
| 53 | getsubopt(optionp, tokens, valuep) | ||
| 54 | register char **optionp, **valuep; | ||
| 55 | register char * const *tokens; | ||
| 56 | { | ||
| 57 | register int cnt; | ||
| 58 | register char *p; | ||
| 59 | |||
| 60 | suboptarg = *valuep = NULL; | ||
| 61 | |||
| 62 | if (!optionp || !*optionp) | ||
| 63 | return(-1); | ||
| 64 | |||
| 65 | /* skip leading white-space, commas */ | ||
| 66 | for (p = *optionp; *p && (*p == ',' || *p == ' ' || *p == '\t'); ++p); | ||
| 67 | |||
| 68 | if (!*p) { | ||
| 69 | *optionp = p; | ||
| 70 | return(-1); | ||
| 71 | } | ||
| 72 | |||
| 73 | /* save the start of the token, and skip the rest of the token. */ | ||
| 74 | for (suboptarg = p; | ||
| 75 | *++p && *p != ',' && *p != '=' && *p != ' ' && *p != '\t';); | ||
| 76 | |||
| 77 | if (*p) { | ||
| 78 | /* | ||
| 79 | * If there's an equals sign, set the value pointer, and | ||
| 80 | * skip over the value part of the token. Terminate the | ||
| 81 | * token. | ||
| 82 | */ | ||
| 83 | if (*p == '=') { | ||
| 84 | *p = '\0'; | ||
| 85 | for (*valuep = ++p; | ||
| 86 | *p && *p != ',' && *p != ' ' && *p != '\t'; ++p); | ||
| 87 | if (*p) | ||
| 88 | *p++ = '\0'; | ||
| 89 | } else | ||
| 90 | *p++ = '\0'; | ||
| 91 | /* Skip any whitespace or commas after this token. */ | ||
| 92 | for (; *p && (*p == ',' || *p == ' ' || *p == '\t'); ++p); | ||
| 93 | } | ||
| 94 | |||
| 95 | /* set optionp for next round. */ | ||
| 96 | *optionp = p; | ||
| 97 | |||
| 98 | for (cnt = 0; *tokens; ++tokens, ++cnt) | ||
| 99 | if (!strcmp(suboptarg, *tokens)) | ||
| 100 | return(cnt); | ||
| 101 | return(-1); | ||
| 102 | } | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/heapsort.c b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/heapsort.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f4aeeef7a3 --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/heapsort.c | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,179 @@ | |||
| 1 | /*- | ||
| 2 | * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993 | ||
| 3 | * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved. | ||
| 4 | * | ||
| 5 | * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by | ||
| 6 | * Ronnie Kon at Mindcraft Inc., Kevin Lew and Elmer Yglesias. | ||
| 7 | * | ||
| 8 | * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without | ||
| 9 | * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions | ||
| 10 | * are met: | ||
| 11 | * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright | ||
| 12 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. | ||
| 13 | * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright | ||
| 14 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the | ||
| 15 | * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. | ||
| 16 | * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors | ||
| 17 | * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software | ||
| 18 | * without specific prior written permission. | ||
| 19 | * | ||
| 20 | * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND | ||
| 21 | * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE | ||
| 22 | * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE | ||
| 23 | * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE | ||
| 24 | * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL | ||
| 25 | * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS | ||
| 26 | * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) | ||
| 27 | * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT | ||
| 28 | * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY | ||
| 29 | * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF | ||
| 30 | * SUCH DAMAGE. | ||
| 31 | */ | ||
| 32 | |||
| 33 | #if defined(LIBC_SCCS) && !defined(lint) | ||
| 34 | static char *rcsid = "$OpenBSD: heapsort.c,v 1.6 2003/09/08 16:24:05 deraadt Exp $"; | ||
| 35 | #endif /* LIBC_SCCS and not lint */ | ||
| 36 | |||
| 37 | #include <sys/types.h> | ||
| 38 | #include <errno.h> | ||
| 39 | #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 40 | |||
| 41 | /* | ||
| 42 | * Swap two areas of size number of bytes. Although qsort(3) permits random | ||
| 43 | * blocks of memory to be sorted, sorting pointers is almost certainly the | ||
| 44 | * common case (and, were it not, could easily be made so). Regardless, it | ||
| 45 | * isn't worth optimizing; the SWAP's get sped up by the cache, and pointer | ||
| 46 | * arithmetic gets lost in the time required for comparison function calls. | ||
| 47 | */ | ||
| 48 | #define SWAP(a, b, count, size, tmp) { \ | ||
| 49 | count = size; \ | ||
| 50 | do { \ | ||
| 51 | tmp = *a; \ | ||
| 52 | *a++ = *b; \ | ||
| 53 | *b++ = tmp; \ | ||
| 54 | } while (--count); \ | ||
| 55 | } | ||
| 56 | |||
| 57 | /* Copy one block of size size to another. */ | ||
| 58 | #define COPY(a, b, count, size, tmp1, tmp2) { \ | ||
| 59 | count = size; \ | ||
| 60 | tmp1 = a; \ | ||
| 61 | tmp2 = b; \ | ||
| 62 | do { \ | ||
| 63 | *tmp1++ = *tmp2++; \ | ||
| 64 | } while (--count); \ | ||
| 65 | } | ||
| 66 | |||
| 67 | /* | ||
| 68 | * Build the list into a heap, where a heap is defined such that for | ||
| 69 | * the records K1 ... KN, Kj/2 >= Kj for 1 <= j/2 <= j <= N. | ||
| 70 | * | ||
| 71 | * There are two cases. If j == nmemb, select largest of Ki and Kj. If | ||
| 72 | * j < nmemb, select largest of Ki, Kj and Kj+1. | ||
| 73 | */ | ||
| 74 | #define CREATE(initval, nmemb, par_i, child_i, par, child, size, count, tmp) { \ | ||
| 75 | for (par_i = initval; (child_i = par_i * 2) <= nmemb; \ | ||
| 76 | par_i = child_i) { \ | ||
| 77 | child = base + child_i * size; \ | ||
| 78 | if (child_i < nmemb && compar(child, child + size) < 0) { \ | ||
| 79 | child += size; \ | ||
| 80 | ++child_i; \ | ||
| 81 | } \ | ||
| 82 | par = base + par_i * size; \ | ||
| 83 | if (compar(child, par) <= 0) \ | ||
| 84 | break; \ | ||
| 85 | SWAP(par, child, count, size, tmp); \ | ||
| 86 | } \ | ||
| 87 | } | ||
| 88 | |||
| 89 | /* | ||
| 90 | * Select the top of the heap and 'heapify'. Since by far the most expensive | ||
| 91 | * action is the call to the compar function, a considerable optimization | ||
| 92 | * in the average case can be achieved due to the fact that k, the displaced | ||
| 93 | * element, is usually quite small, so it would be preferable to first | ||
| 94 | * heapify, always maintaining the invariant that the larger child is copied | ||
| 95 | * over its parent's record. | ||
| 96 | * | ||
| 97 | * Then, starting from the *bottom* of the heap, finding k's correct place, | ||
| 98 | * again maintaining the invariant. As a result of the invariant no element | ||
| 99 | * is 'lost' when k is assigned its correct place in the heap. | ||
| 100 | * | ||
| 101 | * The time savings from this optimization are on the order of 15-20% for the | ||
| 102 | * average case. See Knuth, Vol. 3, page 158, problem 18. | ||
| 103 | * | ||
| 104 | * XXX Don't break the #define SELECT line, below. Reiser cpp gets upset. | ||
| 105 | */ | ||
| 106 | #define SELECT(par_i, child_i, nmemb, par, child, size, k, count, tmp1, tmp2) { \ | ||
| 107 | for (par_i = 1; (child_i = par_i * 2) <= nmemb; par_i = child_i) { \ | ||
| 108 | child = base + child_i * size; \ | ||
| 109 | if (child_i < nmemb && compar(child, child + size) < 0) { \ | ||
| 110 | child += size; \ | ||
| 111 | ++child_i; \ | ||
| 112 | } \ | ||
| 113 | par = base + par_i * size; \ | ||
| 114 | COPY(par, child, count, size, tmp1, tmp2); \ | ||
| 115 | } \ | ||
| 116 | for (;;) { \ | ||
| 117 | child_i = par_i; \ | ||
| 118 | par_i = child_i / 2; \ | ||
| 119 | child = base + child_i * size; \ | ||
| 120 | par = base + par_i * size; \ | ||
| 121 | if (child_i == 1 || compar(k, par) < 0) { \ | ||
| 122 | COPY(child, k, count, size, tmp1, tmp2); \ | ||
| 123 | break; \ | ||
| 124 | } \ | ||
| 125 | COPY(child, par, count, size, tmp1, tmp2); \ | ||
| 126 | } \ | ||
| 127 | } | ||
| 128 | |||
| 129 | /* | ||
| 130 | * Heapsort -- Knuth, Vol. 3, page 145. Runs in O (N lg N), both average | ||
| 131 | * and worst. While heapsort is faster than the worst case of quicksort, | ||
| 132 | * the BSD quicksort does median selection so that the chance of finding | ||
| 133 | * a data set that will trigger the worst case is nonexistent. Heapsort's | ||
| 134 | * only advantage over quicksort is that it requires little additional memory. | ||
| 135 | */ | ||
| 136 | int | ||
| 137 | heapsort(vbase, nmemb, size, compar) | ||
| 138 | void *vbase; | ||
| 139 | size_t nmemb, size; | ||
| 140 | int (*compar)(const void *, const void *); | ||
| 141 | { | ||
| 142 | register int cnt, i, j, l; | ||
| 143 | register char tmp, *tmp1, *tmp2; | ||
| 144 | char *base, *k, *p, *t; | ||
| 145 | |||
| 146 | if (nmemb <= 1) | ||
| 147 | return (0); | ||
| 148 | |||
| 149 | if (!size) { | ||
| 150 | errno = EINVAL; | ||
| 151 | return (-1); | ||
| 152 | } | ||
| 153 | |||
| 154 | if ((k = malloc(size)) == NULL) | ||
| 155 | return (-1); | ||
| 156 | |||
| 157 | /* | ||
| 158 | * Items are numbered from 1 to nmemb, so offset from size bytes | ||
| 159 | * below the starting address. | ||
| 160 | */ | ||
| 161 | base = (char *)vbase - size; | ||
| 162 | |||
| 163 | for (l = nmemb / 2 + 1; --l;) | ||
| 164 | CREATE(l, nmemb, i, j, t, p, size, cnt, tmp); | ||
| 165 | |||
| 166 | /* | ||
| 167 | * For each element of the heap, save the largest element into its | ||
| 168 | * final slot, save the displaced element (k), then recreate the | ||
| 169 | * heap. | ||
| 170 | */ | ||
| 171 | while (nmemb > 1) { | ||
| 172 | COPY(k, base + nmemb * size, cnt, size, tmp1, tmp2); | ||
| 173 | COPY(base + nmemb * size, base + size, cnt, size, tmp1, tmp2); | ||
| 174 | --nmemb; | ||
| 175 | SELECT(i, j, nmemb, t, p, size, k, cnt, tmp1, tmp2); | ||
| 176 | } | ||
| 177 | free(k); | ||
| 178 | return (0); | ||
| 179 | } | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/insque.3 b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/insque.3 new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..cd8110ed90 --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/insque.3 | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,100 @@ | |||
| 1 | .\" $OpenBSD: insque.3,v 1.3 2004/01/25 14:48:32 jmc Exp $ | ||
| 2 | .\" Copyright (c) 1993 John Brezak | ||
| 3 | .\" All rights reserved. | ||
| 4 | .\" | ||
| 5 | .\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without | ||
| 6 | .\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions | ||
| 7 | .\" are met: | ||
| 8 | .\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright | ||
| 9 | .\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. | ||
| 10 | .\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright | ||
| 11 | .\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the | ||
| 12 | .\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. | ||
| 13 | .\" 3. The name of the author may be used to endorse or promote products | ||
| 14 | .\" derived from this software without specific prior written permission. | ||
| 15 | .\" | ||
| 16 | .\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE AUTHOR `AS IS'' AND | ||
| 17 | .\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE | ||
| 18 | .\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE | ||
| 19 | .\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE | ||
| 20 | .\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL | ||
| 21 | .\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS | ||
| 22 | .\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) | ||
| 23 | .\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT | ||
| 24 | .\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY | ||
| 25 | .\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF | ||
| 26 | .\" SUCH DAMAGE. | ||
| 27 | .\" | ||
| 28 | .\" | ||
| 29 | .Dd August 12, 1993 | ||
| 30 | .Dt INSQUE 3 | ||
| 31 | .Os | ||
| 32 | .Sh NAME | ||
| 33 | .Nm insque , | ||
| 34 | .Nm remque | ||
| 35 | .Nd insert/remove element from a queue | ||
| 36 | .Sh SYNOPSIS | ||
| 37 | .Fd #include <search.h> | ||
| 38 | .Ft void | ||
| 39 | .Fn insque "void *elem" "void *pred" | ||
| 40 | .Ft void | ||
| 41 | .Fn remque "void *elem" | ||
| 42 | .Sh DESCRIPTION | ||
| 43 | .Bf -symbolic | ||
| 44 | These interfaces have been superceded by the | ||
| 45 | .Xr queue 3 | ||
| 46 | macros and are provided for compatibility with legacy code. | ||
| 47 | .Ef | ||
| 48 | .Pp | ||
| 49 | .Fn insque | ||
| 50 | and | ||
| 51 | .Fn remque | ||
| 52 | manipulate queues built from doubly linked lists. | ||
| 53 | The queue can be either circular or linear. | ||
| 54 | Each element in the queue must be of the following form: | ||
| 55 | .Bd -literal | ||
| 56 | struct qelem { | ||
| 57 | struct qelem *q_forw; | ||
| 58 | struct qelem *q_back; | ||
| 59 | char q_data[]; | ||
| 60 | }; | ||
| 61 | .Ed | ||
| 62 | .Pp | ||
| 63 | The first two elements in the struct must be pointers of the | ||
| 64 | same type that point to the previous and next elements in | ||
| 65 | the queue respectively. | ||
| 66 | Any subsequent data in the struct is application-dependent. | ||
| 67 | .Pp | ||
| 68 | The | ||
| 69 | .Fn insque | ||
| 70 | function inserts | ||
| 71 | .Fa elem | ||
| 72 | into a queue immediately after | ||
| 73 | .Fa pred . | ||
| 74 | .Pp | ||
| 75 | The | ||
| 76 | .Fn remque | ||
| 77 | function removes | ||
| 78 | .Fa elem | ||
| 79 | from the queue. | ||
| 80 | .Sh DIAGNOSTICS | ||
| 81 | These functions are not atomic unless that machine architecture allows it. | ||
| 82 | .Sh SEE ALSO | ||
| 83 | .Xr queue 3 | ||
| 84 | .Sh STANDARDS | ||
| 85 | The | ||
| 86 | .Fn lsearch | ||
| 87 | and | ||
| 88 | .Fn lfind | ||
| 89 | functions conform to the | ||
| 90 | .St -p1003.1-2001 | ||
| 91 | and | ||
| 92 | .St -xpg4.3 . | ||
| 93 | specifications. | ||
| 94 | .Sh HISTORY | ||
| 95 | The | ||
| 96 | .Fn insque | ||
| 97 | and | ||
| 98 | .Fn remque | ||
| 99 | functions are derived from the insque and remque instructions on a | ||
| 100 | .Tn VAX . | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/insque.c b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/insque.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..549246c71f --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/insque.c | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,52 @@ | |||
| 1 | /* $OpenBSD: insque.c,v 1.1 2003/05/08 23:26:30 millert Exp $ */ | ||
| 2 | |||
| 3 | /* | ||
| 4 | * Copyright (c) 1993 John Brezak | ||
| 5 | * All rights reserved. | ||
| 6 | * | ||
| 7 | * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without | ||
| 8 | * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions | ||
| 9 | * are met: | ||
| 10 | * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright | ||
| 11 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. | ||
| 12 | * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright | ||
| 13 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the | ||
| 14 | * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. | ||
| 15 | * 3. The name of the author may be used to endorse or promote products | ||
| 16 | * derived from this software without specific prior written permission. | ||
| 17 | * | ||
| 18 | * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE AUTHOR `AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR | ||
| 19 | * IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED | ||
| 20 | * WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE | ||
| 21 | * DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, | ||
| 22 | * INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES | ||
| 23 | * (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR | ||
| 24 | * SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) | ||
| 25 | * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, | ||
| 26 | * STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN | ||
| 27 | * ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE | ||
| 28 | * POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. | ||
| 29 | */ | ||
| 30 | |||
| 31 | #if defined(LIBC_SCCS) && !defined(lint) | ||
| 32 | static char *rcsid = "$OpenBSD: insque.c,v 1.1 2003/05/08 23:26:30 millert Exp $"; | ||
| 33 | #endif /* LIBC_SCCS and not lint */ | ||
| 34 | |||
| 35 | #include <search.h> | ||
| 36 | |||
| 37 | struct qelem { | ||
| 38 | struct qelem *q_forw; | ||
| 39 | struct qelem *q_back; | ||
| 40 | }; | ||
| 41 | |||
| 42 | void | ||
| 43 | insque(void *entry, void *pred) | ||
| 44 | { | ||
| 45 | struct qelem *e = (struct qelem *) entry; | ||
| 46 | struct qelem *p = (struct qelem *) pred; | ||
| 47 | |||
| 48 | e->q_forw = p->q_forw; | ||
| 49 | e->q_back = p; | ||
| 50 | p->q_forw->q_back = e; | ||
| 51 | p->q_forw = e; | ||
| 52 | } | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/jrand48.c b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/jrand48.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..99cddb71e5 --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/jrand48.c | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,25 @@ | |||
| 1 | /* | ||
| 2 | * Copyright (c) 1993 Martin Birgmeier | ||
| 3 | * All rights reserved. | ||
| 4 | * | ||
| 5 | * You may redistribute unmodified or modified versions of this source | ||
| 6 | * code provided that the above copyright notice and this and the | ||
| 7 | * following conditions are retained. | ||
| 8 | * | ||
| 9 | * This software is provided ``as is'', and comes with no warranties | ||
| 10 | * of any kind. I shall in no event be liable for anything that happens | ||
| 11 | * to anyone/anything when using this software. | ||
| 12 | */ | ||
| 13 | |||
| 14 | #if defined(LIBC_SCCS) && !defined(lint) | ||
| 15 | static char rcsid[] = "$OpenBSD: jrand48.c,v 1.2 1996/08/19 08:33:33 tholo Exp $"; | ||
| 16 | #endif /* LIBC_SCCS and not lint */ | ||
| 17 | |||
| 18 | #include "rand48.h" | ||
| 19 | |||
| 20 | long | ||
| 21 | jrand48(unsigned short xseed[3]) | ||
| 22 | { | ||
| 23 | __dorand48(xseed); | ||
| 24 | return ((long) xseed[2] << 16) + (long) xseed[1]; | ||
| 25 | } | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/l64a.c b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/l64a.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..4e99391254 --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/l64a.c | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,46 @@ | |||
| 1 | /* | ||
| 2 | * Written by J.T. Conklin <jtc@netbsd.org>. | ||
| 3 | * Public domain. | ||
| 4 | */ | ||
| 5 | |||
| 6 | #if defined(LIBC_SCCS) && !defined(lint) | ||
| 7 | static char *rcsid = "$OpenBSD: l64a.c,v 1.3 1997/08/17 22:58:34 millert Exp $"; | ||
| 8 | #endif /* LIBC_SCCS and not lint */ | ||
| 9 | |||
| 10 | #include <errno.h> | ||
| 11 | #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 12 | |||
| 13 | char * | ||
| 14 | l64a(value) | ||
| 15 | long value; | ||
| 16 | { | ||
| 17 | static char buf[8]; | ||
| 18 | char *s = buf; | ||
| 19 | int digit; | ||
| 20 | int i; | ||
| 21 | |||
| 22 | if (value < 0) { | ||
| 23 | errno = EINVAL; | ||
| 24 | return(NULL); | ||
| 25 | } | ||
| 26 | |||
| 27 | for (i = 0; value != 0 && i < 6; i++) { | ||
| 28 | digit = value & 0x3f; | ||
| 29 | |||
| 30 | if (digit < 2) | ||
| 31 | *s = digit + '.'; | ||
| 32 | else if (digit < 12) | ||
| 33 | *s = digit + '0' - 2; | ||
| 34 | else if (digit < 38) | ||
| 35 | *s = digit + 'A' - 12; | ||
| 36 | else | ||
| 37 | *s = digit + 'a' - 38; | ||
| 38 | |||
| 39 | value >>= 6; | ||
| 40 | s++; | ||
| 41 | } | ||
| 42 | |||
| 43 | *s = '\0'; | ||
| 44 | |||
| 45 | return(buf); | ||
| 46 | } | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/labs.3 b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/labs.3 new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..742f3eedba --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/labs.3 | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,68 @@ | |||
| 1 | .\" Copyright (c) 1990, 1991 The Regents of the University of California. | ||
| 2 | .\" All rights reserved. | ||
| 3 | .\" | ||
| 4 | .\" This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by | ||
| 5 | .\" the American National Standards Committee X3, on Information | ||
| 6 | .\" Processing Systems. | ||
| 7 | .\" | ||
| 8 | .\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without | ||
| 9 | .\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions | ||
| 10 | .\" are met: | ||
| 11 | .\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright | ||
| 12 | .\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. | ||
| 13 | .\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright | ||
| 14 | .\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the | ||
| 15 | .\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. | ||
| 16 | .\" 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors | ||
| 17 | .\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software | ||
| 18 | .\" without specific prior written permission. | ||
| 19 | .\" | ||
| 20 | .\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND | ||
| 21 | .\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE | ||
| 22 | .\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE | ||
| 23 | .\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE | ||
| 24 | .\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL | ||
| 25 | .\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS | ||
| 26 | .\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) | ||
| 27 | .\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT | ||
| 28 | .\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY | ||
| 29 | .\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF | ||
| 30 | .\" SUCH DAMAGE. | ||
| 31 | .\" | ||
| 32 | .\" $OpenBSD: labs.3,v 1.7 2003/07/21 20:20:04 millert Exp $ | ||
| 33 | .\" | ||
| 34 | .Dd May 14, 2003 | ||
| 35 | .Dt LABS 3 | ||
| 36 | .Os | ||
| 37 | .Sh NAME | ||
| 38 | .Nm labs, llabs | ||
| 39 | .Nd return the absolute value of a long integer | ||
| 40 | .Sh SYNOPSIS | ||
| 41 | .Fd #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 42 | .Ft long | ||
| 43 | .Fn labs "long i" | ||
| 44 | .Ft long long | ||
| 45 | .Fn llabs "long long j" | ||
| 46 | .Sh DESCRIPTION | ||
| 47 | The | ||
| 48 | .Fn labs | ||
| 49 | function returns the absolute value of the long integer | ||
| 50 | .Fa i . | ||
| 51 | The | ||
| 52 | .Fn llabs | ||
| 53 | function returns the absolute value of the long long integer | ||
| 54 | .Fa j . | ||
| 55 | .Sh SEE ALSO | ||
| 56 | .Xr abs 3 , | ||
| 57 | .Xr cabs 3 , | ||
| 58 | .Xr floor 3 , | ||
| 59 | .Xr math 3 | ||
| 60 | .Sh STANDARDS | ||
| 61 | The | ||
| 62 | .Fn labs | ||
| 63 | and | ||
| 64 | .Fn llabs | ||
| 65 | functions conform to | ||
| 66 | .St -ansiC-99 . | ||
| 67 | .Sh BUGS | ||
| 68 | The absolute value of the most negative integer remains negative. | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/labs.c b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/labs.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..51ef490d97 --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/labs.c | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,41 @@ | |||
| 1 | /*- | ||
| 2 | * Copyright (c) 1990 The Regents of the University of California. | ||
| 3 | * All rights reserved. | ||
| 4 | * | ||
| 5 | * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without | ||
| 6 | * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions | ||
| 7 | * are met: | ||
| 8 | * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright | ||
| 9 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. | ||
| 10 | * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright | ||
| 11 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the | ||
| 12 | * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. | ||
| 13 | * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors | ||
| 14 | * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software | ||
| 15 | * without specific prior written permission. | ||
| 16 | * | ||
| 17 | * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND | ||
| 18 | * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE | ||
| 19 | * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE | ||
| 20 | * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE | ||
| 21 | * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL | ||
| 22 | * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS | ||
| 23 | * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) | ||
| 24 | * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT | ||
| 25 | * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY | ||
| 26 | * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF | ||
| 27 | * SUCH DAMAGE. | ||
| 28 | */ | ||
| 29 | |||
| 30 | #if defined(LIBC_SCCS) && !defined(lint) | ||
| 31 | static char *rcsid = "$OpenBSD: labs.c,v 1.3 2003/06/02 20:18:37 millert Exp $"; | ||
| 32 | #endif /* LIBC_SCCS and not lint */ | ||
| 33 | |||
| 34 | #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 35 | |||
| 36 | long | ||
| 37 | labs(j) | ||
| 38 | long j; | ||
| 39 | { | ||
| 40 | return(j < 0 ? -j : j); | ||
| 41 | } | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/lcong48.c b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/lcong48.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..44bd74e48a --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/lcong48.c | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,34 @@ | |||
| 1 | /* | ||
| 2 | * Copyright (c) 1993 Martin Birgmeier | ||
| 3 | * All rights reserved. | ||
| 4 | * | ||
| 5 | * You may redistribute unmodified or modified versions of this source | ||
| 6 | * code provided that the above copyright notice and this and the | ||
| 7 | * following conditions are retained. | ||
| 8 | * | ||
| 9 | * This software is provided ``as is'', and comes with no warranties | ||
| 10 | * of any kind. I shall in no event be liable for anything that happens | ||
| 11 | * to anyone/anything when using this software. | ||
| 12 | */ | ||
| 13 | |||
| 14 | #if defined(LIBC_SCCS) && !defined(lint) | ||
| 15 | static char rcsid[] = "$OpenBSD: lcong48.c,v 1.2 1996/08/19 08:33:35 tholo Exp $"; | ||
| 16 | #endif /* LIBC_SCCS and not lint */ | ||
| 17 | |||
| 18 | #include "rand48.h" | ||
| 19 | |||
| 20 | extern unsigned short __rand48_seed[3]; | ||
| 21 | extern unsigned short __rand48_mult[3]; | ||
| 22 | extern unsigned short __rand48_add; | ||
| 23 | |||
| 24 | void | ||
| 25 | lcong48(unsigned short p[7]) | ||
| 26 | { | ||
| 27 | __rand48_seed[0] = p[0]; | ||
| 28 | __rand48_seed[1] = p[1]; | ||
| 29 | __rand48_seed[2] = p[2]; | ||
| 30 | __rand48_mult[0] = p[3]; | ||
| 31 | __rand48_mult[1] = p[4]; | ||
| 32 | __rand48_mult[2] = p[5]; | ||
| 33 | __rand48_add = p[6]; | ||
| 34 | } | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/ldiv.3 b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/ldiv.3 new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..63e1f2165c --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/ldiv.3 | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,65 @@ | |||
| 1 | .\" Copyright (c) 1990, 1991 The Regents of the University of California. | ||
| 2 | .\" All rights reserved. | ||
| 3 | .\" | ||
| 4 | .\" This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by | ||
| 5 | .\" Chris Torek and the American National Standards Committee X3, | ||
| 6 | .\" on Information Processing Systems. | ||
| 7 | .\" | ||
| 8 | .\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without | ||
| 9 | .\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions | ||
| 10 | .\" are met: | ||
| 11 | .\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright | ||
| 12 | .\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. | ||
| 13 | .\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright | ||
| 14 | .\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the | ||
| 15 | .\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. | ||
| 16 | .\" 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors | ||
| 17 | .\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software | ||
| 18 | .\" without specific prior written permission. | ||
| 19 | .\" | ||
| 20 | .\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND | ||
| 21 | .\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE | ||
| 22 | .\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE | ||
| 23 | .\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE | ||
| 24 | .\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL | ||
| 25 | .\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS | ||
| 26 | .\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) | ||
| 27 | .\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT | ||
| 28 | .\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY | ||
| 29 | .\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF | ||
| 30 | .\" SUCH DAMAGE. | ||
| 31 | .\" | ||
| 32 | .\" $OpenBSD: ldiv.3,v 1.7 2004/01/23 23:08:46 jmc Exp $ | ||
| 33 | .\" | ||
| 34 | .Dd June 29, 1991 | ||
| 35 | .Dt LDIV 3 | ||
| 36 | .Os | ||
| 37 | .Sh NAME | ||
| 38 | .Nm ldiv | ||
| 39 | .Nd return quotient and remainder from division | ||
| 40 | .Sh SYNOPSIS | ||
| 41 | .Fd #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 42 | .Ft ldiv_t | ||
| 43 | .Fn ldiv "long num" "long denom" | ||
| 44 | .Sh DESCRIPTION | ||
| 45 | The | ||
| 46 | .Fn ldiv | ||
| 47 | function computes the value | ||
| 48 | .Fa num Ns / Ns Fa denom | ||
| 49 | and returns the quotient and remainder in a structure named | ||
| 50 | .Li ldiv_t | ||
| 51 | that contains two | ||
| 52 | .Li long integer | ||
| 53 | members named | ||
| 54 | .Fa quot | ||
| 55 | and | ||
| 56 | .Fa rem . | ||
| 57 | .Sh SEE ALSO | ||
| 58 | .Xr div 3 , | ||
| 59 | .Xr math 3 , | ||
| 60 | .Xr qdiv 3 | ||
| 61 | .Sh STANDARDS | ||
| 62 | The | ||
| 63 | .Fn ldiv | ||
| 64 | function conforms to | ||
| 65 | .St -ansiC . | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/ldiv.c b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/ldiv.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..e005ff77de --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/ldiv.c | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,54 @@ | |||
| 1 | /* | ||
| 2 | * Copyright (c) 1990 Regents of the University of California. | ||
| 3 | * All rights reserved. | ||
| 4 | * | ||
| 5 | * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by | ||
| 6 | * Chris Torek. | ||
| 7 | * | ||
| 8 | * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without | ||
| 9 | * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions | ||
| 10 | * are met: | ||
| 11 | * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright | ||
| 12 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. | ||
| 13 | * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright | ||
| 14 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the | ||
| 15 | * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. | ||
| 16 | * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors | ||
| 17 | * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software | ||
| 18 | * without specific prior written permission. | ||
| 19 | * | ||
| 20 | * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND | ||
| 21 | * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE | ||
| 22 | * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE | ||
| 23 | * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE | ||
| 24 | * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL | ||
| 25 | * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS | ||
| 26 | * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) | ||
| 27 | * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT | ||
| 28 | * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY | ||
| 29 | * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF | ||
| 30 | * SUCH DAMAGE. | ||
| 31 | */ | ||
| 32 | |||
| 33 | #if defined(LIBC_SCCS) && !defined(lint) | ||
| 34 | static char *rcsid = "$OpenBSD: ldiv.c,v 1.3 2003/06/02 20:18:37 millert Exp $"; | ||
| 35 | #endif /* LIBC_SCCS and not lint */ | ||
| 36 | |||
| 37 | #include <stdlib.h> /* ldiv_t */ | ||
| 38 | |||
| 39 | ldiv_t | ||
| 40 | ldiv(num, denom) | ||
| 41 | long num, denom; | ||
| 42 | { | ||
| 43 | ldiv_t r; | ||
| 44 | |||
| 45 | /* see div.c for comments */ | ||
| 46 | |||
| 47 | r.quot = num / denom; | ||
| 48 | r.rem = num % denom; | ||
| 49 | if (num >= 0 && r.rem < 0) { | ||
| 50 | r.quot++; | ||
| 51 | r.rem -= denom; | ||
| 52 | } | ||
| 53 | return (r); | ||
| 54 | } | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/llabs.c b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/llabs.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..9611b5aefd --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/llabs.c | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,45 @@ | |||
| 1 | /* $OpenBSD: llabs.c,v 1.1 2003/07/21 20:20:04 millert Exp $ */ | ||
| 2 | |||
| 3 | /*- | ||
| 4 | * Copyright (c) 1990 The Regents of the University of California. | ||
| 5 | * All rights reserved. | ||
| 6 | * | ||
| 7 | * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without | ||
| 8 | * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions | ||
| 9 | * are met: | ||
| 10 | * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright | ||
| 11 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. | ||
| 12 | * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright | ||
| 13 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the | ||
| 14 | * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. | ||
| 15 | * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software | ||
| 16 | * must display the following acknowledgement: | ||
| 17 | * This product includes software developed by the University of | ||
| 18 | * California, Berkeley and its contributors. | ||
| 19 | * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors | ||
| 20 | * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software | ||
| 21 | * without specific prior written permission. | ||
| 22 | * | ||
| 23 | * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND | ||
| 24 | * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE | ||
| 25 | * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE | ||
| 26 | * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE | ||
| 27 | * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL | ||
| 28 | * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS | ||
| 29 | * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) | ||
| 30 | * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT | ||
| 31 | * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY | ||
| 32 | * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF | ||
| 33 | * SUCH DAMAGE. | ||
| 34 | */ | ||
| 35 | |||
| 36 | #if defined(LIBC_SCCS) && !defined(lint) | ||
| 37 | static char *rcsid = "$OpenBSD: llabs.c,v 1.1 2003/07/21 20:20:04 millert Exp $"; | ||
| 38 | #endif /* LIBC_SCCS and not lint */ | ||
| 39 | |||
| 40 | #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 41 | |||
| 42 | long long llabs(long long j) | ||
| 43 | { | ||
| 44 | return (j < 0 ? -j : j); | ||
| 45 | } | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/lrand48.c b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/lrand48.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..6b7524a51b --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/lrand48.c | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,27 @@ | |||
| 1 | /* | ||
| 2 | * Copyright (c) 1993 Martin Birgmeier | ||
| 3 | * All rights reserved. | ||
| 4 | * | ||
| 5 | * You may redistribute unmodified or modified versions of this source | ||
| 6 | * code provided that the above copyright notice and this and the | ||
| 7 | * following conditions are retained. | ||
| 8 | * | ||
| 9 | * This software is provided ``as is'', and comes with no warranties | ||
| 10 | * of any kind. I shall in no event be liable for anything that happens | ||
| 11 | * to anyone/anything when using this software. | ||
| 12 | */ | ||
| 13 | |||
| 14 | #if defined(LIBC_SCCS) && !defined(lint) | ||
| 15 | static char rcsid[] = "$OpenBSD: lrand48.c,v 1.2 1996/08/19 08:33:36 tholo Exp $"; | ||
| 16 | #endif /* LIBC_SCCS and not lint */ | ||
| 17 | |||
| 18 | #include "rand48.h" | ||
| 19 | |||
| 20 | extern unsigned short __rand48_seed[3]; | ||
| 21 | |||
| 22 | long | ||
| 23 | lrand48(void) | ||
| 24 | { | ||
| 25 | __dorand48(__rand48_seed); | ||
| 26 | return ((long) __rand48_seed[2] << 15) + ((long) __rand48_seed[1] >> 1); | ||
| 27 | } | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/lsearch.3 b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/lsearch.3 new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..2adc51096d --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/lsearch.3 | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,103 @@ | |||
| 1 | .\" Copyright (c) 1989, 1991, 1993 | ||
| 2 | .\" The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved. | ||
| 3 | .\" | ||
| 4 | .\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without | ||
| 5 | .\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions | ||
| 6 | .\" are met: | ||
| 7 | .\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright | ||
| 8 | .\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. | ||
| 9 | .\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright | ||
| 10 | .\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the | ||
| 11 | .\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. | ||
| 12 | .\" 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors | ||
| 13 | .\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software | ||
| 14 | .\" without specific prior written permission. | ||
| 15 | .\" | ||
| 16 | .\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND | ||
| 17 | .\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE | ||
| 18 | .\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE | ||
| 19 | .\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE | ||
| 20 | .\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL | ||
| 21 | .\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS | ||
| 22 | .\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) | ||
| 23 | .\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT | ||
| 24 | .\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY | ||
| 25 | .\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF | ||
| 26 | .\" SUCH DAMAGE. | ||
| 27 | .\" | ||
| 28 | .\" @(#)lsearch.3 8.1 (Berkeley) 6/4/93 | ||
| 29 | .\" | ||
| 30 | .Dd June 4, 1993 | ||
| 31 | .Dt LSEARCH 3 | ||
| 32 | .Os | ||
| 33 | .Sh NAME | ||
| 34 | .Nm lsearch , | ||
| 35 | .Nm lfind | ||
| 36 | .Nd linear searching routines | ||
| 37 | .Sh SYNOPSIS | ||
| 38 | .Ft char * | ||
| 39 | .Fn lsearch "const void *key" "const void *base" "size_t *nelp" "size_t width" "int (*compar)(void *, void *)" | ||
| 40 | .Ft char * | ||
| 41 | .Fn lfind "const void *key" "const void *base" "size_t *nelp" "size_t width" "int (*compar)(void *, void *)" | ||
| 42 | .Sh DESCRIPTION | ||
| 43 | The functions | ||
| 44 | .Fn lsearch , | ||
| 45 | and | ||
| 46 | .Fn lfind | ||
| 47 | provide basic linear searching functionality. | ||
| 48 | .Pp | ||
| 49 | .Fa base | ||
| 50 | is the pointer to the beginning of an array. | ||
| 51 | The argument | ||
| 52 | .Fa nelp | ||
| 53 | is the current number of elements in the array, where each element | ||
| 54 | is | ||
| 55 | .Fa width | ||
| 56 | bytes long. | ||
| 57 | The | ||
| 58 | .Fa compar | ||
| 59 | function | ||
| 60 | is a comparison routine which is used to compare two elements. | ||
| 61 | It takes two arguments which point to the | ||
| 62 | .Fa key | ||
| 63 | object and to an array member, in that order, and must return an integer | ||
| 64 | less than, equivalent to, or greater than zero if the | ||
| 65 | .Fa key | ||
| 66 | object is considered, respectively, to be less than, equal to, or greater | ||
| 67 | than the array member. | ||
| 68 | .Pp | ||
| 69 | The | ||
| 70 | .Fn lsearch | ||
| 71 | and | ||
| 72 | .Fn lfind | ||
| 73 | functions | ||
| 74 | return a pointer into the array referenced by | ||
| 75 | .Fa base | ||
| 76 | where | ||
| 77 | .Fa key | ||
| 78 | is located. | ||
| 79 | If | ||
| 80 | .Fa key | ||
| 81 | does not exist, | ||
| 82 | .Fn lfind | ||
| 83 | will return a null pointer and | ||
| 84 | .Fn lsearch | ||
| 85 | will add it to the array. | ||
| 86 | When an element is added to the array by | ||
| 87 | .Fn lsearch | ||
| 88 | the location referenced by the argument | ||
| 89 | .Fa nelp | ||
| 90 | is incremented by one. | ||
| 91 | .Sh SEE ALSO | ||
| 92 | .Xr bsearch 3 , | ||
| 93 | .Xr db 3 | ||
| 94 | .Sh STANDARDS | ||
| 95 | The | ||
| 96 | .Fn lsearch | ||
| 97 | and | ||
| 98 | .Fn lfind | ||
| 99 | functions conform to the | ||
| 100 | .St -p1003.1-2001 | ||
| 101 | and | ||
| 102 | .St -xpg4.3 . | ||
| 103 | specifications. | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/lsearch.c b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/lsearch.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..82483d1c82 --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/lsearch.c | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,86 @@ | |||
| 1 | /* | ||
| 2 | * Copyright (c) 1989, 1993 | ||
| 3 | * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved. | ||
| 4 | * | ||
| 5 | * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by | ||
| 6 | * Roger L. Snyder. | ||
| 7 | * | ||
| 8 | * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without | ||
| 9 | * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions | ||
| 10 | * are met: | ||
| 11 | * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright | ||
| 12 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. | ||
| 13 | * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright | ||
| 14 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the | ||
| 15 | * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. | ||
| 16 | * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors | ||
| 17 | * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software | ||
| 18 | * without specific prior written permission. | ||
| 19 | * | ||
| 20 | * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND | ||
| 21 | * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE | ||
| 22 | * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE | ||
| 23 | * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE | ||
| 24 | * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL | ||
| 25 | * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS | ||
| 26 | * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) | ||
| 27 | * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT | ||
| 28 | * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY | ||
| 29 | * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF | ||
| 30 | * SUCH DAMAGE. | ||
| 31 | */ | ||
| 32 | |||
| 33 | #if defined(LIBC_SCCS) && !defined(lint) | ||
| 34 | static char sccsid[] = "@(#)lsearch.c 8.1 (Berkeley) 6/4/93"; | ||
| 35 | #endif /* LIBC_SCCS and not lint */ | ||
| 36 | |||
| 37 | #include <sys/types.h> | ||
| 38 | #include <string.h> | ||
| 39 | #include <search.h> | ||
| 40 | |||
| 41 | typedef int (*cmp_fn_t)(const void *, const void *); | ||
| 42 | static void *linear_base(const void *, const void *, size_t *, size_t, | ||
| 43 | cmp_fn_t, int); | ||
| 44 | |||
| 45 | void * | ||
| 46 | lsearch(const void *key, const void *base, size_t *nelp, size_t width, | ||
| 47 | cmp_fn_t compar) | ||
| 48 | { | ||
| 49 | |||
| 50 | return(linear_base(key, base, nelp, width, compar, 1)); | ||
| 51 | } | ||
| 52 | |||
| 53 | void * | ||
| 54 | lfind(const void *key, const void *base, size_t *nelp, size_t width, | ||
| 55 | cmp_fn_t compar) | ||
| 56 | { | ||
| 57 | return(linear_base(key, base, nelp, width, compar, 0)); | ||
| 58 | } | ||
| 59 | |||
| 60 | static void * | ||
| 61 | linear_base(const void *key, const void *base, size_t *nelp, size_t width, | ||
| 62 | cmp_fn_t compar, int add_flag) | ||
| 63 | { | ||
| 64 | const char *element, *end; | ||
| 65 | |||
| 66 | end = (const char *)base + *nelp * width; | ||
| 67 | for (element = base; element < end; element += width) | ||
| 68 | if (!compar(key, element)) /* key found */ | ||
| 69 | return((void *)element); | ||
| 70 | |||
| 71 | if (!add_flag) /* key not found */ | ||
| 72 | return(NULL); | ||
| 73 | |||
| 74 | /* | ||
| 75 | * The UNIX System User's Manual, 1986 edition claims that | ||
| 76 | * a NULL pointer is returned by lsearch with errno set | ||
| 77 | * appropriately, if there is not enough room in the table | ||
| 78 | * to add a new item. This can't be done as none of these | ||
| 79 | * routines have any method of determining the size of the | ||
| 80 | * table. This comment isn't in the 1986-87 System V | ||
| 81 | * manual. | ||
| 82 | */ | ||
| 83 | ++*nelp; | ||
| 84 | memcpy((void *)end, key, width); | ||
| 85 | return((void *)end); | ||
| 86 | } | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/malloc.3 b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/malloc.3 new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..1154537385 --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/malloc.3 | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,432 @@ | |||
| 1 | .\" | ||
| 2 | .\" Copyright (c) 1980, 1991, 1993 | ||
| 3 | .\" The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved. | ||
| 4 | .\" | ||
| 5 | .\" This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by | ||
| 6 | .\" the American National Standards Committee X3, on Information | ||
| 7 | .\" Processing Systems. | ||
| 8 | .\" | ||
| 9 | .\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without | ||
| 10 | .\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions | ||
| 11 | .\" are met: | ||
| 12 | .\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright | ||
| 13 | .\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. | ||
| 14 | .\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright | ||
| 15 | .\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the | ||
| 16 | .\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. | ||
| 17 | .\" 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors | ||
| 18 | .\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software | ||
| 19 | .\" without specific prior written permission. | ||
| 20 | .\" | ||
| 21 | .\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND | ||
| 22 | .\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE | ||
| 23 | .\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE | ||
| 24 | .\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE | ||
| 25 | .\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL | ||
| 26 | .\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS | ||
| 27 | .\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) | ||
| 28 | .\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT | ||
| 29 | .\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY | ||
| 30 | .\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF | ||
| 31 | .\" SUCH DAMAGE. | ||
| 32 | .\" | ||
| 33 | .\" $OpenBSD: malloc.3,v 1.36 2004/02/09 13:07:42 espie Exp $ | ||
| 34 | .\" | ||
| 35 | .Dd August 27, 1996 | ||
| 36 | .Dt MALLOC 3 | ||
| 37 | .Os | ||
| 38 | .Sh NAME | ||
| 39 | .Nm malloc , | ||
| 40 | .Nm calloc , | ||
| 41 | .Nm realloc , | ||
| 42 | .Nm free , | ||
| 43 | .Nm cfree | ||
| 44 | .Nd memory allocation and deallocation | ||
| 45 | .Sh SYNOPSIS | ||
| 46 | .Fd #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 47 | .Ft void * | ||
| 48 | .Fn malloc "size_t size" | ||
| 49 | .Ft void * | ||
| 50 | .Fn calloc "size_t nmemb" "size_t size" | ||
| 51 | .Ft void * | ||
| 52 | .Fn realloc "void *ptr" "size_t size" | ||
| 53 | .Ft void | ||
| 54 | .Fn free "void *ptr" | ||
| 55 | .Ft void | ||
| 56 | .Fn cfree "void *ptr" | ||
| 57 | .Ft char * | ||
| 58 | .Va malloc_options ; | ||
| 59 | .Sh DESCRIPTION | ||
| 60 | The | ||
| 61 | .Fn malloc | ||
| 62 | function allocates uninitialized space for an object whose | ||
| 63 | size is specified by | ||
| 64 | .Fa size . | ||
| 65 | The | ||
| 66 | .Fn malloc | ||
| 67 | function maintains multiple lists of free blocks according to size, allocating | ||
| 68 | space from the appropriate list. | ||
| 69 | .Pp | ||
| 70 | The allocated space is | ||
| 71 | suitably aligned (after possible pointer | ||
| 72 | coercion) for storage of any type of object. | ||
| 73 | If the space is of | ||
| 74 | .Em pagesize | ||
| 75 | or larger, the memory returned will be page-aligned. | ||
| 76 | .Pp | ||
| 77 | Allocation of a zero size object returns a pointer to a zero size object. | ||
| 78 | This zero size object is access protected, so any access to it will | ||
| 79 | generate an exception (SIGSEGV). | ||
| 80 | Many zero-sized objects can be placed consecutively in shared | ||
| 81 | protected pages. | ||
| 82 | The minimum size of the protection on each object is suitably aligned and | ||
| 83 | sized as previously stated, but the protection may extend further depending | ||
| 84 | on where in a protected zone the object lands. | ||
| 85 | .Pp | ||
| 86 | The | ||
| 87 | .Fn calloc | ||
| 88 | function allocates space for an array of | ||
| 89 | .Fa nmemb | ||
| 90 | objects, each of whose size is | ||
| 91 | .Fa size . | ||
| 92 | The space is initialized to all bits zero. | ||
| 93 | .Pp | ||
| 94 | The | ||
| 95 | .Fn free | ||
| 96 | function causes the space pointed to by | ||
| 97 | .Fa ptr | ||
| 98 | to be deallocated, that is, at least made available for further allocation, | ||
| 99 | but if possible, it will passed back to the kernel with | ||
| 100 | .Xr sbrk 2 . | ||
| 101 | If | ||
| 102 | .Fa ptr | ||
| 103 | is a null pointer, no action occurs. | ||
| 104 | .Pp | ||
| 105 | A | ||
| 106 | .Fn cfree | ||
| 107 | function is also provided for compatibility with old systems and other | ||
| 108 | .Nm malloc | ||
| 109 | libraries; it is simply an alias for | ||
| 110 | .Fn free . | ||
| 111 | .Pp | ||
| 112 | The | ||
| 113 | .Fn realloc | ||
| 114 | function changes the size of the object pointed to by | ||
| 115 | .Fa ptr | ||
| 116 | to | ||
| 117 | .Fa size | ||
| 118 | bytes and returns a pointer to the (possibly moved) object. | ||
| 119 | The contents of the object are unchanged up to the lesser | ||
| 120 | of the new and old sizes. | ||
| 121 | If the new size is larger, the value of the newly allocated portion | ||
| 122 | of the object is indeterminate and uninitialized. | ||
| 123 | If | ||
| 124 | .Fa ptr | ||
| 125 | is a null pointer, the | ||
| 126 | .Fn realloc | ||
| 127 | function behaves like the | ||
| 128 | .Fn malloc | ||
| 129 | function for the specified size. | ||
| 130 | If the space cannot be allocated, the object | ||
| 131 | pointed to by | ||
| 132 | .Fa ptr | ||
| 133 | is unchanged. | ||
| 134 | If | ||
| 135 | .Fa size | ||
| 136 | is zero and | ||
| 137 | .Fa ptr | ||
| 138 | is not a null pointer, the object it points to is freed and a new zero size | ||
| 139 | object is returned. | ||
| 140 | .Pp | ||
| 141 | When using | ||
| 142 | .Fn realloc | ||
| 143 | one must be careful to avoid the following idiom: | ||
| 144 | .Bd -literal -offset indent | ||
| 145 | size += 50; | ||
| 146 | if ((p = realloc(p, size)) == NULL) | ||
| 147 | return (NULL); | ||
| 148 | .Ed | ||
| 149 | .Pp | ||
| 150 | Do not adjust the variable describing how much memory has been allocated | ||
| 151 | until one knows the allocation has been successful. | ||
| 152 | This can cause aberrant program behavior if the incorrect size value is used. | ||
| 153 | In most cases, the above sample will also result in a leak of memory. | ||
| 154 | As stated earlier, a return value of | ||
| 155 | .Dv NULL | ||
| 156 | indicates that the old object still remains allocated. | ||
| 157 | Better code looks like this: | ||
| 158 | .Bd -literal -offset indent | ||
| 159 | newsize = size + 50; | ||
| 160 | if ((newp = realloc(p, newsize)) == NULL) { | ||
| 161 | free(p); | ||
| 162 | p = NULL; | ||
| 163 | size = 0; | ||
| 164 | return (NULL); | ||
| 165 | } | ||
| 166 | p = newp; | ||
| 167 | size = newsize; | ||
| 168 | .Ed | ||
| 169 | .Pp | ||
| 170 | Malloc will first look for a symbolic link called | ||
| 171 | .Pa /etc/malloc.conf | ||
| 172 | and next check the environment for a variable called | ||
| 173 | .Ev MALLOC_OPTIONS | ||
| 174 | and finally for the global variable | ||
| 175 | .Va malloc_options | ||
| 176 | and scan them for flags in that order. | ||
| 177 | Flags are single letters, uppercase means on, lowercase means off. | ||
| 178 | .Bl -tag -width indent | ||
| 179 | .It Cm A | ||
| 180 | .Dq Abort . | ||
| 181 | .Fn malloc | ||
| 182 | will coredump the process, rather than tolerate failure. | ||
| 183 | This is a very handy debugging aid, since the core file will represent the | ||
| 184 | time of failure, rather than when the null pointer was accessed. | ||
| 185 | .Pp | ||
| 186 | .It Cm D | ||
| 187 | .Dq Dump . | ||
| 188 | .Fn malloc | ||
| 189 | will dump statistics in a file called | ||
| 190 | .Pa malloc.out | ||
| 191 | at exit. | ||
| 192 | This option requires the library to have been compiled with -DMALLOC_STATS in | ||
| 193 | order to have any effect. | ||
| 194 | .Pp | ||
| 195 | .It Cm F | ||
| 196 | .Dq Freeguard . | ||
| 197 | Enable use after free protection. | ||
| 198 | Unused pages on the freelist are read and write protected to | ||
| 199 | cause a segmentation fault upon access. | ||
| 200 | .Pp | ||
| 201 | .It Cm G | ||
| 202 | .Dq Guard . | ||
| 203 | Enable guard pages and chunk randomization. | ||
| 204 | Each page size or larger allocation is followed by a guard page that will | ||
| 205 | cause a segmentation fault upon any access. | ||
| 206 | Smaller than page size chunks are returned in a random order. | ||
| 207 | .Pp | ||
| 208 | .It Cm H | ||
| 209 | .Dq Hint . | ||
| 210 | Pass a hint to the kernel about pages we don't use. | ||
| 211 | If the machine is paging a lot this may help a bit. | ||
| 212 | .Pp | ||
| 213 | .It Cm J | ||
| 214 | .Dq Junk . | ||
| 215 | Fill some junk into the area allocated. | ||
| 216 | Currently junk is bytes of 0xd0; this is pronounced | ||
| 217 | .Dq Duh . | ||
| 218 | \&:-) | ||
| 219 | .Pp | ||
| 220 | .It Cm N | ||
| 221 | Do not output warning messages when encountering possible corruption | ||
| 222 | or bad pointers. | ||
| 223 | .Pp | ||
| 224 | .It Cm R | ||
| 225 | .Dq realloc . | ||
| 226 | Always reallocate when | ||
| 227 | .Fn realloc | ||
| 228 | is called, even if the initial allocation was big enough. | ||
| 229 | This can substantially aid in compacting memory. | ||
| 230 | .\".Pp | ||
| 231 | .\".It Cm U | ||
| 232 | .\".Dq utrace . | ||
| 233 | .\"Generate entries for | ||
| 234 | .\".Xr ktrace 1 | ||
| 235 | .\"for all operations. | ||
| 236 | .\"Consult the source for this one. | ||
| 237 | .Pp | ||
| 238 | .It Cm X | ||
| 239 | .Dq xmalloc . | ||
| 240 | Rather than return failure, | ||
| 241 | .Xr abort 3 | ||
| 242 | the program with a diagnostic message on stderr. | ||
| 243 | It is the intention that this option be set at compile time by | ||
| 244 | including in the source: | ||
| 245 | .Bd -literal -offset indent | ||
| 246 | extern char *malloc_options; | ||
| 247 | malloc_options = "X"; | ||
| 248 | .Ed | ||
| 249 | .Pp | ||
| 250 | .It Cm Z | ||
| 251 | .Dq Zero . | ||
| 252 | Fill some junk into the area allocated (see | ||
| 253 | .Cm J ) , | ||
| 254 | except for the exact length the user asked for, which is zeroed. | ||
| 255 | .Pp | ||
| 256 | .It Cm < | ||
| 257 | .Dq Half the cache size . | ||
| 258 | Reduce the size of the cache by a factor of two. | ||
| 259 | .Pp | ||
| 260 | .It Cm > | ||
| 261 | .Dq Double the cache size . | ||
| 262 | Double the size of the cache by a factor of two. | ||
| 263 | .El | ||
| 264 | .Pp | ||
| 265 | So to set a systemwide reduction of cache size and coredumps on problems | ||
| 266 | one would: | ||
| 267 | .Li ln -s 'A<' /etc/malloc.conf | ||
| 268 | .Pp | ||
| 269 | The | ||
| 270 | .Cm J | ||
| 271 | and | ||
| 272 | .Cm Z | ||
| 273 | flags are mostly for testing and debugging. | ||
| 274 | If a program changes behavior if either of these options are used, | ||
| 275 | it is buggy. | ||
| 276 | .Pp | ||
| 277 | The default cache size is 16 pages. | ||
| 278 | .Sh RETURN VALUES | ||
| 279 | The | ||
| 280 | .Fn malloc | ||
| 281 | and | ||
| 282 | .Fn calloc | ||
| 283 | functions return a pointer to the allocated space if successful; otherwise, | ||
| 284 | a null pointer is returned and | ||
| 285 | .Va errno | ||
| 286 | is set to | ||
| 287 | .Er ENOMEM . | ||
| 288 | .Pp | ||
| 289 | The | ||
| 290 | .Fn free | ||
| 291 | and | ||
| 292 | .Fn cfree | ||
| 293 | functions return no value. | ||
| 294 | .Pp | ||
| 295 | The | ||
| 296 | .Fn realloc | ||
| 297 | function returns a pointer to the (possibly moved) allocated space | ||
| 298 | if successful; otherwise, a null pointer is returned and | ||
| 299 | .Va errno | ||
| 300 | is set to | ||
| 301 | .Er ENOMEM . | ||
| 302 | .Sh ENVIRONMENT | ||
| 303 | See above. | ||
| 304 | .Sh FILES | ||
| 305 | .Bl -tag -width "/etc/malloc.conf" | ||
| 306 | .It Pa /etc/malloc.conf | ||
| 307 | symbolic link to filename containing option flags | ||
| 308 | .El | ||
| 309 | .Sh DIAGNOSTICS | ||
| 310 | If | ||
| 311 | .Fn malloc , | ||
| 312 | .Fn calloc , | ||
| 313 | .Fn realloc , | ||
| 314 | or | ||
| 315 | .Fn free | ||
| 316 | detect an error or warning condition, | ||
| 317 | a message will be printed to file descriptor | ||
| 318 | 2 (not using stdio). | ||
| 319 | Errors will always result in the process being | ||
| 320 | .Xr abort 3 'ed. | ||
| 321 | If the | ||
| 322 | .Cm A | ||
| 323 | option has been specified, warnings will also | ||
| 324 | .Xr abort 3 | ||
| 325 | the process. | ||
| 326 | .Pp | ||
| 327 | Here is a brief description of the error messages and what they mean: | ||
| 328 | .Bl -tag -width Fl | ||
| 329 | .It Dq (ES): mumble mumble mumble | ||
| 330 | .Fn malloc | ||
| 331 | has been compiled with | ||
| 332 | .Dv \&-DEXTRA_SANITY | ||
| 333 | and something looks fishy in there. | ||
| 334 | Consult sources and/or wizards. | ||
| 335 | .It Dq allocation failed | ||
| 336 | If the | ||
| 337 | .Cm A | ||
| 338 | option is specified it is an error for | ||
| 339 | .Fn malloc , | ||
| 340 | .Fn calloc , | ||
| 341 | or | ||
| 342 | .Fn realloc | ||
| 343 | to return | ||
| 344 | .Dv NULL . | ||
| 345 | .It Dq mmap(2) failed, check limits. | ||
| 346 | This is a rather weird condition that is most likely to indicate a | ||
| 347 | seriously overloaded system or a | ||
| 348 | .Xr ulimit 1 | ||
| 349 | restriction. | ||
| 350 | .It Dq freelist is destroyed. | ||
| 351 | .Fn malloc Ns 's | ||
| 352 | internal freelist has been stomped on. | ||
| 353 | .El | ||
| 354 | .Pp | ||
| 355 | Here is a brief description of the warning messages and what they mean: | ||
| 356 | .Bl -tag -width Fl | ||
| 357 | .It Dq chunk/page is already free. | ||
| 358 | There was an attempt to free a chunk that had already been freed. | ||
| 359 | .It Dq junk pointer, too high to make sense. | ||
| 360 | The pointer doesn't make sense. | ||
| 361 | It's above the area of memory that | ||
| 362 | .Fn malloc | ||
| 363 | knows something about. | ||
| 364 | This could be a pointer from some | ||
| 365 | .Xr mmap 2 'ed | ||
| 366 | memory. | ||
| 367 | .It Dq junk pointer, too low to make sense. | ||
| 368 | The pointer doesn't make sense. | ||
| 369 | It's below the area of memory that | ||
| 370 | .Fn malloc | ||
| 371 | knows something about. | ||
| 372 | This pointer probably came from your data or bss segments. | ||
| 373 | .It Dq malloc() has never been called. | ||
| 374 | Nothing has ever been allocated, yet something is being freed or | ||
| 375 | realloc'ed. | ||
| 376 | .It Dq modified (chunk-/page-) pointer. | ||
| 377 | The pointer passed to free or realloc has been modified. | ||
| 378 | .It Dq pointer to wrong page. | ||
| 379 | The pointer that | ||
| 380 | .Fn malloc | ||
| 381 | is trying to free is not pointing to | ||
| 382 | a sensible page. | ||
| 383 | .It Dq recursive call. | ||
| 384 | An attempt was made to call recursively into these functions, i.e., from a | ||
| 385 | signal handler. | ||
| 386 | This behavior is not supported. | ||
| 387 | In particular, signal handlers should | ||
| 388 | .Em not | ||
| 389 | use any of the | ||
| 390 | .Fn malloc | ||
| 391 | functions nor utilize any other functions which may call | ||
| 392 | .Fn malloc | ||
| 393 | (e.g., | ||
| 394 | .Xr stdio 3 | ||
| 395 | routines). | ||
| 396 | .It Dq unknown char in MALLOC_OPTIONS | ||
| 397 | We found something we didn't understand. | ||
| 398 | .El | ||
| 399 | .Sh SEE ALSO | ||
| 400 | .Xr brk 2 , | ||
| 401 | .Xr alloca 3 , | ||
| 402 | .Xr getpagesize 3 , | ||
| 403 | .Xr memory 3 | ||
| 404 | .Sh STANDARDS | ||
| 405 | The | ||
| 406 | .Fn malloc | ||
| 407 | function conforms to | ||
| 408 | .St -ansiC . | ||
| 409 | .Sh HISTORY | ||
| 410 | The present implementation of | ||
| 411 | .Fn malloc | ||
| 412 | started out as a filesystem on a drum | ||
| 413 | attached to a 20-bit binary challenged computer built with discrete germanium | ||
| 414 | transistors, and it has since graduated to handle primary storage rather than | ||
| 415 | secondary. | ||
| 416 | .Pp | ||
| 417 | The main difference from other | ||
| 418 | .Fn malloc | ||
| 419 | implementations are believed to be that | ||
| 420 | the free pages are not accessed until allocated. | ||
| 421 | Most | ||
| 422 | .Fn malloc | ||
| 423 | implementations will store a data structure containing a, | ||
| 424 | possibly double-, linked list in the free chunks of memory, used to tie | ||
| 425 | all the free memory together. | ||
| 426 | That is a quite suboptimal thing to do. | ||
| 427 | Every time the free-list is traversed, all the otherwise unused, and very | ||
| 428 | likely paged out, pages get faulted into primary memory, just to see what | ||
| 429 | lies after them in the list. | ||
| 430 | .Pp | ||
| 431 | On systems which are paging, this can increase the page-faults | ||
| 432 | of a process by a factor of five. | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/malloc.c b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/malloc.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f5704754a0 --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/malloc.c | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,1327 @@ | |||
| 1 | /* | ||
| 2 | * ---------------------------------------------------------------------------- | ||
| 3 | * "THE BEER-WARE LICENSE" (Revision 42): | ||
| 4 | * <phk@FreeBSD.ORG> wrote this file. As long as you retain this notice you | ||
| 5 | * can do whatever you want with this stuff. If we meet some day, and you think | ||
| 6 | * this stuff is worth it, you can buy me a beer in return. Poul-Henning Kamp | ||
| 7 | * ---------------------------------------------------------------------------- | ||
| 8 | */ | ||
| 9 | |||
| 10 | #if defined(LIBC_SCCS) && !defined(lint) | ||
| 11 | static char rcsid[] = "$OpenBSD: malloc.c,v 1.66 2004/02/19 23:20:53 tdeval Exp $"; | ||
| 12 | #endif /* LIBC_SCCS and not lint */ | ||
| 13 | |||
| 14 | /* | ||
| 15 | * Defining MALLOC_EXTRA_SANITY will enable extra checks which are | ||
| 16 | * related to internal conditions and consistency in malloc.c. This has | ||
| 17 | * a noticeable runtime performance hit, and generally will not do you | ||
| 18 | * any good unless you fiddle with the internals of malloc or want | ||
| 19 | * to catch random pointer corruption as early as possible. | ||
| 20 | */ | ||
| 21 | #ifndef MALLOC_EXTRA_SANITY | ||
| 22 | #undef MALLOC_EXTRA_SANITY | ||
| 23 | #endif | ||
| 24 | |||
| 25 | /* | ||
| 26 | * Defining MALLOC_STATS will enable you to call malloc_dump() and set | ||
| 27 | * the [dD] options in the MALLOC_OPTIONS environment variable. | ||
| 28 | * It has no run-time performance hit, but does pull in stdio... | ||
| 29 | */ | ||
| 30 | #ifndef MALLOC_STATS | ||
| 31 | #undef MALLOC_STATS | ||
| 32 | #endif | ||
| 33 | |||
| 34 | /* | ||
| 35 | * What to use for Junk. This is the byte value we use to fill with | ||
| 36 | * when the 'J' option is enabled. | ||
| 37 | */ | ||
| 38 | #define SOME_JUNK 0xd0 /* as in "Duh" :-) */ | ||
| 39 | |||
| 40 | #include <sys/types.h> | ||
| 41 | #include <sys/param.h> | ||
| 42 | #include <sys/mman.h> | ||
| 43 | #include <sys/uio.h> | ||
| 44 | #include <stdio.h> | ||
| 45 | #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 46 | #include <string.h> | ||
| 47 | #include <unistd.h> | ||
| 48 | #include <fcntl.h> | ||
| 49 | #include <limits.h> | ||
| 50 | #include <errno.h> | ||
| 51 | |||
| 52 | #include "thread_private.h" | ||
| 53 | |||
| 54 | /* | ||
| 55 | * The basic parameters you can tweak. | ||
| 56 | * | ||
| 57 | * malloc_pageshift pagesize = 1 << malloc_pageshift | ||
| 58 | * It's probably best if this is the native | ||
| 59 | * page size, but it shouldn't have to be. | ||
| 60 | * | ||
| 61 | * malloc_minsize minimum size of an allocation in bytes. | ||
| 62 | * If this is too small it's too much work | ||
| 63 | * to manage them. This is also the smallest | ||
| 64 | * unit of alignment used for the storage | ||
| 65 | * returned by malloc/realloc. | ||
| 66 | * | ||
| 67 | */ | ||
| 68 | |||
| 69 | #if defined(__OpenBSD__) && defined(__sparc__) | ||
| 70 | # define malloc_pageshift 13U | ||
| 71 | #endif /* __OpenBSD__ */ | ||
| 72 | |||
| 73 | /* | ||
| 74 | * No user serviceable parts behind this point. | ||
| 75 | * | ||
| 76 | * This structure describes a page worth of chunks. | ||
| 77 | */ | ||
| 78 | |||
| 79 | struct pginfo { | ||
| 80 | struct pginfo *next; /* next on the free list */ | ||
| 81 | void *page; /* Pointer to the page */ | ||
| 82 | u_short size; /* size of this page's chunks */ | ||
| 83 | u_short shift; /* How far to shift for this size chunks */ | ||
| 84 | u_short free; /* How many free chunks */ | ||
| 85 | u_short total; /* How many chunk */ | ||
| 86 | u_long bits[1]; /* Which chunks are free */ | ||
| 87 | }; | ||
| 88 | |||
| 89 | /* | ||
| 90 | * This structure describes a number of free pages. | ||
| 91 | */ | ||
| 92 | |||
| 93 | struct pgfree { | ||
| 94 | struct pgfree *next; /* next run of free pages */ | ||
| 95 | struct pgfree *prev; /* prev run of free pages */ | ||
| 96 | void *page; /* pointer to free pages */ | ||
| 97 | void *end; /* pointer to end of free pages */ | ||
| 98 | u_long size; /* number of bytes free */ | ||
| 99 | }; | ||
| 100 | |||
| 101 | /* | ||
| 102 | * How many bits per u_long in the bitmap. | ||
| 103 | * Change only if not 8 bits/byte | ||
| 104 | */ | ||
| 105 | #define MALLOC_BITS (8*sizeof(u_long)) | ||
| 106 | |||
| 107 | /* | ||
| 108 | * Magic values to put in the page_directory | ||
| 109 | */ | ||
| 110 | #define MALLOC_NOT_MINE ((struct pginfo*) 0) | ||
| 111 | #define MALLOC_FREE ((struct pginfo*) 1) | ||
| 112 | #define MALLOC_FIRST ((struct pginfo*) 2) | ||
| 113 | #define MALLOC_FOLLOW ((struct pginfo*) 3) | ||
| 114 | #define MALLOC_MAGIC ((struct pginfo*) 4) | ||
| 115 | |||
| 116 | #ifndef malloc_pageshift | ||
| 117 | #define malloc_pageshift (PGSHIFT) | ||
| 118 | #endif | ||
| 119 | |||
| 120 | #ifndef malloc_minsize | ||
| 121 | #define malloc_minsize 16U | ||
| 122 | #endif | ||
| 123 | |||
| 124 | #ifndef malloc_pageshift | ||
| 125 | #error "malloc_pageshift undefined" | ||
| 126 | #endif | ||
| 127 | |||
| 128 | #if !defined(malloc_pagesize) | ||
| 129 | #define malloc_pagesize (1UL<<malloc_pageshift) | ||
| 130 | #endif | ||
| 131 | |||
| 132 | #if ((1UL<<malloc_pageshift) != malloc_pagesize) | ||
| 133 | #error "(1UL<<malloc_pageshift) != malloc_pagesize" | ||
| 134 | #endif | ||
| 135 | |||
| 136 | #ifndef malloc_maxsize | ||
| 137 | #define malloc_maxsize ((malloc_pagesize)>>1) | ||
| 138 | #endif | ||
| 139 | |||
| 140 | /* A mask for the offset inside a page. */ | ||
| 141 | #define malloc_pagemask ((malloc_pagesize)-1) | ||
| 142 | |||
| 143 | #define pageround(foo) (((foo) + (malloc_pagemask))&(~(malloc_pagemask))) | ||
| 144 | #define ptr2index(foo) (((u_long)(foo) >> malloc_pageshift)-malloc_origo) | ||
| 145 | |||
| 146 | /* fd of /dev/zero */ | ||
| 147 | #ifdef USE_DEV_ZERO | ||
| 148 | static int fdzero; | ||
| 149 | #define MMAP_FD fdzero | ||
| 150 | #define INIT_MMAP() \ | ||
| 151 | { if ((fdzero=open("/dev/zero", O_RDWR, 0000)) == -1) \ | ||
| 152 | wrterror("open of /dev/zero\n"); } | ||
| 153 | #else | ||
| 154 | #define MMAP_FD (-1) | ||
| 155 | #define INIT_MMAP() | ||
| 156 | #endif | ||
| 157 | |||
| 158 | /* Set when initialization has been done */ | ||
| 159 | static unsigned int malloc_started; | ||
| 160 | |||
| 161 | /* Number of free pages we cache */ | ||
| 162 | static unsigned int malloc_cache = 16; | ||
| 163 | |||
| 164 | /* The offset from pagenumber to index into the page directory */ | ||
| 165 | static u_long malloc_origo; | ||
| 166 | |||
| 167 | /* The last index in the page directory we care about */ | ||
| 168 | static u_long last_index; | ||
| 169 | |||
| 170 | /* Pointer to page directory. Allocated "as if with" malloc */ | ||
| 171 | static struct pginfo **page_dir; | ||
| 172 | |||
| 173 | /* How many slots in the page directory */ | ||
| 174 | static size_t malloc_ninfo; | ||
| 175 | |||
| 176 | /* Free pages line up here */ | ||
| 177 | static struct pgfree free_list; | ||
| 178 | |||
| 179 | /* Abort(), user doesn't handle problems. */ | ||
| 180 | static int malloc_abort = 2; | ||
| 181 | |||
| 182 | /* Are we trying to die ? */ | ||
| 183 | static int suicide; | ||
| 184 | |||
| 185 | #ifdef MALLOC_STATS | ||
| 186 | /* dump statistics */ | ||
| 187 | static int malloc_stats; | ||
| 188 | #endif | ||
| 189 | |||
| 190 | /* avoid outputting warnings? */ | ||
| 191 | static int malloc_silent; | ||
| 192 | |||
| 193 | /* always realloc ? */ | ||
| 194 | static int malloc_realloc; | ||
| 195 | |||
| 196 | /* mprotect free pages PROT_NONE? */ | ||
| 197 | static int malloc_freeprot; | ||
| 198 | |||
| 199 | /* use guard pages after allocations? */ | ||
| 200 | static int malloc_guard = 0; | ||
| 201 | |||
| 202 | #if defined(__FreeBSD__) || (defined(__OpenBSD__) && defined(MADV_FREE)) | ||
| 203 | /* pass the kernel a hint on free pages ? */ | ||
| 204 | static int malloc_hint; | ||
| 205 | #endif | ||
| 206 | |||
| 207 | /* xmalloc behaviour ? */ | ||
| 208 | static int malloc_xmalloc; | ||
| 209 | |||
| 210 | /* zero fill ? */ | ||
| 211 | static int malloc_zero; | ||
| 212 | |||
| 213 | /* junk fill ? */ | ||
| 214 | static int malloc_junk; | ||
| 215 | |||
| 216 | #ifdef __FreeBSD__ | ||
| 217 | /* utrace ? */ | ||
| 218 | static int malloc_utrace; | ||
| 219 | |||
| 220 | struct ut { void *p; size_t s; void *r; }; | ||
| 221 | |||
| 222 | void utrace(struct ut *, int); | ||
| 223 | |||
| 224 | #define UTRACE(a, b, c) \ | ||
| 225 | if (malloc_utrace) \ | ||
| 226 | {struct ut u; u.p=a; u.s = b; u.r=c; utrace(&u, sizeof u);} | ||
| 227 | #else /* !__FreeBSD__ */ | ||
| 228 | #define UTRACE(a,b,c) | ||
| 229 | #endif | ||
| 230 | |||
| 231 | /* my last break. */ | ||
| 232 | static void *malloc_brk; | ||
| 233 | |||
| 234 | /* one location cache for free-list holders */ | ||
| 235 | static struct pgfree *px; | ||
| 236 | |||
| 237 | /* compile-time options */ | ||
| 238 | char *malloc_options; | ||
| 239 | |||
| 240 | /* Name of the current public function */ | ||
| 241 | static char *malloc_func; | ||
| 242 | |||
| 243 | /* Macro for mmap */ | ||
| 244 | #define MMAP(size) \ | ||
| 245 | mmap((void *)0, (size), PROT_READ|PROT_WRITE, MAP_ANON|MAP_PRIVATE, \ | ||
| 246 | MMAP_FD, (off_t)0) | ||
| 247 | |||
| 248 | /* | ||
| 249 | * Necessary function declarations | ||
| 250 | */ | ||
| 251 | static int extend_pgdir(u_long index); | ||
| 252 | static void *imalloc(size_t size); | ||
| 253 | static void ifree(void *ptr); | ||
| 254 | static void *irealloc(void *ptr, size_t size); | ||
| 255 | static void *malloc_bytes(size_t size); | ||
| 256 | |||
| 257 | #ifdef MALLOC_STATS | ||
| 258 | void | ||
| 259 | malloc_dump(FILE *fd) | ||
| 260 | { | ||
| 261 | struct pginfo **pd; | ||
| 262 | struct pgfree *pf; | ||
| 263 | int j; | ||
| 264 | |||
| 265 | pd = page_dir; | ||
| 266 | |||
| 267 | /* print out all the pages */ | ||
| 268 | for(j=0;j<=last_index;j++) { | ||
| 269 | fprintf(fd, "%08lx %5d ", (j+malloc_origo) << malloc_pageshift, j); | ||
| 270 | if (pd[j] == MALLOC_NOT_MINE) { | ||
| 271 | for(j++;j<=last_index && pd[j] == MALLOC_NOT_MINE;j++) | ||
| 272 | ; | ||
| 273 | j--; | ||
| 274 | fprintf(fd, ".. %5d not mine\n", j); | ||
| 275 | } else if (pd[j] == MALLOC_FREE) { | ||
| 276 | for(j++;j<=last_index && pd[j] == MALLOC_FREE;j++) | ||
| 277 | ; | ||
| 278 | j--; | ||
| 279 | fprintf(fd, ".. %5d free\n", j); | ||
| 280 | } else if (pd[j] == MALLOC_FIRST) { | ||
| 281 | for(j++;j<=last_index && pd[j] == MALLOC_FOLLOW;j++) | ||
| 282 | ; | ||
| 283 | j--; | ||
| 284 | fprintf(fd, ".. %5d in use\n", j); | ||
| 285 | } else if (pd[j] < MALLOC_MAGIC) { | ||
| 286 | fprintf(fd, "(%p)\n", pd[j]); | ||
| 287 | } else { | ||
| 288 | fprintf(fd, "%p %d (of %d) x %d @ %p --> %p\n", | ||
| 289 | pd[j], pd[j]->free, pd[j]->total, | ||
| 290 | pd[j]->size, pd[j]->page, pd[j]->next); | ||
| 291 | } | ||
| 292 | } | ||
| 293 | |||
| 294 | for(pf=free_list.next; pf; pf=pf->next) { | ||
| 295 | fprintf(fd, "Free: @%p [%p...%p[ %ld ->%p <-%p\n", | ||
| 296 | pf, pf->page, pf->end, pf->size, pf->prev, pf->next); | ||
| 297 | if (pf == pf->next) { | ||
| 298 | fprintf(fd, "Free_list loops\n"); | ||
| 299 | break; | ||
| 300 | } | ||
| 301 | } | ||
| 302 | |||
| 303 | /* print out various info */ | ||
| 304 | fprintf(fd, "Minsize\t%d\n", malloc_minsize); | ||
| 305 | fprintf(fd, "Maxsize\t%d\n", malloc_maxsize); | ||
| 306 | fprintf(fd, "Pagesize\t%lu\n", (u_long)malloc_pagesize); | ||
| 307 | fprintf(fd, "Pageshift\t%d\n", malloc_pageshift); | ||
| 308 | fprintf(fd, "FirstPage\t%ld\n", malloc_origo); | ||
| 309 | fprintf(fd, "LastPage\t%ld %lx\n", last_index+malloc_pageshift, | ||
| 310 | (last_index + malloc_pageshift) << malloc_pageshift); | ||
| 311 | fprintf(fd, "Break\t%ld\n", (u_long)sbrk(0) >> malloc_pageshift); | ||
| 312 | } | ||
| 313 | #endif /* MALLOC_STATS */ | ||
| 314 | |||
| 315 | extern char *__progname; | ||
| 316 | |||
| 317 | static void | ||
| 318 | wrterror(char *p) | ||
| 319 | { | ||
| 320 | char *q = " error: "; | ||
| 321 | struct iovec iov[4]; | ||
| 322 | |||
| 323 | iov[0].iov_base = __progname; | ||
| 324 | iov[0].iov_len = strlen(__progname); | ||
| 325 | iov[1].iov_base = malloc_func; | ||
| 326 | iov[1].iov_len = strlen(malloc_func); | ||
| 327 | iov[2].iov_base = q; | ||
| 328 | iov[2].iov_len = strlen(q); | ||
| 329 | iov[3].iov_base = p; | ||
| 330 | iov[3].iov_len = strlen(p); | ||
| 331 | writev(STDERR_FILENO, iov, 4); | ||
| 332 | |||
| 333 | suicide = 1; | ||
| 334 | #ifdef MALLOC_STATS | ||
| 335 | if (malloc_stats) | ||
| 336 | malloc_dump(stderr); | ||
| 337 | #endif /* MALLOC_STATS */ | ||
| 338 | abort(); | ||
| 339 | } | ||
| 340 | |||
| 341 | static void | ||
| 342 | wrtwarning(char *p) | ||
| 343 | { | ||
| 344 | char *q = " warning: "; | ||
| 345 | struct iovec iov[4]; | ||
| 346 | |||
| 347 | if (malloc_abort) | ||
| 348 | wrterror(p); | ||
| 349 | else if (malloc_silent) | ||
| 350 | return; | ||
| 351 | |||
| 352 | iov[0].iov_base = __progname; | ||
| 353 | iov[0].iov_len = strlen(__progname); | ||
| 354 | iov[1].iov_base = malloc_func; | ||
| 355 | iov[1].iov_len = strlen(malloc_func); | ||
| 356 | iov[2].iov_base = q; | ||
| 357 | iov[2].iov_len = strlen(q); | ||
| 358 | iov[3].iov_base = p; | ||
| 359 | iov[3].iov_len = strlen(p); | ||
| 360 | writev(STDERR_FILENO, iov, 4); | ||
| 361 | } | ||
| 362 | |||
| 363 | #ifdef MALLOC_STATS | ||
| 364 | static void | ||
| 365 | malloc_exit(void) | ||
| 366 | { | ||
| 367 | FILE *fd = fopen("malloc.out", "a"); | ||
| 368 | char *q = "malloc() warning: Couldn't dump stats\n"; | ||
| 369 | if (fd != NULL) { | ||
| 370 | malloc_dump(fd); | ||
| 371 | fclose(fd); | ||
| 372 | } else | ||
| 373 | write(STDERR_FILENO, q, strlen(q)); | ||
| 374 | } | ||
| 375 | #endif /* MALLOC_STATS */ | ||
| 376 | |||
| 377 | |||
| 378 | /* | ||
| 379 | * Allocate a number of pages from the OS | ||
| 380 | */ | ||
| 381 | static void * | ||
| 382 | map_pages(size_t pages) | ||
| 383 | { | ||
| 384 | caddr_t result, tail; | ||
| 385 | |||
| 386 | result = (caddr_t)pageround((u_long)sbrk(0)); | ||
| 387 | pages <<= malloc_pageshift; | ||
| 388 | if (pages > SIZE_T_MAX - (size_t)result) { | ||
| 389 | #ifdef MALLOC_EXTRA_SANITY | ||
| 390 | wrtwarning("(ES): overflow in map_pages fails\n"); | ||
| 391 | #endif /* MALLOC_EXTRA_SANITY */ | ||
| 392 | errno = ENOMEM; | ||
| 393 | return (NULL); | ||
| 394 | } | ||
| 395 | tail = result + pages + malloc_guard; | ||
| 396 | |||
| 397 | if (brk(tail) == (char *)-1) { | ||
| 398 | #ifdef MALLOC_EXTRA_SANITY | ||
| 399 | wrtwarning("(ES): map_pages fails\n"); | ||
| 400 | #endif /* MALLOC_EXTRA_SANITY */ | ||
| 401 | return (NULL); | ||
| 402 | } | ||
| 403 | if (malloc_guard) | ||
| 404 | mprotect(result + pages, malloc_pagesize, PROT_NONE); | ||
| 405 | |||
| 406 | last_index = ptr2index(tail) - 1; | ||
| 407 | malloc_brk = tail; | ||
| 408 | |||
| 409 | if ((last_index+1) >= malloc_ninfo && !extend_pgdir(last_index)) | ||
| 410 | return (NULL); | ||
| 411 | |||
| 412 | return (result); | ||
| 413 | } | ||
| 414 | |||
| 415 | /* | ||
| 416 | * Extend page directory | ||
| 417 | */ | ||
| 418 | static int | ||
| 419 | extend_pgdir(u_long index) | ||
| 420 | { | ||
| 421 | struct pginfo **new, **old; | ||
| 422 | size_t i, oldlen; | ||
| 423 | |||
| 424 | /* Make it this many pages */ | ||
| 425 | i = index * sizeof *page_dir; | ||
| 426 | i /= malloc_pagesize; | ||
| 427 | i += 2; | ||
| 428 | |||
| 429 | /* remember the old mapping size */ | ||
| 430 | oldlen = malloc_ninfo * sizeof *page_dir; | ||
| 431 | |||
| 432 | /* | ||
| 433 | * NOTE: we allocate new pages and copy the directory rather than tempt | ||
| 434 | * fate by trying to "grow" the region.. There is nothing to prevent | ||
| 435 | * us from accidently re-mapping space that's been allocated by our caller | ||
| 436 | * via dlopen() or other mmap(). | ||
| 437 | * | ||
| 438 | * The copy problem is not too bad, as there is 4K of page index per | ||
| 439 | * 4MB of malloc arena. | ||
| 440 | * | ||
| 441 | * We can totally avoid the copy if we open a file descriptor to associate | ||
| 442 | * the anon mappings with. Then, when we remap the pages at the new | ||
| 443 | * address, the old pages will be "magically" remapped.. But this means | ||
| 444 | * keeping open a "secret" file descriptor..... | ||
| 445 | */ | ||
| 446 | |||
| 447 | /* Get new pages */ | ||
| 448 | new = (struct pginfo**) MMAP(i * malloc_pagesize); | ||
| 449 | if (new == MAP_FAILED) | ||
| 450 | return (0); | ||
| 451 | |||
| 452 | /* Copy the old stuff */ | ||
| 453 | memcpy(new, page_dir, | ||
| 454 | malloc_ninfo * sizeof *page_dir); | ||
| 455 | |||
| 456 | /* register the new size */ | ||
| 457 | malloc_ninfo = i * malloc_pagesize / sizeof *page_dir; | ||
| 458 | |||
| 459 | /* swap the pointers */ | ||
| 460 | old = page_dir; | ||
| 461 | page_dir = new; | ||
| 462 | |||
| 463 | /* Now free the old stuff */ | ||
| 464 | munmap(old, oldlen); | ||
| 465 | return (1); | ||
| 466 | } | ||
| 467 | |||
| 468 | /* | ||
| 469 | * Initialize the world | ||
| 470 | */ | ||
| 471 | static void | ||
| 472 | malloc_init(void) | ||
| 473 | { | ||
| 474 | char *p, b[64]; | ||
| 475 | int i, j; | ||
| 476 | int save_errno = errno; | ||
| 477 | |||
| 478 | _MALLOC_LOCK_INIT(); | ||
| 479 | |||
| 480 | INIT_MMAP(); | ||
| 481 | |||
| 482 | #ifdef MALLOC_EXTRA_SANITY | ||
| 483 | malloc_junk = 1; | ||
| 484 | #endif /* MALLOC_EXTRA_SANITY */ | ||
| 485 | |||
| 486 | for (i = 0; i < 3; i++) { | ||
| 487 | if (i == 0) { | ||
| 488 | j = readlink("/etc/malloc.conf", b, sizeof b - 1); | ||
| 489 | if (j <= 0) | ||
| 490 | continue; | ||
| 491 | b[j] = '\0'; | ||
| 492 | p = b; | ||
| 493 | } else if (i == 1) { | ||
| 494 | if (issetugid() == 0) | ||
| 495 | p = getenv("MALLOC_OPTIONS"); | ||
| 496 | else | ||
| 497 | continue; | ||
| 498 | } else if (i == 2) { | ||
| 499 | p = malloc_options; | ||
| 500 | } | ||
| 501 | for (; p != NULL && *p != '\0'; p++) { | ||
| 502 | switch (*p) { | ||
| 503 | case '>': malloc_cache <<= 1; break; | ||
| 504 | case '<': malloc_cache >>= 1; break; | ||
| 505 | case 'a': malloc_abort = 0; break; | ||
| 506 | case 'A': malloc_abort = 1; break; | ||
| 507 | #ifdef MALLOC_STATS | ||
| 508 | case 'd': malloc_stats = 0; break; | ||
| 509 | case 'D': malloc_stats = 1; break; | ||
| 510 | #endif /* MALLOC_STATS */ | ||
| 511 | case 'f': malloc_freeprot = 0; break; | ||
| 512 | case 'F': malloc_freeprot = 1; break; | ||
| 513 | case 'g': malloc_guard = 0; break; | ||
| 514 | case 'G': malloc_guard = malloc_pagesize; break; | ||
| 515 | #if defined(__FreeBSD__) || (defined(__OpenBSD__) && defined(MADV_FREE)) | ||
| 516 | case 'h': malloc_hint = 0; break; | ||
| 517 | case 'H': malloc_hint = 1; break; | ||
| 518 | #endif /* __FreeBSD__ */ | ||
| 519 | case 'r': malloc_realloc = 0; break; | ||
| 520 | case 'R': malloc_realloc = 1; break; | ||
| 521 | case 'j': malloc_junk = 0; break; | ||
| 522 | case 'J': malloc_junk = 1; break; | ||
| 523 | case 'n': malloc_silent = 0; break; | ||
| 524 | case 'N': malloc_silent = 1; break; | ||
| 525 | #ifdef __FreeBSD__ | ||
| 526 | case 'u': malloc_utrace = 0; break; | ||
| 527 | case 'U': malloc_utrace = 1; break; | ||
| 528 | #endif /* __FreeBSD__ */ | ||
| 529 | case 'x': malloc_xmalloc = 0; break; | ||
| 530 | case 'X': malloc_xmalloc = 1; break; | ||
| 531 | case 'z': malloc_zero = 0; break; | ||
| 532 | case 'Z': malloc_zero = 1; break; | ||
| 533 | default: | ||
| 534 | j = malloc_abort; | ||
| 535 | malloc_abort = 0; | ||
| 536 | wrtwarning("unknown char in MALLOC_OPTIONS\n"); | ||
| 537 | malloc_abort = j; | ||
| 538 | break; | ||
| 539 | } | ||
| 540 | } | ||
| 541 | } | ||
| 542 | |||
| 543 | UTRACE(0, 0, 0); | ||
| 544 | |||
| 545 | /* | ||
| 546 | * We want junk in the entire allocation, and zero only in the part | ||
| 547 | * the user asked for. | ||
| 548 | */ | ||
| 549 | if (malloc_zero) | ||
| 550 | malloc_junk=1; | ||
| 551 | |||
| 552 | #ifdef MALLOC_STATS | ||
| 553 | if (malloc_stats && (atexit(malloc_exit) == -1)) | ||
| 554 | wrtwarning("atexit(2) failed. Will not be able to dump malloc stats on exit\n"); | ||
| 555 | #endif /* MALLOC_STATS */ | ||
| 556 | |||
| 557 | /* Allocate one page for the page directory */ | ||
| 558 | page_dir = (struct pginfo **) MMAP(malloc_pagesize); | ||
| 559 | |||
| 560 | if (page_dir == MAP_FAILED) | ||
| 561 | wrterror("mmap(2) failed, check limits\n"); | ||
| 562 | |||
| 563 | /* | ||
| 564 | * We need a maximum of malloc_pageshift buckets, steal these from the | ||
| 565 | * front of the page_directory; | ||
| 566 | */ | ||
| 567 | malloc_origo = ((u_long)pageround((u_long)sbrk(0))) >> malloc_pageshift; | ||
| 568 | malloc_origo -= malloc_pageshift; | ||
| 569 | |||
| 570 | malloc_ninfo = malloc_pagesize / sizeof *page_dir; | ||
| 571 | |||
| 572 | /* Been here, done that */ | ||
| 573 | malloc_started++; | ||
| 574 | |||
| 575 | /* Recalculate the cache size in bytes, and make sure it's nonzero */ | ||
| 576 | |||
| 577 | if (!malloc_cache) | ||
| 578 | malloc_cache++; | ||
| 579 | |||
| 580 | malloc_cache <<= malloc_pageshift; | ||
| 581 | |||
| 582 | /* | ||
| 583 | * This is a nice hack from Kaleb Keithly (kaleb@x.org). | ||
| 584 | * We can sbrk(2) further back when we keep this on a low address. | ||
| 585 | */ | ||
| 586 | px = (struct pgfree *) imalloc (sizeof *px); | ||
| 587 | errno = save_errno; | ||
| 588 | } | ||
| 589 | |||
| 590 | /* | ||
| 591 | * Allocate a number of complete pages | ||
| 592 | */ | ||
| 593 | static void * | ||
| 594 | malloc_pages(size_t size) | ||
| 595 | { | ||
| 596 | void *p, *delay_free = NULL; | ||
| 597 | int i; | ||
| 598 | struct pgfree *pf; | ||
| 599 | u_long index; | ||
| 600 | |||
| 601 | size = pageround(size) + malloc_guard; | ||
| 602 | |||
| 603 | p = NULL; | ||
| 604 | /* Look for free pages before asking for more */ | ||
| 605 | for(pf = free_list.next; pf; pf = pf->next) { | ||
| 606 | |||
| 607 | #ifdef MALLOC_EXTRA_SANITY | ||
| 608 | if (pf->size & malloc_pagemask) | ||
| 609 | wrterror("(ES): junk length entry on free_list\n"); | ||
| 610 | if (!pf->size) | ||
| 611 | wrterror("(ES): zero length entry on free_list\n"); | ||
| 612 | if (pf->page == pf->end) | ||
| 613 | wrterror("(ES): zero entry on free_list\n"); | ||
| 614 | if (pf->page > pf->end) | ||
| 615 | wrterror("(ES): sick entry on free_list\n"); | ||
| 616 | if ((void*)pf->page >= (void*)sbrk(0)) | ||
| 617 | wrterror("(ES): entry on free_list past brk\n"); | ||
| 618 | if (page_dir[ptr2index(pf->page)] != MALLOC_FREE) | ||
| 619 | wrterror("(ES): non-free first page on free-list\n"); | ||
| 620 | if (page_dir[ptr2index(pf->end)-1] != MALLOC_FREE) | ||
| 621 | wrterror("(ES): non-free last page on free-list\n"); | ||
| 622 | #endif /* MALLOC_EXTRA_SANITY */ | ||
| 623 | |||
| 624 | if (pf->size < size) | ||
| 625 | continue; | ||
| 626 | |||
| 627 | if (pf->size == size) { | ||
| 628 | p = pf->page; | ||
| 629 | if (pf->next != NULL) | ||
| 630 | pf->next->prev = pf->prev; | ||
| 631 | pf->prev->next = pf->next; | ||
| 632 | delay_free = pf; | ||
| 633 | break; | ||
| 634 | } | ||
| 635 | |||
| 636 | p = pf->page; | ||
| 637 | pf->page = (char *)pf->page + size; | ||
| 638 | pf->size -= size; | ||
| 639 | break; | ||
| 640 | } | ||
| 641 | |||
| 642 | size -= malloc_guard; | ||
| 643 | |||
| 644 | #ifdef MALLOC_EXTRA_SANITY | ||
| 645 | if (p != NULL && page_dir[ptr2index(p)] != MALLOC_FREE) | ||
| 646 | wrterror("(ES): allocated non-free page on free-list\n"); | ||
| 647 | #endif /* MALLOC_EXTRA_SANITY */ | ||
| 648 | |||
| 649 | if ((malloc_guard || malloc_freeprot) && p != NULL) | ||
| 650 | mprotect(p, size, PROT_READ|PROT_WRITE); | ||
| 651 | |||
| 652 | size >>= malloc_pageshift; | ||
| 653 | |||
| 654 | /* Map new pages */ | ||
| 655 | if (p == NULL) | ||
| 656 | p = map_pages(size); | ||
| 657 | |||
| 658 | if (p != NULL) { | ||
| 659 | |||
| 660 | index = ptr2index(p); | ||
| 661 | page_dir[index] = MALLOC_FIRST; | ||
| 662 | for (i=1;i<size;i++) | ||
| 663 | page_dir[index+i] = MALLOC_FOLLOW; | ||
| 664 | |||
| 665 | if (malloc_junk) | ||
| 666 | memset(p, SOME_JUNK, size << malloc_pageshift); | ||
| 667 | } | ||
| 668 | |||
| 669 | if (delay_free) { | ||
| 670 | if (px == NULL) | ||
| 671 | px = delay_free; | ||
| 672 | else | ||
| 673 | ifree(delay_free); | ||
| 674 | } | ||
| 675 | |||
| 676 | return (p); | ||
| 677 | } | ||
| 678 | |||
| 679 | /* | ||
| 680 | * Allocate a page of fragments | ||
| 681 | */ | ||
| 682 | |||
| 683 | static __inline__ int | ||
| 684 | malloc_make_chunks(int bits) | ||
| 685 | { | ||
| 686 | struct pginfo *bp; | ||
| 687 | void *pp; | ||
| 688 | int i, k, l; | ||
| 689 | |||
| 690 | /* Allocate a new bucket */ | ||
| 691 | pp = malloc_pages((size_t)malloc_pagesize); | ||
| 692 | if (pp == NULL) | ||
| 693 | return (0); | ||
| 694 | |||
| 695 | /* Find length of admin structure */ | ||
| 696 | l = sizeof *bp - sizeof(u_long); | ||
| 697 | l += sizeof(u_long) * | ||
| 698 | (((malloc_pagesize >> bits)+MALLOC_BITS-1) / MALLOC_BITS); | ||
| 699 | |||
| 700 | /* Don't waste more than two chunks on this */ | ||
| 701 | /* | ||
| 702 | * If we are to allocate a memory protected page for the malloc(0) | ||
| 703 | * case (when bits=0), it must be from a different page than the | ||
| 704 | * pginfo page. | ||
| 705 | * --> Treat it like the big chunk alloc, get a second data page. | ||
| 706 | */ | ||
| 707 | if (bits != 0 && (1UL<<(bits)) <= l+l) { | ||
| 708 | bp = (struct pginfo *)pp; | ||
| 709 | } else { | ||
| 710 | bp = (struct pginfo *)imalloc(l); | ||
| 711 | if (bp == NULL) { | ||
| 712 | ifree(pp); | ||
| 713 | return (0); | ||
| 714 | } | ||
| 715 | } | ||
| 716 | |||
| 717 | /* memory protect the page allocated in the malloc(0) case */ | ||
| 718 | if (bits == 0) { | ||
| 719 | |||
| 720 | bp->size = 0; | ||
| 721 | bp->shift = 1; | ||
| 722 | i = malloc_minsize-1; | ||
| 723 | while (i >>= 1) | ||
| 724 | bp->shift++; | ||
| 725 | bp->total = bp->free = malloc_pagesize >> bp->shift; | ||
| 726 | bp->page = pp; | ||
| 727 | |||
| 728 | k = mprotect(pp, malloc_pagesize, PROT_NONE); | ||
| 729 | if (k < 0) { | ||
| 730 | ifree(pp); | ||
| 731 | ifree(bp); | ||
| 732 | return (0); | ||
| 733 | } | ||
| 734 | } else { | ||
| 735 | bp->size = (1UL<<bits); | ||
| 736 | bp->shift = bits; | ||
| 737 | bp->total = bp->free = malloc_pagesize >> bits; | ||
| 738 | bp->page = pp; | ||
| 739 | } | ||
| 740 | |||
| 741 | /* set all valid bits in the bitmap */ | ||
| 742 | k = bp->total; | ||
| 743 | i = 0; | ||
| 744 | |||
| 745 | /* Do a bunch at a time */ | ||
| 746 | for(;k-i >= MALLOC_BITS; i += MALLOC_BITS) | ||
| 747 | bp->bits[i / MALLOC_BITS] = ~0UL; | ||
| 748 | |||
| 749 | for(; i < k; i++) | ||
| 750 | bp->bits[i/MALLOC_BITS] |= 1UL<<(i%MALLOC_BITS); | ||
| 751 | |||
| 752 | if (bp == bp->page) { | ||
| 753 | /* Mark the ones we stole for ourselves */ | ||
| 754 | for(i=0;l > 0;i++) { | ||
| 755 | bp->bits[i/MALLOC_BITS] &= ~(1UL<<(i%MALLOC_BITS)); | ||
| 756 | bp->free--; | ||
| 757 | bp->total--; | ||
| 758 | l -= (1 << bits); | ||
| 759 | } | ||
| 760 | } | ||
| 761 | |||
| 762 | /* MALLOC_LOCK */ | ||
| 763 | |||
| 764 | page_dir[ptr2index(pp)] = bp; | ||
| 765 | |||
| 766 | bp->next = page_dir[bits]; | ||
| 767 | page_dir[bits] = bp; | ||
| 768 | |||
| 769 | /* MALLOC_UNLOCK */ | ||
| 770 | |||
| 771 | return (1); | ||
| 772 | } | ||
| 773 | |||
| 774 | /* | ||
| 775 | * Allocate a fragment | ||
| 776 | */ | ||
| 777 | static void * | ||
| 778 | malloc_bytes(size_t size) | ||
| 779 | { | ||
| 780 | int i,j; | ||
| 781 | u_long u; | ||
| 782 | struct pginfo *bp; | ||
| 783 | int k; | ||
| 784 | u_long *lp; | ||
| 785 | |||
| 786 | /* Don't bother with anything less than this */ | ||
| 787 | /* unless we have a malloc(0) requests */ | ||
| 788 | if (size != 0 && size < malloc_minsize) | ||
| 789 | size = malloc_minsize; | ||
| 790 | |||
| 791 | /* Find the right bucket */ | ||
| 792 | if (size == 0) | ||
| 793 | j=0; | ||
| 794 | else { | ||
| 795 | j = 1; | ||
| 796 | i = size-1; | ||
| 797 | while (i >>= 1) | ||
| 798 | j++; | ||
| 799 | } | ||
| 800 | |||
| 801 | /* If it's empty, make a page more of that size chunks */ | ||
| 802 | if (page_dir[j] == NULL && !malloc_make_chunks(j)) | ||
| 803 | return (NULL); | ||
| 804 | |||
| 805 | bp = page_dir[j]; | ||
| 806 | |||
| 807 | /* Find first word of bitmap which isn't empty */ | ||
| 808 | for (lp = bp->bits; !*lp; lp++) | ||
| 809 | ; | ||
| 810 | |||
| 811 | /* Find that bit, and tweak it */ | ||
| 812 | u = 1; | ||
| 813 | k = 0; | ||
| 814 | while (!(*lp & u)) { | ||
| 815 | u += u; | ||
| 816 | k++; | ||
| 817 | } | ||
| 818 | |||
| 819 | if (malloc_guard) { | ||
| 820 | /* Walk to a random position. */ | ||
| 821 | i = arc4random() % bp->free; | ||
| 822 | while (i > 0) { | ||
| 823 | u += u; | ||
| 824 | k++; | ||
| 825 | if (k >= MALLOC_BITS) { | ||
| 826 | lp++; | ||
| 827 | u = 1; | ||
| 828 | k = 0; | ||
| 829 | } | ||
| 830 | #ifdef MALLOC_EXTRA_SANITY | ||
| 831 | if (lp - bp->bits > (bp->total - 1) / MALLOC_BITS) | ||
| 832 | wrterror("chunk overflow\n"); | ||
| 833 | #endif /* MALLOC_EXTRA_SANITY */ | ||
| 834 | if (*lp & u) | ||
| 835 | i--; | ||
| 836 | } | ||
| 837 | } | ||
| 838 | *lp ^= u; | ||
| 839 | |||
| 840 | /* If there are no more free, remove from free-list */ | ||
| 841 | if (!--bp->free) { | ||
| 842 | page_dir[j] = bp->next; | ||
| 843 | bp->next = NULL; | ||
| 844 | } | ||
| 845 | |||
| 846 | /* Adjust to the real offset of that chunk */ | ||
| 847 | k += (lp-bp->bits)*MALLOC_BITS; | ||
| 848 | k <<= bp->shift; | ||
| 849 | |||
| 850 | if (malloc_junk && bp->size != 0) | ||
| 851 | memset((char *)bp->page + k, SOME_JUNK, bp->size); | ||
| 852 | |||
| 853 | return ((u_char *)bp->page + k); | ||
| 854 | } | ||
| 855 | |||
| 856 | /* | ||
| 857 | * Allocate a piece of memory | ||
| 858 | */ | ||
| 859 | static void * | ||
| 860 | imalloc(size_t size) | ||
| 861 | { | ||
| 862 | void *result; | ||
| 863 | |||
| 864 | if (!malloc_started) | ||
| 865 | malloc_init(); | ||
| 866 | |||
| 867 | if (suicide) | ||
| 868 | abort(); | ||
| 869 | |||
| 870 | if ((size + malloc_pagesize) < size) { /* Check for overflow */ | ||
| 871 | result = NULL; | ||
| 872 | errno = ENOMEM; | ||
| 873 | } | ||
| 874 | else if (size <= malloc_maxsize) | ||
| 875 | result = malloc_bytes(size); | ||
| 876 | else | ||
| 877 | result = malloc_pages(size); | ||
| 878 | |||
| 879 | if (malloc_abort == 1 && result == NULL) | ||
| 880 | wrterror("allocation failed\n"); | ||
| 881 | |||
| 882 | if (malloc_zero && result != NULL) | ||
| 883 | memset(result, 0, size); | ||
| 884 | |||
| 885 | return (result); | ||
| 886 | } | ||
| 887 | |||
| 888 | /* | ||
| 889 | * Change the size of an allocation. | ||
| 890 | */ | ||
| 891 | static void * | ||
| 892 | irealloc(void *ptr, size_t size) | ||
| 893 | { | ||
| 894 | void *p; | ||
| 895 | u_long osize, index; | ||
| 896 | struct pginfo **mp; | ||
| 897 | int i; | ||
| 898 | |||
| 899 | if (suicide) | ||
| 900 | abort(); | ||
| 901 | |||
| 902 | if (!malloc_started) { | ||
| 903 | wrtwarning("malloc() has never been called\n"); | ||
| 904 | return (NULL); | ||
| 905 | } | ||
| 906 | |||
| 907 | index = ptr2index(ptr); | ||
| 908 | |||
| 909 | if (index < malloc_pageshift) { | ||
| 910 | wrtwarning("junk pointer, too low to make sense\n"); | ||
| 911 | return (NULL); | ||
| 912 | } | ||
| 913 | |||
| 914 | if (index > last_index) { | ||
| 915 | wrtwarning("junk pointer, too high to make sense\n"); | ||
| 916 | return (NULL); | ||
| 917 | } | ||
| 918 | |||
| 919 | mp = &page_dir[index]; | ||
| 920 | |||
| 921 | if (*mp == MALLOC_FIRST) { /* Page allocation */ | ||
| 922 | |||
| 923 | /* Check the pointer */ | ||
| 924 | if ((u_long)ptr & malloc_pagemask) { | ||
| 925 | wrtwarning("modified (page-) pointer\n"); | ||
| 926 | return (NULL); | ||
| 927 | } | ||
| 928 | |||
| 929 | /* Find the size in bytes */ | ||
| 930 | for (osize = malloc_pagesize; *(++mp) == MALLOC_FOLLOW;) | ||
| 931 | osize += malloc_pagesize; | ||
| 932 | |||
| 933 | if (!malloc_realloc && /* Unless we have to, */ | ||
| 934 | size <= osize && /* .. or are too small, */ | ||
| 935 | size > (osize - malloc_pagesize)) { /* .. or can free a page, */ | ||
| 936 | if (malloc_junk) | ||
| 937 | memset((char *)ptr + size, SOME_JUNK, osize-size); | ||
| 938 | return (ptr); /* ..don't do anything else. */ | ||
| 939 | } | ||
| 940 | |||
| 941 | } else if (*mp >= MALLOC_MAGIC) { /* Chunk allocation */ | ||
| 942 | |||
| 943 | /* Check the pointer for sane values */ | ||
| 944 | if ((u_long)ptr & ((1UL<<((*mp)->shift))-1)) { | ||
| 945 | wrtwarning("modified (chunk-) pointer\n"); | ||
| 946 | return (NULL); | ||
| 947 | } | ||
| 948 | |||
| 949 | /* Find the chunk index in the page */ | ||
| 950 | i = ((u_long)ptr & malloc_pagemask) >> (*mp)->shift; | ||
| 951 | |||
| 952 | /* Verify that it isn't a free chunk already */ | ||
| 953 | if ((*mp)->bits[i/MALLOC_BITS] & (1UL<<(i%MALLOC_BITS))) { | ||
| 954 | wrtwarning("chunk is already free\n"); | ||
| 955 | return (NULL); | ||
| 956 | } | ||
| 957 | |||
| 958 | osize = (*mp)->size; | ||
| 959 | |||
| 960 | if (!malloc_realloc && /* Unless we have to, */ | ||
| 961 | size <= osize && /* ..or are too small, */ | ||
| 962 | (size > osize/2 || /* ..or could use a smaller size, */ | ||
| 963 | osize == malloc_minsize)) { /* ..(if there is one) */ | ||
| 964 | if (malloc_junk) | ||
| 965 | memset((char *)ptr + size, SOME_JUNK, osize-size); | ||
| 966 | return (ptr); /* ..don't do anything else. */ | ||
| 967 | } | ||
| 968 | |||
| 969 | } else { | ||
| 970 | wrtwarning("pointer to wrong page\n"); | ||
| 971 | return (NULL); | ||
| 972 | } | ||
| 973 | |||
| 974 | p = imalloc(size); | ||
| 975 | |||
| 976 | if (p != NULL) { | ||
| 977 | /* copy the lesser of the two sizes, and free the old one */ | ||
| 978 | /* Don't move from/to 0 sized region !!! */ | ||
| 979 | if (osize != 0 && size != 0) { | ||
| 980 | if (osize < size) | ||
| 981 | memcpy(p, ptr, osize); | ||
| 982 | else | ||
| 983 | memcpy(p, ptr, size); | ||
| 984 | } | ||
| 985 | ifree(ptr); | ||
| 986 | } | ||
| 987 | return (p); | ||
| 988 | } | ||
| 989 | |||
| 990 | /* | ||
| 991 | * Free a sequence of pages | ||
| 992 | */ | ||
| 993 | |||
| 994 | static __inline__ void | ||
| 995 | free_pages(void *ptr, u_long index, struct pginfo *info) | ||
| 996 | { | ||
| 997 | u_long i, l; | ||
| 998 | struct pgfree *pf, *pt=NULL; | ||
| 999 | void *tail; | ||
| 1000 | |||
| 1001 | if (info == MALLOC_FREE) { | ||
| 1002 | wrtwarning("page is already free\n"); | ||
| 1003 | return; | ||
| 1004 | } | ||
| 1005 | |||
| 1006 | if (info != MALLOC_FIRST) { | ||
| 1007 | wrtwarning("pointer to wrong page\n"); | ||
| 1008 | return; | ||
| 1009 | } | ||
| 1010 | |||
| 1011 | if ((u_long)ptr & malloc_pagemask) { | ||
| 1012 | wrtwarning("modified (page-) pointer\n"); | ||
| 1013 | return; | ||
| 1014 | } | ||
| 1015 | |||
| 1016 | /* Count how many pages and mark them free at the same time */ | ||
| 1017 | page_dir[index] = MALLOC_FREE; | ||
| 1018 | for (i = 1; page_dir[index+i] == MALLOC_FOLLOW; i++) | ||
| 1019 | page_dir[index + i] = MALLOC_FREE; | ||
| 1020 | |||
| 1021 | l = i << malloc_pageshift; | ||
| 1022 | |||
| 1023 | if (malloc_junk) | ||
| 1024 | memset(ptr, SOME_JUNK, l); | ||
| 1025 | |||
| 1026 | #if defined(__FreeBSD__) || (defined(__OpenBSD__) && defined(MADV_FREE)) | ||
| 1027 | if (malloc_hint) | ||
| 1028 | madvise(ptr, l, MADV_FREE); | ||
| 1029 | #endif | ||
| 1030 | |||
| 1031 | if (malloc_guard) { | ||
| 1032 | page_dir[index + i] = MALLOC_FREE; | ||
| 1033 | l += malloc_guard; | ||
| 1034 | } | ||
| 1035 | tail = (char *)ptr+l; | ||
| 1036 | |||
| 1037 | if (malloc_freeprot) | ||
| 1038 | mprotect(ptr, tail - ptr, PROT_NONE); | ||
| 1039 | |||
| 1040 | /* add to free-list */ | ||
| 1041 | if (px == NULL) | ||
| 1042 | px = imalloc(sizeof *px); /* This cannot fail... */ | ||
| 1043 | px->page = ptr; | ||
| 1044 | px->end = tail; | ||
| 1045 | px->size = l; | ||
| 1046 | |||
| 1047 | if (free_list.next == NULL) { | ||
| 1048 | |||
| 1049 | /* Nothing on free list, put this at head */ | ||
| 1050 | px->next = free_list.next; | ||
| 1051 | px->prev = &free_list; | ||
| 1052 | free_list.next = px; | ||
| 1053 | pf = px; | ||
| 1054 | px = NULL; | ||
| 1055 | |||
| 1056 | } else { | ||
| 1057 | |||
| 1058 | /* Find the right spot, leave pf pointing to the modified entry. */ | ||
| 1059 | |||
| 1060 | for(pf = free_list.next; pf->end < ptr && pf->next != NULL; | ||
| 1061 | pf = pf->next) | ||
| 1062 | ; /* Race ahead here */ | ||
| 1063 | |||
| 1064 | if (pf->page > tail) { | ||
| 1065 | /* Insert before entry */ | ||
| 1066 | px->next = pf; | ||
| 1067 | px->prev = pf->prev; | ||
| 1068 | pf->prev = px; | ||
| 1069 | px->prev->next = px; | ||
| 1070 | pf = px; | ||
| 1071 | px = NULL; | ||
| 1072 | } else if (pf->end == ptr ) { | ||
| 1073 | /* Append to the previous entry */ | ||
| 1074 | pf->end = (char *)pf->end + l; | ||
| 1075 | pf->size += l; | ||
| 1076 | if (pf->next != NULL && pf->end == pf->next->page ) { | ||
| 1077 | /* And collapse the next too. */ | ||
| 1078 | pt = pf->next; | ||
| 1079 | pf->end = pt->end; | ||
| 1080 | pf->size += pt->size; | ||
| 1081 | pf->next = pt->next; | ||
| 1082 | if (pf->next != NULL) | ||
| 1083 | pf->next->prev = pf; | ||
| 1084 | } | ||
| 1085 | } else if (pf->page == tail) { | ||
| 1086 | /* Prepend to entry */ | ||
| 1087 | pf->size += l; | ||
| 1088 | pf->page = ptr; | ||
| 1089 | } else if (pf->next == NULL) { | ||
| 1090 | /* Append at tail of chain */ | ||
| 1091 | px->next = NULL; | ||
| 1092 | px->prev = pf; | ||
| 1093 | pf->next = px; | ||
| 1094 | pf = px; | ||
| 1095 | px = NULL; | ||
| 1096 | } else { | ||
| 1097 | wrterror("freelist is destroyed\n"); | ||
| 1098 | } | ||
| 1099 | } | ||
| 1100 | |||
| 1101 | /* Return something to OS ? */ | ||
| 1102 | if (pf->next == NULL && /* If we're the last one, */ | ||
| 1103 | pf->size > malloc_cache && /* ..and the cache is full, */ | ||
| 1104 | pf->end == malloc_brk && /* ..and none behind us, */ | ||
| 1105 | malloc_brk == sbrk(0)) { /* ..and it's OK to do... */ | ||
| 1106 | |||
| 1107 | /* | ||
| 1108 | * Keep the cache intact. Notice that the '>' above guarantees that | ||
| 1109 | * the pf will always have at least one page afterwards. | ||
| 1110 | */ | ||
| 1111 | pf->end = (char *)pf->page + malloc_cache; | ||
| 1112 | pf->size = malloc_cache; | ||
| 1113 | |||
| 1114 | brk(pf->end); | ||
| 1115 | malloc_brk = pf->end; | ||
| 1116 | |||
| 1117 | index = ptr2index(pf->end); | ||
| 1118 | |||
| 1119 | for(i=index;i <= last_index;) | ||
| 1120 | page_dir[i++] = MALLOC_NOT_MINE; | ||
| 1121 | |||
| 1122 | last_index = index - 1; | ||
| 1123 | |||
| 1124 | /* XXX: We could realloc/shrink the pagedir here I guess. */ | ||
| 1125 | } | ||
| 1126 | if (pt != NULL) | ||
| 1127 | ifree(pt); | ||
| 1128 | } | ||
| 1129 | |||
| 1130 | /* | ||
| 1131 | * Free a chunk, and possibly the page it's on, if the page becomes empty. | ||
| 1132 | */ | ||
| 1133 | |||
| 1134 | /* ARGSUSED */ | ||
| 1135 | static __inline__ void | ||
| 1136 | free_bytes(void *ptr, int index, struct pginfo *info) | ||
| 1137 | { | ||
| 1138 | int i; | ||
| 1139 | struct pginfo **mp; | ||
| 1140 | void *vp; | ||
| 1141 | |||
| 1142 | /* Find the chunk number on the page */ | ||
| 1143 | i = ((u_long)ptr & malloc_pagemask) >> info->shift; | ||
| 1144 | |||
| 1145 | if ((u_long)ptr & ((1UL<<(info->shift))-1)) { | ||
| 1146 | wrtwarning("modified (chunk-) pointer\n"); | ||
| 1147 | return; | ||
| 1148 | } | ||
| 1149 | |||
| 1150 | if (info->bits[i/MALLOC_BITS] & (1UL<<(i%MALLOC_BITS))) { | ||
| 1151 | wrtwarning("chunk is already free\n"); | ||
| 1152 | return; | ||
| 1153 | } | ||
| 1154 | |||
| 1155 | if (malloc_junk && info->size != 0) | ||
| 1156 | memset(ptr, SOME_JUNK, info->size); | ||
| 1157 | |||
| 1158 | info->bits[i/MALLOC_BITS] |= 1UL<<(i%MALLOC_BITS); | ||
| 1159 | info->free++; | ||
| 1160 | |||
| 1161 | if (info->size != 0) | ||
| 1162 | mp = page_dir + info->shift; | ||
| 1163 | else | ||
| 1164 | mp = page_dir; | ||
| 1165 | |||
| 1166 | if (info->free == 1) { | ||
| 1167 | |||
| 1168 | /* Page became non-full */ | ||
| 1169 | |||
| 1170 | /* Insert in address order */ | ||
| 1171 | while (*mp && (*mp)->next && (*mp)->next->page < info->page) | ||
| 1172 | mp = &(*mp)->next; | ||
| 1173 | info->next = *mp; | ||
| 1174 | *mp = info; | ||
| 1175 | return; | ||
| 1176 | } | ||
| 1177 | |||
| 1178 | if (info->free != info->total) | ||
| 1179 | return; | ||
| 1180 | |||
| 1181 | /* Find & remove this page in the queue */ | ||
| 1182 | while (*mp != info) { | ||
| 1183 | mp = &((*mp)->next); | ||
| 1184 | #ifdef MALLOC_EXTRA_SANITY | ||
| 1185 | if (!*mp) | ||
| 1186 | wrterror("(ES): Not on queue\n"); | ||
| 1187 | #endif /* MALLOC_EXTRA_SANITY */ | ||
| 1188 | } | ||
| 1189 | *mp = info->next; | ||
| 1190 | |||
| 1191 | /* Free the page & the info structure if need be */ | ||
| 1192 | page_dir[ptr2index(info->page)] = MALLOC_FIRST; | ||
| 1193 | |||
| 1194 | /* If the page was mprotected, unprotect it before releasing it */ | ||
| 1195 | if (info->size == 0) { | ||
| 1196 | mprotect(info->page, malloc_pagesize, PROT_READ|PROT_WRITE); | ||
| 1197 | /* Do we have to care if mprotect succeeds here ? */ | ||
| 1198 | } | ||
| 1199 | |||
| 1200 | vp = info->page; /* Order is important ! */ | ||
| 1201 | if(vp != (void*)info) | ||
| 1202 | ifree(info); | ||
| 1203 | ifree(vp); | ||
| 1204 | } | ||
| 1205 | |||
| 1206 | static void | ||
| 1207 | ifree(void *ptr) | ||
| 1208 | { | ||
| 1209 | struct pginfo *info; | ||
| 1210 | u_long index; | ||
| 1211 | |||
| 1212 | /* This is legal */ | ||
| 1213 | if (ptr == NULL) | ||
| 1214 | return; | ||
| 1215 | |||
| 1216 | if (!malloc_started) { | ||
| 1217 | wrtwarning("malloc() has never been called\n"); | ||
| 1218 | return; | ||
| 1219 | } | ||
| 1220 | |||
| 1221 | /* If we're already sinking, don't make matters any worse. */ | ||
| 1222 | if (suicide) | ||
| 1223 | return; | ||
| 1224 | |||
| 1225 | index = ptr2index(ptr); | ||
| 1226 | |||
| 1227 | if (index < malloc_pageshift) { | ||
| 1228 | wrtwarning("junk pointer, too low to make sense\n"); | ||
| 1229 | return; | ||
| 1230 | } | ||
| 1231 | |||
| 1232 | if (index > last_index) { | ||
| 1233 | wrtwarning("junk pointer, too high to make sense\n"); | ||
| 1234 | return; | ||
| 1235 | } | ||
| 1236 | |||
| 1237 | info = page_dir[index]; | ||
| 1238 | |||
| 1239 | if (info < MALLOC_MAGIC) | ||
| 1240 | free_pages(ptr, index, info); | ||
| 1241 | else | ||
| 1242 | free_bytes(ptr, index, info); | ||
| 1243 | return; | ||
| 1244 | } | ||
| 1245 | |||
| 1246 | static int malloc_active; | ||
| 1247 | |||
| 1248 | /* | ||
| 1249 | * Common function for handling recursion. Only | ||
| 1250 | * print the error message once, to avoid making the problem | ||
| 1251 | * potentially worse. | ||
| 1252 | */ | ||
| 1253 | static void | ||
| 1254 | malloc_recurse(void) | ||
| 1255 | { | ||
| 1256 | static int noprint; | ||
| 1257 | |||
| 1258 | if (noprint == 0) | ||
| 1259 | wrtwarning("recursive call\n"); | ||
| 1260 | noprint = 1; | ||
| 1261 | malloc_active--; | ||
| 1262 | _MALLOC_UNLOCK(); | ||
| 1263 | errno = EDEADLK; | ||
| 1264 | } | ||
| 1265 | |||
| 1266 | /* | ||
| 1267 | * These are the public exported interface routines. | ||
| 1268 | */ | ||
| 1269 | void * | ||
| 1270 | malloc(size_t size) | ||
| 1271 | { | ||
| 1272 | void *r; | ||
| 1273 | |||
| 1274 | _MALLOC_LOCK(); | ||
| 1275 | malloc_func = " in malloc():"; | ||
| 1276 | if (malloc_active++) { | ||
| 1277 | malloc_recurse(); | ||
| 1278 | return (NULL); | ||
| 1279 | } | ||
| 1280 | r = imalloc(size); | ||
| 1281 | UTRACE(0, size, r); | ||
| 1282 | malloc_active--; | ||
| 1283 | _MALLOC_UNLOCK(); | ||
| 1284 | if (malloc_xmalloc && r == NULL) | ||
| 1285 | wrterror("out of memory\n"); | ||
| 1286 | return (r); | ||
| 1287 | } | ||
| 1288 | |||
| 1289 | void | ||
| 1290 | free(void *ptr) | ||
| 1291 | { | ||
| 1292 | _MALLOC_LOCK(); | ||
| 1293 | malloc_func = " in free():"; | ||
| 1294 | if (malloc_active++) { | ||
| 1295 | malloc_recurse(); | ||
| 1296 | return; | ||
| 1297 | } | ||
| 1298 | ifree(ptr); | ||
| 1299 | UTRACE(ptr, 0, 0); | ||
| 1300 | malloc_active--; | ||
| 1301 | _MALLOC_UNLOCK(); | ||
| 1302 | return; | ||
| 1303 | } | ||
| 1304 | |||
| 1305 | void * | ||
| 1306 | realloc(void *ptr, size_t size) | ||
| 1307 | { | ||
| 1308 | void *r; | ||
| 1309 | |||
| 1310 | _MALLOC_LOCK(); | ||
| 1311 | malloc_func = " in realloc():"; | ||
| 1312 | if (malloc_active++) { | ||
| 1313 | malloc_recurse(); | ||
| 1314 | return (NULL); | ||
| 1315 | } | ||
| 1316 | if (ptr == NULL) { | ||
| 1317 | r = imalloc(size); | ||
| 1318 | } else { | ||
| 1319 | r = irealloc(ptr, size); | ||
| 1320 | } | ||
| 1321 | UTRACE(ptr, size, r); | ||
| 1322 | malloc_active--; | ||
| 1323 | _MALLOC_UNLOCK(); | ||
| 1324 | if (malloc_xmalloc && r == NULL) | ||
| 1325 | wrterror("out of memory\n"); | ||
| 1326 | return (r); | ||
| 1327 | } | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/merge.c b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/merge.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..1826acc369 --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/merge.c | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,343 @@ | |||
| 1 | /*- | ||
| 2 | * Copyright (c) 1992, 1993 | ||
| 3 | * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved. | ||
| 4 | * | ||
| 5 | * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by | ||
| 6 | * Peter McIlroy. | ||
| 7 | * | ||
| 8 | * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without | ||
| 9 | * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions | ||
| 10 | * are met: | ||
| 11 | * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright | ||
| 12 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. | ||
| 13 | * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright | ||
| 14 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the | ||
| 15 | * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. | ||
| 16 | * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors | ||
| 17 | * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software | ||
| 18 | * without specific prior written permission. | ||
| 19 | * | ||
| 20 | * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND | ||
| 21 | * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE | ||
| 22 | * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE | ||
| 23 | * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE | ||
| 24 | * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL | ||
| 25 | * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS | ||
| 26 | * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) | ||
| 27 | * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT | ||
| 28 | * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY | ||
| 29 | * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF | ||
| 30 | * SUCH DAMAGE. | ||
| 31 | */ | ||
| 32 | |||
| 33 | #if defined(LIBC_SCCS) && !defined(lint) | ||
| 34 | static char *rcsid = "$OpenBSD: merge.c,v 1.6 2003/06/02 20:18:38 millert Exp $"; | ||
| 35 | #endif /* LIBC_SCCS and not lint */ | ||
| 36 | |||
| 37 | /* | ||
| 38 | * Hybrid exponential search/linear search merge sort with hybrid | ||
| 39 | * natural/pairwise first pass. Requires about .3% more comparisons | ||
| 40 | * for random data than LSMS with pairwise first pass alone. | ||
| 41 | * It works for objects as small as two bytes. | ||
| 42 | */ | ||
| 43 | |||
| 44 | #define NATURAL | ||
| 45 | #define THRESHOLD 16 /* Best choice for natural merge cut-off. */ | ||
| 46 | |||
| 47 | /* #define NATURAL to get hybrid natural merge. | ||
| 48 | * (The default is pairwise merging.) | ||
| 49 | */ | ||
| 50 | |||
| 51 | #include <sys/types.h> | ||
| 52 | |||
| 53 | #include <errno.h> | ||
| 54 | #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 55 | #include <string.h> | ||
| 56 | |||
| 57 | static void setup(u_char *, u_char *, size_t, size_t, int (*)()); | ||
| 58 | static void insertionsort(u_char *, size_t, size_t, int (*)()); | ||
| 59 | |||
| 60 | #define ISIZE sizeof(int) | ||
| 61 | #define PSIZE sizeof(u_char *) | ||
| 62 | #define ICOPY_LIST(src, dst, last) \ | ||
| 63 | do \ | ||
| 64 | *(int*)dst = *(int*)src, src += ISIZE, dst += ISIZE; \ | ||
| 65 | while(src < last) | ||
| 66 | #define ICOPY_ELT(src, dst, i) \ | ||
| 67 | do \ | ||
| 68 | *(int*) dst = *(int*) src, src += ISIZE, dst += ISIZE; \ | ||
| 69 | while (i -= ISIZE) | ||
| 70 | |||
| 71 | #define CCOPY_LIST(src, dst, last) \ | ||
| 72 | do \ | ||
| 73 | *dst++ = *src++; \ | ||
| 74 | while (src < last) | ||
| 75 | #define CCOPY_ELT(src, dst, i) \ | ||
| 76 | do \ | ||
| 77 | *dst++ = *src++; \ | ||
| 78 | while (i -= 1) | ||
| 79 | |||
| 80 | /* | ||
| 81 | * Find the next possible pointer head. (Trickery for forcing an array | ||
| 82 | * to do double duty as a linked list when objects do not align with word | ||
| 83 | * boundaries. | ||
| 84 | */ | ||
| 85 | /* Assumption: PSIZE is a power of 2. */ | ||
| 86 | #define EVAL(p) (u_char **) \ | ||
| 87 | ((u_char *)0 + \ | ||
| 88 | (((u_char *)p + PSIZE - 1 - (u_char *) 0) & ~(PSIZE - 1))) | ||
| 89 | |||
| 90 | /* | ||
| 91 | * Arguments are as for qsort. | ||
| 92 | */ | ||
| 93 | int | ||
| 94 | mergesort(base, nmemb, size, cmp) | ||
| 95 | void *base; | ||
| 96 | size_t nmemb; | ||
| 97 | register size_t size; | ||
| 98 | int (*cmp)(const void *, const void *); | ||
| 99 | { | ||
| 100 | register int i, sense; | ||
| 101 | int big, iflag; | ||
| 102 | register u_char *f1, *f2, *t, *b, *tp2, *q, *l1, *l2; | ||
| 103 | u_char *list2, *list1, *p2, *p, *last, **p1; | ||
| 104 | |||
| 105 | if (size < PSIZE / 2) { /* Pointers must fit into 2 * size. */ | ||
| 106 | errno = EINVAL; | ||
| 107 | return (-1); | ||
| 108 | } | ||
| 109 | |||
| 110 | /* | ||
| 111 | * XXX | ||
| 112 | * Stupid subtraction for the Cray. | ||
| 113 | */ | ||
| 114 | iflag = 0; | ||
| 115 | if (!(size % ISIZE) && !(((char *)base - (char *)0) % ISIZE)) | ||
| 116 | iflag = 1; | ||
| 117 | |||
| 118 | if ((list2 = malloc(nmemb * size + PSIZE)) == NULL) | ||
| 119 | return (-1); | ||
| 120 | |||
| 121 | list1 = base; | ||
| 122 | setup(list1, list2, nmemb, size, cmp); | ||
| 123 | last = list2 + nmemb * size; | ||
| 124 | i = big = 0; | ||
| 125 | while (*EVAL(list2) != last) { | ||
| 126 | l2 = list1; | ||
| 127 | p1 = EVAL(list1); | ||
| 128 | for (tp2 = p2 = list2; p2 != last; p1 = EVAL(l2)) { | ||
| 129 | p2 = *EVAL(p2); | ||
| 130 | f1 = l2; | ||
| 131 | f2 = l1 = list1 + (p2 - list2); | ||
| 132 | if (p2 != last) | ||
| 133 | p2 = *EVAL(p2); | ||
| 134 | l2 = list1 + (p2 - list2); | ||
| 135 | while (f1 < l1 && f2 < l2) { | ||
| 136 | if ((*cmp)(f1, f2) <= 0) { | ||
| 137 | q = f2; | ||
| 138 | b = f1, t = l1; | ||
| 139 | sense = -1; | ||
| 140 | } else { | ||
| 141 | q = f1; | ||
| 142 | b = f2, t = l2; | ||
| 143 | sense = 0; | ||
| 144 | } | ||
| 145 | if (!big) { /* here i = 0 */ | ||
| 146 | while ((b += size) < t && cmp(q, b) >sense) | ||
| 147 | if (++i == 6) { | ||
| 148 | big = 1; | ||
| 149 | goto EXPONENTIAL; | ||
| 150 | } | ||
| 151 | } else { | ||
| 152 | EXPONENTIAL: for (i = size; ; i <<= 1) | ||
| 153 | if ((p = (b + i)) >= t) { | ||
| 154 | if ((p = t - size) > b && | ||
| 155 | (*cmp)(q, p) <= sense) | ||
| 156 | t = p; | ||
| 157 | else | ||
| 158 | b = p; | ||
| 159 | break; | ||
| 160 | } else if ((*cmp)(q, p) <= sense) { | ||
| 161 | t = p; | ||
| 162 | if (i == size) | ||
| 163 | big = 0; | ||
| 164 | goto FASTCASE; | ||
| 165 | } else | ||
| 166 | b = p; | ||
| 167 | while (t > b+size) { | ||
| 168 | i = (((t - b) / size) >> 1) * size; | ||
| 169 | if ((*cmp)(q, p = b + i) <= sense) | ||
| 170 | t = p; | ||
| 171 | else | ||
| 172 | b = p; | ||
| 173 | } | ||
| 174 | goto COPY; | ||
| 175 | FASTCASE: while (i > size) | ||
| 176 | if ((*cmp)(q, | ||
| 177 | p = b + (i >>= 1)) <= sense) | ||
| 178 | t = p; | ||
| 179 | else | ||
| 180 | b = p; | ||
| 181 | COPY: b = t; | ||
| 182 | } | ||
| 183 | i = size; | ||
| 184 | if (q == f1) { | ||
| 185 | if (iflag) { | ||
| 186 | ICOPY_LIST(f2, tp2, b); | ||
| 187 | ICOPY_ELT(f1, tp2, i); | ||
| 188 | } else { | ||
| 189 | CCOPY_LIST(f2, tp2, b); | ||
| 190 | CCOPY_ELT(f1, tp2, i); | ||
| 191 | } | ||
| 192 | } else { | ||
| 193 | if (iflag) { | ||
| 194 | ICOPY_LIST(f1, tp2, b); | ||
| 195 | ICOPY_ELT(f2, tp2, i); | ||
| 196 | } else { | ||
| 197 | CCOPY_LIST(f1, tp2, b); | ||
| 198 | CCOPY_ELT(f2, tp2, i); | ||
| 199 | } | ||
| 200 | } | ||
| 201 | } | ||
| 202 | if (f2 < l2) { | ||
| 203 | if (iflag) | ||
| 204 | ICOPY_LIST(f2, tp2, l2); | ||
| 205 | else | ||
| 206 | CCOPY_LIST(f2, tp2, l2); | ||
| 207 | } else if (f1 < l1) { | ||
| 208 | if (iflag) | ||
| 209 | ICOPY_LIST(f1, tp2, l1); | ||
| 210 | else | ||
| 211 | CCOPY_LIST(f1, tp2, l1); | ||
| 212 | } | ||
| 213 | *p1 = l2; | ||
| 214 | } | ||
| 215 | tp2 = list1; /* swap list1, list2 */ | ||
| 216 | list1 = list2; | ||
| 217 | list2 = tp2; | ||
| 218 | last = list2 + nmemb*size; | ||
| 219 | } | ||
| 220 | if (base == list2) { | ||
| 221 | memmove(list2, list1, nmemb*size); | ||
| 222 | list2 = list1; | ||
| 223 | } | ||
| 224 | free(list2); | ||
| 225 | return (0); | ||
| 226 | } | ||
| 227 | |||
| 228 | #define swap(a, b) { \ | ||
| 229 | s = b; \ | ||
| 230 | i = size; \ | ||
| 231 | do { \ | ||
| 232 | tmp = *a; *a++ = *s; *s++ = tmp; \ | ||
| 233 | } while (--i); \ | ||
| 234 | a -= size; \ | ||
| 235 | } | ||
| 236 | #define reverse(bot, top) { \ | ||
| 237 | s = top; \ | ||
| 238 | do { \ | ||
| 239 | i = size; \ | ||
| 240 | do { \ | ||
| 241 | tmp = *bot; *bot++ = *s; *s++ = tmp; \ | ||
| 242 | } while (--i); \ | ||
| 243 | s -= size2; \ | ||
| 244 | } while(bot < s); \ | ||
| 245 | } | ||
| 246 | |||
| 247 | /* | ||
| 248 | * Optional hybrid natural/pairwise first pass. Eats up list1 in runs of | ||
| 249 | * increasing order, list2 in a corresponding linked list. Checks for runs | ||
| 250 | * when THRESHOLD/2 pairs compare with same sense. (Only used when NATURAL | ||
| 251 | * is defined. Otherwise simple pairwise merging is used.) | ||
| 252 | */ | ||
| 253 | void | ||
| 254 | setup(list1, list2, n, size, cmp) | ||
| 255 | size_t n, size; | ||
| 256 | int (*cmp)(const void *, const void *); | ||
| 257 | u_char *list1, *list2; | ||
| 258 | { | ||
| 259 | int i, length, size2, tmp, sense; | ||
| 260 | u_char *f1, *f2, *s, *l2, *last, *p2; | ||
| 261 | |||
| 262 | size2 = size*2; | ||
| 263 | if (n <= 5) { | ||
| 264 | insertionsort(list1, n, size, cmp); | ||
| 265 | *EVAL(list2) = (u_char*) list2 + n*size; | ||
| 266 | return; | ||
| 267 | } | ||
| 268 | /* | ||
| 269 | * Avoid running pointers out of bounds; limit n to evens | ||
| 270 | * for simplicity. | ||
| 271 | */ | ||
| 272 | i = 4 + (n & 1); | ||
| 273 | insertionsort(list1 + (n - i) * size, i, size, cmp); | ||
| 274 | last = list1 + size * (n - i); | ||
| 275 | *EVAL(list2 + (last - list1)) = list2 + n * size; | ||
| 276 | |||
| 277 | #ifdef NATURAL | ||
| 278 | p2 = list2; | ||
| 279 | f1 = list1; | ||
| 280 | sense = (cmp(f1, f1 + size) > 0); | ||
| 281 | for (; f1 < last; sense = !sense) { | ||
| 282 | length = 2; | ||
| 283 | /* Find pairs with same sense. */ | ||
| 284 | for (f2 = f1 + size2; f2 < last; f2 += size2) { | ||
| 285 | if ((cmp(f2, f2+ size) > 0) != sense) | ||
| 286 | break; | ||
| 287 | length += 2; | ||
| 288 | } | ||
| 289 | if (length < THRESHOLD) { /* Pairwise merge */ | ||
| 290 | do { | ||
| 291 | p2 = *EVAL(p2) = f1 + size2 - list1 + list2; | ||
| 292 | if (sense > 0) | ||
| 293 | swap (f1, f1 + size); | ||
| 294 | } while ((f1 += size2) < f2); | ||
| 295 | } else { /* Natural merge */ | ||
| 296 | l2 = f2; | ||
| 297 | for (f2 = f1 + size2; f2 < l2; f2 += size2) { | ||
| 298 | if ((cmp(f2-size, f2) > 0) != sense) { | ||
| 299 | p2 = *EVAL(p2) = f2 - list1 + list2; | ||
| 300 | if (sense > 0) | ||
| 301 | reverse(f1, f2-size); | ||
| 302 | f1 = f2; | ||
| 303 | } | ||
| 304 | } | ||
| 305 | if (sense > 0) | ||
| 306 | reverse (f1, f2-size); | ||
| 307 | f1 = f2; | ||
| 308 | if (f2 < last || cmp(f2 - size, f2) > 0) | ||
| 309 | p2 = *EVAL(p2) = f2 - list1 + list2; | ||
| 310 | else | ||
| 311 | p2 = *EVAL(p2) = list2 + n*size; | ||
| 312 | } | ||
| 313 | } | ||
| 314 | #else /* pairwise merge only. */ | ||
| 315 | for (f1 = list1, p2 = list2; f1 < last; f1 += size2) { | ||
| 316 | p2 = *EVAL(p2) = p2 + size2; | ||
| 317 | if (cmp (f1, f1 + size) > 0) | ||
| 318 | swap(f1, f1 + size); | ||
| 319 | } | ||
| 320 | #endif /* NATURAL */ | ||
| 321 | } | ||
| 322 | |||
| 323 | /* | ||
| 324 | * This is to avoid out-of-bounds addresses in sorting the | ||
| 325 | * last 4 elements. | ||
| 326 | */ | ||
| 327 | static void | ||
| 328 | insertionsort(a, n, size, cmp) | ||
| 329 | u_char *a; | ||
| 330 | size_t n, size; | ||
| 331 | int (*cmp)(const void *, const void *); | ||
| 332 | { | ||
| 333 | u_char *ai, *s, *t, *u, tmp; | ||
| 334 | int i; | ||
| 335 | |||
| 336 | for (ai = a+size; --n >= 1; ai += size) | ||
| 337 | for (t = ai; t > a; t -= size) { | ||
| 338 | u = t - size; | ||
| 339 | if (cmp(u, t) <= 0) | ||
| 340 | break; | ||
| 341 | swap(u, t); | ||
| 342 | } | ||
| 343 | } | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/mrand48.c b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/mrand48.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..cd34260b5c --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/mrand48.c | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,27 @@ | |||
| 1 | /* | ||
| 2 | * Copyright (c) 1993 Martin Birgmeier | ||
| 3 | * All rights reserved. | ||
| 4 | * | ||
| 5 | * You may redistribute unmodified or modified versions of this source | ||
| 6 | * code provided that the above copyright notice and this and the | ||
| 7 | * following conditions are retained. | ||
| 8 | * | ||
| 9 | * This software is provided ``as is'', and comes with no warranties | ||
| 10 | * of any kind. I shall in no event be liable for anything that happens | ||
| 11 | * to anyone/anything when using this software. | ||
| 12 | */ | ||
| 13 | |||
| 14 | #if defined(LIBC_SCCS) && !defined(lint) | ||
| 15 | static char rcsid[] = "$OpenBSD: mrand48.c,v 1.2 1996/08/19 08:33:39 tholo Exp $"; | ||
| 16 | #endif /* LIBC_SCCS and not lint */ | ||
| 17 | |||
| 18 | #include "rand48.h" | ||
| 19 | |||
| 20 | extern unsigned short __rand48_seed[3]; | ||
| 21 | |||
| 22 | long | ||
| 23 | mrand48(void) | ||
| 24 | { | ||
| 25 | __dorand48(__rand48_seed); | ||
| 26 | return ((long) __rand48_seed[2] << 16) + (long) __rand48_seed[1]; | ||
| 27 | } | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/multibyte.c b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/multibyte.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..ba878b8fdc --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/multibyte.c | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,120 @@ | |||
| 1 | /* | ||
| 2 | * Copyright (c) 1991 The Regents of the University of California. | ||
| 3 | * All rights reserved. | ||
| 4 | * | ||
| 5 | * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without | ||
| 6 | * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions | ||
| 7 | * are met: | ||
| 8 | * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright | ||
| 9 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. | ||
| 10 | * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright | ||
| 11 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the | ||
| 12 | * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. | ||
| 13 | * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors | ||
| 14 | * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software | ||
| 15 | * without specific prior written permission. | ||
| 16 | * | ||
| 17 | * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND | ||
| 18 | * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE | ||
| 19 | * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE | ||
| 20 | * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE | ||
| 21 | * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL | ||
| 22 | * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS | ||
| 23 | * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) | ||
| 24 | * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT | ||
| 25 | * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY | ||
| 26 | * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF | ||
| 27 | * SUCH DAMAGE. | ||
| 28 | */ | ||
| 29 | |||
| 30 | #if defined(LIBC_SCCS) && !defined(lint) | ||
| 31 | static char *rcsid = "$OpenBSD: multibyte.c,v 1.4 2003/06/02 20:18:38 millert Exp $"; | ||
| 32 | #endif /* LIBC_SCCS and not lint */ | ||
| 33 | |||
| 34 | #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 35 | |||
| 36 | /* | ||
| 37 | * Stub multibyte character functions. | ||
| 38 | * This cheezy implementation is fixed to the native single-byte | ||
| 39 | * character set. | ||
| 40 | */ | ||
| 41 | |||
| 42 | int | ||
| 43 | mblen(s, n) | ||
| 44 | const char *s; | ||
| 45 | size_t n; | ||
| 46 | { | ||
| 47 | if (s == NULL || *s == '\0') | ||
| 48 | return 0; | ||
| 49 | if (n == 0) | ||
| 50 | return -1; | ||
| 51 | return 1; | ||
| 52 | } | ||
| 53 | |||
| 54 | /*ARGSUSED*/ | ||
| 55 | int | ||
| 56 | mbtowc(pwc, s, n) | ||
| 57 | wchar_t *pwc; | ||
| 58 | const char *s; | ||
| 59 | size_t n; | ||
| 60 | { | ||
| 61 | if (s == NULL) | ||
| 62 | return 0; | ||
| 63 | if (n == 0) | ||
| 64 | return -1; | ||
| 65 | if (pwc) | ||
| 66 | *pwc = (wchar_t) *s; | ||
| 67 | return (*s != '\0'); | ||
| 68 | } | ||
| 69 | |||
| 70 | /*ARGSUSED*/ | ||
| 71 | int | ||
| 72 | wctomb(char *s, wchar_t wchar) | ||
| 73 | { | ||
| 74 | if (s == NULL) | ||
| 75 | return 0; | ||
| 76 | |||
| 77 | *s = (char) wchar; | ||
| 78 | return 1; | ||
| 79 | } | ||
| 80 | |||
| 81 | /*ARGSUSED*/ | ||
| 82 | size_t | ||
| 83 | mbstowcs(pwcs, s, n) | ||
| 84 | wchar_t *pwcs; | ||
| 85 | const char *s; | ||
| 86 | size_t n; | ||
| 87 | { | ||
| 88 | int count = 0; | ||
| 89 | |||
| 90 | if (n != 0) { | ||
| 91 | do { | ||
| 92 | if ((*pwcs++ = (wchar_t) *s++) == 0) | ||
| 93 | break; | ||
| 94 | count++; | ||
| 95 | } while (--n != 0); | ||
| 96 | } | ||
| 97 | |||
| 98 | return count; | ||
| 99 | } | ||
| 100 | |||
| 101 | /*ARGSUSED*/ | ||
| 102 | size_t | ||
| 103 | wcstombs(s, pwcs, n) | ||
| 104 | char *s; | ||
| 105 | const wchar_t *pwcs; | ||
| 106 | size_t n; | ||
| 107 | { | ||
| 108 | int count = 0; | ||
| 109 | |||
| 110 | if (n != 0) { | ||
| 111 | do { | ||
| 112 | if ((*s++ = (char) *pwcs++) == 0) | ||
| 113 | break; | ||
| 114 | count++; | ||
| 115 | } while (--n != 0); | ||
| 116 | } | ||
| 117 | |||
| 118 | return count; | ||
| 119 | } | ||
| 120 | |||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/nrand48.c b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/nrand48.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b1ec2cebb1 --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/nrand48.c | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,25 @@ | |||
| 1 | /* | ||
| 2 | * Copyright (c) 1993 Martin Birgmeier | ||
| 3 | * All rights reserved. | ||
| 4 | * | ||
| 5 | * You may redistribute unmodified or modified versions of this source | ||
| 6 | * code provided that the above copyright notice and this and the | ||
| 7 | * following conditions are retained. | ||
| 8 | * | ||
| 9 | * This software is provided ``as is'', and comes with no warranties | ||
| 10 | * of any kind. I shall in no event be liable for anything that happens | ||
| 11 | * to anyone/anything when using this software. | ||
| 12 | */ | ||
| 13 | |||
| 14 | #if defined(LIBC_SCCS) && !defined(lint) | ||
| 15 | static char rcsid[] = "$OpenBSD: nrand48.c,v 1.2 1996/08/19 08:33:40 tholo Exp $"; | ||
| 16 | #endif /* LIBC_SCCS and not lint */ | ||
| 17 | |||
| 18 | #include "rand48.h" | ||
| 19 | |||
| 20 | long | ||
| 21 | nrand48(unsigned short xseed[3]) | ||
| 22 | { | ||
| 23 | __dorand48(xseed); | ||
| 24 | return ((long) xseed[2] << 15) + ((long) xseed[1] >> 1); | ||
| 25 | } | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/putenv.c b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/putenv.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..1789e686ef --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/putenv.c | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,54 @@ | |||
| 1 | /*- | ||
| 2 | * Copyright (c) 1988, 1993 | ||
| 3 | * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved. | ||
| 4 | * | ||
| 5 | * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without | ||
| 6 | * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions | ||
| 7 | * are met: | ||
| 8 | * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright | ||
| 9 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. | ||
| 10 | * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright | ||
| 11 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the | ||
| 12 | * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. | ||
| 13 | * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors | ||
| 14 | * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software | ||
| 15 | * without specific prior written permission. | ||
| 16 | * | ||
| 17 | * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND | ||
| 18 | * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE | ||
| 19 | * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE | ||
| 20 | * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE | ||
| 21 | * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL | ||
| 22 | * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS | ||
| 23 | * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) | ||
| 24 | * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT | ||
| 25 | * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY | ||
| 26 | * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF | ||
| 27 | * SUCH DAMAGE. | ||
| 28 | */ | ||
| 29 | |||
| 30 | #if defined(LIBC_SCCS) && !defined(lint) | ||
| 31 | static char *rcsid = "$OpenBSD: putenv.c,v 1.3 2003/06/02 20:18:38 millert Exp $"; | ||
| 32 | #endif /* LIBC_SCCS and not lint */ | ||
| 33 | |||
| 34 | #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 35 | #include <string.h> | ||
| 36 | |||
| 37 | int | ||
| 38 | putenv(str) | ||
| 39 | const char *str; | ||
| 40 | { | ||
| 41 | char *p, *equal; | ||
| 42 | int rval; | ||
| 43 | |||
| 44 | if ((p = strdup(str)) == NULL) | ||
| 45 | return (-1); | ||
| 46 | if ((equal = strchr(p, '=')) == NULL) { | ||
| 47 | (void)free(p); | ||
| 48 | return (-1); | ||
| 49 | } | ||
| 50 | *equal = '\0'; | ||
| 51 | rval = setenv(p, equal + 1, 1); | ||
| 52 | (void)free(p); | ||
| 53 | return (rval); | ||
| 54 | } | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/qabs.3 b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/qabs.3 new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..093212edf5 --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/qabs.3 | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,56 @@ | |||
| 1 | .\" Copyright (c) 1990, 1991 The Regents of the University of California. | ||
| 2 | .\" All rights reserved. | ||
| 3 | .\" | ||
| 4 | .\" This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by | ||
| 5 | .\" the American National Standards Committee X3, on Information | ||
| 6 | .\" Processing Systems. | ||
| 7 | .\" | ||
| 8 | .\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without | ||
| 9 | .\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions | ||
| 10 | .\" are met: | ||
| 11 | .\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright | ||
| 12 | .\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. | ||
| 13 | .\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright | ||
| 14 | .\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the | ||
| 15 | .\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. | ||
| 16 | .\" 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors | ||
| 17 | .\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software | ||
| 18 | .\" without specific prior written permission. | ||
| 19 | .\" | ||
| 20 | .\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND | ||
| 21 | .\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE | ||
| 22 | .\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE | ||
| 23 | .\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE | ||
| 24 | .\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL | ||
| 25 | .\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS | ||
| 26 | .\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) | ||
| 27 | .\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT | ||
| 28 | .\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY | ||
| 29 | .\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF | ||
| 30 | .\" SUCH DAMAGE. | ||
| 31 | .\" | ||
| 32 | .\" $OpenBSD: qabs.3,v 1.6 2003/06/02 20:18:38 millert Exp $ | ||
| 33 | .\" | ||
| 34 | .Dd June 29, 1991 | ||
| 35 | .Dt QABS 3 | ||
| 36 | .Os | ||
| 37 | .Sh NAME | ||
| 38 | .Nm qabs | ||
| 39 | .Nd return the absolute value of a quad integer | ||
| 40 | .Sh SYNOPSIS | ||
| 41 | .Fd #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 42 | .Ft quad_t | ||
| 43 | .Fn qabs "quad_t j" | ||
| 44 | .Sh DESCRIPTION | ||
| 45 | The | ||
| 46 | .Fn qabs | ||
| 47 | function returns the absolute value of the quad integer | ||
| 48 | .Fa j . | ||
| 49 | .Sh SEE ALSO | ||
| 50 | .Xr abs 3 , | ||
| 51 | .Xr cabs 3 , | ||
| 52 | .Xr floor 3 , | ||
| 53 | .Xr labs 3 , | ||
| 54 | .Xr math 3 | ||
| 55 | .Sh BUGS | ||
| 56 | The absolute value of the most negative integer remains negative. | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/qabs.c b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/qabs.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..296d2d4742 --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/qabs.c | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,41 @@ | |||
| 1 | /*- | ||
| 2 | * Copyright (c) 1990 The Regents of the University of California. | ||
| 3 | * All rights reserved. | ||
| 4 | * | ||
| 5 | * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without | ||
| 6 | * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions | ||
| 7 | * are met: | ||
| 8 | * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright | ||
| 9 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. | ||
| 10 | * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright | ||
| 11 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the | ||
| 12 | * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. | ||
| 13 | * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors | ||
| 14 | * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software | ||
| 15 | * without specific prior written permission. | ||
| 16 | * | ||
| 17 | * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND | ||
| 18 | * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE | ||
| 19 | * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE | ||
| 20 | * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE | ||
| 21 | * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL | ||
| 22 | * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS | ||
| 23 | * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) | ||
| 24 | * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT | ||
| 25 | * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY | ||
| 26 | * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF | ||
| 27 | * SUCH DAMAGE. | ||
| 28 | */ | ||
| 29 | |||
| 30 | #if defined(LIBC_SCCS) && !defined(lint) | ||
| 31 | static char *rcsid = "$OpenBSD: qabs.c,v 1.3 2003/06/02 20:18:38 millert Exp $"; | ||
| 32 | #endif /* LIBC_SCCS and not lint */ | ||
| 33 | |||
| 34 | #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 35 | |||
| 36 | quad_t | ||
| 37 | qabs(j) | ||
| 38 | quad_t j; | ||
| 39 | { | ||
| 40 | return(j < 0 ? -j : j); | ||
| 41 | } | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/qdiv.3 b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/qdiv.3 new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..5f17ec17d4 --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/qdiv.3 | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,60 @@ | |||
| 1 | .\" Copyright (c) 1990, 1991 The Regents of the University of California. | ||
| 2 | .\" All rights reserved. | ||
| 3 | .\" | ||
| 4 | .\" This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by | ||
| 5 | .\" Chris Torek and the American National Standards Committee X3, | ||
| 6 | .\" on Information Processing Systems. | ||
| 7 | .\" | ||
| 8 | .\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without | ||
| 9 | .\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions | ||
| 10 | .\" are met: | ||
| 11 | .\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright | ||
| 12 | .\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. | ||
| 13 | .\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright | ||
| 14 | .\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the | ||
| 15 | .\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. | ||
| 16 | .\" 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors | ||
| 17 | .\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software | ||
| 18 | .\" without specific prior written permission. | ||
| 19 | .\" | ||
| 20 | .\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND | ||
| 21 | .\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE | ||
| 22 | .\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE | ||
| 23 | .\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE | ||
| 24 | .\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL | ||
| 25 | .\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS | ||
| 26 | .\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) | ||
| 27 | .\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT | ||
| 28 | .\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY | ||
| 29 | .\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF | ||
| 30 | .\" SUCH DAMAGE. | ||
| 31 | .\" | ||
| 32 | .\" $OpenBSD: qdiv.3,v 1.6 2004/01/23 23:08:46 jmc Exp $ | ||
| 33 | .\" | ||
| 34 | .Dd June 29, 1991 | ||
| 35 | .Dt QDIV 3 | ||
| 36 | .Os | ||
| 37 | .Sh NAME | ||
| 38 | .Nm qdiv | ||
| 39 | .Nd return quotient and remainder from division | ||
| 40 | .Sh SYNOPSIS | ||
| 41 | .Fd #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 42 | .Ft qdiv_t | ||
| 43 | .Fn qdiv "quad_t num" "quad_t denom" | ||
| 44 | .Sh DESCRIPTION | ||
| 45 | The | ||
| 46 | .Fn qdiv | ||
| 47 | function computes the value | ||
| 48 | .Fa num Ns / Ns Fa denom | ||
| 49 | and returns the quotient and remainder in a structure named | ||
| 50 | .Li qdiv_t | ||
| 51 | that contains two | ||
| 52 | .Li quad integer | ||
| 53 | members named | ||
| 54 | .Fa quot | ||
| 55 | and | ||
| 56 | .Fa rem . | ||
| 57 | .Sh SEE ALSO | ||
| 58 | .Xr div 3 , | ||
| 59 | .Xr ldiv 3 , | ||
| 60 | .Xr math 3 | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/qdiv.c b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/qdiv.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..6688ccb712 --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/qdiv.c | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,54 @@ | |||
| 1 | /* | ||
| 2 | * Copyright (c) 1990 Regents of the University of California. | ||
| 3 | * All rights reserved. | ||
| 4 | * | ||
| 5 | * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by | ||
| 6 | * Chris Torek. | ||
| 7 | * | ||
| 8 | * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without | ||
| 9 | * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions | ||
| 10 | * are met: | ||
| 11 | * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright | ||
| 12 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. | ||
| 13 | * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright | ||
| 14 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the | ||
| 15 | * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. | ||
| 16 | * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors | ||
| 17 | * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software | ||
| 18 | * without specific prior written permission. | ||
| 19 | * | ||
| 20 | * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND | ||
| 21 | * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE | ||
| 22 | * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE | ||
| 23 | * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE | ||
| 24 | * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL | ||
| 25 | * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS | ||
| 26 | * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) | ||
| 27 | * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT | ||
| 28 | * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY | ||
| 29 | * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF | ||
| 30 | * SUCH DAMAGE. | ||
| 31 | */ | ||
| 32 | |||
| 33 | #if defined(LIBC_SCCS) && !defined(lint) | ||
| 34 | static char *rcsid = "$OpenBSD: qdiv.c,v 1.3 2003/06/02 20:18:38 millert Exp $"; | ||
| 35 | #endif /* LIBC_SCCS and not lint */ | ||
| 36 | |||
| 37 | #include <stdlib.h> /* qdiv_t */ | ||
| 38 | |||
| 39 | qdiv_t | ||
| 40 | qdiv(num, denom) | ||
| 41 | quad_t num, denom; | ||
| 42 | { | ||
| 43 | qdiv_t r; | ||
| 44 | |||
| 45 | /* see div.c for comments */ | ||
| 46 | |||
| 47 | r.quot = num / denom; | ||
| 48 | r.rem = num % denom; | ||
| 49 | if (num >= 0 && r.rem < 0) { | ||
| 50 | r.quot++; | ||
| 51 | r.rem -= denom; | ||
| 52 | } | ||
| 53 | return (r); | ||
| 54 | } | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/qsort.3 b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/qsort.3 new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..668ea90243 --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/qsort.3 | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,233 @@ | |||
| 1 | .\" Copyright (c) 1990, 1991, 1993 | ||
| 2 | .\" The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved. | ||
| 3 | .\" | ||
| 4 | .\" This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by | ||
| 5 | .\" the American National Standards Committee X3, on Information | ||
| 6 | .\" Processing Systems. | ||
| 7 | .\" | ||
| 8 | .\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without | ||
| 9 | .\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions | ||
| 10 | .\" are met: | ||
| 11 | .\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright | ||
| 12 | .\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. | ||
| 13 | .\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright | ||
| 14 | .\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the | ||
| 15 | .\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. | ||
| 16 | .\" 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors | ||
| 17 | .\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software | ||
| 18 | .\" without specific prior written permission. | ||
| 19 | .\" | ||
| 20 | .\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND | ||
| 21 | .\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE | ||
| 22 | .\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE | ||
| 23 | .\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE | ||
| 24 | .\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL | ||
| 25 | .\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS | ||
| 26 | .\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) | ||
| 27 | .\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT | ||
| 28 | .\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY | ||
| 29 | .\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF | ||
| 30 | .\" SUCH DAMAGE. | ||
| 31 | .\" | ||
| 32 | .\" $OpenBSD: qsort.3,v 1.14 2003/10/01 08:11:58 jmc Exp $ | ||
| 33 | .\" | ||
| 34 | .Dd June 4, 1993 | ||
| 35 | .Dt QSORT 3 | ||
| 36 | .Os | ||
| 37 | .Sh NAME | ||
| 38 | .Nm qsort , | ||
| 39 | .Nm heapsort , | ||
| 40 | .Nm mergesort | ||
| 41 | .Nd sort functions | ||
| 42 | .Sh SYNOPSIS | ||
| 43 | .Fd #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 44 | .Ft void | ||
| 45 | .Fn qsort "void *base" "size_t nmemb" "size_t size" "int (*compar)(const void *, const void *)" | ||
| 46 | .Ft int | ||
| 47 | .Fn heapsort "void *base" "size_t nmemb" "size_t size" "int (*compar)(const void *, const void *)" | ||
| 48 | .Ft int | ||
| 49 | .Fn mergesort "void *base" "size_t nmemb" "size_t size" "int (*compar)(const void *, const void *)" | ||
| 50 | .Sh DESCRIPTION | ||
| 51 | The | ||
| 52 | .Fn qsort | ||
| 53 | function is a modified partition-exchange sort, or quicksort. | ||
| 54 | The | ||
| 55 | .Fn heapsort | ||
| 56 | function is a modified selection sort. | ||
| 57 | The | ||
| 58 | .Fn mergesort | ||
| 59 | function is a modified merge sort with exponential search | ||
| 60 | intended for sorting data with pre-existing order. | ||
| 61 | .Pp | ||
| 62 | The | ||
| 63 | .Fn qsort | ||
| 64 | and | ||
| 65 | .Fn heapsort | ||
| 66 | functions sort an array of | ||
| 67 | .Fa nmemb | ||
| 68 | objects, the initial member of which is pointed to by | ||
| 69 | .Fa base . | ||
| 70 | The size of each object is specified by | ||
| 71 | .Fa size . | ||
| 72 | .Fn mergesort | ||
| 73 | behaves similarly, but | ||
| 74 | .Em requires | ||
| 75 | that | ||
| 76 | .Fa size | ||
| 77 | be greater than | ||
| 78 | .Dq "sizeof(void *) / 2" . | ||
| 79 | .Pp | ||
| 80 | The contents of the array | ||
| 81 | .Fa base | ||
| 82 | are sorted in ascending order according to | ||
| 83 | a comparison function pointed to by | ||
| 84 | .Fa compar , | ||
| 85 | which requires two arguments pointing to the objects being | ||
| 86 | compared. | ||
| 87 | .Pp | ||
| 88 | The comparison function must return an integer less than, equal to, or | ||
| 89 | greater than zero if the first argument is considered to be respectively | ||
| 90 | less than, equal to, or greater than the second. | ||
| 91 | .Pp | ||
| 92 | The functions | ||
| 93 | .Fn qsort | ||
| 94 | and | ||
| 95 | .Fn heapsort | ||
| 96 | are | ||
| 97 | .Em not | ||
| 98 | stable, that is, if two members compare as equal, their order in | ||
| 99 | the sorted array is undefined. | ||
| 100 | The function | ||
| 101 | .Fn mergesort | ||
| 102 | is stable. | ||
| 103 | .Pp | ||
| 104 | The | ||
| 105 | .Fn qsort | ||
| 106 | function is an implementation of C.A.R. Hoare's | ||
| 107 | .Dq quicksort | ||
| 108 | algorithm, | ||
| 109 | a variant of partition-exchange sorting; in particular, see D.E. Knuth's | ||
| 110 | Algorithm Q. | ||
| 111 | .Fn qsort | ||
| 112 | takes O N lg N average time. | ||
| 113 | This implementation uses median selection to avoid its | ||
| 114 | O N**2 worst-case behavior. | ||
| 115 | .Pp | ||
| 116 | The | ||
| 117 | .Fn heapsort | ||
| 118 | function is an implementation of J.W.J. William's | ||
| 119 | .Dq heapsort | ||
| 120 | algorithm, | ||
| 121 | a variant of selection sorting; in particular, see D.E. Knuth's Algorithm H. | ||
| 122 | .Fn heapsort | ||
| 123 | takes O N lg N worst-case time. | ||
| 124 | This implementation of | ||
| 125 | .Fn heapsort | ||
| 126 | is implemented without recursive function calls. | ||
| 127 | .Pp | ||
| 128 | The function | ||
| 129 | .Fn mergesort | ||
| 130 | requires additional memory of size | ||
| 131 | .Fa nmemb * | ||
| 132 | .Fa size | ||
| 133 | bytes; it should be used only when space is not at a premium. | ||
| 134 | .Fn mergesort | ||
| 135 | is optimized for data with pre-existing order; its worst case | ||
| 136 | time is O N lg N; its best case is O N. | ||
| 137 | .Pp | ||
| 138 | Normally, | ||
| 139 | .Fn qsort | ||
| 140 | is faster than | ||
| 141 | .Fn mergesort , | ||
| 142 | which is faster than | ||
| 143 | .Fn heapsort . | ||
| 144 | Memory availability and pre-existing order in the data can make this untrue. | ||
| 145 | .Sh RETURN VALUES | ||
| 146 | The | ||
| 147 | .Fn qsort | ||
| 148 | function returns no value. | ||
| 149 | .Pp | ||
| 150 | Upon successful completion, | ||
| 151 | .Fn heapsort | ||
| 152 | and | ||
| 153 | .Fn mergesort | ||
| 154 | return 0. | ||
| 155 | Otherwise, they return \-1 and the global variable | ||
| 156 | .Va errno | ||
| 157 | is set to indicate the error. | ||
| 158 | .Sh ERRORS | ||
| 159 | The | ||
| 160 | .Fn heapsort | ||
| 161 | and | ||
| 162 | .Fn mergesort | ||
| 163 | functions succeed unless: | ||
| 164 | .Bl -tag -width Er | ||
| 165 | .It Bq Er EINVAL | ||
| 166 | The | ||
| 167 | .Fa size | ||
| 168 | argument is zero, or the | ||
| 169 | .Fa size | ||
| 170 | argument to | ||
| 171 | .Fn mergesort | ||
| 172 | is less than | ||
| 173 | .Dq "sizeof(void *) / 2" . | ||
| 174 | .It Bq Er ENOMEM | ||
| 175 | .Fn heapsort | ||
| 176 | or | ||
| 177 | .Fn mergesort | ||
| 178 | were unable to allocate memory. | ||
| 179 | .El | ||
| 180 | .Sh SEE ALSO | ||
| 181 | .Xr sort 1 , | ||
| 182 | .Xr radixsort 3 | ||
| 183 | .Rs | ||
| 184 | .%A Hoare, C.A.R. | ||
| 185 | .%D 1962 | ||
| 186 | .%T "Quicksort" | ||
| 187 | .%J "The Computer Journal" | ||
| 188 | .%V 5:1 | ||
| 189 | .%P pp. 10-15 | ||
| 190 | .Re | ||
| 191 | .Rs | ||
| 192 | .%A Williams, J.W.J | ||
| 193 | .%D 1964 | ||
| 194 | .%T "Heapsort" | ||
| 195 | .%J "Communications of the ACM" | ||
| 196 | .%V 7:1 | ||
| 197 | .%P pp. 347\-348 | ||
| 198 | .Re | ||
| 199 | .Rs | ||
| 200 | .%A Knuth, D.E. | ||
| 201 | .%D 1968 | ||
| 202 | .%B "The Art of Computer Programming" | ||
| 203 | .%V Vol. 3 | ||
| 204 | .%T "Sorting and Searching" | ||
| 205 | .%P pp. 114\-123, 145\-149 | ||
| 206 | .Re | ||
| 207 | .Rs | ||
| 208 | .%A McIlroy, P.M. | ||
| 209 | .%T "Optimistic Sorting and Information Theoretic Complexity" | ||
| 210 | .%J "Fourth Annual ACM-SIAM Symposium on Discrete Algorithms" | ||
| 211 | .%P pp. 467\-464 | ||
| 212 | .%D January 1993 | ||
| 213 | .Re | ||
| 214 | .Rs | ||
| 215 | .%A Bentley, J.L. | ||
| 216 | .%A McIlroy, M.D. | ||
| 217 | .%T "Engineering a Sort Function" | ||
| 218 | .%J "Software \- Practice and Experience" | ||
| 219 | .%V Vol. 23(11) | ||
| 220 | .%P pp. 1249\-1265 | ||
| 221 | .%D November 1993 | ||
| 222 | .Re | ||
| 223 | .Sh STANDARDS | ||
| 224 | Previous versions of | ||
| 225 | .Fn qsort | ||
| 226 | did not permit the comparison routine itself to call | ||
| 227 | .Fn qsort . | ||
| 228 | This is no longer true. | ||
| 229 | .Pp | ||
| 230 | The | ||
| 231 | .Fn qsort | ||
| 232 | function conforms to | ||
| 233 | .St -ansiC . | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/qsort.c b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/qsort.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..2a972c0eb0 --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/qsort.c | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,171 @@ | |||
| 1 | /*- | ||
| 2 | * Copyright (c) 1992, 1993 | ||
| 3 | * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved. | ||
| 4 | * | ||
| 5 | * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without | ||
| 6 | * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions | ||
| 7 | * are met: | ||
| 8 | * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright | ||
| 9 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. | ||
| 10 | * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright | ||
| 11 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the | ||
| 12 | * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. | ||
| 13 | * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors | ||
| 14 | * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software | ||
| 15 | * without specific prior written permission. | ||
| 16 | * | ||
| 17 | * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND | ||
| 18 | * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE | ||
| 19 | * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE | ||
| 20 | * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE | ||
| 21 | * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL | ||
| 22 | * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS | ||
| 23 | * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) | ||
| 24 | * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT | ||
| 25 | * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY | ||
| 26 | * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF | ||
| 27 | * SUCH DAMAGE. | ||
| 28 | */ | ||
| 29 | |||
| 30 | #if defined(LIBC_SCCS) && !defined(lint) | ||
| 31 | static char *rcsid = "$OpenBSD: qsort.c,v 1.8 2003/06/02 20:18:38 millert Exp $"; | ||
| 32 | #endif /* LIBC_SCCS and not lint */ | ||
| 33 | |||
| 34 | #include <sys/types.h> | ||
| 35 | #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 36 | |||
| 37 | static __inline char *med3(char *, char *, char *, int (*)()); | ||
| 38 | static __inline void swapfunc(char *, char *, int, int); | ||
| 39 | |||
| 40 | #define min(a, b) (a) < (b) ? a : b | ||
| 41 | |||
| 42 | /* | ||
| 43 | * Qsort routine from Bentley & McIlroy's "Engineering a Sort Function". | ||
| 44 | */ | ||
| 45 | #define swapcode(TYPE, parmi, parmj, n) { \ | ||
| 46 | long i = (n) / sizeof (TYPE); \ | ||
| 47 | register TYPE *pi = (TYPE *) (parmi); \ | ||
| 48 | register TYPE *pj = (TYPE *) (parmj); \ | ||
| 49 | do { \ | ||
| 50 | register TYPE t = *pi; \ | ||
| 51 | *pi++ = *pj; \ | ||
| 52 | *pj++ = t; \ | ||
| 53 | } while (--i > 0); \ | ||
| 54 | } | ||
| 55 | |||
| 56 | #define SWAPINIT(a, es) swaptype = ((char *)a - (char *)0) % sizeof(long) || \ | ||
| 57 | es % sizeof(long) ? 2 : es == sizeof(long)? 0 : 1; | ||
| 58 | |||
| 59 | static __inline void | ||
| 60 | swapfunc(a, b, n, swaptype) | ||
| 61 | char *a, *b; | ||
| 62 | int n, swaptype; | ||
| 63 | { | ||
| 64 | if (swaptype <= 1) | ||
| 65 | swapcode(long, a, b, n) | ||
| 66 | else | ||
| 67 | swapcode(char, a, b, n) | ||
| 68 | } | ||
| 69 | |||
| 70 | #define swap(a, b) \ | ||
| 71 | if (swaptype == 0) { \ | ||
| 72 | long t = *(long *)(a); \ | ||
| 73 | *(long *)(a) = *(long *)(b); \ | ||
| 74 | *(long *)(b) = t; \ | ||
| 75 | } else \ | ||
| 76 | swapfunc(a, b, es, swaptype) | ||
| 77 | |||
| 78 | #define vecswap(a, b, n) if ((n) > 0) swapfunc(a, b, n, swaptype) | ||
| 79 | |||
| 80 | static __inline char * | ||
| 81 | med3(a, b, c, cmp) | ||
| 82 | char *a, *b, *c; | ||
| 83 | int (*cmp)(); | ||
| 84 | { | ||
| 85 | return cmp(a, b) < 0 ? | ||
| 86 | (cmp(b, c) < 0 ? b : (cmp(a, c) < 0 ? c : a )) | ||
| 87 | :(cmp(b, c) > 0 ? b : (cmp(a, c) < 0 ? a : c )); | ||
| 88 | } | ||
| 89 | |||
| 90 | void | ||
| 91 | qsort(aa, n, es, cmp) | ||
| 92 | void *aa; | ||
| 93 | size_t n, es; | ||
| 94 | int (*cmp)(); | ||
| 95 | { | ||
| 96 | char *pa, *pb, *pc, *pd, *pl, *pm, *pn; | ||
| 97 | int d, r, swaptype, swap_cnt; | ||
| 98 | register char *a = aa; | ||
| 99 | |||
| 100 | loop: SWAPINIT(a, es); | ||
| 101 | swap_cnt = 0; | ||
| 102 | if (n < 7) { | ||
| 103 | for (pm = (char *)a + es; pm < (char *) a + n * es; pm += es) | ||
| 104 | for (pl = pm; pl > (char *) a && cmp(pl - es, pl) > 0; | ||
| 105 | pl -= es) | ||
| 106 | swap(pl, pl - es); | ||
| 107 | return; | ||
| 108 | } | ||
| 109 | pm = (char *)a + (n / 2) * es; | ||
| 110 | if (n > 7) { | ||
| 111 | pl = (char *)a; | ||
| 112 | pn = (char *)a + (n - 1) * es; | ||
| 113 | if (n > 40) { | ||
| 114 | d = (n / 8) * es; | ||
| 115 | pl = med3(pl, pl + d, pl + 2 * d, cmp); | ||
| 116 | pm = med3(pm - d, pm, pm + d, cmp); | ||
| 117 | pn = med3(pn - 2 * d, pn - d, pn, cmp); | ||
| 118 | } | ||
| 119 | pm = med3(pl, pm, pn, cmp); | ||
| 120 | } | ||
| 121 | swap(a, pm); | ||
| 122 | pa = pb = (char *)a + es; | ||
| 123 | |||
| 124 | pc = pd = (char *)a + (n - 1) * es; | ||
| 125 | for (;;) { | ||
| 126 | while (pb <= pc && (r = cmp(pb, a)) <= 0) { | ||
| 127 | if (r == 0) { | ||
| 128 | swap_cnt = 1; | ||
| 129 | swap(pa, pb); | ||
| 130 | pa += es; | ||
| 131 | } | ||
| 132 | pb += es; | ||
| 133 | } | ||
| 134 | while (pb <= pc && (r = cmp(pc, a)) >= 0) { | ||
| 135 | if (r == 0) { | ||
| 136 | swap_cnt = 1; | ||
| 137 | swap(pc, pd); | ||
| 138 | pd -= es; | ||
| 139 | } | ||
| 140 | pc -= es; | ||
| 141 | } | ||
| 142 | if (pb > pc) | ||
| 143 | break; | ||
| 144 | swap(pb, pc); | ||
| 145 | swap_cnt = 1; | ||
| 146 | pb += es; | ||
| 147 | pc -= es; | ||
| 148 | } | ||
| 149 | if (swap_cnt == 0) { /* Switch to insertion sort */ | ||
| 150 | for (pm = (char *) a + es; pm < (char *) a + n * es; pm += es) | ||
| 151 | for (pl = pm; pl > (char *) a && cmp(pl - es, pl) > 0; | ||
| 152 | pl -= es) | ||
| 153 | swap(pl, pl - es); | ||
| 154 | return; | ||
| 155 | } | ||
| 156 | |||
| 157 | pn = (char *)a + n * es; | ||
| 158 | r = min(pa - (char *)a, pb - pa); | ||
| 159 | vecswap(a, pb - r, r); | ||
| 160 | r = min(pd - pc, pn - pd - es); | ||
| 161 | vecswap(pb, pn - r, r); | ||
| 162 | if ((r = pb - pa) > es) | ||
| 163 | qsort(a, r / es, es, cmp); | ||
| 164 | if ((r = pd - pc) > es) { | ||
| 165 | /* Iterate rather than recurse to save stack space */ | ||
| 166 | a = pn - r; | ||
| 167 | n = r / es; | ||
| 168 | goto loop; | ||
| 169 | } | ||
| 170 | /* qsort(pn - r, r / es, es, cmp);*/ | ||
| 171 | } | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/radixsort.3 b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/radixsort.3 new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..028837d4d1 --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/radixsort.3 | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,155 @@ | |||
| 1 | .\" Copyright (c) 1990, 1991, 1993 | ||
| 2 | .\" The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved. | ||
| 3 | .\" | ||
| 4 | .\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without | ||
| 5 | .\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions | ||
| 6 | .\" are met: | ||
| 7 | .\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright | ||
| 8 | .\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. | ||
| 9 | .\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright | ||
| 10 | .\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the | ||
| 11 | .\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. | ||
| 12 | .\" 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors | ||
| 13 | .\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software | ||
| 14 | .\" without specific prior written permission. | ||
| 15 | .\" | ||
| 16 | .\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND | ||
| 17 | .\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE | ||
| 18 | .\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE | ||
| 19 | .\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE | ||
| 20 | .\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL | ||
| 21 | .\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS | ||
| 22 | .\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) | ||
| 23 | .\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT | ||
| 24 | .\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY | ||
| 25 | .\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF | ||
| 26 | .\" SUCH DAMAGE. | ||
| 27 | .\" | ||
| 28 | .\" $OpenBSD: radixsort.3,v 1.9 2003/06/02 20:18:38 millert Exp $ | ||
| 29 | .\" | ||
| 30 | .Dd January 27, 1994 | ||
| 31 | .Dt RADIXSORT 3 | ||
| 32 | .Os | ||
| 33 | .Sh NAME | ||
| 34 | .Nm radixsort , | ||
| 35 | .Nm sradixsort | ||
| 36 | .Nd radix sort | ||
| 37 | .Sh SYNOPSIS | ||
| 38 | .Fd #include <limits.h> | ||
| 39 | .Fd #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 40 | .Ft int | ||
| 41 | .Fn radixsort "const u_char **base" "int nmemb" "const u_char *table" "u_int endbyte" | ||
| 42 | .Ft int | ||
| 43 | .Fn sradixsort "const u_char **base" "int nmemb" "const u_char *table" "u_int endbyte" | ||
| 44 | .Sh DESCRIPTION | ||
| 45 | The | ||
| 46 | .Fn radixsort | ||
| 47 | and | ||
| 48 | .Fn sradixsort | ||
| 49 | functions are implementations of radix sort. | ||
| 50 | .Pp | ||
| 51 | These functions sort an array of | ||
| 52 | .Fa nmemb | ||
| 53 | pointers to byte strings. | ||
| 54 | The initial member is referenced by | ||
| 55 | .Fa base . | ||
| 56 | The byte strings may contain any values; the end of each string | ||
| 57 | is denoted by the user-specified value | ||
| 58 | .Fa endbyte . | ||
| 59 | .Pp | ||
| 60 | Applications may specify a sort order by providing the | ||
| 61 | .Fa table | ||
| 62 | argument. | ||
| 63 | If non-null, | ||
| 64 | .Fa table | ||
| 65 | must reference an array of | ||
| 66 | .Dv UCHAR_MAX | ||
| 67 | + 1 bytes which contains the sort weight of each possible byte value. | ||
| 68 | The end-of-string byte must have a sort weight of 0 or 255 | ||
| 69 | (for sorting in reverse order). | ||
| 70 | More than one byte may have the same sort weight. | ||
| 71 | The | ||
| 72 | .Fa table | ||
| 73 | argument is useful for applications which wish to sort different characters | ||
| 74 | equally, for example, providing a table with the same weights | ||
| 75 | for A-Z as for a-z will result in a case-insensitive sort. | ||
| 76 | If | ||
| 77 | .Fa table | ||
| 78 | is | ||
| 79 | .Dv NULL , | ||
| 80 | the contents of the array are sorted in ascending order according to the | ||
| 81 | .Tn ASCII | ||
| 82 | order of the byte strings they reference and | ||
| 83 | .Fa endbyte | ||
| 84 | has a sorting weight of 0. | ||
| 85 | .Pp | ||
| 86 | The | ||
| 87 | .Fn sradixsort | ||
| 88 | function is stable; that is, if two elements compare as equal, their | ||
| 89 | order in the sorted array is unchanged. | ||
| 90 | The | ||
| 91 | .Fn sradixsort | ||
| 92 | function uses additional memory sufficient to hold | ||
| 93 | .Fa nmemb | ||
| 94 | pointers. | ||
| 95 | .Pp | ||
| 96 | The | ||
| 97 | .Fn radixsort | ||
| 98 | function is not stable, but uses no additional memory. | ||
| 99 | .Pp | ||
| 100 | These functions are variants of most-significant-byte radix sorting; in | ||
| 101 | particular, see D.E. Knuth's Algorithm R and section 5.2.5, exercise 10. | ||
| 102 | They take linear time relative to the number of bytes in the strings. | ||
| 103 | .Sh RETURN VALUES | ||
| 104 | Upon successful completion 0 is returned. | ||
| 105 | Otherwise, \-1 is returned and the global variable | ||
| 106 | .Va errno | ||
| 107 | is set to indicate the error. | ||
| 108 | .Sh ERRORS | ||
| 109 | .Bl -tag -width Er | ||
| 110 | .It Bq Er EINVAL | ||
| 111 | The value of the | ||
| 112 | .Fa endbyte | ||
| 113 | element of | ||
| 114 | .Fa table | ||
| 115 | is not 0 or 255. | ||
| 116 | .El | ||
| 117 | .Pp | ||
| 118 | Additionally, the | ||
| 119 | .Fn sradixsort | ||
| 120 | function may fail and set | ||
| 121 | .Va errno | ||
| 122 | for any of the errors specified for the library routine | ||
| 123 | .Xr malloc 3 . | ||
| 124 | .Sh SEE ALSO | ||
| 125 | .Xr sort 1 , | ||
| 126 | .Xr qsort 3 | ||
| 127 | .Rs | ||
| 128 | .%A Knuth, D.E. | ||
| 129 | .%D 1968 | ||
| 130 | .%B "The Art of Computer Programming" | ||
| 131 | .%T "Sorting and Searching" | ||
| 132 | .%V Vol. 3 | ||
| 133 | .%P pp. 170-178 | ||
| 134 | .Re | ||
| 135 | .Rs | ||
| 136 | .%A Paige, R. | ||
| 137 | .%D 1987 | ||
| 138 | .%T "Three Partition Refinement Algorithms" | ||
| 139 | .%J "SIAM J. Comput." | ||
| 140 | .%V Vol. 16 | ||
| 141 | .%N No. 6 | ||
| 142 | .Re | ||
| 143 | .Rs | ||
| 144 | .%A McIlroy, P. | ||
| 145 | .%D 1993 | ||
| 146 | .%B "Engineering Radix Sort" | ||
| 147 | .%T "Computing Systems" | ||
| 148 | .%V Vol. 6:1 | ||
| 149 | .%P pp. 5-27 | ||
| 150 | .Re | ||
| 151 | .Sh HISTORY | ||
| 152 | The | ||
| 153 | .Fn radixsort | ||
| 154 | function first appeared in | ||
| 155 | .Bx 4.4 . | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/radixsort.c b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/radixsort.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..1ff30416d9 --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/radixsort.c | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,313 @@ | |||
| 1 | /*- | ||
| 2 | * Copyright (c) 1990, 1993 | ||
| 3 | * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved. | ||
| 4 | * | ||
| 5 | * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by | ||
| 6 | * Peter McIlroy and by Dan Bernstein at New York University, | ||
| 7 | * | ||
| 8 | * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without | ||
| 9 | * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions | ||
| 10 | * are met: | ||
| 11 | * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright | ||
| 12 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. | ||
| 13 | * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright | ||
| 14 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the | ||
| 15 | * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. | ||
| 16 | * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors | ||
| 17 | * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software | ||
| 18 | * without specific prior written permission. | ||
| 19 | * | ||
| 20 | * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND | ||
| 21 | * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE | ||
| 22 | * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE | ||
| 23 | * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE | ||
| 24 | * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL | ||
| 25 | * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS | ||
| 26 | * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) | ||
| 27 | * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT | ||
| 28 | * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY | ||
| 29 | * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF | ||
| 30 | * SUCH DAMAGE. | ||
| 31 | */ | ||
| 32 | |||
| 33 | #if defined(LIBC_SCCS) && !defined(lint) | ||
| 34 | static char *rcsid = "$OpenBSD: radixsort.c,v 1.6 2003/06/02 20:18:38 millert Exp $"; | ||
| 35 | #endif /* LIBC_SCCS and not lint */ | ||
| 36 | |||
| 37 | /* | ||
| 38 | * Radixsort routines. | ||
| 39 | * | ||
| 40 | * Program r_sort_a() is unstable but uses O(logN) extra memory for a stack. | ||
| 41 | * Use radixsort(a, n, trace, endchar) for this case. | ||
| 42 | * | ||
| 43 | * For stable sorting (using N extra pointers) use sradixsort(), which calls | ||
| 44 | * r_sort_b(). | ||
| 45 | * | ||
| 46 | * For a description of this code, see D. McIlroy, P. McIlroy, K. Bostic, | ||
| 47 | * "Engineering Radix Sort". | ||
| 48 | */ | ||
| 49 | |||
| 50 | #include <sys/types.h> | ||
| 51 | #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 52 | #include <errno.h> | ||
| 53 | |||
| 54 | typedef struct { | ||
| 55 | const u_char **sa; | ||
| 56 | int sn, si; | ||
| 57 | } stack; | ||
| 58 | |||
| 59 | static __inline void simplesort | ||
| 60 | (const u_char **, int, int, const u_char *, u_int); | ||
| 61 | static void r_sort_a(const u_char **, int, int, const u_char *, u_int); | ||
| 62 | static void r_sort_b(const u_char **, | ||
| 63 | const u_char **, int, int, const u_char *, u_int); | ||
| 64 | |||
| 65 | #define THRESHOLD 20 /* Divert to simplesort(). */ | ||
| 66 | #define SIZE 512 /* Default stack size. */ | ||
| 67 | |||
| 68 | #define SETUP { \ | ||
| 69 | if (tab == NULL) { \ | ||
| 70 | tr = tr0; \ | ||
| 71 | for (c = 0; c < endch; c++) \ | ||
| 72 | tr0[c] = c + 1; \ | ||
| 73 | tr0[c] = 0; \ | ||
| 74 | for (c++; c < 256; c++) \ | ||
| 75 | tr0[c] = c; \ | ||
| 76 | endch = 0; \ | ||
| 77 | } else { \ | ||
| 78 | endch = tab[endch]; \ | ||
| 79 | tr = tab; \ | ||
| 80 | if (endch != 0 && endch != 255) { \ | ||
| 81 | errno = EINVAL; \ | ||
| 82 | return (-1); \ | ||
| 83 | } \ | ||
| 84 | } \ | ||
| 85 | } | ||
| 86 | |||
| 87 | int | ||
| 88 | radixsort(a, n, tab, endch) | ||
| 89 | const u_char **a, *tab; | ||
| 90 | int n; | ||
| 91 | u_int endch; | ||
| 92 | { | ||
| 93 | const u_char *tr; | ||
| 94 | int c; | ||
| 95 | u_char tr0[256]; | ||
| 96 | |||
| 97 | SETUP; | ||
| 98 | r_sort_a(a, n, 0, tr, endch); | ||
| 99 | return (0); | ||
| 100 | } | ||
| 101 | |||
| 102 | int | ||
| 103 | sradixsort(a, n, tab, endch) | ||
| 104 | const u_char **a, *tab; | ||
| 105 | int n; | ||
| 106 | u_int endch; | ||
| 107 | { | ||
| 108 | const u_char *tr, **ta; | ||
| 109 | int c; | ||
| 110 | u_char tr0[256]; | ||
| 111 | |||
| 112 | SETUP; | ||
| 113 | if (n < THRESHOLD) | ||
| 114 | simplesort(a, n, 0, tr, endch); | ||
| 115 | else { | ||
| 116 | if ((ta = malloc(n * sizeof(a))) == NULL) | ||
| 117 | return (-1); | ||
| 118 | r_sort_b(a, ta, n, 0, tr, endch); | ||
| 119 | free(ta); | ||
| 120 | } | ||
| 121 | return (0); | ||
| 122 | } | ||
| 123 | |||
| 124 | #define empty(s) (s >= sp) | ||
| 125 | #define pop(a, n, i) a = (--sp)->sa, n = sp->sn, i = sp->si | ||
| 126 | #define push(a, n, i) sp->sa = a, sp->sn = n, (sp++)->si = i | ||
| 127 | #define swap(a, b, t) t = a, a = b, b = t | ||
| 128 | |||
| 129 | /* Unstable, in-place sort. */ | ||
| 130 | void | ||
| 131 | r_sort_a(a, n, i, tr, endch) | ||
| 132 | const u_char **a; | ||
| 133 | int n, i; | ||
| 134 | const u_char *tr; | ||
| 135 | u_int endch; | ||
| 136 | { | ||
| 137 | static int count[256], nc, bmin; | ||
| 138 | register int c; | ||
| 139 | register const u_char **ak, *r; | ||
| 140 | stack s[SIZE], *sp, *sp0, *sp1, temp; | ||
| 141 | int *cp, bigc; | ||
| 142 | const u_char **an, *t, **aj, **top[256]; | ||
| 143 | |||
| 144 | /* Set up stack. */ | ||
| 145 | sp = s; | ||
| 146 | push(a, n, i); | ||
| 147 | while (!empty(s)) { | ||
| 148 | pop(a, n, i); | ||
| 149 | if (n < THRESHOLD) { | ||
| 150 | simplesort(a, n, i, tr, endch); | ||
| 151 | continue; | ||
| 152 | } | ||
| 153 | an = a + n; | ||
| 154 | |||
| 155 | /* Make character histogram. */ | ||
| 156 | if (nc == 0) { | ||
| 157 | bmin = 255; /* First occupied bin, excluding eos. */ | ||
| 158 | for (ak = a; ak < an;) { | ||
| 159 | c = tr[(*ak++)[i]]; | ||
| 160 | if (++count[c] == 1 && c != endch) { | ||
| 161 | if (c < bmin) | ||
| 162 | bmin = c; | ||
| 163 | nc++; | ||
| 164 | } | ||
| 165 | } | ||
| 166 | if (sp + nc > s + SIZE) { /* Get more stack. */ | ||
| 167 | r_sort_a(a, n, i, tr, endch); | ||
| 168 | continue; | ||
| 169 | } | ||
| 170 | } | ||
| 171 | |||
| 172 | /* | ||
| 173 | * Set top[]; push incompletely sorted bins onto stack. | ||
| 174 | * top[] = pointers to last out-of-place element in bins. | ||
| 175 | * count[] = counts of elements in bins. | ||
| 176 | * Before permuting: top[c-1] + count[c] = top[c]; | ||
| 177 | * during deal: top[c] counts down to top[c-1]. | ||
| 178 | */ | ||
| 179 | sp0 = sp1 = sp; /* Stack position of biggest bin. */ | ||
| 180 | bigc = 2; /* Size of biggest bin. */ | ||
| 181 | if (endch == 0) /* Special case: set top[eos]. */ | ||
| 182 | top[0] = ak = a + count[0]; | ||
| 183 | else { | ||
| 184 | ak = a; | ||
| 185 | top[255] = an; | ||
| 186 | } | ||
| 187 | for (cp = count + bmin; nc > 0; cp++) { | ||
| 188 | while (*cp == 0) /* Find next non-empty pile. */ | ||
| 189 | cp++; | ||
| 190 | if (*cp > 1) { | ||
| 191 | if (*cp > bigc) { | ||
| 192 | bigc = *cp; | ||
| 193 | sp1 = sp; | ||
| 194 | } | ||
| 195 | push(ak, *cp, i+1); | ||
| 196 | } | ||
| 197 | top[cp-count] = ak += *cp; | ||
| 198 | nc--; | ||
| 199 | } | ||
| 200 | swap(*sp0, *sp1, temp); /* Play it safe -- biggest bin last. */ | ||
| 201 | |||
| 202 | /* | ||
| 203 | * Permute misplacements home. Already home: everything | ||
| 204 | * before aj, and in bin[c], items from top[c] on. | ||
| 205 | * Inner loop: | ||
| 206 | * r = next element to put in place; | ||
| 207 | * ak = top[r[i]] = location to put the next element. | ||
| 208 | * aj = bottom of 1st disordered bin. | ||
| 209 | * Outer loop: | ||
| 210 | * Once the 1st disordered bin is done, ie. aj >= ak, | ||
| 211 | * aj<-aj + count[c] connects the bins in a linked list; | ||
| 212 | * reset count[c]. | ||
| 213 | */ | ||
| 214 | for (aj = a; aj < an; *aj = r, aj += count[c], count[c] = 0) | ||
| 215 | for (r = *aj; aj < (ak = --top[c = tr[r[i]]]);) | ||
| 216 | swap(*ak, r, t); | ||
| 217 | } | ||
| 218 | } | ||
| 219 | |||
| 220 | /* Stable sort, requiring additional memory. */ | ||
| 221 | void | ||
| 222 | r_sort_b(a, ta, n, i, tr, endch) | ||
| 223 | const u_char **a, **ta; | ||
| 224 | int n, i; | ||
| 225 | const u_char *tr; | ||
| 226 | u_int endch; | ||
| 227 | { | ||
| 228 | static int count[256], nc, bmin; | ||
| 229 | register int c; | ||
| 230 | register const u_char **ak, **ai; | ||
| 231 | stack s[512], *sp, *sp0, *sp1, temp; | ||
| 232 | const u_char **top[256]; | ||
| 233 | int *cp, bigc; | ||
| 234 | |||
| 235 | sp = s; | ||
| 236 | push(a, n, i); | ||
| 237 | while (!empty(s)) { | ||
| 238 | pop(a, n, i); | ||
| 239 | if (n < THRESHOLD) { | ||
| 240 | simplesort(a, n, i, tr, endch); | ||
| 241 | continue; | ||
| 242 | } | ||
| 243 | |||
| 244 | if (nc == 0) { | ||
| 245 | bmin = 255; | ||
| 246 | for (ak = a + n; --ak >= a;) { | ||
| 247 | c = tr[(*ak)[i]]; | ||
| 248 | if (++count[c] == 1 && c != endch) { | ||
| 249 | if (c < bmin) | ||
| 250 | bmin = c; | ||
| 251 | nc++; | ||
| 252 | } | ||
| 253 | } | ||
| 254 | if (sp + nc > s + SIZE) { | ||
| 255 | r_sort_b(a, ta, n, i, tr, endch); | ||
| 256 | continue; | ||
| 257 | } | ||
| 258 | } | ||
| 259 | |||
| 260 | sp0 = sp1 = sp; | ||
| 261 | bigc = 2; | ||
| 262 | if (endch == 0) { | ||
| 263 | top[0] = ak = a + count[0]; | ||
| 264 | count[0] = 0; | ||
| 265 | } else { | ||
| 266 | ak = a; | ||
| 267 | top[255] = a + n; | ||
| 268 | count[255] = 0; | ||
| 269 | } | ||
| 270 | for (cp = count + bmin; nc > 0; cp++) { | ||
| 271 | while (*cp == 0) | ||
| 272 | cp++; | ||
| 273 | if ((c = *cp) > 1) { | ||
| 274 | if (c > bigc) { | ||
| 275 | bigc = c; | ||
| 276 | sp1 = sp; | ||
| 277 | } | ||
| 278 | push(ak, c, i+1); | ||
| 279 | } | ||
| 280 | top[cp-count] = ak += c; | ||
| 281 | *cp = 0; /* Reset count[]. */ | ||
| 282 | nc--; | ||
| 283 | } | ||
| 284 | swap(*sp0, *sp1, temp); | ||
| 285 | |||
| 286 | for (ak = ta + n, ai = a+n; ak > ta;) /* Copy to temp. */ | ||
| 287 | *--ak = *--ai; | ||
| 288 | for (ak = ta+n; --ak >= ta;) /* Deal to piles. */ | ||
| 289 | *--top[tr[(*ak)[i]]] = *ak; | ||
| 290 | } | ||
| 291 | } | ||
| 292 | |||
| 293 | static __inline void | ||
| 294 | simplesort(a, n, b, tr, endch) /* insertion sort */ | ||
| 295 | register const u_char **a; | ||
| 296 | int n, b; | ||
| 297 | register const u_char *tr; | ||
| 298 | u_int endch; | ||
| 299 | { | ||
| 300 | register u_char ch; | ||
| 301 | const u_char **ak, **ai, *s, *t; | ||
| 302 | |||
| 303 | for (ak = a+1; --n >= 1; ak++) | ||
| 304 | for (ai = ak; ai > a; ai--) { | ||
| 305 | for (s = ai[0] + b, t = ai[-1] + b; | ||
| 306 | (ch = tr[*s]) != endch; s++, t++) | ||
| 307 | if (ch != tr[*t]) | ||
| 308 | break; | ||
| 309 | if (ch >= tr[*t]) | ||
| 310 | break; | ||
| 311 | swap(ai[0], ai[-1], s); | ||
| 312 | } | ||
| 313 | } | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/rand.3 b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/rand.3 new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..0d9c52a3b9 --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/rand.3 | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,98 @@ | |||
| 1 | .\" Copyright (c) 1990, 1991 The Regents of the University of California. | ||
| 2 | .\" All rights reserved. | ||
| 3 | .\" | ||
| 4 | .\" This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by | ||
| 5 | .\" the American National Standards Committee X3, on Information | ||
| 6 | .\" Processing Systems. | ||
| 7 | .\" | ||
| 8 | .\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without | ||
| 9 | .\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions | ||
| 10 | .\" are met: | ||
| 11 | .\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright | ||
| 12 | .\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. | ||
| 13 | .\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright | ||
| 14 | .\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the | ||
| 15 | .\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. | ||
| 16 | .\" 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors | ||
| 17 | .\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software | ||
| 18 | .\" without specific prior written permission. | ||
| 19 | .\" | ||
| 20 | .\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND | ||
| 21 | .\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE | ||
| 22 | .\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE | ||
| 23 | .\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE | ||
| 24 | .\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL | ||
| 25 | .\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS | ||
| 26 | .\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) | ||
| 27 | .\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT | ||
| 28 | .\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY | ||
| 29 | .\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF | ||
| 30 | .\" SUCH DAMAGE. | ||
| 31 | .\" | ||
| 32 | .\" $OpenBSD: rand.3,v 1.9 2003/06/02 20:18:38 millert Exp $ | ||
| 33 | .\" | ||
| 34 | .Dd June 29, 1991 | ||
| 35 | .Dt RAND 3 | ||
| 36 | .Os | ||
| 37 | .Sh NAME | ||
| 38 | .Nm rand , | ||
| 39 | .Nm srand | ||
| 40 | .Nd bad random number generator | ||
| 41 | .Sh SYNOPSIS | ||
| 42 | .Fd #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 43 | .Ft void | ||
| 44 | .Fn srand "unsigned int seed" | ||
| 45 | .Ft int | ||
| 46 | .Fn rand void | ||
| 47 | .Ft int | ||
| 48 | .Fn rand_r "unsigned int *seed" | ||
| 49 | .Sh DESCRIPTION | ||
| 50 | .Bf -symbolic | ||
| 51 | These interfaces are obsoleted by | ||
| 52 | .Xr random 3 . | ||
| 53 | .Ef | ||
| 54 | .Pp | ||
| 55 | The | ||
| 56 | .Fn rand | ||
| 57 | function computes a sequence of pseudo-random integers in the range | ||
| 58 | of 0 to | ||
| 59 | .Dv RAND_MAX | ||
| 60 | (as defined by the header file | ||
| 61 | .Aq Pa stdlib.h ) . | ||
| 62 | .Pp | ||
| 63 | The | ||
| 64 | .Fn srand | ||
| 65 | function sets its argument as the seed for a new sequence of | ||
| 66 | pseudo-random numbers to be returned by | ||
| 67 | .Fn rand . | ||
| 68 | These sequences are repeatable by calling | ||
| 69 | .Fn srand | ||
| 70 | with the same seed value. | ||
| 71 | .Pp | ||
| 72 | If no seed value is provided, the functions are automatically | ||
| 73 | seeded with a value of 1. | ||
| 74 | .Pp | ||
| 75 | The | ||
| 76 | .Fn rand_r | ||
| 77 | is a thread-safe version of | ||
| 78 | .Fn rand . | ||
| 79 | Storage for the seed must be provided through the | ||
| 80 | .Fa seed | ||
| 81 | argument, and needs to have been initialized by the caller. | ||
| 82 | .Sh SEE ALSO | ||
| 83 | .Xr arc4random 3 , | ||
| 84 | .Xr rand48 3 , | ||
| 85 | .Xr random 3 | ||
| 86 | .Sh STANDARDS | ||
| 87 | The | ||
| 88 | .Fn rand | ||
| 89 | and | ||
| 90 | .Fn srand | ||
| 91 | functions conform to | ||
| 92 | .St -ansiC . | ||
| 93 | .Pp | ||
| 94 | The | ||
| 95 | .Fn rand_r | ||
| 96 | function conforms to ISO/IEC 9945-1 ANSI/IEEE | ||
| 97 | .Pq Dq Tn POSIX | ||
| 98 | Std 1003.1c Draft 10. | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/rand.c b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/rand.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..d58d040ad5 --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/rand.c | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,61 @@ | |||
| 1 | /*- | ||
| 2 | * Copyright (c) 1990 The Regents of the University of California. | ||
| 3 | * All rights reserved. | ||
| 4 | * | ||
| 5 | * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without | ||
| 6 | * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions | ||
| 7 | * are met: | ||
| 8 | * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright | ||
| 9 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. | ||
| 10 | * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright | ||
| 11 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the | ||
| 12 | * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. | ||
| 13 | * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors | ||
| 14 | * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software | ||
| 15 | * without specific prior written permission. | ||
| 16 | * | ||
| 17 | * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND | ||
| 18 | * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE | ||
| 19 | * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE | ||
| 20 | * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE | ||
| 21 | * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL | ||
| 22 | * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS | ||
| 23 | * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) | ||
| 24 | * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT | ||
| 25 | * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY | ||
| 26 | * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF | ||
| 27 | * SUCH DAMAGE. | ||
| 28 | */ | ||
| 29 | |||
| 30 | #if defined(LIBC_SCCS) && !defined(lint) | ||
| 31 | static char *rcsid = "$OpenBSD: rand.c,v 1.7 2003/06/02 20:18:38 millert Exp $"; | ||
| 32 | #endif /* LIBC_SCCS and not lint */ | ||
| 33 | |||
| 34 | #include <sys/types.h> | ||
| 35 | #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 36 | |||
| 37 | static u_int next = 1; | ||
| 38 | |||
| 39 | int | ||
| 40 | rand_r(seed) | ||
| 41 | u_int *seed; | ||
| 42 | { | ||
| 43 | |||
| 44 | *seed = *seed * 1103515245 + 12345; | ||
| 45 | return (*seed % ((u_int)RAND_MAX + 1)); | ||
| 46 | } | ||
| 47 | |||
| 48 | int | ||
| 49 | rand() | ||
| 50 | { | ||
| 51 | |||
| 52 | return (rand_r(&next)); | ||
| 53 | } | ||
| 54 | |||
| 55 | void | ||
| 56 | srand(seed) | ||
| 57 | u_int seed; | ||
| 58 | { | ||
| 59 | |||
| 60 | next = seed; | ||
| 61 | } | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/rand48.3 b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/rand48.3 new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..78cd0a7cd5 --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/rand48.3 | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,165 @@ | |||
| 1 | .\" Copyright (c) 1993 Martin Birgmeier | ||
| 2 | .\" All rights reserved. | ||
| 3 | .\" | ||
| 4 | .\" You may redistribute unmodified or modified versions of this source | ||
| 5 | .\" code provided that the above copyright notice and this and the | ||
| 6 | .\" following conditions are retained. | ||
| 7 | .\" | ||
| 8 | .\" This software is provided ``as is'', and comes with no warranties | ||
| 9 | .\" of any kind. I shall in no event be liable for anything that happens | ||
| 10 | .\" to anyone/anything when using this software. | ||
| 11 | .\" | ||
| 12 | .\" $OpenBSD: rand48.3,v 1.10 2003/06/01 19:27:27 jmc Exp $ | ||
| 13 | .\" | ||
| 14 | .Dd October 8, 1993 | ||
| 15 | .Dt RAND48 3 | ||
| 16 | .Os | ||
| 17 | .Sh NAME | ||
| 18 | .Nm drand48 , | ||
| 19 | .Nm erand48 , | ||
| 20 | .Nm lrand48 , | ||
| 21 | .Nm nrand48 , | ||
| 22 | .Nm mrand48 , | ||
| 23 | .Nm jrand48 , | ||
| 24 | .Nm srand48 , | ||
| 25 | .Nm seed48 , | ||
| 26 | .Nm lcong48 | ||
| 27 | .Nd pseudo-random number generators and initialization routines | ||
| 28 | .Sh SYNOPSIS | ||
| 29 | .Fd #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 30 | .Ft double | ||
| 31 | .Fn drand48 void | ||
| 32 | .Ft double | ||
| 33 | .Fn erand48 "unsigned short xseed[3]" | ||
| 34 | .Ft long | ||
| 35 | .Fn lrand48 void | ||
| 36 | .Ft long | ||
| 37 | .Fn nrand48 "unsigned short xseed[3]" | ||
| 38 | .Ft long | ||
| 39 | .Fn mrand48 void | ||
| 40 | .Ft long | ||
| 41 | .Fn jrand48 "unsigned short xseed[3]" | ||
| 42 | .Ft void | ||
| 43 | .Fn srand48 "long seed" | ||
| 44 | .Ft "unsigned short *" | ||
| 45 | .Fn seed48 "unsigned short xseed[3]" | ||
| 46 | .Ft void | ||
| 47 | .Fn lcong48 "unsigned short p[7]" | ||
| 48 | .Sh DESCRIPTION | ||
| 49 | The | ||
| 50 | .Fn rand48 | ||
| 51 | family of functions generates pseudo-random numbers using a linear | ||
| 52 | congruential algorithm working on integers 48 bits in size. | ||
| 53 | The particular formula employed is | ||
| 54 | r(n+1) = (a * r(n) + c) mod m | ||
| 55 | where the default values are | ||
| 56 | for the multiplicand a = 0xfdeece66d = 25214903917 and | ||
| 57 | the addend c = 0xb = 11. | ||
| 58 | The modulus is always fixed at m = 2 ** 48. | ||
| 59 | r(n) is called the seed of the random number generator. | ||
| 60 | .Pp | ||
| 61 | For all the six generator routines described next, the first | ||
| 62 | computational step is to perform a single iteration of the algorithm. | ||
| 63 | .Pp | ||
| 64 | .Fn drand48 | ||
| 65 | and | ||
| 66 | .Fn erand48 | ||
| 67 | return values of type double. | ||
| 68 | The full 48 bits of r(n+1) are | ||
| 69 | loaded into the mantissa of the returned value, with the exponent set | ||
| 70 | such that the values produced lie in the interval [0.0, 1.0]. | ||
| 71 | .Pp | ||
| 72 | .Fn lrand48 | ||
| 73 | and | ||
| 74 | .Fn nrand48 | ||
| 75 | return values of type long in the range | ||
| 76 | [0, 2**31-1]. | ||
| 77 | The high-order (31) bits of | ||
| 78 | r(n+1) are loaded into the lower bits of the returned value, with | ||
| 79 | the topmost (sign) bit set to zero. | ||
| 80 | .Pp | ||
| 81 | .Fn mrand48 | ||
| 82 | and | ||
| 83 | .Fn jrand48 | ||
| 84 | return values of type long in the range | ||
| 85 | [-2**31, 2**31-1]. | ||
| 86 | The high-order (32) bits of r(n+1) are loaded into the returned value. | ||
| 87 | .Pp | ||
| 88 | .Fn drand48 , | ||
| 89 | .Fn lrand48 , | ||
| 90 | and | ||
| 91 | .Fn mrand48 | ||
| 92 | use an internal buffer to store r(n). | ||
| 93 | For these functions | ||
| 94 | the initial value of r(0) = 0x1234abcd330e = 20017429951246. | ||
| 95 | .Pp | ||
| 96 | On the other hand, | ||
| 97 | .Fn erand48 , | ||
| 98 | .Fn nrand48 , | ||
| 99 | and | ||
| 100 | .Fn jrand48 | ||
| 101 | use a user-supplied buffer to store the seed r(n), | ||
| 102 | which consists of an array of 3 shorts, where the zeroth member | ||
| 103 | holds the least significant bits. | ||
| 104 | .Pp | ||
| 105 | All functions share the same multiplicand and addend. | ||
| 106 | .Pp | ||
| 107 | .Fn srand48 | ||
| 108 | is used to initialize the internal buffer r(n) of | ||
| 109 | .Fn drand48 , | ||
| 110 | .Fn lrand48 , | ||
| 111 | and | ||
| 112 | .Fn mrand48 | ||
| 113 | such that the 32 bits of the seed value are copied into the upper 32 bits | ||
| 114 | of r(n), with the lower 16 bits of r(n) arbitrarily being set to 0x330e. | ||
| 115 | Additionally, the constant multiplicand and addend of the algorithm are | ||
| 116 | reset to the default values given above. | ||
| 117 | .Pp | ||
| 118 | .Fn seed48 | ||
| 119 | also initializes the internal buffer r(n) of | ||
| 120 | .Fn drand48 , | ||
| 121 | .Fn lrand48 , | ||
| 122 | and | ||
| 123 | .Fn mrand48 , | ||
| 124 | but here all 48 bits of the seed can be specified in an array of 3 shorts, | ||
| 125 | where the zeroth member specifies the lowest bits. | ||
| 126 | Again, the constant multiplicand and addend of the algorithm are | ||
| 127 | reset to the default values given above. | ||
| 128 | .Fn seed48 | ||
| 129 | returns a pointer to an array of 3 shorts which contains the old seed. | ||
| 130 | This array is statically allocated, so its contents are lost after | ||
| 131 | each new call to | ||
| 132 | .Fn seed48 . | ||
| 133 | .Pp | ||
| 134 | Finally, | ||
| 135 | .Fn lcong48 | ||
| 136 | allows full control over the multiplicand and addend used in | ||
| 137 | .Fn drand48 , | ||
| 138 | .Fn erand48 , | ||
| 139 | .Fn lrand48 , | ||
| 140 | .Fn nrand48 , | ||
| 141 | .Fn mrand48 , | ||
| 142 | and | ||
| 143 | .Fn jrand48 , | ||
| 144 | and the seed used in | ||
| 145 | .Fn drand48 , | ||
| 146 | .Fn lrand48 , | ||
| 147 | and | ||
| 148 | .Fn mrand48 . | ||
| 149 | An array of 7 shorts is passed as parameter; the first three shorts are | ||
| 150 | used to initialize the seed; the second three are used to initialize the | ||
| 151 | multiplicand; and the last short is used to initialize the addend. | ||
| 152 | It is thus not possible to use values greater than 0xffff as the addend. | ||
| 153 | .Pp | ||
| 154 | Note that all three methods of seeding the random number generator | ||
| 155 | always also set the multiplicand and addend for any of the six | ||
| 156 | generator calls. | ||
| 157 | .Pp | ||
| 158 | For a more powerful random number generator, see | ||
| 159 | .Xr random 3 . | ||
| 160 | .Sh SEE ALSO | ||
| 161 | .Xr arc4random 3 , | ||
| 162 | .Xr rand 3 , | ||
| 163 | .Xr random 3 | ||
| 164 | .Sh AUTHORS | ||
| 165 | Martin Birgmeier | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/rand48.h b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/rand48.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..afa49f65f3 --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/rand48.h | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,32 @@ | |||
| 1 | /* | ||
| 2 | * Copyright (c) 1993 Martin Birgmeier | ||
| 3 | * All rights reserved. | ||
| 4 | * | ||
| 5 | * You may redistribute unmodified or modified versions of this source | ||
| 6 | * code provided that the above copyright notice and this and the | ||
| 7 | * following conditions are retained. | ||
| 8 | * | ||
| 9 | * This software is provided ``as is'', and comes with no warranties | ||
| 10 | * of any kind. I shall in no event be liable for anything that happens | ||
| 11 | * to anyone/anything when using this software. | ||
| 12 | * | ||
| 13 | * $OpenBSD: rand48.h,v 1.3 2002/02/16 21:27:24 millert Exp $ | ||
| 14 | */ | ||
| 15 | |||
| 16 | #ifndef _RAND48_H_ | ||
| 17 | #define _RAND48_H_ | ||
| 18 | |||
| 19 | #include <math.h> | ||
| 20 | #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 21 | |||
| 22 | void __dorand48(unsigned short[3]); | ||
| 23 | |||
| 24 | #define RAND48_SEED_0 (0x330e) | ||
| 25 | #define RAND48_SEED_1 (0xabcd) | ||
| 26 | #define RAND48_SEED_2 (0x1234) | ||
| 27 | #define RAND48_MULT_0 (0xe66d) | ||
| 28 | #define RAND48_MULT_1 (0xdeec) | ||
| 29 | #define RAND48_MULT_2 (0x0005) | ||
| 30 | #define RAND48_ADD (0x000b) | ||
| 31 | |||
| 32 | #endif /* _RAND48_H_ */ | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/random.3 b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/random.3 new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f43f06420d --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/random.3 | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,186 @@ | |||
| 1 | .\" Copyright (c) 1983, 1991 The Regents of the University of California. | ||
| 2 | .\" All rights reserved. | ||
| 3 | .\" | ||
| 4 | .\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without | ||
| 5 | .\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions | ||
| 6 | .\" are met: | ||
| 7 | .\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright | ||
| 8 | .\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. | ||
| 9 | .\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright | ||
| 10 | .\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the | ||
| 11 | .\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. | ||
| 12 | .\" 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors | ||
| 13 | .\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software | ||
| 14 | .\" without specific prior written permission. | ||
| 15 | .\" | ||
| 16 | .\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND | ||
| 17 | .\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE | ||
| 18 | .\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE | ||
| 19 | .\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE | ||
| 20 | .\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL | ||
| 21 | .\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS | ||
| 22 | .\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) | ||
| 23 | .\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT | ||
| 24 | .\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY | ||
| 25 | .\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF | ||
| 26 | .\" SUCH DAMAGE. | ||
| 27 | .\" | ||
| 28 | .\" $OpenBSD: random.3,v 1.17 2003/06/02 20:18:38 millert Exp $ | ||
| 29 | .\" | ||
| 30 | .Dd April 19, 1991 | ||
| 31 | .Dt RANDOM 3 | ||
| 32 | .Os | ||
| 33 | .Sh NAME | ||
| 34 | .Nm random , | ||
| 35 | .Nm srandom , | ||
| 36 | .Nm srandomdev , | ||
| 37 | .Nm initstate , | ||
| 38 | .Nm setstate | ||
| 39 | .Nd better random number generator; routines for changing generators | ||
| 40 | .Sh SYNOPSIS | ||
| 41 | .Fd #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 42 | .Ft long | ||
| 43 | .Fn random void | ||
| 44 | .Ft void | ||
| 45 | .Fn srandom "unsigned int seed" | ||
| 46 | .Ft void | ||
| 47 | .Fn srandomdev void | ||
| 48 | .Ft char * | ||
| 49 | .Fn initstate "unsigned int seed" "char *state" "size_t n" | ||
| 50 | .Ft char * | ||
| 51 | .Fn setstate "const char *state" | ||
| 52 | .Sh DESCRIPTION | ||
| 53 | The | ||
| 54 | .Fn random | ||
| 55 | function uses a non-linear additive feedback random number generator employing | ||
| 56 | a default table of size 31 long integers to return successive pseudo-random | ||
| 57 | numbers in the range from 0 to (2**31)\-1. | ||
| 58 | The period of this random number generator is very large, approximately | ||
| 59 | 16*((2**31)\-1). | ||
| 60 | .Pp | ||
| 61 | The | ||
| 62 | .Fn random | ||
| 63 | and | ||
| 64 | .Fn srandom | ||
| 65 | functions have (almost) the same calling sequence and initialization | ||
| 66 | properties as | ||
| 67 | .Xr rand 3 Ns / Ns Xr srand 3 . | ||
| 68 | The difference is that | ||
| 69 | .Xr rand | ||
| 70 | produces a much less random sequence \(em in fact, the low dozen bits | ||
| 71 | generated by rand go through a cyclic pattern. | ||
| 72 | All the bits generated by | ||
| 73 | .Fn random | ||
| 74 | are usable. | ||
| 75 | For example, | ||
| 76 | .Sq Li random()&01 | ||
| 77 | will produce a random binary | ||
| 78 | value. | ||
| 79 | .Pp | ||
| 80 | Like | ||
| 81 | .Xr rand 3 , | ||
| 82 | .Fn random | ||
| 83 | will by default produce a sequence of numbers that can be duplicated | ||
| 84 | by calling | ||
| 85 | .Fn srandom | ||
| 86 | with | ||
| 87 | .Ql 1 | ||
| 88 | as the seed. | ||
| 89 | .Pp | ||
| 90 | The | ||
| 91 | .Fn srandomdev | ||
| 92 | routine initializes a state array using the | ||
| 93 | .Xr arandom 4 | ||
| 94 | random number device which returns good random numbers, | ||
| 95 | suitable for cryptographic use. | ||
| 96 | Note that this particular seeding procedure can generate | ||
| 97 | states which are impossible to reproduce by calling | ||
| 98 | .Fn srandom | ||
| 99 | with any value, since the succeeding terms in the | ||
| 100 | state buffer are no longer derived from the LC algorithm applied to | ||
| 101 | a fixed seed. | ||
| 102 | .Pp | ||
| 103 | The | ||
| 104 | .Fn initstate | ||
| 105 | routine allows a state array, passed in as an argument, to be initialized | ||
| 106 | for future use. | ||
| 107 | The size of the state array (in bytes) is used by | ||
| 108 | .Fn initstate | ||
| 109 | to decide how sophisticated a random number generator it should use \(em the | ||
| 110 | more state, the better the random numbers will be. | ||
| 111 | (Current "optimal" values for the amount of state information are | ||
| 112 | 8, 32, 64, 128, and 256 bytes; other amounts will be rounded down to | ||
| 113 | the nearest known amount. | ||
| 114 | Using less than 8 bytes will cause an error.) | ||
| 115 | The seed for the initialization (which specifies a starting point for | ||
| 116 | the random number sequence, and provides for restarting at the same | ||
| 117 | point) is also an argument. | ||
| 118 | The | ||
| 119 | .Fn initstate | ||
| 120 | function returns a pointer to the previous state information array. | ||
| 121 | .Pp | ||
| 122 | Once a state has been initialized, the | ||
| 123 | .Fn setstate | ||
| 124 | routine provides for rapid switching between states. | ||
| 125 | The | ||
| 126 | .Fn setstate | ||
| 127 | function returns a pointer to the previous state array; its | ||
| 128 | argument state array is used for further random number generation | ||
| 129 | until the next call to | ||
| 130 | .Fn initstate | ||
| 131 | or | ||
| 132 | .Fn setstate . | ||
| 133 | .Pp | ||
| 134 | Once a state array has been initialized, it may be restarted at a | ||
| 135 | different point either by calling | ||
| 136 | .Fn initstate | ||
| 137 | (with the desired seed, the state array, and its size) or by calling | ||
| 138 | both | ||
| 139 | .Fn setstate | ||
| 140 | (with the state array) and | ||
| 141 | .Fn srandom | ||
| 142 | (with the desired seed). | ||
| 143 | The advantage of calling both | ||
| 144 | .Fn setstate | ||
| 145 | and | ||
| 146 | .Fn srandom | ||
| 147 | is that the size of the state array does not have to be remembered after | ||
| 148 | it is initialized. | ||
| 149 | .Pp | ||
| 150 | With 256 bytes of state information, the period of the random number | ||
| 151 | generator is greater than 2**69 | ||
| 152 | which should be sufficient for most purposes. | ||
| 153 | .Sh DIAGNOSTICS | ||
| 154 | If | ||
| 155 | .Fn initstate | ||
| 156 | is called with less than 8 bytes of state information, or if | ||
| 157 | .Fn setstate | ||
| 158 | detects that the state information has been garbled, error | ||
| 159 | messages are printed on the standard error output. | ||
| 160 | .Sh SEE ALSO | ||
| 161 | .Xr arc4random 3 , | ||
| 162 | .Xr drand48 3 , | ||
| 163 | .Xr rand 3 , | ||
| 164 | .Xr random 4 | ||
| 165 | .Sh STANDARDS | ||
| 166 | The | ||
| 167 | .Fn random , | ||
| 168 | .Fn srandom , | ||
| 169 | .Fn initstate , | ||
| 170 | and | ||
| 171 | .Fn setstate | ||
| 172 | functions conform to | ||
| 173 | .St -xpg4.2 . | ||
| 174 | .Pp | ||
| 175 | The | ||
| 176 | .Fn srandomdev | ||
| 177 | function is an extension. | ||
| 178 | .Sh HISTORY | ||
| 179 | These | ||
| 180 | functions appeared in | ||
| 181 | .Bx 4.2 . | ||
| 182 | .Sh AUTHORS | ||
| 183 | .An Earl T. Cohen | ||
| 184 | .Sh BUGS | ||
| 185 | About 2/3 the speed of | ||
| 186 | .Xr rand 3 . | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/random.c b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/random.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..4807d2f27d --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/random.c | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,430 @@ | |||
| 1 | /* | ||
| 2 | * Copyright (c) 1983 Regents of the University of California. | ||
| 3 | * All rights reserved. | ||
| 4 | * | ||
| 5 | * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without | ||
| 6 | * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions | ||
| 7 | * are met: | ||
| 8 | * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright | ||
| 9 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. | ||
| 10 | * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright | ||
| 11 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the | ||
| 12 | * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. | ||
| 13 | * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors | ||
| 14 | * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software | ||
| 15 | * without specific prior written permission. | ||
| 16 | * | ||
| 17 | * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND | ||
| 18 | * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE | ||
| 19 | * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE | ||
| 20 | * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE | ||
| 21 | * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL | ||
| 22 | * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS | ||
| 23 | * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) | ||
| 24 | * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT | ||
| 25 | * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY | ||
| 26 | * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF | ||
| 27 | * SUCH DAMAGE. | ||
| 28 | */ | ||
| 29 | |||
| 30 | #if defined(LIBC_SCCS) && !defined(lint) | ||
| 31 | static char *rcsid = "$OpenBSD: random.c,v 1.12 2003/06/02 20:18:38 millert Exp $"; | ||
| 32 | #endif /* LIBC_SCCS and not lint */ | ||
| 33 | |||
| 34 | #include <sys/param.h> | ||
| 35 | #include <sys/sysctl.h> | ||
| 36 | #include <sys/time.h> | ||
| 37 | #include <fcntl.h> | ||
| 38 | #include <stdio.h> | ||
| 39 | #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 40 | #include <unistd.h> | ||
| 41 | |||
| 42 | /* | ||
| 43 | * random.c: | ||
| 44 | * | ||
| 45 | * An improved random number generation package. In addition to the standard | ||
| 46 | * rand()/srand() like interface, this package also has a special state info | ||
| 47 | * interface. The initstate() routine is called with a seed, an array of | ||
| 48 | * bytes, and a count of how many bytes are being passed in; this array is | ||
| 49 | * then initialized to contain information for random number generation with | ||
| 50 | * that much state information. Good sizes for the amount of state | ||
| 51 | * information are 32, 64, 128, and 256 bytes. The state can be switched by | ||
| 52 | * calling the setstate() routine with the same array as was initiallized | ||
| 53 | * with initstate(). By default, the package runs with 128 bytes of state | ||
| 54 | * information and generates far better random numbers than a linear | ||
| 55 | * congruential generator. If the amount of state information is less than | ||
| 56 | * 32 bytes, a simple linear congruential R.N.G. is used. | ||
| 57 | * | ||
| 58 | * Internally, the state information is treated as an array of int32_t; the | ||
| 59 | * zeroeth element of the array is the type of R.N.G. being used (small | ||
| 60 | * integer); the remainder of the array is the state information for the | ||
| 61 | * R.N.G. Thus, 32 bytes of state information will give 7 int32_ts worth of | ||
| 62 | * state information, which will allow a degree seven polynomial. (Note: | ||
| 63 | * the zeroeth word of state information also has some other information | ||
| 64 | * stored in it -- see setstate() for details). | ||
| 65 | * | ||
| 66 | * The random number generation technique is a linear feedback shift register | ||
| 67 | * approach, employing trinomials (since there are fewer terms to sum up that | ||
| 68 | * way). In this approach, the least significant bit of all the numbers in | ||
| 69 | * the state table will act as a linear feedback shift register, and will | ||
| 70 | * have period 2^deg - 1 (where deg is the degree of the polynomial being | ||
| 71 | * used, assuming that the polynomial is irreducible and primitive). The | ||
| 72 | * higher order bits will have longer periods, since their values are also | ||
| 73 | * influenced by pseudo-random carries out of the lower bits. The total | ||
| 74 | * period of the generator is approximately deg*(2**deg - 1); thus doubling | ||
| 75 | * the amount of state information has a vast influence on the period of the | ||
| 76 | * generator. Note: the deg*(2**deg - 1) is an approximation only good for | ||
| 77 | * large deg, when the period of the shift register is the dominant factor. | ||
| 78 | * With deg equal to seven, the period is actually much longer than the | ||
| 79 | * 7*(2**7 - 1) predicted by this formula. | ||
| 80 | */ | ||
| 81 | |||
| 82 | /* | ||
| 83 | * For each of the currently supported random number generators, we have a | ||
| 84 | * break value on the amount of state information (you need at least this | ||
| 85 | * many bytes of state info to support this random number generator), a degree | ||
| 86 | * for the polynomial (actually a trinomial) that the R.N.G. is based on, and | ||
| 87 | * the separation between the two lower order coefficients of the trinomial. | ||
| 88 | */ | ||
| 89 | #define TYPE_0 0 /* linear congruential */ | ||
| 90 | #define BREAK_0 8 | ||
| 91 | #define DEG_0 0 | ||
| 92 | #define SEP_0 0 | ||
| 93 | |||
| 94 | #define TYPE_1 1 /* x**7 + x**3 + 1 */ | ||
| 95 | #define BREAK_1 32 | ||
| 96 | #define DEG_1 7 | ||
| 97 | #define SEP_1 3 | ||
| 98 | |||
| 99 | #define TYPE_2 2 /* x**15 + x + 1 */ | ||
| 100 | #define BREAK_2 64 | ||
| 101 | #define DEG_2 15 | ||
| 102 | #define SEP_2 1 | ||
| 103 | |||
| 104 | #define TYPE_3 3 /* x**31 + x**3 + 1 */ | ||
| 105 | #define BREAK_3 128 | ||
| 106 | #define DEG_3 31 | ||
| 107 | #define SEP_3 3 | ||
| 108 | |||
| 109 | #define TYPE_4 4 /* x**63 + x + 1 */ | ||
| 110 | #define BREAK_4 256 | ||
| 111 | #define DEG_4 63 | ||
| 112 | #define SEP_4 1 | ||
| 113 | |||
| 114 | /* | ||
| 115 | * Array versions of the above information to make code run faster -- | ||
| 116 | * relies on fact that TYPE_i == i. | ||
| 117 | */ | ||
| 118 | #define MAX_TYPES 5 /* max number of types above */ | ||
| 119 | |||
| 120 | static int degrees[MAX_TYPES] = { DEG_0, DEG_1, DEG_2, DEG_3, DEG_4 }; | ||
| 121 | static int seps [MAX_TYPES] = { SEP_0, SEP_1, SEP_2, SEP_3, SEP_4 }; | ||
| 122 | |||
| 123 | /* | ||
| 124 | * Initially, everything is set up as if from: | ||
| 125 | * | ||
| 126 | * initstate(1, &randtbl, 128); | ||
| 127 | * | ||
| 128 | * Note that this initialization takes advantage of the fact that srandom() | ||
| 129 | * advances the front and rear pointers 10*rand_deg times, and hence the | ||
| 130 | * rear pointer which starts at 0 will also end up at zero; thus the zeroeth | ||
| 131 | * element of the state information, which contains info about the current | ||
| 132 | * position of the rear pointer is just | ||
| 133 | * | ||
| 134 | * MAX_TYPES * (rptr - state) + TYPE_3 == TYPE_3. | ||
| 135 | */ | ||
| 136 | |||
| 137 | static int32_t randtbl[DEG_3 + 1] = { | ||
| 138 | TYPE_3, | ||
| 139 | 0x991539b1, 0x16a5bce3, 0x6774a4cd, 0x3e01511e, 0x4e508aaa, 0x61048c05, | ||
| 140 | 0xf5500617, 0x846b7115, 0x6a19892c, 0x896a97af, 0xdb48f936, 0x14898454, | ||
| 141 | 0x37ffd106, 0xb58bff9c, 0x59e17104, 0xcf918a49, 0x09378c83, 0x52c7a471, | ||
| 142 | 0x8d293ea9, 0x1f4fc301, 0xc3db71be, 0x39b44e1c, 0xf8a44ef9, 0x4c8b80b1, | ||
| 143 | 0x19edc328, 0x87bf4bdd, 0xc9b240e5, 0xe9ee4b1b, 0x4382aee7, 0x535b6b41, | ||
| 144 | 0xf3bec5da, | ||
| 145 | }; | ||
| 146 | |||
| 147 | /* | ||
| 148 | * fptr and rptr are two pointers into the state info, a front and a rear | ||
| 149 | * pointer. These two pointers are always rand_sep places aparts, as they | ||
| 150 | * cycle cyclically through the state information. (Yes, this does mean we | ||
| 151 | * could get away with just one pointer, but the code for random() is more | ||
| 152 | * efficient this way). The pointers are left positioned as they would be | ||
| 153 | * from the call | ||
| 154 | * | ||
| 155 | * initstate(1, randtbl, 128); | ||
| 156 | * | ||
| 157 | * (The position of the rear pointer, rptr, is really 0 (as explained above | ||
| 158 | * in the initialization of randtbl) because the state table pointer is set | ||
| 159 | * to point to randtbl[1] (as explained below). | ||
| 160 | */ | ||
| 161 | static int32_t *fptr = &randtbl[SEP_3 + 1]; | ||
| 162 | static int32_t *rptr = &randtbl[1]; | ||
| 163 | |||
| 164 | /* | ||
| 165 | * The following things are the pointer to the state information table, the | ||
| 166 | * type of the current generator, the degree of the current polynomial being | ||
| 167 | * used, and the separation between the two pointers. Note that for efficiency | ||
| 168 | * of random(), we remember the first location of the state information, not | ||
| 169 | * the zeroeth. Hence it is valid to access state[-1], which is used to | ||
| 170 | * store the type of the R.N.G. Also, we remember the last location, since | ||
| 171 | * this is more efficient than indexing every time to find the address of | ||
| 172 | * the last element to see if the front and rear pointers have wrapped. | ||
| 173 | */ | ||
| 174 | static int32_t *state = &randtbl[1]; | ||
| 175 | static int32_t *end_ptr = &randtbl[DEG_3 + 1]; | ||
| 176 | static int rand_type = TYPE_3; | ||
| 177 | static int rand_deg = DEG_3; | ||
| 178 | static int rand_sep = SEP_3; | ||
| 179 | |||
| 180 | /* | ||
| 181 | * srandom: | ||
| 182 | * | ||
| 183 | * Initialize the random number generator based on the given seed. If the | ||
| 184 | * type is the trivial no-state-information type, just remember the seed. | ||
| 185 | * Otherwise, initializes state[] based on the given "seed" via a linear | ||
| 186 | * congruential generator. Then, the pointers are set to known locations | ||
| 187 | * that are exactly rand_sep places apart. Lastly, it cycles the state | ||
| 188 | * information a given number of times to get rid of any initial dependencies | ||
| 189 | * introduced by the L.C.R.N.G. Note that the initialization of randtbl[] | ||
| 190 | * for default usage relies on values produced by this routine. | ||
| 191 | */ | ||
| 192 | void | ||
| 193 | srandom(x) | ||
| 194 | unsigned int x; | ||
| 195 | { | ||
| 196 | int i; | ||
| 197 | int32_t test; | ||
| 198 | div_t val; | ||
| 199 | |||
| 200 | if (rand_type == TYPE_0) | ||
| 201 | state[0] = x; | ||
| 202 | else { | ||
| 203 | state[0] = x; | ||
| 204 | for (i = 1; i < rand_deg; i++) { | ||
| 205 | /* | ||
| 206 | * Implement the following, without overflowing 31 bits: | ||
| 207 | * | ||
| 208 | * state[i] = (16807 * state[i - 1]) % 2147483647; | ||
| 209 | * | ||
| 210 | * 2^31-1 (prime) = 2147483647 = 127773*16807+2836 | ||
| 211 | */ | ||
| 212 | val = div(state[i-1], 127773); | ||
| 213 | test = 16807 * val.rem - 2836 * val.quot; | ||
| 214 | state[i] = test + (test < 0 ? 2147483647 : 0); | ||
| 215 | } | ||
| 216 | fptr = &state[rand_sep]; | ||
| 217 | rptr = &state[0]; | ||
| 218 | for (i = 0; i < 10 * rand_deg; i++) | ||
| 219 | (void)random(); | ||
| 220 | } | ||
| 221 | } | ||
| 222 | |||
| 223 | /* | ||
| 224 | * srandomdev: | ||
| 225 | * | ||
| 226 | * Many programs choose the seed value in a totally predictable manner. | ||
| 227 | * This often causes problems. We seed the generator using the much more | ||
| 228 | * secure arandom(4) interface. Note that this particular seeding | ||
| 229 | * procedure can generate states which are impossible to reproduce by | ||
| 230 | * calling srandom() with any value, since the succeeding terms in the | ||
| 231 | * state buffer are no longer derived from the LC algorithm applied to | ||
| 232 | * a fixed seed. | ||
| 233 | */ | ||
| 234 | void | ||
| 235 | srandomdev() | ||
| 236 | { | ||
| 237 | int fd, i, mib[2], n; | ||
| 238 | size_t len; | ||
| 239 | |||
| 240 | if (rand_type == TYPE_0) | ||
| 241 | len = sizeof(state[0]); | ||
| 242 | else | ||
| 243 | len = rand_deg * sizeof(state[0]); | ||
| 244 | |||
| 245 | /* | ||
| 246 | * To get seed data, first try reading from /dev/arandom. | ||
| 247 | * If that fails, try the KERN_ARND sysctl() (one int at a time). | ||
| 248 | * As a last resort, call srandom(). | ||
| 249 | */ | ||
| 250 | if ((fd = open("/dev/arandom", O_RDONLY, 0)) != -1 && | ||
| 251 | read(fd, (void *) state, len) == (ssize_t) len) { | ||
| 252 | close(fd); | ||
| 253 | } else { | ||
| 254 | if (fd != -1) | ||
| 255 | close(fd); | ||
| 256 | mib[0] = CTL_KERN; | ||
| 257 | mib[1] = KERN_ARND; | ||
| 258 | n = len / sizeof(int); | ||
| 259 | len = sizeof(int); | ||
| 260 | for (i = 0; i < n; i++) { | ||
| 261 | if (sysctl(mib, 2, (char *)((int *)state + i), &len, | ||
| 262 | NULL, 0) == -1) | ||
| 263 | break; | ||
| 264 | } | ||
| 265 | if (i != n) { | ||
| 266 | struct timeval tv; | ||
| 267 | u_int junk; | ||
| 268 | |||
| 269 | /* XXX - this could be better */ | ||
| 270 | gettimeofday(&tv, NULL); | ||
| 271 | srandom(getpid() ^ tv.tv_sec ^ tv.tv_usec ^ junk); | ||
| 272 | return; | ||
| 273 | } | ||
| 274 | } | ||
| 275 | |||
| 276 | if (rand_type != TYPE_0) { | ||
| 277 | fptr = &state[rand_sep]; | ||
| 278 | rptr = &state[0]; | ||
| 279 | } | ||
| 280 | } | ||
| 281 | |||
| 282 | /* | ||
| 283 | * initstate: | ||
| 284 | * | ||
| 285 | * Initialize the state information in the given array of n bytes for future | ||
| 286 | * random number generation. Based on the number of bytes we are given, and | ||
| 287 | * the break values for the different R.N.G.'s, we choose the best (largest) | ||
| 288 | * one we can and set things up for it. srandom() is then called to | ||
| 289 | * initialize the state information. | ||
| 290 | * | ||
| 291 | * Note that on return from srandom(), we set state[-1] to be the type | ||
| 292 | * multiplexed with the current value of the rear pointer; this is so | ||
| 293 | * successive calls to initstate() won't lose this information and will be | ||
| 294 | * able to restart with setstate(). | ||
| 295 | * | ||
| 296 | * Note: the first thing we do is save the current state, if any, just like | ||
| 297 | * setstate() so that it doesn't matter when initstate is called. | ||
| 298 | * | ||
| 299 | * Returns a pointer to the old state. | ||
| 300 | */ | ||
| 301 | char * | ||
| 302 | initstate(seed, arg_state, n) | ||
| 303 | u_int seed; /* seed for R.N.G. */ | ||
| 304 | char *arg_state; /* pointer to state array */ | ||
| 305 | size_t n; /* # bytes of state info */ | ||
| 306 | { | ||
| 307 | char *ostate = (char *)(&state[-1]); | ||
| 308 | |||
| 309 | if (rand_type == TYPE_0) | ||
| 310 | state[-1] = rand_type; | ||
| 311 | else | ||
| 312 | state[-1] = MAX_TYPES * (rptr - state) + rand_type; | ||
| 313 | if (n < BREAK_0) | ||
| 314 | return(NULL); | ||
| 315 | if (n < BREAK_1) { | ||
| 316 | rand_type = TYPE_0; | ||
| 317 | rand_deg = DEG_0; | ||
| 318 | rand_sep = SEP_0; | ||
| 319 | } else if (n < BREAK_2) { | ||
| 320 | rand_type = TYPE_1; | ||
| 321 | rand_deg = DEG_1; | ||
| 322 | rand_sep = SEP_1; | ||
| 323 | } else if (n < BREAK_3) { | ||
| 324 | rand_type = TYPE_2; | ||
| 325 | rand_deg = DEG_2; | ||
| 326 | rand_sep = SEP_2; | ||
| 327 | } else if (n < BREAK_4) { | ||
| 328 | rand_type = TYPE_3; | ||
| 329 | rand_deg = DEG_3; | ||
| 330 | rand_sep = SEP_3; | ||
| 331 | } else { | ||
| 332 | rand_type = TYPE_4; | ||
| 333 | rand_deg = DEG_4; | ||
| 334 | rand_sep = SEP_4; | ||
| 335 | } | ||
| 336 | state = &(((int32_t *)arg_state)[1]); /* first location */ | ||
| 337 | end_ptr = &state[rand_deg]; /* must set end_ptr before srandom */ | ||
| 338 | srandom(seed); | ||
| 339 | if (rand_type == TYPE_0) | ||
| 340 | state[-1] = rand_type; | ||
| 341 | else | ||
| 342 | state[-1] = MAX_TYPES*(rptr - state) + rand_type; | ||
| 343 | return(ostate); | ||
| 344 | } | ||
| 345 | |||
| 346 | /* | ||
| 347 | * setstate: | ||
| 348 | * | ||
| 349 | * Restore the state from the given state array. | ||
| 350 | * | ||
| 351 | * Note: it is important that we also remember the locations of the pointers | ||
| 352 | * in the current state information, and restore the locations of the pointers | ||
| 353 | * from the old state information. This is done by multiplexing the pointer | ||
| 354 | * location into the zeroeth word of the state information. | ||
| 355 | * | ||
| 356 | * Note that due to the order in which things are done, it is OK to call | ||
| 357 | * setstate() with the same state as the current state. | ||
| 358 | * | ||
| 359 | * Returns a pointer to the old state information. | ||
| 360 | */ | ||
| 361 | char * | ||
| 362 | setstate(arg_state) | ||
| 363 | const char *arg_state; | ||
| 364 | { | ||
| 365 | int32_t *new_state = (int32_t *)arg_state; | ||
| 366 | int32_t type = new_state[0] % MAX_TYPES; | ||
| 367 | int32_t rear = new_state[0] / MAX_TYPES; | ||
| 368 | char *ostate = (char *)(&state[-1]); | ||
| 369 | |||
| 370 | if (rand_type == TYPE_0) | ||
| 371 | state[-1] = rand_type; | ||
| 372 | else | ||
| 373 | state[-1] = MAX_TYPES * (rptr - state) + rand_type; | ||
| 374 | switch(type) { | ||
| 375 | case TYPE_0: | ||
| 376 | case TYPE_1: | ||
| 377 | case TYPE_2: | ||
| 378 | case TYPE_3: | ||
| 379 | case TYPE_4: | ||
| 380 | rand_type = type; | ||
| 381 | rand_deg = degrees[type]; | ||
| 382 | rand_sep = seps[type]; | ||
| 383 | break; | ||
| 384 | default: | ||
| 385 | return(NULL); | ||
| 386 | } | ||
| 387 | state = &new_state[1]; | ||
| 388 | if (rand_type != TYPE_0) { | ||
| 389 | rptr = &state[rear]; | ||
| 390 | fptr = &state[(rear + rand_sep) % rand_deg]; | ||
| 391 | } | ||
| 392 | end_ptr = &state[rand_deg]; /* set end_ptr too */ | ||
| 393 | return(ostate); | ||
| 394 | } | ||
| 395 | |||
| 396 | /* | ||
| 397 | * random: | ||
| 398 | * | ||
| 399 | * If we are using the trivial TYPE_0 R.N.G., just do the old linear | ||
| 400 | * congruential bit. Otherwise, we do our fancy trinomial stuff, which is | ||
| 401 | * the same in all the other cases due to all the global variables that have | ||
| 402 | * been set up. The basic operation is to add the number at the rear pointer | ||
| 403 | * into the one at the front pointer. Then both pointers are advanced to | ||
| 404 | * the next location cyclically in the table. The value returned is the sum | ||
| 405 | * generated, reduced to 31 bits by throwing away the "least random" low bit. | ||
| 406 | * | ||
| 407 | * Note: the code takes advantage of the fact that both the front and | ||
| 408 | * rear pointers can't wrap on the same call by not testing the rear | ||
| 409 | * pointer if the front one has wrapped. | ||
| 410 | * | ||
| 411 | * Returns a 31-bit random number. | ||
| 412 | */ | ||
| 413 | long | ||
| 414 | random() | ||
| 415 | { | ||
| 416 | int32_t i; | ||
| 417 | |||
| 418 | if (rand_type == TYPE_0) | ||
| 419 | i = state[0] = (state[0] * 1103515245 + 12345) & 0x7fffffff; | ||
| 420 | else { | ||
| 421 | *fptr += *rptr; | ||
| 422 | i = (*fptr >> 1) & 0x7fffffff; /* chucking least random bit */ | ||
| 423 | if (++fptr >= end_ptr) { | ||
| 424 | fptr = state; | ||
| 425 | ++rptr; | ||
| 426 | } else if (++rptr >= end_ptr) | ||
| 427 | rptr = state; | ||
| 428 | } | ||
| 429 | return((long)i); | ||
| 430 | } | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/realpath.3 b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/realpath.3 new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b8093b51e1 --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/realpath.3 | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,120 @@ | |||
| 1 | .\" Copyright (c) 1994 | ||
| 2 | .\" The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved. | ||
| 3 | .\" | ||
| 4 | .\" This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by | ||
| 5 | .\" Jan-Simon Pendry. | ||
| 6 | .\" | ||
| 7 | .\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without | ||
| 8 | .\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions | ||
| 9 | .\" are met: | ||
| 10 | .\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright | ||
| 11 | .\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. | ||
| 12 | .\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright | ||
| 13 | .\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the | ||
| 14 | .\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. | ||
| 15 | .\" 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors | ||
| 16 | .\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software | ||
| 17 | .\" without specific prior written permission. | ||
| 18 | .\" | ||
| 19 | .\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND | ||
| 20 | .\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE | ||
| 21 | .\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE | ||
| 22 | .\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE | ||
| 23 | .\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL | ||
| 24 | .\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS | ||
| 25 | .\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) | ||
| 26 | .\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT | ||
| 27 | .\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY | ||
| 28 | .\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF | ||
| 29 | .\" SUCH DAMAGE. | ||
| 30 | .\" | ||
| 31 | .\" $OpenBSD: realpath.3,v 1.10 2003/06/02 20:18:38 millert Exp $ | ||
| 32 | .\" | ||
| 33 | .Dd February 16, 1994 | ||
| 34 | .Dt REALPATH 3 | ||
| 35 | .Os | ||
| 36 | .Sh NAME | ||
| 37 | .Nm realpath | ||
| 38 | .Nd returns the canonicalized absolute pathname | ||
| 39 | .Sh SYNOPSIS | ||
| 40 | .Fd #include <sys/param.h> | ||
| 41 | .Fd #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 42 | .Ft "char *" | ||
| 43 | .Fn realpath "const char *pathname" "char resolvedname[MAXPATHLEN]" | ||
| 44 | .Sh DESCRIPTION | ||
| 45 | The | ||
| 46 | .Fn realpath | ||
| 47 | function resolves all symbolic links, extra | ||
| 48 | .Dq / | ||
| 49 | characters and references to | ||
| 50 | .Pa /./ | ||
| 51 | and | ||
| 52 | .Pa /../ | ||
| 53 | in | ||
| 54 | .Fa pathname , | ||
| 55 | and copies the resulting absolute pathname into the memory referenced by | ||
| 56 | .Fa resolvedname . | ||
| 57 | The | ||
| 58 | .Fa resolvedname | ||
| 59 | argument | ||
| 60 | .Em must | ||
| 61 | refer to a buffer capable of storing at least | ||
| 62 | .Dv MAXPATHLEN | ||
| 63 | characters. | ||
| 64 | .Pp | ||
| 65 | The | ||
| 66 | .Fn realpath | ||
| 67 | function will resolve both absolute and relative paths | ||
| 68 | and return the absolute pathname corresponding to | ||
| 69 | .Fa pathname . | ||
| 70 | All but the last component of | ||
| 71 | .Fa pathname | ||
| 72 | must exist when | ||
| 73 | .Fn realpath | ||
| 74 | is called. | ||
| 75 | .Sh RETURN VALUES | ||
| 76 | The | ||
| 77 | .Fn realpath | ||
| 78 | function returns | ||
| 79 | .Fa resolvedname | ||
| 80 | on success. | ||
| 81 | If an error occurs, | ||
| 82 | .Fn realpath | ||
| 83 | returns | ||
| 84 | .Dv NULL , | ||
| 85 | and | ||
| 86 | .Fa resolvedname | ||
| 87 | contains the pathname which caused the problem. | ||
| 88 | .Sh ERRORS | ||
| 89 | The function | ||
| 90 | .Fn realpath | ||
| 91 | may fail and set the external variable | ||
| 92 | .Va errno | ||
| 93 | for any of the errors specified for the library functions | ||
| 94 | .Xr chdir 2 , | ||
| 95 | .Xr close 2 , | ||
| 96 | .Xr fchdir 2 , | ||
| 97 | .Xr lstat 2 , | ||
| 98 | .Xr open 2 , | ||
| 99 | .Xr readlink 2 , | ||
| 100 | and | ||
| 101 | .Xr getcwd 3 . | ||
| 102 | .Sh SEE ALSO | ||
| 103 | .Xr getcwd 3 | ||
| 104 | .Sh HISTORY | ||
| 105 | The | ||
| 106 | .Fn realpath | ||
| 107 | function call first appeared in | ||
| 108 | .Bx 4.4 . | ||
| 109 | .Sh CAVEATS | ||
| 110 | This implementation of | ||
| 111 | .Fn realpath | ||
| 112 | differs slightly from the Solaris implementation. | ||
| 113 | The | ||
| 114 | .Bx 4.4 | ||
| 115 | version always returns absolute pathnames, | ||
| 116 | whereas the Solaris implementation will, | ||
| 117 | under certain circumstances, return a relative | ||
| 118 | .Fa resolvedname | ||
| 119 | when given a relative | ||
| 120 | .Fa pathname . | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/realpath.c b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/realpath.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..1525d0372f --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/realpath.c | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,162 @@ | |||
| 1 | /* | ||
| 2 | * Copyright (c) 1994 | ||
| 3 | * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved. | ||
| 4 | * | ||
| 5 | * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by | ||
| 6 | * Jan-Simon Pendry. | ||
| 7 | * | ||
| 8 | * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without | ||
| 9 | * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions | ||
| 10 | * are met: | ||
| 11 | * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright | ||
| 12 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. | ||
| 13 | * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright | ||
| 14 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the | ||
| 15 | * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. | ||
| 16 | * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors | ||
| 17 | * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software | ||
| 18 | * without specific prior written permission. | ||
| 19 | * | ||
| 20 | * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND | ||
| 21 | * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE | ||
| 22 | * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE | ||
| 23 | * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE | ||
| 24 | * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL | ||
| 25 | * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS | ||
| 26 | * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) | ||
| 27 | * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT | ||
| 28 | * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY | ||
| 29 | * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF | ||
| 30 | * SUCH DAMAGE. | ||
| 31 | */ | ||
| 32 | |||
| 33 | #if defined(LIBC_SCCS) && !defined(lint) | ||
| 34 | static char *rcsid = "$OpenBSD: realpath.c,v 1.10 2003/08/01 21:04:59 millert Exp $"; | ||
| 35 | #endif /* LIBC_SCCS and not lint */ | ||
| 36 | |||
| 37 | #include <sys/param.h> | ||
| 38 | #include <sys/stat.h> | ||
| 39 | |||
| 40 | #include <errno.h> | ||
| 41 | #include <fcntl.h> | ||
| 42 | #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 43 | #include <string.h> | ||
| 44 | #include <unistd.h> | ||
| 45 | |||
| 46 | /* | ||
| 47 | * char *realpath(const char *path, char resolved_path[MAXPATHLEN]); | ||
| 48 | * | ||
| 49 | * Find the real name of path, by removing all ".", ".." and symlink | ||
| 50 | * components. Returns (resolved) on success, or (NULL) on failure, | ||
| 51 | * in which case the path which caused trouble is left in (resolved). | ||
| 52 | */ | ||
| 53 | char * | ||
| 54 | realpath(path, resolved) | ||
| 55 | const char *path; | ||
| 56 | char *resolved; | ||
| 57 | { | ||
| 58 | struct stat sb; | ||
| 59 | int fd, n, needslash, serrno; | ||
| 60 | char *p, *q, wbuf[MAXPATHLEN]; | ||
| 61 | int symlinks = 0; | ||
| 62 | |||
| 63 | /* Save the starting point. */ | ||
| 64 | if ((fd = open(".", O_RDONLY)) < 0) { | ||
| 65 | (void)strlcpy(resolved, ".", MAXPATHLEN); | ||
| 66 | return (NULL); | ||
| 67 | } | ||
| 68 | |||
| 69 | /* Convert "." -> "" to optimize away a needless lstat() and chdir() */ | ||
| 70 | if (path[0] == '.' && path[1] == '\0') | ||
| 71 | path = ""; | ||
| 72 | |||
| 73 | /* | ||
| 74 | * Find the dirname and basename from the path to be resolved. | ||
| 75 | * Change directory to the dirname component. | ||
| 76 | * lstat the basename part. | ||
| 77 | * if it is a symlink, read in the value and loop. | ||
| 78 | * if it is a directory, then change to that directory. | ||
| 79 | * get the current directory name and append the basename. | ||
| 80 | */ | ||
| 81 | strlcpy(resolved, path, MAXPATHLEN); | ||
| 82 | loop: | ||
| 83 | q = strrchr(resolved, '/'); | ||
| 84 | if (q != NULL) { | ||
| 85 | p = q + 1; | ||
| 86 | if (q == resolved) | ||
| 87 | q = "/"; | ||
| 88 | else { | ||
| 89 | do { | ||
| 90 | --q; | ||
| 91 | } while (q > resolved && *q == '/'); | ||
| 92 | q[1] = '\0'; | ||
| 93 | q = resolved; | ||
| 94 | } | ||
| 95 | if (chdir(q) < 0) | ||
| 96 | goto err1; | ||
| 97 | } else | ||
| 98 | p = resolved; | ||
| 99 | |||
| 100 | /* Deal with the last component. */ | ||
| 101 | if (*p != '\0' && lstat(p, &sb) == 0) { | ||
| 102 | if (S_ISLNK(sb.st_mode)) { | ||
| 103 | if (++symlinks > MAXSYMLINKS) { | ||
| 104 | errno = ELOOP; | ||
| 105 | goto err1; | ||
| 106 | } | ||
| 107 | n = readlink(p, resolved, MAXPATHLEN-1); | ||
| 108 | if (n < 0) | ||
| 109 | goto err1; | ||
| 110 | resolved[n] = '\0'; | ||
| 111 | goto loop; | ||
| 112 | } | ||
| 113 | if (S_ISDIR(sb.st_mode)) { | ||
| 114 | if (chdir(p) < 0) | ||
| 115 | goto err1; | ||
| 116 | p = ""; | ||
| 117 | } | ||
| 118 | } | ||
| 119 | |||
| 120 | /* | ||
| 121 | * Save the last component name and get the full pathname of | ||
| 122 | * the current directory. | ||
| 123 | */ | ||
| 124 | (void)strlcpy(wbuf, p, sizeof wbuf); | ||
| 125 | if (getcwd(resolved, MAXPATHLEN) == 0) | ||
| 126 | goto err1; | ||
| 127 | |||
| 128 | /* | ||
| 129 | * Join the two strings together, ensuring that the right thing | ||
| 130 | * happens if the last component is empty, or the dirname is root. | ||
| 131 | */ | ||
| 132 | if (resolved[0] == '/' && resolved[1] == '\0') | ||
| 133 | needslash = 0; | ||
| 134 | else | ||
| 135 | needslash = 1; | ||
| 136 | |||
| 137 | if (*wbuf) { | ||
| 138 | if (strlen(resolved) + strlen(wbuf) + needslash >= MAXPATHLEN) { | ||
| 139 | errno = ENAMETOOLONG; | ||
| 140 | goto err1; | ||
| 141 | } | ||
| 142 | if (needslash) | ||
| 143 | strlcat(resolved, "/", MAXPATHLEN); | ||
| 144 | strlcat(resolved, wbuf, MAXPATHLEN); | ||
| 145 | } | ||
| 146 | |||
| 147 | /* Go back to where we came from. */ | ||
| 148 | if (fchdir(fd) < 0) { | ||
| 149 | serrno = errno; | ||
| 150 | goto err2; | ||
| 151 | } | ||
| 152 | |||
| 153 | /* It's okay if the close fails, what's an fd more or less? */ | ||
| 154 | (void)close(fd); | ||
| 155 | return (resolved); | ||
| 156 | |||
| 157 | err1: serrno = errno; | ||
| 158 | (void)fchdir(fd); | ||
| 159 | err2: (void)close(fd); | ||
| 160 | errno = serrno; | ||
| 161 | return (NULL); | ||
| 162 | } | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/remque.c b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/remque.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f4c5769a8c --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/remque.c | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,48 @@ | |||
| 1 | /* $OpenBSD: remque.c,v 1.1 2003/05/08 23:26:30 millert Exp $ */ | ||
| 2 | |||
| 3 | /* | ||
| 4 | * Copyright (c) 1993 John Brezak | ||
| 5 | * All rights reserved. | ||
| 6 | * | ||
| 7 | * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without | ||
| 8 | * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions | ||
| 9 | * are met: | ||
| 10 | * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright | ||
| 11 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. | ||
| 12 | * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright | ||
| 13 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the | ||
| 14 | * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. | ||
| 15 | * 3. The name of the author may be used to endorse or promote products | ||
| 16 | * derived from this software without specific prior written permission. | ||
| 17 | * | ||
| 18 | * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE AUTHOR `AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR | ||
| 19 | * IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED | ||
| 20 | * WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE | ||
| 21 | * DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, | ||
| 22 | * INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES | ||
| 23 | * (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR | ||
| 24 | * SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) | ||
| 25 | * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, | ||
| 26 | * STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN | ||
| 27 | * ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE | ||
| 28 | * POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. | ||
| 29 | */ | ||
| 30 | |||
| 31 | #if defined(LIBC_SCCS) && !defined(lint) | ||
| 32 | static char *rcsid = "$OpenBSD: remque.c,v 1.1 2003/05/08 23:26:30 millert Exp $"; | ||
| 33 | #endif /* LIBC_SCCS and not lint */ | ||
| 34 | |||
| 35 | #include <search.h> | ||
| 36 | |||
| 37 | struct qelem { | ||
| 38 | struct qelem *q_forw; | ||
| 39 | struct qelem *q_back; | ||
| 40 | }; | ||
| 41 | |||
| 42 | void | ||
| 43 | remque(void *element) | ||
| 44 | { | ||
| 45 | struct qelem *e = (struct qelem *) element; | ||
| 46 | e->q_forw->q_back = e->q_back; | ||
| 47 | e->q_back->q_forw = e->q_forw; | ||
| 48 | } | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/seed48.c b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/seed48.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..c4dcd0ead8 --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/seed48.c | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,40 @@ | |||
| 1 | /* | ||
| 2 | * Copyright (c) 1993 Martin Birgmeier | ||
| 3 | * All rights reserved. | ||
| 4 | * | ||
| 5 | * You may redistribute unmodified or modified versions of this source | ||
| 6 | * code provided that the above copyright notice and this and the | ||
| 7 | * following conditions are retained. | ||
| 8 | * | ||
| 9 | * This software is provided ``as is'', and comes with no warranties | ||
| 10 | * of any kind. I shall in no event be liable for anything that happens | ||
| 11 | * to anyone/anything when using this software. | ||
| 12 | */ | ||
| 13 | |||
| 14 | #if defined(LIBC_SCCS) && !defined(lint) | ||
| 15 | static char rcsid[] = "$OpenBSD: seed48.c,v 1.2 1996/08/19 08:33:48 tholo Exp $"; | ||
| 16 | #endif /* LIBC_SCCS and not lint */ | ||
| 17 | |||
| 18 | #include "rand48.h" | ||
| 19 | |||
| 20 | extern unsigned short __rand48_seed[3]; | ||
| 21 | extern unsigned short __rand48_mult[3]; | ||
| 22 | extern unsigned short __rand48_add; | ||
| 23 | |||
| 24 | unsigned short * | ||
| 25 | seed48(unsigned short xseed[3]) | ||
| 26 | { | ||
| 27 | static unsigned short sseed[3]; | ||
| 28 | |||
| 29 | sseed[0] = __rand48_seed[0]; | ||
| 30 | sseed[1] = __rand48_seed[1]; | ||
| 31 | sseed[2] = __rand48_seed[2]; | ||
| 32 | __rand48_seed[0] = xseed[0]; | ||
| 33 | __rand48_seed[1] = xseed[1]; | ||
| 34 | __rand48_seed[2] = xseed[2]; | ||
| 35 | __rand48_mult[0] = RAND48_MULT_0; | ||
| 36 | __rand48_mult[1] = RAND48_MULT_1; | ||
| 37 | __rand48_mult[2] = RAND48_MULT_2; | ||
| 38 | __rand48_add = RAND48_ADD; | ||
| 39 | return sseed; | ||
| 40 | } | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/setenv.c b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/setenv.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..2ba072b65c --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/setenv.c | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,118 @@ | |||
| 1 | /* | ||
| 2 | * Copyright (c) 1987 Regents of the University of California. | ||
| 3 | * All rights reserved. | ||
| 4 | * | ||
| 5 | * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without | ||
| 6 | * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions | ||
| 7 | * are met: | ||
| 8 | * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright | ||
| 9 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. | ||
| 10 | * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright | ||
| 11 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the | ||
| 12 | * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. | ||
| 13 | * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors | ||
| 14 | * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software | ||
| 15 | * without specific prior written permission. | ||
| 16 | * | ||
| 17 | * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND | ||
| 18 | * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE | ||
| 19 | * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE | ||
| 20 | * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE | ||
| 21 | * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL | ||
| 22 | * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS | ||
| 23 | * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) | ||
| 24 | * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT | ||
| 25 | * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY | ||
| 26 | * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF | ||
| 27 | * SUCH DAMAGE. | ||
| 28 | */ | ||
| 29 | |||
| 30 | #if defined(LIBC_SCCS) && !defined(lint) | ||
| 31 | static char *rcsid = "$OpenBSD: setenv.c,v 1.6 2003/06/02 20:18:38 millert Exp $"; | ||
| 32 | #endif /* LIBC_SCCS and not lint */ | ||
| 33 | |||
| 34 | #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 35 | #include <string.h> | ||
| 36 | |||
| 37 | char *__findenv(const char *name, int *offset); | ||
| 38 | |||
| 39 | /* | ||
| 40 | * setenv -- | ||
| 41 | * Set the value of the environmental variable "name" to be | ||
| 42 | * "value". If rewrite is set, replace any current value. | ||
| 43 | */ | ||
| 44 | int | ||
| 45 | setenv(name, value, rewrite) | ||
| 46 | register const char *name; | ||
| 47 | register const char *value; | ||
| 48 | int rewrite; | ||
| 49 | { | ||
| 50 | extern char **environ; | ||
| 51 | static int alloced; /* if allocated space before */ | ||
| 52 | register char *C; | ||
| 53 | int l_value, offset; | ||
| 54 | |||
| 55 | if (*value == '=') /* no `=' in value */ | ||
| 56 | ++value; | ||
| 57 | l_value = strlen(value); | ||
| 58 | if ((C = __findenv(name, &offset))) { /* find if already exists */ | ||
| 59 | if (!rewrite) | ||
| 60 | return (0); | ||
| 61 | if (strlen(C) >= l_value) { /* old larger; copy over */ | ||
| 62 | while ((*C++ = *value++)) | ||
| 63 | ; | ||
| 64 | return (0); | ||
| 65 | } | ||
| 66 | } else { /* create new slot */ | ||
| 67 | register int cnt; | ||
| 68 | register char **P; | ||
| 69 | |||
| 70 | for (P = environ, cnt = 0; *P; ++P, ++cnt); | ||
| 71 | if (alloced) { /* just increase size */ | ||
| 72 | P = (char **)realloc((void *)environ, | ||
| 73 | (size_t)(sizeof(char *) * (cnt + 2))); | ||
| 74 | if (!P) | ||
| 75 | return (-1); | ||
| 76 | environ = P; | ||
| 77 | } | ||
| 78 | else { /* get new space */ | ||
| 79 | alloced = 1; /* copy old entries into it */ | ||
| 80 | P = (char **)malloc((size_t)(sizeof(char *) * | ||
| 81 | (cnt + 2))); | ||
| 82 | if (!P) | ||
| 83 | return (-1); | ||
| 84 | bcopy(environ, P, cnt * sizeof(char *)); | ||
| 85 | environ = P; | ||
| 86 | } | ||
| 87 | environ[cnt + 1] = NULL; | ||
| 88 | offset = cnt; | ||
| 89 | } | ||
| 90 | for (C = (char *)name; *C && *C != '='; ++C); /* no `=' in name */ | ||
| 91 | if (!(environ[offset] = /* name + `=' + value */ | ||
| 92 | malloc((size_t)((int)(C - name) + l_value + 2)))) | ||
| 93 | return (-1); | ||
| 94 | for (C = environ[offset]; (*C = *name++) && *C != '='; ++C) | ||
| 95 | ; | ||
| 96 | for (*C++ = '='; (*C++ = *value++); ) | ||
| 97 | ; | ||
| 98 | return (0); | ||
| 99 | } | ||
| 100 | |||
| 101 | /* | ||
| 102 | * unsetenv(name) -- | ||
| 103 | * Delete environmental variable "name". | ||
| 104 | */ | ||
| 105 | void | ||
| 106 | unsetenv(name) | ||
| 107 | const char *name; | ||
| 108 | { | ||
| 109 | extern char **environ; | ||
| 110 | register char **P; | ||
| 111 | int offset; | ||
| 112 | char *__findenv(); | ||
| 113 | |||
| 114 | while (__findenv(name, &offset)) /* if set multiple times */ | ||
| 115 | for (P = &environ[offset];; ++P) | ||
| 116 | if (!(*P = *(P + 1))) | ||
| 117 | break; | ||
| 118 | } | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/srand48.c b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/srand48.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..fcff8a172e --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/srand48.c | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,34 @@ | |||
| 1 | /* | ||
| 2 | * Copyright (c) 1993 Martin Birgmeier | ||
| 3 | * All rights reserved. | ||
| 4 | * | ||
| 5 | * You may redistribute unmodified or modified versions of this source | ||
| 6 | * code provided that the above copyright notice and this and the | ||
| 7 | * following conditions are retained. | ||
| 8 | * | ||
| 9 | * This software is provided ``as is'', and comes with no warranties | ||
| 10 | * of any kind. I shall in no event be liable for anything that happens | ||
| 11 | * to anyone/anything when using this software. | ||
| 12 | */ | ||
| 13 | |||
| 14 | #if defined(LIBC_SCCS) && !defined(lint) | ||
| 15 | static char rcsid[] = "$OpenBSD: srand48.c,v 1.2 1996/08/19 08:33:49 tholo Exp $"; | ||
| 16 | #endif /* LIBC_SCCS and not lint */ | ||
| 17 | |||
| 18 | #include "rand48.h" | ||
| 19 | |||
| 20 | extern unsigned short __rand48_seed[3]; | ||
| 21 | extern unsigned short __rand48_mult[3]; | ||
| 22 | extern unsigned short __rand48_add; | ||
| 23 | |||
| 24 | void | ||
| 25 | srand48(long seed) | ||
| 26 | { | ||
| 27 | __rand48_seed[0] = RAND48_SEED_0; | ||
| 28 | __rand48_seed[1] = (unsigned short) seed; | ||
| 29 | __rand48_seed[2] = (unsigned short) (seed >> 16); | ||
| 30 | __rand48_mult[0] = RAND48_MULT_0; | ||
| 31 | __rand48_mult[1] = RAND48_MULT_1; | ||
| 32 | __rand48_mult[2] = RAND48_MULT_2; | ||
| 33 | __rand48_add = RAND48_ADD; | ||
| 34 | } | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/strtod.3 b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/strtod.3 new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..e25b0a5511 --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/strtod.3 | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,113 @@ | |||
| 1 | .\" Copyright (c) 1990, 1991 The Regents of the University of California. | ||
| 2 | .\" All rights reserved. | ||
| 3 | .\" | ||
| 4 | .\" This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by | ||
| 5 | .\" the American National Standards Committee X3, on Information | ||
| 6 | .\" Processing Systems. | ||
| 7 | .\" | ||
| 8 | .\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without | ||
| 9 | .\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions | ||
| 10 | .\" are met: | ||
| 11 | .\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright | ||
| 12 | .\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. | ||
| 13 | .\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright | ||
| 14 | .\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the | ||
| 15 | .\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. | ||
| 16 | .\" 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors | ||
| 17 | .\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software | ||
| 18 | .\" without specific prior written permission. | ||
| 19 | .\" | ||
| 20 | .\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND | ||
| 21 | .\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE | ||
| 22 | .\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE | ||
| 23 | .\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE | ||
| 24 | .\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL | ||
| 25 | .\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS | ||
| 26 | .\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) | ||
| 27 | .\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT | ||
| 28 | .\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY | ||
| 29 | .\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF | ||
| 30 | .\" SUCH DAMAGE. | ||
| 31 | .\" | ||
| 32 | .\" $OpenBSD: strtod.3,v 1.8 2003/06/02 20:18:38 millert Exp $ | ||
| 33 | .\" | ||
| 34 | .Dd June 29, 1991 | ||
| 35 | .Dt STRTOD 3 | ||
| 36 | .Os | ||
| 37 | .Sh NAME | ||
| 38 | .Nm strtod | ||
| 39 | .Nd convert | ||
| 40 | .Tn ASCII | ||
| 41 | string to double | ||
| 42 | .Sh SYNOPSIS | ||
| 43 | .Fd #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 44 | .Ft double | ||
| 45 | .Fn strtod "const char *nptr" "char **endptr" | ||
| 46 | .Sh DESCRIPTION | ||
| 47 | The | ||
| 48 | .Fn strtod | ||
| 49 | function converts the initial portion of the string pointed to by | ||
| 50 | .Fa nptr | ||
| 51 | to | ||
| 52 | .Li double | ||
| 53 | representation. | ||
| 54 | .Pp | ||
| 55 | The expected form of the string is an optional plus | ||
| 56 | .Pq Ql + | ||
| 57 | or minus sign | ||
| 58 | .Pq Ql - | ||
| 59 | followed by a sequence of digits optionally containing | ||
| 60 | a decimal-point character, optionally followed by an exponent. | ||
| 61 | An exponent consists of an | ||
| 62 | .Sq E | ||
| 63 | or | ||
| 64 | .Sq e , | ||
| 65 | followed by an optional plus or minus sign, followed by a sequence of digits. | ||
| 66 | .Pp | ||
| 67 | Leading whitespace characters in the string (as defined by the | ||
| 68 | .Xr isspace 3 | ||
| 69 | function) are skipped. | ||
| 70 | .Sh RETURN VALUES | ||
| 71 | The | ||
| 72 | .Fn strtod | ||
| 73 | function returns the converted value, if any. | ||
| 74 | .Pp | ||
| 75 | If | ||
| 76 | .Fa endptr | ||
| 77 | is not | ||
| 78 | .Dv NULL , | ||
| 79 | a pointer to the character after the last character used | ||
| 80 | in the conversion is stored in the location referenced by | ||
| 81 | .Fa endptr . | ||
| 82 | .Pp | ||
| 83 | If no conversion is performed, zero is returned and the value of | ||
| 84 | .Fa nptr | ||
| 85 | is stored in the location referenced by | ||
| 86 | .Fa endptr . | ||
| 87 | .Pp | ||
| 88 | If the correct value would cause overflow, plus or minus | ||
| 89 | .Dv HUGE_VAL | ||
| 90 | is returned (according to the sign of the value), and | ||
| 91 | .Er ERANGE | ||
| 92 | is stored in | ||
| 93 | .Va errno . | ||
| 94 | If the correct value would cause underflow, zero is returned and | ||
| 95 | .Er ERANGE | ||
| 96 | is stored in | ||
| 97 | .Va errno . | ||
| 98 | .Sh ERRORS | ||
| 99 | .Bl -tag -width Er | ||
| 100 | .It Bq Er ERANGE | ||
| 101 | Overflow or underflow occurred. | ||
| 102 | .El | ||
| 103 | .Sh SEE ALSO | ||
| 104 | .Xr atof 3 , | ||
| 105 | .Xr atoi 3 , | ||
| 106 | .Xr atol 3 , | ||
| 107 | .Xr strtol 3 , | ||
| 108 | .Xr strtoul 3 | ||
| 109 | .Sh STANDARDS | ||
| 110 | The | ||
| 111 | .Fn strtod | ||
| 112 | function conforms to | ||
| 113 | .St -ansiC . | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/strtod.c b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/strtod.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..8e839d6155 --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/strtod.c | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,2529 @@ | |||
| 1 | /**************************************************************** | ||
| 2 | * | ||
| 3 | * The author of this software is David M. Gay. | ||
| 4 | * | ||
| 5 | * Copyright (c) 1991 by AT&T. | ||
| 6 | * | ||
| 7 | * Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software for any | ||
| 8 | * purpose without fee is hereby granted, provided that this entire notice | ||
| 9 | * is included in all copies of any software which is or includes a copy | ||
| 10 | * or modification of this software and in all copies of the supporting | ||
| 11 | * documentation for such software. | ||
| 12 | * | ||
| 13 | * THIS SOFTWARE IS BEING PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED | ||
| 14 | * WARRANTY. IN PARTICULAR, NEITHER THE AUTHOR NOR AT&T MAKES ANY | ||
| 15 | * REPRESENTATION OR WARRANTY OF ANY KIND CONCERNING THE MERCHANTABILITY | ||
| 16 | * OF THIS SOFTWARE OR ITS FITNESS FOR ANY PARTICULAR PURPOSE. | ||
| 17 | * | ||
| 18 | ***************************************************************/ | ||
| 19 | |||
| 20 | /* Please send bug reports to | ||
| 21 | David M. Gay | ||
| 22 | AT&T Bell Laboratories, Room 2C-463 | ||
| 23 | 600 Mountain Avenue | ||
| 24 | Murray Hill, NJ 07974-2070 | ||
| 25 | U.S.A. | ||
| 26 | dmg@research.att.com or research!dmg | ||
| 27 | */ | ||
| 28 | |||
| 29 | /* strtod for IEEE-, VAX-, and IBM-arithmetic machines. | ||
| 30 | * | ||
| 31 | * This strtod returns a nearest machine number to the input decimal | ||
| 32 | * string (or sets errno to ERANGE). With IEEE arithmetic, ties are | ||
| 33 | * broken by the IEEE round-even rule. Otherwise ties are broken by | ||
| 34 | * biased rounding (add half and chop). | ||
| 35 | * | ||
| 36 | * Inspired loosely by William D. Clinger's paper "How to Read Floating | ||
| 37 | * Point Numbers Accurately" [Proc. ACM SIGPLAN '90, pp. 92-101]. | ||
| 38 | * | ||
| 39 | * Modifications: | ||
| 40 | * | ||
| 41 | * 1. We only require IEEE, IBM, or VAX double-precision | ||
| 42 | * arithmetic (not IEEE double-extended). | ||
| 43 | * 2. We get by with floating-point arithmetic in a case that | ||
| 44 | * Clinger missed -- when we're computing d * 10^n | ||
| 45 | * for a small integer d and the integer n is not too | ||
| 46 | * much larger than 22 (the maximum integer k for which | ||
| 47 | * we can represent 10^k exactly), we may be able to | ||
| 48 | * compute (d*10^k) * 10^(e-k) with just one roundoff. | ||
| 49 | * 3. Rather than a bit-at-a-time adjustment of the binary | ||
| 50 | * result in the hard case, we use floating-point | ||
| 51 | * arithmetic to determine the adjustment to within | ||
| 52 | * one bit; only in really hard cases do we need to | ||
| 53 | * compute a second residual. | ||
| 54 | * 4. Because of 3., we don't need a large table of powers of 10 | ||
| 55 | * for ten-to-e (just some small tables, e.g. of 10^k | ||
| 56 | * for 0 <= k <= 22). | ||
| 57 | */ | ||
| 58 | |||
| 59 | /* | ||
| 60 | * #define IEEE_LITTLE_ENDIAN for IEEE-arithmetic machines where the least | ||
| 61 | * significant byte has the lowest address. | ||
| 62 | * #define IEEE_BIG_ENDIAN for IEEE-arithmetic machines where the most | ||
| 63 | * significant byte has the lowest address. | ||
| 64 | * #define Long int on machines with 32-bit ints and 64-bit longs. | ||
| 65 | * #define Sudden_Underflow for IEEE-format machines without gradual | ||
| 66 | * underflow (i.e., that flush to zero on underflow). | ||
| 67 | * #define IBM for IBM mainframe-style floating-point arithmetic. | ||
| 68 | * #define VAX for VAX-style floating-point arithmetic. | ||
| 69 | * #define Unsigned_Shifts if >> does treats its left operand as unsigned. | ||
| 70 | * #define No_leftright to omit left-right logic in fast floating-point | ||
| 71 | * computation of dtoa. | ||
| 72 | * #define Check_FLT_ROUNDS if FLT_ROUNDS can assume the values 2 or 3. | ||
| 73 | * #define RND_PRODQUOT to use rnd_prod and rnd_quot (assembly routines | ||
| 74 | * that use extended-precision instructions to compute rounded | ||
| 75 | * products and quotients) with IBM. | ||
| 76 | * #define ROUND_BIASED for IEEE-format with biased rounding. | ||
| 77 | * #define Inaccurate_Divide for IEEE-format with correctly rounded | ||
| 78 | * products but inaccurate quotients, e.g., for Intel i860. | ||
| 79 | * #define Just_16 to store 16 bits per 32-bit Long when doing high-precision | ||
| 80 | * integer arithmetic. Whether this speeds things up or slows things | ||
| 81 | * down depends on the machine and the number being converted. | ||
| 82 | * #define KR_headers for old-style C function headers. | ||
| 83 | * #define Bad_float_h if your system lacks a float.h or if it does not | ||
| 84 | * define some or all of DBL_DIG, DBL_MAX_10_EXP, DBL_MAX_EXP, | ||
| 85 | * FLT_RADIX, FLT_ROUNDS, and DBL_MAX. | ||
| 86 | * #define MALLOC your_malloc, where your_malloc(n) acts like malloc(n) | ||
| 87 | * if memory is available and otherwise does something you deem | ||
| 88 | * appropriate. If MALLOC is undefined, malloc will be invoked | ||
| 89 | * directly -- and assumed always to succeed. | ||
| 90 | */ | ||
| 91 | |||
| 92 | #if defined(LIBC_SCCS) && !defined(lint) | ||
| 93 | static char *rcsid = "$OpenBSD: strtod.c,v 1.19 2004/02/03 16:52:11 drahn Exp $"; | ||
| 94 | #endif /* LIBC_SCCS and not lint */ | ||
| 95 | |||
| 96 | #if defined(__m68k__) || defined(__sparc__) || defined(__i386__) || \ | ||
| 97 | defined(__mips__) || defined(__ns32k__) || defined(__alpha__) || \ | ||
| 98 | defined(__powerpc__) || defined(__m88k__) || defined(__hppa__) || \ | ||
| 99 | defined(__x86_64__) || (defined(__arm__) && defined(__VFP_FP__)) | ||
| 100 | #include <sys/types.h> | ||
| 101 | #if BYTE_ORDER == BIG_ENDIAN | ||
| 102 | #define IEEE_BIG_ENDIAN | ||
| 103 | #else | ||
| 104 | #define IEEE_LITTLE_ENDIAN | ||
| 105 | #endif | ||
| 106 | #endif | ||
| 107 | |||
| 108 | #if defined(__arm__) && !defined(__VFP_FP__) | ||
| 109 | /* | ||
| 110 | * Although the CPU is little endian the FP has different | ||
| 111 | * byte and word endianness. The byte order is still little endian | ||
| 112 | * but the word order is big endian. | ||
| 113 | */ | ||
| 114 | #define IEEE_BIG_ENDIAN | ||
| 115 | #endif | ||
| 116 | |||
| 117 | #ifdef __vax__ | ||
| 118 | #define VAX | ||
| 119 | #endif | ||
| 120 | |||
| 121 | #define Long int32_t | ||
| 122 | #define ULong u_int32_t | ||
| 123 | |||
| 124 | #ifdef DEBUG | ||
| 125 | #include "stdio.h" | ||
| 126 | #define Bug(x) {fprintf(stderr, "%s\n", x); exit(1);} | ||
| 127 | #endif | ||
| 128 | |||
| 129 | #ifdef __cplusplus | ||
| 130 | #include "malloc.h" | ||
| 131 | #include "memory.h" | ||
| 132 | #else | ||
| 133 | #ifndef KR_headers | ||
| 134 | #include "stdlib.h" | ||
| 135 | #include "string.h" | ||
| 136 | #include "locale.h" | ||
| 137 | #else | ||
| 138 | #include "malloc.h" | ||
| 139 | #include "memory.h" | ||
| 140 | #endif | ||
| 141 | #endif | ||
| 142 | |||
| 143 | #ifdef MALLOC | ||
| 144 | #ifdef KR_headers | ||
| 145 | extern char *MALLOC(); | ||
| 146 | #else | ||
| 147 | extern void *MALLOC(size_t); | ||
| 148 | #endif | ||
| 149 | #else | ||
| 150 | #define MALLOC malloc | ||
| 151 | #endif | ||
| 152 | |||
| 153 | #include "ctype.h" | ||
| 154 | #include "errno.h" | ||
| 155 | |||
| 156 | #ifdef Bad_float_h | ||
| 157 | #ifdef IEEE_BIG_ENDIAN | ||
| 158 | #define IEEE_ARITHMETIC | ||
| 159 | #endif | ||
| 160 | #ifdef IEEE_LITTLE_ENDIAN | ||
| 161 | #define IEEE_ARITHMETIC | ||
| 162 | #endif | ||
| 163 | |||
| 164 | #ifdef IEEE_ARITHMETIC | ||
| 165 | #define DBL_DIG 15 | ||
| 166 | #define DBL_MAX_10_EXP 308 | ||
| 167 | #define DBL_MAX_EXP 1024 | ||
| 168 | #define FLT_RADIX 2 | ||
| 169 | #define FLT_ROUNDS 1 | ||
| 170 | #define DBL_MAX 1.7976931348623157e+308 | ||
| 171 | #endif | ||
| 172 | |||
| 173 | #ifdef IBM | ||
| 174 | #define DBL_DIG 16 | ||
| 175 | #define DBL_MAX_10_EXP 75 | ||
| 176 | #define DBL_MAX_EXP 63 | ||
| 177 | #define FLT_RADIX 16 | ||
| 178 | #define FLT_ROUNDS 0 | ||
| 179 | #define DBL_MAX 7.2370055773322621e+75 | ||
| 180 | #endif | ||
| 181 | |||
| 182 | #ifdef VAX | ||
| 183 | #define DBL_DIG 16 | ||
| 184 | #define DBL_MAX_10_EXP 38 | ||
| 185 | #define DBL_MAX_EXP 127 | ||
| 186 | #define FLT_RADIX 2 | ||
| 187 | #define FLT_ROUNDS 1 | ||
| 188 | #define DBL_MAX 1.7014118346046923e+38 | ||
| 189 | #endif | ||
| 190 | |||
| 191 | #ifndef LONG_MAX | ||
| 192 | #define LONG_MAX 2147483647 | ||
| 193 | #endif | ||
| 194 | #else | ||
| 195 | #include "float.h" | ||
| 196 | #endif | ||
| 197 | #ifndef __MATH_H__ | ||
| 198 | #include "math.h" | ||
| 199 | #endif | ||
| 200 | |||
| 201 | #ifdef __cplusplus | ||
| 202 | extern "C" { | ||
| 203 | #endif | ||
| 204 | |||
| 205 | #ifndef CONST | ||
| 206 | #ifdef KR_headers | ||
| 207 | #define CONST /* blank */ | ||
| 208 | #else | ||
| 209 | #define CONST const | ||
| 210 | #endif | ||
| 211 | #endif | ||
| 212 | |||
| 213 | #ifdef Unsigned_Shifts | ||
| 214 | #define Sign_Extend(a,b) if (b < 0) a |= 0xffff0000; | ||
| 215 | #else | ||
| 216 | #define Sign_Extend(a,b) /*no-op*/ | ||
| 217 | #endif | ||
| 218 | |||
| 219 | #if defined(IEEE_LITTLE_ENDIAN) + defined(IEEE_BIG_ENDIAN) + defined(VAX) + \ | ||
| 220 | defined(IBM) != 1 | ||
| 221 | Exactly one of IEEE_LITTLE_ENDIAN IEEE_BIG_ENDIAN, VAX, or | ||
| 222 | IBM should be defined. | ||
| 223 | #endif | ||
| 224 | |||
| 225 | typedef union { | ||
| 226 | double d; | ||
| 227 | ULong ul[2]; | ||
| 228 | } _double; | ||
| 229 | #define value(x) ((x).d) | ||
| 230 | #ifdef IEEE_LITTLE_ENDIAN | ||
| 231 | #define word0(x) ((x).ul[1]) | ||
| 232 | #define word1(x) ((x).ul[0]) | ||
| 233 | #else | ||
| 234 | #define word0(x) ((x).ul[0]) | ||
| 235 | #define word1(x) ((x).ul[1]) | ||
| 236 | #endif | ||
| 237 | |||
| 238 | /* The following definition of Storeinc is appropriate for MIPS processors. | ||
| 239 | * An alternative that might be better on some machines is | ||
| 240 | * #define Storeinc(a,b,c) (*a++ = b << 16 | c & 0xffff) | ||
| 241 | */ | ||
| 242 | #if defined(IEEE_LITTLE_ENDIAN) + defined(VAX) + defined(__arm__) | ||
| 243 | #define Storeinc(a,b,c) (((unsigned short *)a)[1] = (unsigned short)b, \ | ||
| 244 | ((unsigned short *)a)[0] = (unsigned short)c, a++) | ||
| 245 | #else | ||
| 246 | #define Storeinc(a,b,c) (((unsigned short *)a)[0] = (unsigned short)b, \ | ||
| 247 | ((unsigned short *)a)[1] = (unsigned short)c, a++) | ||
| 248 | #endif | ||
| 249 | |||
| 250 | /* #define P DBL_MANT_DIG */ | ||
| 251 | /* Ten_pmax = floor(P*log(2)/log(5)) */ | ||
| 252 | /* Bletch = (highest power of 2 < DBL_MAX_10_EXP) / 16 */ | ||
| 253 | /* Quick_max = floor((P-1)*log(FLT_RADIX)/log(10) - 1) */ | ||
| 254 | /* Int_max = floor(P*log(FLT_RADIX)/log(10) - 1) */ | ||
| 255 | |||
| 256 | #if defined(IEEE_LITTLE_ENDIAN) + defined(IEEE_BIG_ENDIAN) | ||
| 257 | #define Exp_shift 20 | ||
| 258 | #define Exp_shift1 20 | ||
| 259 | #define Exp_msk1 0x100000 | ||
| 260 | #define Exp_msk11 0x100000 | ||
| 261 | #define Exp_mask 0x7ff00000 | ||
| 262 | #define P 53 | ||
| 263 | #define Bias 1023 | ||
| 264 | #define IEEE_Arith | ||
| 265 | #define Emin (-1022) | ||
| 266 | #define Exp_1 0x3ff00000 | ||
| 267 | #define Exp_11 0x3ff00000 | ||
| 268 | #define Ebits 11 | ||
| 269 | #define Frac_mask 0xfffff | ||
| 270 | #define Frac_mask1 0xfffff | ||
| 271 | #define Ten_pmax 22 | ||
| 272 | #define Bletch 0x10 | ||
| 273 | #define Bndry_mask 0xfffff | ||
| 274 | #define Bndry_mask1 0xfffff | ||
| 275 | #define LSB 1 | ||
| 276 | #define Sign_bit 0x80000000 | ||
| 277 | #define Log2P 1 | ||
| 278 | #define Tiny0 0 | ||
| 279 | #define Tiny1 1 | ||
| 280 | #define Quick_max 14 | ||
| 281 | #define Int_max 14 | ||
| 282 | #define Infinite(x) (word0(x) == 0x7ff00000) /* sufficient test for here */ | ||
| 283 | #else | ||
| 284 | #undef Sudden_Underflow | ||
| 285 | #define Sudden_Underflow | ||
| 286 | #ifdef IBM | ||
| 287 | #define Exp_shift 24 | ||
| 288 | #define Exp_shift1 24 | ||
| 289 | #define Exp_msk1 0x1000000 | ||
| 290 | #define Exp_msk11 0x1000000 | ||
| 291 | #define Exp_mask 0x7f000000 | ||
| 292 | #define P 14 | ||
| 293 | #define Bias 65 | ||
| 294 | #define Exp_1 0x41000000 | ||
| 295 | #define Exp_11 0x41000000 | ||
| 296 | #define Ebits 8 /* exponent has 7 bits, but 8 is the right value in b2d */ | ||
| 297 | #define Frac_mask 0xffffff | ||
| 298 | #define Frac_mask1 0xffffff | ||
| 299 | #define Bletch 4 | ||
| 300 | #define Ten_pmax 22 | ||
| 301 | #define Bndry_mask 0xefffff | ||
| 302 | #define Bndry_mask1 0xffffff | ||
| 303 | #define LSB 1 | ||
| 304 | #define Sign_bit 0x80000000 | ||
| 305 | #define Log2P 4 | ||
| 306 | #define Tiny0 0x100000 | ||
| 307 | #define Tiny1 0 | ||
| 308 | #define Quick_max 14 | ||
| 309 | #define Int_max 15 | ||
| 310 | #else /* VAX */ | ||
| 311 | #define Exp_shift 23 | ||
| 312 | #define Exp_shift1 7 | ||
| 313 | #define Exp_msk1 0x80 | ||
| 314 | #define Exp_msk11 0x800000 | ||
| 315 | #define Exp_mask 0x7f80 | ||
| 316 | #define P 56 | ||
| 317 | #define Bias 129 | ||
| 318 | #define Exp_1 0x40800000 | ||
| 319 | #define Exp_11 0x4080 | ||
| 320 | #define Ebits 8 | ||
| 321 | #define Frac_mask 0x7fffff | ||
| 322 | #define Frac_mask1 0xffff007f | ||
| 323 | #define Ten_pmax 24 | ||
| 324 | #define Bletch 2 | ||
| 325 | #define Bndry_mask 0xffff007f | ||
| 326 | #define Bndry_mask1 0xffff007f | ||
| 327 | #define LSB 0x10000 | ||
| 328 | #define Sign_bit 0x8000 | ||
| 329 | #define Log2P 1 | ||
| 330 | #define Tiny0 0x80 | ||
| 331 | #define Tiny1 0 | ||
| 332 | #define Quick_max 15 | ||
| 333 | #define Int_max 15 | ||
| 334 | #endif | ||
| 335 | #endif | ||
| 336 | |||
| 337 | #ifndef IEEE_Arith | ||
| 338 | #define ROUND_BIASED | ||
| 339 | #endif | ||
| 340 | |||
| 341 | #ifdef RND_PRODQUOT | ||
| 342 | #define rounded_product(a,b) a = rnd_prod(a, b) | ||
| 343 | #define rounded_quotient(a,b) a = rnd_quot(a, b) | ||
| 344 | #ifdef KR_headers | ||
| 345 | extern double rnd_prod(), rnd_quot(); | ||
| 346 | #else | ||
| 347 | extern double rnd_prod(double, double), rnd_quot(double, double); | ||
| 348 | #endif | ||
| 349 | #else | ||
| 350 | #define rounded_product(a,b) a *= b | ||
| 351 | #define rounded_quotient(a,b) a /= b | ||
| 352 | #endif | ||
| 353 | |||
| 354 | #define Big0 (Frac_mask1 | Exp_msk1*(DBL_MAX_EXP+Bias-1)) | ||
| 355 | #define Big1 0xffffffff | ||
| 356 | |||
| 357 | #ifndef Just_16 | ||
| 358 | /* When Pack_32 is not defined, we store 16 bits per 32-bit Long. | ||
| 359 | * This makes some inner loops simpler and sometimes saves work | ||
| 360 | * during multiplications, but it often seems to make things slightly | ||
| 361 | * slower. Hence the default is now to store 32 bits per Long. | ||
| 362 | */ | ||
| 363 | #ifndef Pack_32 | ||
| 364 | #define Pack_32 | ||
| 365 | #endif | ||
| 366 | #endif | ||
| 367 | |||
| 368 | #define Kmax 15 | ||
| 369 | |||
| 370 | #ifdef __cplusplus | ||
| 371 | extern "C" double strtod(const char *s00, char **se); | ||
| 372 | extern "C" char *__dtoa(double d, int mode, int ndigits, | ||
| 373 | int *decpt, int *sign, char **rve); | ||
| 374 | #endif | ||
| 375 | |||
| 376 | struct | ||
| 377 | Bigint { | ||
| 378 | struct Bigint *next; | ||
| 379 | int k, maxwds, sign, wds; | ||
| 380 | ULong x[1]; | ||
| 381 | }; | ||
| 382 | |||
| 383 | typedef struct Bigint Bigint; | ||
| 384 | |||
| 385 | static Bigint *freelist[Kmax+1]; | ||
| 386 | |||
| 387 | static Bigint * | ||
| 388 | Balloc | ||
| 389 | #ifdef KR_headers | ||
| 390 | (k) int k; | ||
| 391 | #else | ||
| 392 | (int k) | ||
| 393 | #endif | ||
| 394 | { | ||
| 395 | int x; | ||
| 396 | Bigint *rv; | ||
| 397 | |||
| 398 | if ((rv = freelist[k])) { | ||
| 399 | freelist[k] = rv->next; | ||
| 400 | } | ||
| 401 | else { | ||
| 402 | x = 1 << k; | ||
| 403 | rv = (Bigint *)MALLOC(sizeof(Bigint) + (x-1)*sizeof(Long)); | ||
| 404 | rv->k = k; | ||
| 405 | rv->maxwds = x; | ||
| 406 | } | ||
| 407 | rv->sign = rv->wds = 0; | ||
| 408 | return rv; | ||
| 409 | } | ||
| 410 | |||
| 411 | static void | ||
| 412 | Bfree | ||
| 413 | #ifdef KR_headers | ||
| 414 | (v) Bigint *v; | ||
| 415 | #else | ||
| 416 | (Bigint *v) | ||
| 417 | #endif | ||
| 418 | { | ||
| 419 | if (v) { | ||
| 420 | v->next = freelist[v->k]; | ||
| 421 | freelist[v->k] = v; | ||
| 422 | } | ||
| 423 | } | ||
| 424 | |||
| 425 | #define Bcopy(x,y) memcpy((char *)&x->sign, (char *)&y->sign, \ | ||
| 426 | y->wds*sizeof(Long) + 2*sizeof(int)) | ||
| 427 | |||
| 428 | static Bigint * | ||
| 429 | multadd | ||
| 430 | #ifdef KR_headers | ||
| 431 | (b, m, a) Bigint *b; int m, a; | ||
| 432 | #else | ||
| 433 | (Bigint *b, int m, int a) /* multiply by m and add a */ | ||
| 434 | #endif | ||
| 435 | { | ||
| 436 | int i, wds; | ||
| 437 | ULong *x, y; | ||
| 438 | #ifdef Pack_32 | ||
| 439 | ULong xi, z; | ||
| 440 | #endif | ||
| 441 | Bigint *b1; | ||
| 442 | |||
| 443 | wds = b->wds; | ||
| 444 | x = b->x; | ||
| 445 | i = 0; | ||
| 446 | do { | ||
| 447 | #ifdef Pack_32 | ||
| 448 | xi = *x; | ||
| 449 | y = (xi & 0xffff) * m + a; | ||
| 450 | z = (xi >> 16) * m + (y >> 16); | ||
| 451 | a = (int)(z >> 16); | ||
| 452 | *x++ = (z << 16) + (y & 0xffff); | ||
| 453 | #else | ||
| 454 | y = *x * m + a; | ||
| 455 | a = (int)(y >> 16); | ||
| 456 | *x++ = y & 0xffff; | ||
| 457 | #endif | ||
| 458 | } | ||
| 459 | while(++i < wds); | ||
| 460 | if (a) { | ||
| 461 | if (wds >= b->maxwds) { | ||
| 462 | b1 = Balloc(b->k+1); | ||
| 463 | Bcopy(b1, b); | ||
| 464 | Bfree(b); | ||
| 465 | b = b1; | ||
| 466 | } | ||
| 467 | b->x[wds++] = a; | ||
| 468 | b->wds = wds; | ||
| 469 | } | ||
| 470 | return b; | ||
| 471 | } | ||
| 472 | |||
| 473 | static Bigint * | ||
| 474 | s2b | ||
| 475 | #ifdef KR_headers | ||
| 476 | (s, nd0, nd, y9) CONST char *s; int nd0, nd; ULong y9; | ||
| 477 | #else | ||
| 478 | (CONST char *s, int nd0, int nd, ULong y9) | ||
| 479 | #endif | ||
| 480 | { | ||
| 481 | Bigint *b; | ||
| 482 | int i, k; | ||
| 483 | Long x, y; | ||
| 484 | |||
| 485 | x = (nd + 8) / 9; | ||
| 486 | for(k = 0, y = 1; x > y; y <<= 1, k++) ; | ||
| 487 | #ifdef Pack_32 | ||
| 488 | b = Balloc(k); | ||
| 489 | b->x[0] = y9; | ||
| 490 | b->wds = 1; | ||
| 491 | #else | ||
| 492 | b = Balloc(k+1); | ||
| 493 | b->x[0] = y9 & 0xffff; | ||
| 494 | b->wds = (b->x[1] = y9 >> 16) ? 2 : 1; | ||
| 495 | #endif | ||
| 496 | |||
| 497 | i = 9; | ||
| 498 | if (9 < nd0) { | ||
| 499 | s += 9; | ||
| 500 | do b = multadd(b, 10, *s++ - '0'); | ||
| 501 | while(++i < nd0); | ||
| 502 | s++; | ||
| 503 | } | ||
| 504 | else | ||
| 505 | s += 10; | ||
| 506 | for(; i < nd; i++) | ||
| 507 | b = multadd(b, 10, *s++ - '0'); | ||
| 508 | return b; | ||
| 509 | } | ||
| 510 | |||
| 511 | static int | ||
| 512 | hi0bits | ||
| 513 | #ifdef KR_headers | ||
| 514 | (x) register ULong x; | ||
| 515 | #else | ||
| 516 | (register ULong x) | ||
| 517 | #endif | ||
| 518 | { | ||
| 519 | register int k = 0; | ||
| 520 | |||
| 521 | if (!(x & 0xffff0000)) { | ||
| 522 | k = 16; | ||
| 523 | x <<= 16; | ||
| 524 | } | ||
| 525 | if (!(x & 0xff000000)) { | ||
| 526 | k += 8; | ||
| 527 | x <<= 8; | ||
| 528 | } | ||
| 529 | if (!(x & 0xf0000000)) { | ||
| 530 | k += 4; | ||
| 531 | x <<= 4; | ||
| 532 | } | ||
| 533 | if (!(x & 0xc0000000)) { | ||
| 534 | k += 2; | ||
| 535 | x <<= 2; | ||
| 536 | } | ||
| 537 | if (!(x & 0x80000000)) { | ||
| 538 | k++; | ||
| 539 | if (!(x & 0x40000000)) | ||
| 540 | return 32; | ||
| 541 | } | ||
| 542 | return k; | ||
| 543 | } | ||
| 544 | |||
| 545 | static int | ||
| 546 | lo0bits | ||
| 547 | #ifdef KR_headers | ||
| 548 | (y) ULong *y; | ||
| 549 | #else | ||
| 550 | (ULong *y) | ||
| 551 | #endif | ||
| 552 | { | ||
| 553 | register int k; | ||
| 554 | register ULong x = *y; | ||
| 555 | |||
| 556 | if (x & 7) { | ||
| 557 | if (x & 1) | ||
| 558 | return 0; | ||
| 559 | if (x & 2) { | ||
| 560 | *y = x >> 1; | ||
| 561 | return 1; | ||
| 562 | } | ||
| 563 | *y = x >> 2; | ||
| 564 | return 2; | ||
| 565 | } | ||
| 566 | k = 0; | ||
| 567 | if (!(x & 0xffff)) { | ||
| 568 | k = 16; | ||
| 569 | x >>= 16; | ||
| 570 | } | ||
| 571 | if (!(x & 0xff)) { | ||
| 572 | k += 8; | ||
| 573 | x >>= 8; | ||
| 574 | } | ||
| 575 | if (!(x & 0xf)) { | ||
| 576 | k += 4; | ||
| 577 | x >>= 4; | ||
| 578 | } | ||
| 579 | if (!(x & 0x3)) { | ||
| 580 | k += 2; | ||
| 581 | x >>= 2; | ||
| 582 | } | ||
| 583 | if (!(x & 1)) { | ||
| 584 | k++; | ||
| 585 | x >>= 1; | ||
| 586 | if (!x & 1) | ||
| 587 | return 32; | ||
| 588 | } | ||
| 589 | *y = x; | ||
| 590 | return k; | ||
| 591 | } | ||
| 592 | |||
| 593 | static Bigint * | ||
| 594 | i2b | ||
| 595 | #ifdef KR_headers | ||
| 596 | (i) int i; | ||
| 597 | #else | ||
| 598 | (int i) | ||
| 599 | #endif | ||
| 600 | { | ||
| 601 | Bigint *b; | ||
| 602 | |||
| 603 | b = Balloc(1); | ||
| 604 | b->x[0] = i; | ||
| 605 | b->wds = 1; | ||
| 606 | return b; | ||
| 607 | } | ||
| 608 | |||
| 609 | static Bigint * | ||
| 610 | mult | ||
| 611 | #ifdef KR_headers | ||
| 612 | (a, b) Bigint *a, *b; | ||
| 613 | #else | ||
| 614 | (Bigint *a, Bigint *b) | ||
| 615 | #endif | ||
| 616 | { | ||
| 617 | Bigint *c; | ||
| 618 | int k, wa, wb, wc; | ||
| 619 | ULong carry, y, z; | ||
| 620 | ULong *x, *xa, *xae, *xb, *xbe, *xc, *xc0; | ||
| 621 | #ifdef Pack_32 | ||
| 622 | ULong z2; | ||
| 623 | #endif | ||
| 624 | |||
| 625 | if (a->wds < b->wds) { | ||
| 626 | c = a; | ||
| 627 | a = b; | ||
| 628 | b = c; | ||
| 629 | } | ||
| 630 | k = a->k; | ||
| 631 | wa = a->wds; | ||
| 632 | wb = b->wds; | ||
| 633 | wc = wa + wb; | ||
| 634 | if (wc > a->maxwds) | ||
| 635 | k++; | ||
| 636 | c = Balloc(k); | ||
| 637 | for(x = c->x, xa = x + wc; x < xa; x++) | ||
| 638 | *x = 0; | ||
| 639 | xa = a->x; | ||
| 640 | xae = xa + wa; | ||
| 641 | xb = b->x; | ||
| 642 | xbe = xb + wb; | ||
| 643 | xc0 = c->x; | ||
| 644 | #ifdef Pack_32 | ||
| 645 | for(; xb < xbe; xb++, xc0++) { | ||
| 646 | if ((y = *xb & 0xffff)) { | ||
| 647 | x = xa; | ||
| 648 | xc = xc0; | ||
| 649 | carry = 0; | ||
| 650 | do { | ||
| 651 | z = (*x & 0xffff) * y + (*xc & 0xffff) + carry; | ||
| 652 | carry = z >> 16; | ||
| 653 | z2 = (*x++ >> 16) * y + (*xc >> 16) + carry; | ||
| 654 | carry = z2 >> 16; | ||
| 655 | Storeinc(xc, z2, z); | ||
| 656 | } | ||
| 657 | while(x < xae); | ||
| 658 | *xc = carry; | ||
| 659 | } | ||
| 660 | if ((y = *xb >> 16)) { | ||
| 661 | x = xa; | ||
| 662 | xc = xc0; | ||
| 663 | carry = 0; | ||
| 664 | z2 = *xc; | ||
| 665 | do { | ||
| 666 | z = (*x & 0xffff) * y + (*xc >> 16) + carry; | ||
| 667 | carry = z >> 16; | ||
| 668 | Storeinc(xc, z, z2); | ||
| 669 | z2 = (*x++ >> 16) * y + (*xc & 0xffff) + carry; | ||
| 670 | carry = z2 >> 16; | ||
| 671 | } | ||
| 672 | while(x < xae); | ||
| 673 | *xc = z2; | ||
| 674 | } | ||
| 675 | } | ||
| 676 | #else | ||
| 677 | for(; xb < xbe; xc0++) { | ||
| 678 | if (y = *xb++) { | ||
| 679 | x = xa; | ||
| 680 | xc = xc0; | ||
| 681 | carry = 0; | ||
| 682 | do { | ||
| 683 | z = *x++ * y + *xc + carry; | ||
| 684 | carry = z >> 16; | ||
| 685 | *xc++ = z & 0xffff; | ||
| 686 | } | ||
| 687 | while(x < xae); | ||
| 688 | *xc = carry; | ||
| 689 | } | ||
| 690 | } | ||
| 691 | #endif | ||
| 692 | for(xc0 = c->x, xc = xc0 + wc; wc > 0 && !*--xc; --wc) ; | ||
| 693 | c->wds = wc; | ||
| 694 | return c; | ||
| 695 | } | ||
| 696 | |||
| 697 | static Bigint *p5s; | ||
| 698 | |||
| 699 | static Bigint * | ||
| 700 | pow5mult | ||
| 701 | #ifdef KR_headers | ||
| 702 | (b, k) Bigint *b; int k; | ||
| 703 | #else | ||
| 704 | (Bigint *b, int k) | ||
| 705 | #endif | ||
| 706 | { | ||
| 707 | Bigint *b1, *p5, *p51; | ||
| 708 | int i; | ||
| 709 | static int p05[3] = { 5, 25, 125 }; | ||
| 710 | |||
| 711 | if ((i = k & 3)) | ||
| 712 | b = multadd(b, p05[i-1], 0); | ||
| 713 | |||
| 714 | if (!(k >>= 2)) | ||
| 715 | return b; | ||
| 716 | if (!(p5 = p5s)) { | ||
| 717 | /* first time */ | ||
| 718 | p5 = p5s = i2b(625); | ||
| 719 | p5->next = 0; | ||
| 720 | } | ||
| 721 | for(;;) { | ||
| 722 | if (k & 1) { | ||
| 723 | b1 = mult(b, p5); | ||
| 724 | Bfree(b); | ||
| 725 | b = b1; | ||
| 726 | } | ||
| 727 | if (!(k >>= 1)) | ||
| 728 | break; | ||
| 729 | if (!(p51 = p5->next)) { | ||
| 730 | p51 = p5->next = mult(p5,p5); | ||
| 731 | p51->next = 0; | ||
| 732 | } | ||
| 733 | p5 = p51; | ||
| 734 | } | ||
| 735 | return b; | ||
| 736 | } | ||
| 737 | |||
| 738 | static Bigint * | ||
| 739 | lshift | ||
| 740 | #ifdef KR_headers | ||
| 741 | (b, k) Bigint *b; int k; | ||
| 742 | #else | ||
| 743 | (Bigint *b, int k) | ||
| 744 | #endif | ||
| 745 | { | ||
| 746 | int i, k1, n, n1; | ||
| 747 | Bigint *b1; | ||
| 748 | ULong *x, *x1, *xe, z; | ||
| 749 | |||
| 750 | #ifdef Pack_32 | ||
| 751 | n = k >> 5; | ||
| 752 | #else | ||
| 753 | n = k >> 4; | ||
| 754 | #endif | ||
| 755 | k1 = b->k; | ||
| 756 | n1 = n + b->wds + 1; | ||
| 757 | for(i = b->maxwds; n1 > i; i <<= 1) | ||
| 758 | k1++; | ||
| 759 | b1 = Balloc(k1); | ||
| 760 | x1 = b1->x; | ||
| 761 | for(i = 0; i < n; i++) | ||
| 762 | *x1++ = 0; | ||
| 763 | x = b->x; | ||
| 764 | xe = x + b->wds; | ||
| 765 | #ifdef Pack_32 | ||
| 766 | if (k &= 0x1f) { | ||
| 767 | k1 = 32 - k; | ||
| 768 | z = 0; | ||
| 769 | do { | ||
| 770 | *x1++ = *x << k | z; | ||
| 771 | z = *x++ >> k1; | ||
| 772 | } | ||
| 773 | while(x < xe); | ||
| 774 | if ((*x1 = z)) | ||
| 775 | ++n1; | ||
| 776 | } | ||
| 777 | #else | ||
| 778 | if (k &= 0xf) { | ||
| 779 | k1 = 16 - k; | ||
| 780 | z = 0; | ||
| 781 | do { | ||
| 782 | *x1++ = *x << k & 0xffff | z; | ||
| 783 | z = *x++ >> k1; | ||
| 784 | } | ||
| 785 | while(x < xe); | ||
| 786 | if (*x1 = z) | ||
| 787 | ++n1; | ||
| 788 | } | ||
| 789 | #endif | ||
| 790 | else do | ||
| 791 | *x1++ = *x++; | ||
| 792 | while(x < xe); | ||
| 793 | b1->wds = n1 - 1; | ||
| 794 | Bfree(b); | ||
| 795 | return b1; | ||
| 796 | } | ||
| 797 | |||
| 798 | static int | ||
| 799 | cmp | ||
| 800 | #ifdef KR_headers | ||
| 801 | (a, b) Bigint *a, *b; | ||
| 802 | #else | ||
| 803 | (Bigint *a, Bigint *b) | ||
| 804 | #endif | ||
| 805 | { | ||
| 806 | ULong *xa, *xa0, *xb, *xb0; | ||
| 807 | int i, j; | ||
| 808 | |||
| 809 | i = a->wds; | ||
| 810 | j = b->wds; | ||
| 811 | #ifdef DEBUG | ||
| 812 | if (i > 1 && !a->x[i-1]) | ||
| 813 | Bug("cmp called with a->x[a->wds-1] == 0"); | ||
| 814 | if (j > 1 && !b->x[j-1]) | ||
| 815 | Bug("cmp called with b->x[b->wds-1] == 0"); | ||
| 816 | #endif | ||
| 817 | if (i -= j) | ||
| 818 | return i; | ||
| 819 | xa0 = a->x; | ||
| 820 | xa = xa0 + j; | ||
| 821 | xb0 = b->x; | ||
| 822 | xb = xb0 + j; | ||
| 823 | for(;;) { | ||
| 824 | if (*--xa != *--xb) | ||
| 825 | return *xa < *xb ? -1 : 1; | ||
| 826 | if (xa <= xa0) | ||
| 827 | break; | ||
| 828 | } | ||
| 829 | return 0; | ||
| 830 | } | ||
| 831 | |||
| 832 | static Bigint * | ||
| 833 | diff | ||
| 834 | #ifdef KR_headers | ||
| 835 | (a, b) Bigint *a, *b; | ||
| 836 | #else | ||
| 837 | (Bigint *a, Bigint *b) | ||
| 838 | #endif | ||
| 839 | { | ||
| 840 | Bigint *c; | ||
| 841 | int i, wa, wb; | ||
| 842 | Long borrow, y; /* We need signed shifts here. */ | ||
| 843 | ULong *xa, *xae, *xb, *xbe, *xc; | ||
| 844 | #ifdef Pack_32 | ||
| 845 | Long z; | ||
| 846 | #endif | ||
| 847 | |||
| 848 | i = cmp(a,b); | ||
| 849 | if (!i) { | ||
| 850 | c = Balloc(0); | ||
| 851 | c->wds = 1; | ||
| 852 | c->x[0] = 0; | ||
| 853 | return c; | ||
| 854 | } | ||
| 855 | if (i < 0) { | ||
| 856 | c = a; | ||
| 857 | a = b; | ||
| 858 | b = c; | ||
| 859 | i = 1; | ||
| 860 | } | ||
| 861 | else | ||
| 862 | i = 0; | ||
| 863 | c = Balloc(a->k); | ||
| 864 | c->sign = i; | ||
| 865 | wa = a->wds; | ||
| 866 | xa = a->x; | ||
| 867 | xae = xa + wa; | ||
| 868 | wb = b->wds; | ||
| 869 | xb = b->x; | ||
| 870 | xbe = xb + wb; | ||
| 871 | xc = c->x; | ||
| 872 | borrow = 0; | ||
| 873 | #ifdef Pack_32 | ||
| 874 | do { | ||
| 875 | y = (*xa & 0xffff) - (*xb & 0xffff) + borrow; | ||
| 876 | borrow = y >> 16; | ||
| 877 | Sign_Extend(borrow, y); | ||
| 878 | z = (*xa++ >> 16) - (*xb++ >> 16) + borrow; | ||
| 879 | borrow = z >> 16; | ||
| 880 | Sign_Extend(borrow, z); | ||
| 881 | Storeinc(xc, z, y); | ||
| 882 | } | ||
| 883 | while(xb < xbe); | ||
| 884 | while(xa < xae) { | ||
| 885 | y = (*xa & 0xffff) + borrow; | ||
| 886 | borrow = y >> 16; | ||
| 887 | Sign_Extend(borrow, y); | ||
| 888 | z = (*xa++ >> 16) + borrow; | ||
| 889 | borrow = z >> 16; | ||
| 890 | Sign_Extend(borrow, z); | ||
| 891 | Storeinc(xc, z, y); | ||
| 892 | } | ||
| 893 | #else | ||
| 894 | do { | ||
| 895 | y = *xa++ - *xb++ + borrow; | ||
| 896 | borrow = y >> 16; | ||
| 897 | Sign_Extend(borrow, y); | ||
| 898 | *xc++ = y & 0xffff; | ||
| 899 | } | ||
| 900 | while(xb < xbe); | ||
| 901 | while(xa < xae) { | ||
| 902 | y = *xa++ + borrow; | ||
| 903 | borrow = y >> 16; | ||
| 904 | Sign_Extend(borrow, y); | ||
| 905 | *xc++ = y & 0xffff; | ||
| 906 | } | ||
| 907 | #endif | ||
| 908 | while(!*--xc) | ||
| 909 | wa--; | ||
| 910 | c->wds = wa; | ||
| 911 | return c; | ||
| 912 | } | ||
| 913 | |||
| 914 | static double | ||
| 915 | ulp | ||
| 916 | #ifdef KR_headers | ||
| 917 | (_x) double _x; | ||
| 918 | #else | ||
| 919 | (double _x) | ||
| 920 | #endif | ||
| 921 | { | ||
| 922 | _double x; | ||
| 923 | register Long L; | ||
| 924 | _double a; | ||
| 925 | |||
| 926 | value(x) = _x; | ||
| 927 | L = (word0(x) & Exp_mask) - (P-1)*Exp_msk1; | ||
| 928 | #ifndef Sudden_Underflow | ||
| 929 | if (L > 0) { | ||
| 930 | #endif | ||
| 931 | #ifdef IBM | ||
| 932 | L |= Exp_msk1 >> 4; | ||
| 933 | #endif | ||
| 934 | word0(a) = L; | ||
| 935 | word1(a) = 0; | ||
| 936 | #ifndef Sudden_Underflow | ||
| 937 | } | ||
| 938 | else { | ||
| 939 | L = -L >> Exp_shift; | ||
| 940 | if (L < Exp_shift) { | ||
| 941 | word0(a) = 0x80000 >> L; | ||
| 942 | word1(a) = 0; | ||
| 943 | } | ||
| 944 | else { | ||
| 945 | word0(a) = 0; | ||
| 946 | L -= Exp_shift; | ||
| 947 | word1(a) = L >= 31 ? 1 : 1 << 31 - L; | ||
| 948 | } | ||
| 949 | } | ||
| 950 | #endif | ||
| 951 | return value(a); | ||
| 952 | } | ||
| 953 | |||
| 954 | static double | ||
| 955 | b2d | ||
| 956 | #ifdef KR_headers | ||
| 957 | (a, e) Bigint *a; int *e; | ||
| 958 | #else | ||
| 959 | (Bigint *a, int *e) | ||
| 960 | #endif | ||
| 961 | { | ||
| 962 | ULong *xa, *xa0, w, y, z; | ||
| 963 | int k; | ||
| 964 | _double d; | ||
| 965 | #ifdef VAX | ||
| 966 | ULong d0, d1; | ||
| 967 | #else | ||
| 968 | #define d0 word0(d) | ||
| 969 | #define d1 word1(d) | ||
| 970 | #endif | ||
| 971 | |||
| 972 | xa0 = a->x; | ||
| 973 | xa = xa0 + a->wds; | ||
| 974 | y = *--xa; | ||
| 975 | #ifdef DEBUG | ||
| 976 | if (!y) Bug("zero y in b2d"); | ||
| 977 | #endif | ||
| 978 | k = hi0bits(y); | ||
| 979 | *e = 32 - k; | ||
| 980 | #ifdef Pack_32 | ||
| 981 | if (k < Ebits) { | ||
| 982 | d0 = Exp_1 | y >> Ebits - k; | ||
| 983 | w = xa > xa0 ? *--xa : 0; | ||
| 984 | d1 = y << (32-Ebits) + k | w >> Ebits - k; | ||
| 985 | goto ret_d; | ||
| 986 | } | ||
| 987 | z = xa > xa0 ? *--xa : 0; | ||
| 988 | if (k -= Ebits) { | ||
| 989 | d0 = Exp_1 | y << k | z >> 32 - k; | ||
| 990 | y = xa > xa0 ? *--xa : 0; | ||
| 991 | d1 = z << k | y >> 32 - k; | ||
| 992 | } | ||
| 993 | else { | ||
| 994 | d0 = Exp_1 | y; | ||
| 995 | d1 = z; | ||
| 996 | } | ||
| 997 | #else | ||
| 998 | if (k < Ebits + 16) { | ||
| 999 | z = xa > xa0 ? *--xa : 0; | ||
| 1000 | d0 = Exp_1 | y << k - Ebits | z >> Ebits + 16 - k; | ||
| 1001 | w = xa > xa0 ? *--xa : 0; | ||
| 1002 | y = xa > xa0 ? *--xa : 0; | ||
| 1003 | d1 = z << k + 16 - Ebits | w << k - Ebits | y >> 16 + Ebits - k; | ||
| 1004 | goto ret_d; | ||
| 1005 | } | ||
| 1006 | z = xa > xa0 ? *--xa : 0; | ||
| 1007 | w = xa > xa0 ? *--xa : 0; | ||
| 1008 | k -= Ebits + 16; | ||
| 1009 | d0 = Exp_1 | y << k + 16 | z << k | w >> 16 - k; | ||
| 1010 | y = xa > xa0 ? *--xa : 0; | ||
| 1011 | d1 = w << k + 16 | y << k; | ||
| 1012 | #endif | ||
| 1013 | ret_d: | ||
| 1014 | #ifdef VAX | ||
| 1015 | word0(d) = d0 >> 16 | d0 << 16; | ||
| 1016 | word1(d) = d1 >> 16 | d1 << 16; | ||
| 1017 | #else | ||
| 1018 | #undef d0 | ||
| 1019 | #undef d1 | ||
| 1020 | #endif | ||
| 1021 | return value(d); | ||
| 1022 | } | ||
| 1023 | |||
| 1024 | static Bigint * | ||
| 1025 | d2b | ||
| 1026 | #ifdef KR_headers | ||
| 1027 | (_d, e, bits) double d; int *e, *bits; | ||
| 1028 | #else | ||
| 1029 | (double _d, int *e, int *bits) | ||
| 1030 | #endif | ||
| 1031 | { | ||
| 1032 | Bigint *b; | ||
| 1033 | int de, i, k; | ||
| 1034 | ULong *x, y, z; | ||
| 1035 | _double d; | ||
| 1036 | #ifdef VAX | ||
| 1037 | ULong d0, d1; | ||
| 1038 | #endif | ||
| 1039 | |||
| 1040 | value(d) = _d; | ||
| 1041 | #ifdef VAX | ||
| 1042 | d0 = word0(d) >> 16 | word0(d) << 16; | ||
| 1043 | d1 = word1(d) >> 16 | word1(d) << 16; | ||
| 1044 | #else | ||
| 1045 | #define d0 word0(d) | ||
| 1046 | #define d1 word1(d) | ||
| 1047 | #endif | ||
| 1048 | |||
| 1049 | #ifdef Pack_32 | ||
| 1050 | b = Balloc(1); | ||
| 1051 | #else | ||
| 1052 | b = Balloc(2); | ||
| 1053 | #endif | ||
| 1054 | x = b->x; | ||
| 1055 | |||
| 1056 | z = d0 & Frac_mask; | ||
| 1057 | d0 &= 0x7fffffff; /* clear sign bit, which we ignore */ | ||
| 1058 | #ifdef Sudden_Underflow | ||
| 1059 | de = (int)(d0 >> Exp_shift); | ||
| 1060 | #ifndef IBM | ||
| 1061 | z |= Exp_msk11; | ||
| 1062 | #endif | ||
| 1063 | #else | ||
| 1064 | if (de = (int)(d0 >> Exp_shift)) | ||
| 1065 | z |= Exp_msk1; | ||
| 1066 | #endif | ||
| 1067 | #ifdef Pack_32 | ||
| 1068 | if (y = d1) { | ||
| 1069 | if (k = lo0bits(&y)) { | ||
| 1070 | x[0] = y | z << 32 - k; | ||
| 1071 | z >>= k; | ||
| 1072 | } | ||
| 1073 | else | ||
| 1074 | x[0] = y; | ||
| 1075 | i = b->wds = (x[1] = z) ? 2 : 1; | ||
| 1076 | } | ||
| 1077 | else { | ||
| 1078 | #ifdef DEBUG | ||
| 1079 | if (!z) | ||
| 1080 | Bug("Zero passed to d2b"); | ||
| 1081 | #endif | ||
| 1082 | k = lo0bits(&z); | ||
| 1083 | x[0] = z; | ||
| 1084 | i = b->wds = 1; | ||
| 1085 | k += 32; | ||
| 1086 | } | ||
| 1087 | #else | ||
| 1088 | if (y = d1) { | ||
| 1089 | if (k = lo0bits(&y)) | ||
| 1090 | if (k >= 16) { | ||
| 1091 | x[0] = y | z << 32 - k & 0xffff; | ||
| 1092 | x[1] = z >> k - 16 & 0xffff; | ||
| 1093 | x[2] = z >> k; | ||
| 1094 | i = 2; | ||
| 1095 | } | ||
| 1096 | else { | ||
| 1097 | x[0] = y & 0xffff; | ||
| 1098 | x[1] = y >> 16 | z << 16 - k & 0xffff; | ||
| 1099 | x[2] = z >> k & 0xffff; | ||
| 1100 | x[3] = z >> k+16; | ||
| 1101 | i = 3; | ||
| 1102 | } | ||
| 1103 | else { | ||
| 1104 | x[0] = y & 0xffff; | ||
| 1105 | x[1] = y >> 16; | ||
| 1106 | x[2] = z & 0xffff; | ||
| 1107 | x[3] = z >> 16; | ||
| 1108 | i = 3; | ||
| 1109 | } | ||
| 1110 | } | ||
| 1111 | else { | ||
| 1112 | #ifdef DEBUG | ||
| 1113 | if (!z) | ||
| 1114 | Bug("Zero passed to d2b"); | ||
| 1115 | #endif | ||
| 1116 | k = lo0bits(&z); | ||
| 1117 | if (k >= 16) { | ||
| 1118 | x[0] = z; | ||
| 1119 | i = 0; | ||
| 1120 | } | ||
| 1121 | else { | ||
| 1122 | x[0] = z & 0xffff; | ||
| 1123 | x[1] = z >> 16; | ||
| 1124 | i = 1; | ||
| 1125 | } | ||
| 1126 | k += 32; | ||
| 1127 | } | ||
| 1128 | while(!x[i]) | ||
| 1129 | --i; | ||
| 1130 | b->wds = i + 1; | ||
| 1131 | #endif | ||
| 1132 | #ifndef Sudden_Underflow | ||
| 1133 | if (de) { | ||
| 1134 | #endif | ||
| 1135 | #ifdef IBM | ||
| 1136 | *e = (de - Bias - (P-1) << 2) + k; | ||
| 1137 | *bits = 4*P + 8 - k - hi0bits(word0(d) & Frac_mask); | ||
| 1138 | #else | ||
| 1139 | *e = de - Bias - (P-1) + k; | ||
| 1140 | *bits = P - k; | ||
| 1141 | #endif | ||
| 1142 | #ifndef Sudden_Underflow | ||
| 1143 | } | ||
| 1144 | else { | ||
| 1145 | *e = de - Bias - (P-1) + 1 + k; | ||
| 1146 | #ifdef Pack_32 | ||
| 1147 | *bits = 32*i - hi0bits(x[i-1]); | ||
| 1148 | #else | ||
| 1149 | *bits = (i+2)*16 - hi0bits(x[i]); | ||
| 1150 | #endif | ||
| 1151 | } | ||
| 1152 | #endif | ||
| 1153 | return b; | ||
| 1154 | } | ||
| 1155 | #undef d0 | ||
| 1156 | #undef d1 | ||
| 1157 | |||
| 1158 | static double | ||
| 1159 | ratio | ||
| 1160 | #ifdef KR_headers | ||
| 1161 | (a, b) Bigint *a, *b; | ||
| 1162 | #else | ||
| 1163 | (Bigint *a, Bigint *b) | ||
| 1164 | #endif | ||
| 1165 | { | ||
| 1166 | _double da, db; | ||
| 1167 | int k, ka, kb; | ||
| 1168 | |||
| 1169 | value(da) = b2d(a, &ka); | ||
| 1170 | value(db) = b2d(b, &kb); | ||
| 1171 | #ifdef Pack_32 | ||
| 1172 | k = ka - kb + 32*(a->wds - b->wds); | ||
| 1173 | #else | ||
| 1174 | k = ka - kb + 16*(a->wds - b->wds); | ||
| 1175 | #endif | ||
| 1176 | #ifdef IBM | ||
| 1177 | if (k > 0) { | ||
| 1178 | word0(da) += (k >> 2)*Exp_msk1; | ||
| 1179 | if (k &= 3) | ||
| 1180 | da *= 1 << k; | ||
| 1181 | } | ||
| 1182 | else { | ||
| 1183 | k = -k; | ||
| 1184 | word0(db) += (k >> 2)*Exp_msk1; | ||
| 1185 | if (k &= 3) | ||
| 1186 | db *= 1 << k; | ||
| 1187 | } | ||
| 1188 | #else | ||
| 1189 | if (k > 0) | ||
| 1190 | word0(da) += k*Exp_msk1; | ||
| 1191 | else { | ||
| 1192 | k = -k; | ||
| 1193 | word0(db) += k*Exp_msk1; | ||
| 1194 | } | ||
| 1195 | #endif | ||
| 1196 | return value(da) / value(db); | ||
| 1197 | } | ||
| 1198 | |||
| 1199 | static CONST double | ||
| 1200 | tens[] = { | ||
| 1201 | 1e0, 1e1, 1e2, 1e3, 1e4, 1e5, 1e6, 1e7, 1e8, 1e9, | ||
| 1202 | 1e10, 1e11, 1e12, 1e13, 1e14, 1e15, 1e16, 1e17, 1e18, 1e19, | ||
| 1203 | 1e20, 1e21, 1e22 | ||
| 1204 | #ifdef VAX | ||
| 1205 | , 1e23, 1e24 | ||
| 1206 | #endif | ||
| 1207 | }; | ||
| 1208 | |||
| 1209 | #ifdef IEEE_Arith | ||
| 1210 | static CONST double bigtens[] = { 1e16, 1e32, 1e64, 1e128, 1e256 }; | ||
| 1211 | static CONST double tinytens[] = { 1e-16, 1e-32, 1e-64, 1e-128, 1e-256 }; | ||
| 1212 | #define n_bigtens 5 | ||
| 1213 | #else | ||
| 1214 | #ifdef IBM | ||
| 1215 | static CONST double bigtens[] = { 1e16, 1e32, 1e64 }; | ||
| 1216 | static CONST double tinytens[] = { 1e-16, 1e-32, 1e-64 }; | ||
| 1217 | #define n_bigtens 3 | ||
| 1218 | #else | ||
| 1219 | static CONST double bigtens[] = { 1e16, 1e32 }; | ||
| 1220 | static CONST double tinytens[] = { 1e-16, 1e-32 }; | ||
| 1221 | #define n_bigtens 2 | ||
| 1222 | #endif | ||
| 1223 | #endif | ||
| 1224 | |||
| 1225 | double | ||
| 1226 | strtod | ||
| 1227 | #ifdef KR_headers | ||
| 1228 | (s00, se) CONST char *s00; char **se; | ||
| 1229 | #else | ||
| 1230 | (CONST char *s00, char **se) | ||
| 1231 | #endif | ||
| 1232 | { | ||
| 1233 | int bb2, bb5, bbe, bd2, bd5, bbbits, bs2, c, dsign, | ||
| 1234 | e, e1, esign, i, j, k, nd, nd0, nf, nz, nz0, sign; | ||
| 1235 | CONST char *s, *s0, *s1; | ||
| 1236 | double aadj, aadj1, adj; | ||
| 1237 | _double rv, rv0; | ||
| 1238 | Long L; | ||
| 1239 | ULong y, z; | ||
| 1240 | Bigint *bb, *bb1, *bd, *bd0, *bs, *delta; | ||
| 1241 | |||
| 1242 | #ifndef KR_headers | ||
| 1243 | CONST char decimal_point = localeconv()->decimal_point[0]; | ||
| 1244 | #else | ||
| 1245 | CONST char decimal_point = '.'; | ||
| 1246 | #endif | ||
| 1247 | |||
| 1248 | sign = nz0 = nz = 0; | ||
| 1249 | value(rv) = 0.; | ||
| 1250 | |||
| 1251 | |||
| 1252 | for(s = s00; isspace((unsigned char) *s); s++) | ||
| 1253 | ; | ||
| 1254 | |||
| 1255 | if (*s == '-') { | ||
| 1256 | sign = 1; | ||
| 1257 | s++; | ||
| 1258 | } else if (*s == '+') { | ||
| 1259 | s++; | ||
| 1260 | } | ||
| 1261 | |||
| 1262 | if (*s == '\0') { | ||
| 1263 | s = s00; | ||
| 1264 | goto ret; | ||
| 1265 | } | ||
| 1266 | |||
| 1267 | if (*s == '0') { | ||
| 1268 | nz0 = 1; | ||
| 1269 | while(*++s == '0') ; | ||
| 1270 | if (!*s) | ||
| 1271 | goto ret; | ||
| 1272 | } | ||
| 1273 | s0 = s; | ||
| 1274 | y = z = 0; | ||
| 1275 | for(nd = nf = 0; (c = *s) >= '0' && c <= '9'; nd++, s++) | ||
| 1276 | if (nd < 9) | ||
| 1277 | y = 10*y + c - '0'; | ||
| 1278 | else if (nd < 16) | ||
| 1279 | z = 10*z + c - '0'; | ||
| 1280 | nd0 = nd; | ||
| 1281 | if (c == decimal_point) { | ||
| 1282 | c = *++s; | ||
| 1283 | if (!nd) { | ||
| 1284 | for(; c == '0'; c = *++s) | ||
| 1285 | nz++; | ||
| 1286 | if (c > '0' && c <= '9') { | ||
| 1287 | s0 = s; | ||
| 1288 | nf += nz; | ||
| 1289 | nz = 0; | ||
| 1290 | goto have_dig; | ||
| 1291 | } | ||
| 1292 | goto dig_done; | ||
| 1293 | } | ||
| 1294 | for(; c >= '0' && c <= '9'; c = *++s) { | ||
| 1295 | have_dig: | ||
| 1296 | nz++; | ||
| 1297 | if (c -= '0') { | ||
| 1298 | nf += nz; | ||
| 1299 | for(i = 1; i < nz; i++) | ||
| 1300 | if (nd++ < 9) | ||
| 1301 | y *= 10; | ||
| 1302 | else if (nd <= DBL_DIG + 1) | ||
| 1303 | z *= 10; | ||
| 1304 | if (nd++ < 9) | ||
| 1305 | y = 10*y + c; | ||
| 1306 | else if (nd <= DBL_DIG + 1) | ||
| 1307 | z = 10*z + c; | ||
| 1308 | nz = 0; | ||
| 1309 | } | ||
| 1310 | } | ||
| 1311 | } | ||
| 1312 | dig_done: | ||
| 1313 | e = 0; | ||
| 1314 | if (c == 'e' || c == 'E') { | ||
| 1315 | if (!nd && !nz && !nz0) { | ||
| 1316 | s = s00; | ||
| 1317 | goto ret; | ||
| 1318 | } | ||
| 1319 | s00 = s; | ||
| 1320 | esign = 0; | ||
| 1321 | switch(c = *++s) { | ||
| 1322 | case '-': | ||
| 1323 | esign = 1; | ||
| 1324 | case '+': | ||
| 1325 | c = *++s; | ||
| 1326 | } | ||
| 1327 | if (c >= '0' && c <= '9') { | ||
| 1328 | while(c == '0') | ||
| 1329 | c = *++s; | ||
| 1330 | if (c > '0' && c <= '9') { | ||
| 1331 | L = c - '0'; | ||
| 1332 | s1 = s; | ||
| 1333 | while((c = *++s) >= '0' && c <= '9') | ||
| 1334 | L = 10*L + c - '0'; | ||
| 1335 | if (s - s1 > 8 || L > 19999) | ||
| 1336 | /* Avoid confusion from exponents | ||
| 1337 | * so large that e might overflow. | ||
| 1338 | */ | ||
| 1339 | e = 19999; /* safe for 16 bit ints */ | ||
| 1340 | else | ||
| 1341 | e = (int)L; | ||
| 1342 | if (esign) | ||
| 1343 | e = -e; | ||
| 1344 | } | ||
| 1345 | else | ||
| 1346 | e = 0; | ||
| 1347 | } | ||
| 1348 | else | ||
| 1349 | s = s00; | ||
| 1350 | } | ||
| 1351 | if (!nd) { | ||
| 1352 | if (!nz && !nz0) | ||
| 1353 | s = s00; | ||
| 1354 | goto ret; | ||
| 1355 | } | ||
| 1356 | e1 = e -= nf; | ||
| 1357 | |||
| 1358 | /* Now we have nd0 digits, starting at s0, followed by a | ||
| 1359 | * decimal point, followed by nd-nd0 digits. The number we're | ||
| 1360 | * after is the integer represented by those digits times | ||
| 1361 | * 10**e */ | ||
| 1362 | |||
| 1363 | if (!nd0) | ||
| 1364 | nd0 = nd; | ||
| 1365 | k = nd < DBL_DIG + 1 ? nd : DBL_DIG + 1; | ||
| 1366 | value(rv) = y; | ||
| 1367 | if (k > 9) | ||
| 1368 | value(rv) = tens[k - 9] * value(rv) + z; | ||
| 1369 | bd0 = 0; | ||
| 1370 | if (nd <= DBL_DIG | ||
| 1371 | #ifndef RND_PRODQUOT | ||
| 1372 | && FLT_ROUNDS == 1 | ||
| 1373 | #endif | ||
| 1374 | ) { | ||
| 1375 | if (!e) | ||
| 1376 | goto ret; | ||
| 1377 | if (e > 0) { | ||
| 1378 | if (e <= Ten_pmax) { | ||
| 1379 | #ifdef VAX | ||
| 1380 | goto vax_ovfl_check; | ||
| 1381 | #else | ||
| 1382 | /* value(rv) = */ rounded_product(value(rv), | ||
| 1383 | tens[e]); | ||
| 1384 | goto ret; | ||
| 1385 | #endif | ||
| 1386 | } | ||
| 1387 | i = DBL_DIG - nd; | ||
| 1388 | if (e <= Ten_pmax + i) { | ||
| 1389 | /* A fancier test would sometimes let us do | ||
| 1390 | * this for larger i values. | ||
| 1391 | */ | ||
| 1392 | e -= i; | ||
| 1393 | value(rv) *= tens[i]; | ||
| 1394 | #ifdef VAX | ||
| 1395 | /* VAX exponent range is so narrow we must | ||
| 1396 | * worry about overflow here... | ||
| 1397 | */ | ||
| 1398 | vax_ovfl_check: | ||
| 1399 | word0(rv) -= P*Exp_msk1; | ||
| 1400 | /* value(rv) = */ rounded_product(value(rv), | ||
| 1401 | tens[e]); | ||
| 1402 | if ((word0(rv) & Exp_mask) | ||
| 1403 | > Exp_msk1*(DBL_MAX_EXP+Bias-1-P)) | ||
| 1404 | goto ovfl; | ||
| 1405 | word0(rv) += P*Exp_msk1; | ||
| 1406 | #else | ||
| 1407 | /* value(rv) = */ rounded_product(value(rv), | ||
| 1408 | tens[e]); | ||
| 1409 | #endif | ||
| 1410 | goto ret; | ||
| 1411 | } | ||
| 1412 | } | ||
| 1413 | #ifndef Inaccurate_Divide | ||
| 1414 | else if (e >= -Ten_pmax) { | ||
| 1415 | /* value(rv) = */ rounded_quotient(value(rv), | ||
| 1416 | tens[-e]); | ||
| 1417 | goto ret; | ||
| 1418 | } | ||
| 1419 | #endif | ||
| 1420 | } | ||
| 1421 | e1 += nd - k; | ||
| 1422 | |||
| 1423 | /* Get starting approximation = rv * 10**e1 */ | ||
| 1424 | |||
| 1425 | if (e1 > 0) { | ||
| 1426 | if (i = e1 & 15) | ||
| 1427 | value(rv) *= tens[i]; | ||
| 1428 | if (e1 &= ~15) { | ||
| 1429 | if (e1 > DBL_MAX_10_EXP) { | ||
| 1430 | ovfl: | ||
| 1431 | errno = ERANGE; | ||
| 1432 | #ifndef Bad_float_h | ||
| 1433 | value(rv) = HUGE_VAL; | ||
| 1434 | #else | ||
| 1435 | /* Can't trust HUGE_VAL */ | ||
| 1436 | #ifdef IEEE_Arith | ||
| 1437 | word0(rv) = Exp_mask; | ||
| 1438 | word1(rv) = 0; | ||
| 1439 | #else | ||
| 1440 | word0(rv) = Big0; | ||
| 1441 | word1(rv) = Big1; | ||
| 1442 | #endif | ||
| 1443 | #endif | ||
| 1444 | if (bd0) | ||
| 1445 | goto retfree; | ||
| 1446 | goto ret; | ||
| 1447 | } | ||
| 1448 | if (e1 >>= 4) { | ||
| 1449 | for(j = 0; e1 > 1; j++, e1 >>= 1) | ||
| 1450 | if (e1 & 1) | ||
| 1451 | value(rv) *= bigtens[j]; | ||
| 1452 | /* The last multiplication could overflow. */ | ||
| 1453 | word0(rv) -= P*Exp_msk1; | ||
| 1454 | value(rv) *= bigtens[j]; | ||
| 1455 | if ((z = word0(rv) & Exp_mask) | ||
| 1456 | > Exp_msk1*(DBL_MAX_EXP+Bias-P)) | ||
| 1457 | goto ovfl; | ||
| 1458 | if (z > Exp_msk1*(DBL_MAX_EXP+Bias-1-P)) { | ||
| 1459 | /* set to largest number */ | ||
| 1460 | /* (Can't trust DBL_MAX) */ | ||
| 1461 | word0(rv) = Big0; | ||
| 1462 | word1(rv) = Big1; | ||
| 1463 | } | ||
| 1464 | else | ||
| 1465 | word0(rv) += P*Exp_msk1; | ||
| 1466 | } | ||
| 1467 | |||
| 1468 | } | ||
| 1469 | } | ||
| 1470 | else if (e1 < 0) { | ||
| 1471 | e1 = -e1; | ||
| 1472 | if (i = e1 & 15) | ||
| 1473 | value(rv) /= tens[i]; | ||
| 1474 | if (e1 &= ~15) { | ||
| 1475 | e1 >>= 4; | ||
| 1476 | if (e1 >= 1 << n_bigtens) | ||
| 1477 | goto undfl; | ||
| 1478 | for(j = 0; e1 > 1; j++, e1 >>= 1) | ||
| 1479 | if (e1 & 1) | ||
| 1480 | value(rv) *= tinytens[j]; | ||
| 1481 | /* The last multiplication could underflow. */ | ||
| 1482 | value(rv0) = value(rv); | ||
| 1483 | value(rv) *= tinytens[j]; | ||
| 1484 | if (!value(rv)) { | ||
| 1485 | value(rv) = 2.*value(rv0); | ||
| 1486 | value(rv) *= tinytens[j]; | ||
| 1487 | if (!value(rv)) { | ||
| 1488 | undfl: | ||
| 1489 | value(rv) = 0.; | ||
| 1490 | errno = ERANGE; | ||
| 1491 | if (bd0) | ||
| 1492 | goto retfree; | ||
| 1493 | goto ret; | ||
| 1494 | } | ||
| 1495 | word0(rv) = Tiny0; | ||
| 1496 | word1(rv) = Tiny1; | ||
| 1497 | /* The refinement below will clean | ||
| 1498 | * this approximation up. | ||
| 1499 | */ | ||
| 1500 | } | ||
| 1501 | } | ||
| 1502 | } | ||
| 1503 | |||
| 1504 | /* Now the hard part -- adjusting rv to the correct value.*/ | ||
| 1505 | |||
| 1506 | /* Put digits into bd: true value = bd * 10^e */ | ||
| 1507 | |||
| 1508 | bd0 = s2b(s0, nd0, nd, y); | ||
| 1509 | |||
| 1510 | for(;;) { | ||
| 1511 | bd = Balloc(bd0->k); | ||
| 1512 | Bcopy(bd, bd0); | ||
| 1513 | bb = d2b(value(rv), &bbe, &bbbits); /* rv = bb * 2^bbe */ | ||
| 1514 | bs = i2b(1); | ||
| 1515 | |||
| 1516 | if (e >= 0) { | ||
| 1517 | bb2 = bb5 = 0; | ||
| 1518 | bd2 = bd5 = e; | ||
| 1519 | } | ||
| 1520 | else { | ||
| 1521 | bb2 = bb5 = -e; | ||
| 1522 | bd2 = bd5 = 0; | ||
| 1523 | } | ||
| 1524 | if (bbe >= 0) | ||
| 1525 | bb2 += bbe; | ||
| 1526 | else | ||
| 1527 | bd2 -= bbe; | ||
| 1528 | bs2 = bb2; | ||
| 1529 | #ifdef Sudden_Underflow | ||
| 1530 | #ifdef IBM | ||
| 1531 | j = 1 + 4*P - 3 - bbbits + ((bbe + bbbits - 1) & 3); | ||
| 1532 | #else | ||
| 1533 | j = P + 1 - bbbits; | ||
| 1534 | #endif | ||
| 1535 | #else | ||
| 1536 | i = bbe + bbbits - 1; /* logb(rv) */ | ||
| 1537 | if (i < Emin) /* denormal */ | ||
| 1538 | j = bbe + (P-Emin); | ||
| 1539 | else | ||
| 1540 | j = P + 1 - bbbits; | ||
| 1541 | #endif | ||
| 1542 | bb2 += j; | ||
| 1543 | bd2 += j; | ||
| 1544 | i = bb2 < bd2 ? bb2 : bd2; | ||
| 1545 | if (i > bs2) | ||
| 1546 | i = bs2; | ||
| 1547 | if (i > 0) { | ||
| 1548 | bb2 -= i; | ||
| 1549 | bd2 -= i; | ||
| 1550 | bs2 -= i; | ||
| 1551 | } | ||
| 1552 | if (bb5 > 0) { | ||
| 1553 | bs = pow5mult(bs, bb5); | ||
| 1554 | bb1 = mult(bs, bb); | ||
| 1555 | Bfree(bb); | ||
| 1556 | bb = bb1; | ||
| 1557 | } | ||
| 1558 | if (bb2 > 0) | ||
| 1559 | bb = lshift(bb, bb2); | ||
| 1560 | if (bd5 > 0) | ||
| 1561 | bd = pow5mult(bd, bd5); | ||
| 1562 | if (bd2 > 0) | ||
| 1563 | bd = lshift(bd, bd2); | ||
| 1564 | if (bs2 > 0) | ||
| 1565 | bs = lshift(bs, bs2); | ||
| 1566 | delta = diff(bb, bd); | ||
| 1567 | dsign = delta->sign; | ||
| 1568 | delta->sign = 0; | ||
| 1569 | i = cmp(delta, bs); | ||
| 1570 | if (i < 0) { | ||
| 1571 | /* Error is less than half an ulp -- check for | ||
| 1572 | * special case of mantissa a power of two. | ||
| 1573 | */ | ||
| 1574 | if (dsign || word1(rv) || word0(rv) & Bndry_mask) | ||
| 1575 | break; | ||
| 1576 | delta = lshift(delta,Log2P); | ||
| 1577 | if (cmp(delta, bs) > 0) | ||
| 1578 | goto drop_down; | ||
| 1579 | break; | ||
| 1580 | } | ||
| 1581 | if (i == 0) { | ||
| 1582 | /* exactly half-way between */ | ||
| 1583 | if (dsign) { | ||
| 1584 | if ((word0(rv) & Bndry_mask1) == Bndry_mask1 | ||
| 1585 | && word1(rv) == 0xffffffff) { | ||
| 1586 | /*boundary case -- increment exponent*/ | ||
| 1587 | word0(rv) = (word0(rv) & Exp_mask) | ||
| 1588 | + Exp_msk1 | ||
| 1589 | #ifdef IBM | ||
| 1590 | | Exp_msk1 >> 4 | ||
| 1591 | #endif | ||
| 1592 | ; | ||
| 1593 | word1(rv) = 0; | ||
| 1594 | break; | ||
| 1595 | } | ||
| 1596 | } | ||
| 1597 | else if (!(word0(rv) & Bndry_mask) && !word1(rv)) { | ||
| 1598 | drop_down: | ||
| 1599 | /* boundary case -- decrement exponent */ | ||
| 1600 | #ifdef Sudden_Underflow | ||
| 1601 | L = word0(rv) & Exp_mask; | ||
| 1602 | #ifdef IBM | ||
| 1603 | if (L < Exp_msk1) | ||
| 1604 | #else | ||
| 1605 | if (L <= Exp_msk1) | ||
| 1606 | #endif | ||
| 1607 | goto undfl; | ||
| 1608 | L -= Exp_msk1; | ||
| 1609 | #else | ||
| 1610 | L = (word0(rv) & Exp_mask) - Exp_msk1; | ||
| 1611 | #endif | ||
| 1612 | word0(rv) = L | Bndry_mask1; | ||
| 1613 | word1(rv) = 0xffffffff; | ||
| 1614 | #ifdef IBM | ||
| 1615 | goto cont; | ||
| 1616 | #else | ||
| 1617 | break; | ||
| 1618 | #endif | ||
| 1619 | } | ||
| 1620 | #ifndef ROUND_BIASED | ||
| 1621 | if (!(word1(rv) & LSB)) | ||
| 1622 | break; | ||
| 1623 | #endif | ||
| 1624 | if (dsign) | ||
| 1625 | value(rv) += ulp(value(rv)); | ||
| 1626 | #ifndef ROUND_BIASED | ||
| 1627 | else { | ||
| 1628 | value(rv) -= ulp(value(rv)); | ||
| 1629 | #ifndef Sudden_Underflow | ||
| 1630 | if (!value(rv)) | ||
| 1631 | goto undfl; | ||
| 1632 | #endif | ||
| 1633 | } | ||
| 1634 | #endif | ||
| 1635 | break; | ||
| 1636 | } | ||
| 1637 | if ((aadj = ratio(delta, bs)) <= 2.) { | ||
| 1638 | if (dsign) | ||
| 1639 | aadj = aadj1 = 1.; | ||
| 1640 | else if (word1(rv) || word0(rv) & Bndry_mask) { | ||
| 1641 | #ifndef Sudden_Underflow | ||
| 1642 | if (word1(rv) == Tiny1 && !word0(rv)) | ||
| 1643 | goto undfl; | ||
| 1644 | #endif | ||
| 1645 | aadj = 1.; | ||
| 1646 | aadj1 = -1.; | ||
| 1647 | } | ||
| 1648 | else { | ||
| 1649 | /* special case -- power of FLT_RADIX to be */ | ||
| 1650 | /* rounded down... */ | ||
| 1651 | |||
| 1652 | if (aadj < 2./FLT_RADIX) | ||
| 1653 | aadj = 1./FLT_RADIX; | ||
| 1654 | else | ||
| 1655 | aadj *= 0.5; | ||
| 1656 | aadj1 = -aadj; | ||
| 1657 | } | ||
| 1658 | } | ||
| 1659 | else { | ||
| 1660 | aadj *= 0.5; | ||
| 1661 | aadj1 = dsign ? aadj : -aadj; | ||
| 1662 | #ifdef Check_FLT_ROUNDS | ||
| 1663 | switch(FLT_ROUNDS) { | ||
| 1664 | case 2: /* towards +infinity */ | ||
| 1665 | aadj1 -= 0.5; | ||
| 1666 | break; | ||
| 1667 | case 0: /* towards 0 */ | ||
| 1668 | case 3: /* towards -infinity */ | ||
| 1669 | aadj1 += 0.5; | ||
| 1670 | } | ||
| 1671 | #else | ||
| 1672 | if (FLT_ROUNDS == 0) | ||
| 1673 | aadj1 += 0.5; | ||
| 1674 | #endif | ||
| 1675 | } | ||
| 1676 | y = word0(rv) & Exp_mask; | ||
| 1677 | |||
| 1678 | /* Check for overflow */ | ||
| 1679 | |||
| 1680 | if (y == Exp_msk1*(DBL_MAX_EXP+Bias-1)) { | ||
| 1681 | value(rv0) = value(rv); | ||
| 1682 | word0(rv) -= P*Exp_msk1; | ||
| 1683 | adj = aadj1 * ulp(value(rv)); | ||
| 1684 | value(rv) += adj; | ||
| 1685 | if ((word0(rv) & Exp_mask) >= | ||
| 1686 | Exp_msk1*(DBL_MAX_EXP+Bias-P)) { | ||
| 1687 | if (word0(rv0) == Big0 && word1(rv0) == Big1) | ||
| 1688 | goto ovfl; | ||
| 1689 | word0(rv) = Big0; | ||
| 1690 | word1(rv) = Big1; | ||
| 1691 | goto cont; | ||
| 1692 | } | ||
| 1693 | else | ||
| 1694 | word0(rv) += P*Exp_msk1; | ||
| 1695 | } | ||
| 1696 | else { | ||
| 1697 | #ifdef Sudden_Underflow | ||
| 1698 | if ((word0(rv) & Exp_mask) <= P*Exp_msk1) { | ||
| 1699 | value(rv0) = value(rv); | ||
| 1700 | word0(rv) += P*Exp_msk1; | ||
| 1701 | adj = aadj1 * ulp(value(rv)); | ||
| 1702 | value(rv) += adj; | ||
| 1703 | #ifdef IBM | ||
| 1704 | if ((word0(rv) & Exp_mask) < P*Exp_msk1) | ||
| 1705 | #else | ||
| 1706 | if ((word0(rv) & Exp_mask) <= P*Exp_msk1) | ||
| 1707 | #endif | ||
| 1708 | { | ||
| 1709 | if (word0(rv0) == Tiny0 | ||
| 1710 | && word1(rv0) == Tiny1) | ||
| 1711 | goto undfl; | ||
| 1712 | word0(rv) = Tiny0; | ||
| 1713 | word1(rv) = Tiny1; | ||
| 1714 | goto cont; | ||
| 1715 | } | ||
| 1716 | else | ||
| 1717 | word0(rv) -= P*Exp_msk1; | ||
| 1718 | } | ||
| 1719 | else { | ||
| 1720 | adj = aadj1 * ulp(value(rv)); | ||
| 1721 | value(rv) += adj; | ||
| 1722 | } | ||
| 1723 | #else | ||
| 1724 | /* Compute adj so that the IEEE rounding rules will | ||
| 1725 | * correctly round rv + adj in some half-way cases. | ||
| 1726 | * If rv * ulp(rv) is denormalized (i.e., | ||
| 1727 | * y <= (P-1)*Exp_msk1), we must adjust aadj to avoid | ||
| 1728 | * trouble from bits lost to denormalization; | ||
| 1729 | * example: 1.2e-307 . | ||
| 1730 | */ | ||
| 1731 | if (y <= (P-1)*Exp_msk1 && aadj >= 1.) { | ||
| 1732 | aadj1 = (double)(int)(aadj + 0.5); | ||
| 1733 | if (!dsign) | ||
| 1734 | aadj1 = -aadj1; | ||
| 1735 | } | ||
| 1736 | adj = aadj1 * ulp(value(rv)); | ||
| 1737 | value(rv) += adj; | ||
| 1738 | #endif | ||
| 1739 | } | ||
| 1740 | z = word0(rv) & Exp_mask; | ||
| 1741 | if (y == z) { | ||
| 1742 | /* Can we stop now? */ | ||
| 1743 | L = aadj; | ||
| 1744 | aadj -= L; | ||
| 1745 | /* The tolerances below are conservative. */ | ||
| 1746 | if (dsign || word1(rv) || word0(rv) & Bndry_mask) { | ||
| 1747 | if (aadj < .4999999 || aadj > .5000001) | ||
| 1748 | break; | ||
| 1749 | } | ||
| 1750 | else if (aadj < .4999999/FLT_RADIX) | ||
| 1751 | break; | ||
| 1752 | } | ||
| 1753 | cont: | ||
| 1754 | Bfree(bb); | ||
| 1755 | Bfree(bd); | ||
| 1756 | Bfree(bs); | ||
| 1757 | Bfree(delta); | ||
| 1758 | } | ||
| 1759 | retfree: | ||
| 1760 | Bfree(bb); | ||
| 1761 | Bfree(bd); | ||
| 1762 | Bfree(bs); | ||
| 1763 | Bfree(bd0); | ||
| 1764 | Bfree(delta); | ||
| 1765 | ret: | ||
| 1766 | if (se) | ||
| 1767 | *se = (char *)s; | ||
| 1768 | return sign ? -value(rv) : value(rv); | ||
| 1769 | } | ||
| 1770 | |||
| 1771 | static int | ||
| 1772 | quorem | ||
| 1773 | #ifdef KR_headers | ||
| 1774 | (b, S) Bigint *b, *S; | ||
| 1775 | #else | ||
| 1776 | (Bigint *b, Bigint *S) | ||
| 1777 | #endif | ||
| 1778 | { | ||
| 1779 | int n; | ||
| 1780 | Long borrow, y; | ||
| 1781 | ULong carry, q, ys; | ||
| 1782 | ULong *bx, *bxe, *sx, *sxe; | ||
| 1783 | #ifdef Pack_32 | ||
| 1784 | Long z; | ||
| 1785 | ULong si, zs; | ||
| 1786 | #endif | ||
| 1787 | |||
| 1788 | n = S->wds; | ||
| 1789 | #ifdef DEBUG | ||
| 1790 | /*debug*/ if (b->wds > n) | ||
| 1791 | /*debug*/ Bug("oversize b in quorem"); | ||
| 1792 | #endif | ||
| 1793 | if (b->wds < n) | ||
| 1794 | return 0; | ||
| 1795 | sx = S->x; | ||
| 1796 | sxe = sx + --n; | ||
| 1797 | bx = b->x; | ||
| 1798 | bxe = bx + n; | ||
| 1799 | q = *bxe / (*sxe + 1); /* ensure q <= true quotient */ | ||
| 1800 | #ifdef DEBUG | ||
| 1801 | /*debug*/ if (q > 9) | ||
| 1802 | /*debug*/ Bug("oversized quotient in quorem"); | ||
| 1803 | #endif | ||
| 1804 | if (q) { | ||
| 1805 | borrow = 0; | ||
| 1806 | carry = 0; | ||
| 1807 | do { | ||
| 1808 | #ifdef Pack_32 | ||
| 1809 | si = *sx++; | ||
| 1810 | ys = (si & 0xffff) * q + carry; | ||
| 1811 | zs = (si >> 16) * q + (ys >> 16); | ||
| 1812 | carry = zs >> 16; | ||
| 1813 | y = (*bx & 0xffff) - (ys & 0xffff) + borrow; | ||
| 1814 | borrow = y >> 16; | ||
| 1815 | Sign_Extend(borrow, y); | ||
| 1816 | z = (*bx >> 16) - (zs & 0xffff) + borrow; | ||
| 1817 | borrow = z >> 16; | ||
| 1818 | Sign_Extend(borrow, z); | ||
| 1819 | Storeinc(bx, z, y); | ||
| 1820 | #else | ||
| 1821 | ys = *sx++ * q + carry; | ||
| 1822 | carry = ys >> 16; | ||
| 1823 | y = *bx - (ys & 0xffff) + borrow; | ||
| 1824 | borrow = y >> 16; | ||
| 1825 | Sign_Extend(borrow, y); | ||
| 1826 | *bx++ = y & 0xffff; | ||
| 1827 | #endif | ||
| 1828 | } | ||
| 1829 | while(sx <= sxe); | ||
| 1830 | if (!*bxe) { | ||
| 1831 | bx = b->x; | ||
| 1832 | while(--bxe > bx && !*bxe) | ||
| 1833 | --n; | ||
| 1834 | b->wds = n; | ||
| 1835 | } | ||
| 1836 | } | ||
| 1837 | if (cmp(b, S) >= 0) { | ||
| 1838 | q++; | ||
| 1839 | borrow = 0; | ||
| 1840 | carry = 0; | ||
| 1841 | bx = b->x; | ||
| 1842 | sx = S->x; | ||
| 1843 | do { | ||
| 1844 | #ifdef Pack_32 | ||
| 1845 | si = *sx++; | ||
| 1846 | ys = (si & 0xffff) + carry; | ||
| 1847 | zs = (si >> 16) + (ys >> 16); | ||
| 1848 | carry = zs >> 16; | ||
| 1849 | y = (*bx & 0xffff) - (ys & 0xffff) + borrow; | ||
| 1850 | borrow = y >> 16; | ||
| 1851 | Sign_Extend(borrow, y); | ||
| 1852 | z = (*bx >> 16) - (zs & 0xffff) + borrow; | ||
| 1853 | borrow = z >> 16; | ||
| 1854 | Sign_Extend(borrow, z); | ||
| 1855 | Storeinc(bx, z, y); | ||
| 1856 | #else | ||
| 1857 | ys = *sx++ + carry; | ||
| 1858 | carry = ys >> 16; | ||
| 1859 | y = *bx - (ys & 0xffff) + borrow; | ||
| 1860 | borrow = y >> 16; | ||
| 1861 | Sign_Extend(borrow, y); | ||
| 1862 | *bx++ = y & 0xffff; | ||
| 1863 | #endif | ||
| 1864 | } | ||
| 1865 | while(sx <= sxe); | ||
| 1866 | bx = b->x; | ||
| 1867 | bxe = bx + n; | ||
| 1868 | if (!*bxe) { | ||
| 1869 | while(--bxe > bx && !*bxe) | ||
| 1870 | --n; | ||
| 1871 | b->wds = n; | ||
| 1872 | } | ||
| 1873 | } | ||
| 1874 | return q; | ||
| 1875 | } | ||
| 1876 | |||
| 1877 | /* dtoa for IEEE arithmetic (dmg): convert double to ASCII string. | ||
| 1878 | * | ||
| 1879 | * Inspired by "How to Print Floating-Point Numbers Accurately" by | ||
| 1880 | * Guy L. Steele, Jr. and Jon L. White [Proc. ACM SIGPLAN '90, pp. 92-101]. | ||
| 1881 | * | ||
| 1882 | * Modifications: | ||
| 1883 | * 1. Rather than iterating, we use a simple numeric overestimate | ||
| 1884 | * to determine k = floor(log10(d)). We scale relevant | ||
| 1885 | * quantities using O(log2(k)) rather than O(k) multiplications. | ||
| 1886 | * 2. For some modes > 2 (corresponding to ecvt and fcvt), we don't | ||
| 1887 | * try to generate digits strictly left to right. Instead, we | ||
| 1888 | * compute with fewer bits and propagate the carry if necessary | ||
| 1889 | * when rounding the final digit up. This is often faster. | ||
| 1890 | * 3. Under the assumption that input will be rounded nearest, | ||
| 1891 | * mode 0 renders 1e23 as 1e23 rather than 9.999999999999999e22. | ||
| 1892 | * That is, we allow equality in stopping tests when the | ||
| 1893 | * round-nearest rule will give the same floating-point value | ||
| 1894 | * as would satisfaction of the stopping test with strict | ||
| 1895 | * inequality. | ||
| 1896 | * 4. We remove common factors of powers of 2 from relevant | ||
| 1897 | * quantities. | ||
| 1898 | * 5. When converting floating-point integers less than 1e16, | ||
| 1899 | * we use floating-point arithmetic rather than resorting | ||
| 1900 | * to multiple-precision integers. | ||
| 1901 | * 6. When asked to produce fewer than 15 digits, we first try | ||
| 1902 | * to get by with floating-point arithmetic; we resort to | ||
| 1903 | * multiple-precision integer arithmetic only if we cannot | ||
| 1904 | * guarantee that the floating-point calculation has given | ||
| 1905 | * the correctly rounded result. For k requested digits and | ||
| 1906 | * "uniformly" distributed input, the probability is | ||
| 1907 | * something like 10^(k-15) that we must resort to the Long | ||
| 1908 | * calculation. | ||
| 1909 | */ | ||
| 1910 | |||
| 1911 | char * | ||
| 1912 | __dtoa | ||
| 1913 | #ifdef KR_headers | ||
| 1914 | (_d, mode, ndigits, decpt, sign, rve) | ||
| 1915 | double _d; int mode, ndigits, *decpt, *sign; char **rve; | ||
| 1916 | #else | ||
| 1917 | (double _d, int mode, int ndigits, int *decpt, int *sign, char **rve) | ||
| 1918 | #endif | ||
| 1919 | { | ||
| 1920 | /* Arguments ndigits, decpt, sign are similar to those | ||
| 1921 | of ecvt and fcvt; trailing zeros are suppressed from | ||
| 1922 | the returned string. If not null, *rve is set to point | ||
| 1923 | to the end of the return value. If d is +-Infinity or NaN, | ||
| 1924 | then *decpt is set to 9999. | ||
| 1925 | |||
| 1926 | mode: | ||
| 1927 | 0 ==> shortest string that yields d when read in | ||
| 1928 | and rounded to nearest. | ||
| 1929 | 1 ==> like 0, but with Steele & White stopping rule; | ||
| 1930 | e.g. with IEEE P754 arithmetic , mode 0 gives | ||
| 1931 | 1e23 whereas mode 1 gives 9.999999999999999e22. | ||
| 1932 | 2 ==> max(1,ndigits) significant digits. This gives a | ||
| 1933 | return value similar to that of ecvt, except | ||
| 1934 | that trailing zeros are suppressed. | ||
| 1935 | 3 ==> through ndigits past the decimal point. This | ||
| 1936 | gives a return value similar to that from fcvt, | ||
| 1937 | except that trailing zeros are suppressed, and | ||
| 1938 | ndigits can be negative. | ||
| 1939 | 4-9 should give the same return values as 2-3, i.e., | ||
| 1940 | 4 <= mode <= 9 ==> same return as mode | ||
| 1941 | 2 + (mode & 1). These modes are mainly for | ||
| 1942 | debugging; often they run slower but sometimes | ||
| 1943 | faster than modes 2-3. | ||
| 1944 | 4,5,8,9 ==> left-to-right digit generation. | ||
| 1945 | 6-9 ==> don't try fast floating-point estimate | ||
| 1946 | (if applicable). | ||
| 1947 | |||
| 1948 | Values of mode other than 0-9 are treated as mode 0. | ||
| 1949 | |||
| 1950 | Sufficient space is allocated to the return value | ||
| 1951 | to hold the suppressed trailing zeros. | ||
| 1952 | */ | ||
| 1953 | |||
| 1954 | int bbits, b2, b5, be, dig, i, ieps, ilim, ilim0, ilim1, | ||
| 1955 | j, j1, k, k0, k_check, leftright, m2, m5, s2, s5, | ||
| 1956 | spec_case, try_quick; | ||
| 1957 | Long L; | ||
| 1958 | #ifndef Sudden_Underflow | ||
| 1959 | int denorm; | ||
| 1960 | ULong x; | ||
| 1961 | #endif | ||
| 1962 | Bigint *b, *b1, *delta, *mlo, *mhi, *S; | ||
| 1963 | double ds; | ||
| 1964 | char *s, *s0; | ||
| 1965 | static Bigint *result; | ||
| 1966 | static int result_k; | ||
| 1967 | _double d, d2, eps; | ||
| 1968 | |||
| 1969 | value(d) = _d; | ||
| 1970 | if (result) { | ||
| 1971 | result->k = result_k; | ||
| 1972 | result->maxwds = 1 << result_k; | ||
| 1973 | Bfree(result); | ||
| 1974 | result = 0; | ||
| 1975 | } | ||
| 1976 | |||
| 1977 | if (word0(d) & Sign_bit) { | ||
| 1978 | /* set sign for everything, including 0's and NaNs */ | ||
| 1979 | *sign = 1; | ||
| 1980 | word0(d) &= ~Sign_bit; /* clear sign bit */ | ||
| 1981 | } | ||
| 1982 | else | ||
| 1983 | *sign = 0; | ||
| 1984 | |||
| 1985 | #if defined(IEEE_Arith) + defined(VAX) | ||
| 1986 | #ifdef IEEE_Arith | ||
| 1987 | if ((word0(d) & Exp_mask) == Exp_mask) | ||
| 1988 | #else | ||
| 1989 | if (word0(d) == 0x8000) | ||
| 1990 | #endif | ||
| 1991 | { | ||
| 1992 | /* Infinity or NaN */ | ||
| 1993 | *decpt = 9999; | ||
| 1994 | s = | ||
| 1995 | #ifdef IEEE_Arith | ||
| 1996 | !word1(d) && !(word0(d) & 0xfffff) ? ndigits < 8 ? "Inf" : "Infinity" : | ||
| 1997 | #endif | ||
| 1998 | "NaN"; | ||
| 1999 | if (rve) | ||
| 2000 | *rve = | ||
| 2001 | #ifdef IEEE_Arith | ||
| 2002 | s[3] ? s + 8 : | ||
| 2003 | #endif | ||
| 2004 | s + 3; | ||
| 2005 | return s; | ||
| 2006 | } | ||
| 2007 | #endif | ||
| 2008 | #ifdef IBM | ||
| 2009 | value(d) += 0; /* normalize */ | ||
| 2010 | #endif | ||
| 2011 | if (!value(d)) { | ||
| 2012 | *decpt = 1; | ||
| 2013 | s = "0"; | ||
| 2014 | if (rve) | ||
| 2015 | *rve = s + 1; | ||
| 2016 | return s; | ||
| 2017 | } | ||
| 2018 | |||
| 2019 | b = d2b(value(d), &be, &bbits); | ||
| 2020 | #ifdef Sudden_Underflow | ||
| 2021 | i = (int)(word0(d) >> Exp_shift1 & (Exp_mask>>Exp_shift1)); | ||
| 2022 | #else | ||
| 2023 | if (i = (int)(word0(d) >> Exp_shift1 & (Exp_mask>>Exp_shift1))) { | ||
| 2024 | #endif | ||
| 2025 | value(d2) = value(d); | ||
| 2026 | word0(d2) &= Frac_mask1; | ||
| 2027 | word0(d2) |= Exp_11; | ||
| 2028 | #ifdef IBM | ||
| 2029 | if (j = 11 - hi0bits(word0(d2) & Frac_mask)) | ||
| 2030 | value(d2) /= 1 << j; | ||
| 2031 | #endif | ||
| 2032 | |||
| 2033 | /* log(x) ~=~ log(1.5) + (x-1.5)/1.5 | ||
| 2034 | * log10(x) = log(x) / log(10) | ||
| 2035 | * ~=~ log(1.5)/log(10) + (x-1.5)/(1.5*log(10)) | ||
| 2036 | * log10(d) = (i-Bias)*log(2)/log(10) + log10(d2) | ||
| 2037 | * | ||
| 2038 | * This suggests computing an approximation k to log10(d) by | ||
| 2039 | * | ||
| 2040 | * k = (i - Bias)*0.301029995663981 | ||
| 2041 | * + ( (d2-1.5)*0.289529654602168 + 0.176091259055681 ); | ||
| 2042 | * | ||
| 2043 | * We want k to be too large rather than too small. | ||
| 2044 | * The error in the first-order Taylor series approximation | ||
| 2045 | * is in our favor, so we just round up the constant enough | ||
| 2046 | * to compensate for any error in the multiplication of | ||
| 2047 | * (i - Bias) by 0.301029995663981; since |i - Bias| <= 1077, | ||
| 2048 | * and 1077 * 0.30103 * 2^-52 ~=~ 7.2e-14, | ||
| 2049 | * adding 1e-13 to the constant term more than suffices. | ||
| 2050 | * Hence we adjust the constant term to 0.1760912590558. | ||
| 2051 | * (We could get a more accurate k by invoking log10, | ||
| 2052 | * but this is probably not worthwhile.) | ||
| 2053 | */ | ||
| 2054 | |||
| 2055 | i -= Bias; | ||
| 2056 | #ifdef IBM | ||
| 2057 | i <<= 2; | ||
| 2058 | i += j; | ||
| 2059 | #endif | ||
| 2060 | #ifndef Sudden_Underflow | ||
| 2061 | denorm = 0; | ||
| 2062 | } | ||
| 2063 | else { | ||
| 2064 | /* d is denormalized */ | ||
| 2065 | |||
| 2066 | i = bbits + be + (Bias + (P-1) - 1); | ||
| 2067 | x = i > 32 ? word0(d) << 64 - i | word1(d) >> i - 32 | ||
| 2068 | : word1(d) << 32 - i; | ||
| 2069 | value(d2) = x; | ||
| 2070 | word0(d2) -= 31*Exp_msk1; /* adjust exponent */ | ||
| 2071 | i -= (Bias + (P-1) - 1) + 1; | ||
| 2072 | denorm = 1; | ||
| 2073 | } | ||
| 2074 | #endif | ||
| 2075 | ds = (value(d2)-1.5)*0.289529654602168 + 0.1760912590558 + | ||
| 2076 | i*0.301029995663981; | ||
| 2077 | k = (int)ds; | ||
| 2078 | if (ds < 0. && ds != k) | ||
| 2079 | k--; /* want k = floor(ds) */ | ||
| 2080 | k_check = 1; | ||
| 2081 | if (k >= 0 && k <= Ten_pmax) { | ||
| 2082 | if (value(d) < tens[k]) | ||
| 2083 | k--; | ||
| 2084 | k_check = 0; | ||
| 2085 | } | ||
| 2086 | j = bbits - i - 1; | ||
| 2087 | if (j >= 0) { | ||
| 2088 | b2 = 0; | ||
| 2089 | s2 = j; | ||
| 2090 | } | ||
| 2091 | else { | ||
| 2092 | b2 = -j; | ||
| 2093 | s2 = 0; | ||
| 2094 | } | ||
| 2095 | if (k >= 0) { | ||
| 2096 | b5 = 0; | ||
| 2097 | s5 = k; | ||
| 2098 | s2 += k; | ||
| 2099 | } | ||
| 2100 | else { | ||
| 2101 | b2 -= k; | ||
| 2102 | b5 = -k; | ||
| 2103 | s5 = 0; | ||
| 2104 | } | ||
| 2105 | if (mode < 0 || mode > 9) | ||
| 2106 | mode = 0; | ||
| 2107 | try_quick = 1; | ||
| 2108 | if (mode > 5) { | ||
| 2109 | mode -= 4; | ||
| 2110 | try_quick = 0; | ||
| 2111 | } | ||
| 2112 | leftright = 1; | ||
| 2113 | switch(mode) { | ||
| 2114 | case 0: | ||
| 2115 | case 1: | ||
| 2116 | ilim = ilim1 = -1; | ||
| 2117 | i = 18; | ||
| 2118 | ndigits = 0; | ||
| 2119 | break; | ||
| 2120 | case 2: | ||
| 2121 | leftright = 0; | ||
| 2122 | /* no break */ | ||
| 2123 | case 4: | ||
| 2124 | if (ndigits <= 0) | ||
| 2125 | ndigits = 1; | ||
| 2126 | ilim = ilim1 = i = ndigits; | ||
| 2127 | break; | ||
| 2128 | case 3: | ||
| 2129 | leftright = 0; | ||
| 2130 | /* no break */ | ||
| 2131 | case 5: | ||
| 2132 | i = ndigits + k + 1; | ||
| 2133 | ilim = i; | ||
| 2134 | ilim1 = i - 1; | ||
| 2135 | if (i <= 0) | ||
| 2136 | i = 1; | ||
| 2137 | } | ||
| 2138 | j = sizeof(ULong); | ||
| 2139 | for(result_k = 0; sizeof(Bigint) - sizeof(ULong) + j <= i; | ||
| 2140 | j <<= 1) result_k++; | ||
| 2141 | result = Balloc(result_k); | ||
| 2142 | s = s0 = (char *)result; | ||
| 2143 | |||
| 2144 | if (ilim >= 0 && ilim <= Quick_max && try_quick) { | ||
| 2145 | |||
| 2146 | /* Try to get by with floating-point arithmetic. */ | ||
| 2147 | |||
| 2148 | i = 0; | ||
| 2149 | value(d2) = value(d); | ||
| 2150 | k0 = k; | ||
| 2151 | ilim0 = ilim; | ||
| 2152 | ieps = 2; /* conservative */ | ||
| 2153 | if (k > 0) { | ||
| 2154 | ds = tens[k&0xf]; | ||
| 2155 | j = k >> 4; | ||
| 2156 | if (j & Bletch) { | ||
| 2157 | /* prevent overflows */ | ||
| 2158 | j &= Bletch - 1; | ||
| 2159 | value(d) /= bigtens[n_bigtens-1]; | ||
| 2160 | ieps++; | ||
| 2161 | } | ||
| 2162 | for(; j; j >>= 1, i++) | ||
| 2163 | if (j & 1) { | ||
| 2164 | ieps++; | ||
| 2165 | ds *= bigtens[i]; | ||
| 2166 | } | ||
| 2167 | value(d) /= ds; | ||
| 2168 | } | ||
| 2169 | else if (j1 = -k) { | ||
| 2170 | value(d) *= tens[j1 & 0xf]; | ||
| 2171 | for(j = j1 >> 4; j; j >>= 1, i++) | ||
| 2172 | if (j & 1) { | ||
| 2173 | ieps++; | ||
| 2174 | value(d) *= bigtens[i]; | ||
| 2175 | } | ||
| 2176 | } | ||
| 2177 | if (k_check && value(d) < 1. && ilim > 0) { | ||
| 2178 | if (ilim1 <= 0) | ||
| 2179 | goto fast_failed; | ||
| 2180 | ilim = ilim1; | ||
| 2181 | k--; | ||
| 2182 | value(d) *= 10.; | ||
| 2183 | ieps++; | ||
| 2184 | } | ||
| 2185 | value(eps) = ieps*value(d) + 7.; | ||
| 2186 | word0(eps) -= (P-1)*Exp_msk1; | ||
| 2187 | if (ilim == 0) { | ||
| 2188 | S = mhi = 0; | ||
| 2189 | value(d) -= 5.; | ||
| 2190 | if (value(d) > value(eps)) | ||
| 2191 | goto one_digit; | ||
| 2192 | if (value(d) < -value(eps)) | ||
| 2193 | goto no_digits; | ||
| 2194 | goto fast_failed; | ||
| 2195 | } | ||
| 2196 | #ifndef No_leftright | ||
| 2197 | if (leftright) { | ||
| 2198 | /* Use Steele & White method of only | ||
| 2199 | * generating digits needed. | ||
| 2200 | */ | ||
| 2201 | value(eps) = 0.5/tens[ilim-1] - value(eps); | ||
| 2202 | for(i = 0;;) { | ||
| 2203 | L = value(d); | ||
| 2204 | value(d) -= L; | ||
| 2205 | *s++ = '0' + (int)L; | ||
| 2206 | if (value(d) < value(eps)) | ||
| 2207 | goto ret1; | ||
| 2208 | if (1. - value(d) < value(eps)) | ||
| 2209 | goto bump_up; | ||
| 2210 | if (++i >= ilim) | ||
| 2211 | break; | ||
| 2212 | value(eps) *= 10.; | ||
| 2213 | value(d) *= 10.; | ||
| 2214 | } | ||
| 2215 | } | ||
| 2216 | else { | ||
| 2217 | #endif | ||
| 2218 | /* Generate ilim digits, then fix them up. */ | ||
| 2219 | value(eps) *= tens[ilim-1]; | ||
| 2220 | for(i = 1;; i++, value(d) *= 10.) { | ||
| 2221 | L = value(d); | ||
| 2222 | value(d) -= L; | ||
| 2223 | *s++ = '0' + (int)L; | ||
| 2224 | if (i == ilim) { | ||
| 2225 | if (value(d) > 0.5 + value(eps)) | ||
| 2226 | goto bump_up; | ||
| 2227 | else if (value(d) < 0.5 - value(eps)) { | ||
| 2228 | while(*--s == '0'); | ||
| 2229 | s++; | ||
| 2230 | goto ret1; | ||
| 2231 | } | ||
| 2232 | break; | ||
| 2233 | } | ||
| 2234 | } | ||
| 2235 | #ifndef No_leftright | ||
| 2236 | } | ||
| 2237 | #endif | ||
| 2238 | fast_failed: | ||
| 2239 | s = s0; | ||
| 2240 | value(d) = value(d2); | ||
| 2241 | k = k0; | ||
| 2242 | ilim = ilim0; | ||
| 2243 | } | ||
| 2244 | |||
| 2245 | /* Do we have a "small" integer? */ | ||
| 2246 | |||
| 2247 | if (be >= 0 && k <= Int_max) { | ||
| 2248 | /* Yes. */ | ||
| 2249 | ds = tens[k]; | ||
| 2250 | if (ndigits < 0 && ilim <= 0) { | ||
| 2251 | S = mhi = 0; | ||
| 2252 | if (ilim < 0 || value(d) <= 5*ds) | ||
| 2253 | goto no_digits; | ||
| 2254 | goto one_digit; | ||
| 2255 | } | ||
| 2256 | for(i = 1;; i++) { | ||
| 2257 | L = value(d) / ds; | ||
| 2258 | value(d) -= L*ds; | ||
| 2259 | #ifdef Check_FLT_ROUNDS | ||
| 2260 | /* If FLT_ROUNDS == 2, L will usually be high by 1 */ | ||
| 2261 | if (value(d) < 0) { | ||
| 2262 | L--; | ||
| 2263 | value(d) += ds; | ||
| 2264 | } | ||
| 2265 | #endif | ||
| 2266 | *s++ = '0' + (int)L; | ||
| 2267 | if (i == ilim) { | ||
| 2268 | value(d) += value(d); | ||
| 2269 | if (value(d) > ds || value(d) == ds && L & 1) { | ||
| 2270 | bump_up: | ||
| 2271 | while(*--s == '9') | ||
| 2272 | if (s == s0) { | ||
| 2273 | k++; | ||
| 2274 | *s = '0'; | ||
| 2275 | break; | ||
| 2276 | } | ||
| 2277 | ++*s++; | ||
| 2278 | } | ||
| 2279 | break; | ||
| 2280 | } | ||
| 2281 | if (!(value(d) *= 10.)) | ||
| 2282 | break; | ||
| 2283 | } | ||
| 2284 | goto ret1; | ||
| 2285 | } | ||
| 2286 | |||
| 2287 | m2 = b2; | ||
| 2288 | m5 = b5; | ||
| 2289 | mhi = mlo = 0; | ||
| 2290 | if (leftright) { | ||
| 2291 | if (mode < 2) { | ||
| 2292 | i = | ||
| 2293 | #ifndef Sudden_Underflow | ||
| 2294 | denorm ? be + (Bias + (P-1) - 1 + 1) : | ||
| 2295 | #endif | ||
| 2296 | #ifdef IBM | ||
| 2297 | 1 + 4*P - 3 - bbits + ((bbits + be - 1) & 3); | ||
| 2298 | #else | ||
| 2299 | 1 + P - bbits; | ||
| 2300 | #endif | ||
| 2301 | } | ||
| 2302 | else { | ||
| 2303 | j = ilim - 1; | ||
| 2304 | if (m5 >= j) | ||
| 2305 | m5 -= j; | ||
| 2306 | else { | ||
| 2307 | s5 += j -= m5; | ||
| 2308 | b5 += j; | ||
| 2309 | m5 = 0; | ||
| 2310 | } | ||
| 2311 | if ((i = ilim) < 0) { | ||
| 2312 | m2 -= i; | ||
| 2313 | i = 0; | ||
| 2314 | } | ||
| 2315 | } | ||
| 2316 | b2 += i; | ||
| 2317 | s2 += i; | ||
| 2318 | mhi = i2b(1); | ||
| 2319 | } | ||
| 2320 | if (m2 > 0 && s2 > 0) { | ||
| 2321 | i = m2 < s2 ? m2 : s2; | ||
| 2322 | b2 -= i; | ||
| 2323 | m2 -= i; | ||
| 2324 | s2 -= i; | ||
| 2325 | } | ||
| 2326 | if (b5 > 0) { | ||
| 2327 | if (leftright) { | ||
| 2328 | if (m5 > 0) { | ||
| 2329 | mhi = pow5mult(mhi, m5); | ||
| 2330 | b1 = mult(mhi, b); | ||
| 2331 | Bfree(b); | ||
| 2332 | b = b1; | ||
| 2333 | } | ||
| 2334 | if (j = b5 - m5) | ||
| 2335 | b = pow5mult(b, j); | ||
| 2336 | } | ||
| 2337 | else | ||
| 2338 | b = pow5mult(b, b5); | ||
| 2339 | } | ||
| 2340 | S = i2b(1); | ||
| 2341 | if (s5 > 0) | ||
| 2342 | S = pow5mult(S, s5); | ||
| 2343 | |||
| 2344 | /* Check for special case that d is a normalized power of 2. */ | ||
| 2345 | |||
| 2346 | if (mode < 2) { | ||
| 2347 | if (!word1(d) && !(word0(d) & Bndry_mask) | ||
| 2348 | #ifndef Sudden_Underflow | ||
| 2349 | && word0(d) & Exp_mask | ||
| 2350 | #endif | ||
| 2351 | ) { | ||
| 2352 | /* The special case */ | ||
| 2353 | b2 += Log2P; | ||
| 2354 | s2 += Log2P; | ||
| 2355 | spec_case = 1; | ||
| 2356 | } | ||
| 2357 | else | ||
| 2358 | spec_case = 0; | ||
| 2359 | } | ||
| 2360 | |||
| 2361 | /* Arrange for convenient computation of quotients: | ||
| 2362 | * shift left if necessary so divisor has 4 leading 0 bits. | ||
| 2363 | * | ||
| 2364 | * Perhaps we should just compute leading 28 bits of S once | ||
| 2365 | * and for all and pass them and a shift to quorem, so it | ||
| 2366 | * can do shifts and ors to compute the numerator for q. | ||
| 2367 | */ | ||
| 2368 | #ifdef Pack_32 | ||
| 2369 | if (i = ((s5 ? 32 - hi0bits(S->x[S->wds-1]) : 1) + s2) & 0x1f) | ||
| 2370 | i = 32 - i; | ||
| 2371 | #else | ||
| 2372 | if (i = ((s5 ? 32 - hi0bits(S->x[S->wds-1]) : 1) + s2) & 0xf) | ||
| 2373 | i = 16 - i; | ||
| 2374 | #endif | ||
| 2375 | if (i > 4) { | ||
| 2376 | i -= 4; | ||
| 2377 | b2 += i; | ||
| 2378 | m2 += i; | ||
| 2379 | s2 += i; | ||
| 2380 | } | ||
| 2381 | else if (i < 4) { | ||
| 2382 | i += 28; | ||
| 2383 | b2 += i; | ||
| 2384 | m2 += i; | ||
| 2385 | s2 += i; | ||
| 2386 | } | ||
| 2387 | if (b2 > 0) | ||
| 2388 | b = lshift(b, b2); | ||
| 2389 | if (s2 > 0) | ||
| 2390 | S = lshift(S, s2); | ||
| 2391 | if (k_check) { | ||
| 2392 | if (cmp(b,S) < 0) { | ||
| 2393 | k--; | ||
| 2394 | b = multadd(b, 10, 0); /* we botched the k estimate */ | ||
| 2395 | if (leftright) | ||
| 2396 | mhi = multadd(mhi, 10, 0); | ||
| 2397 | ilim = ilim1; | ||
| 2398 | } | ||
| 2399 | } | ||
| 2400 | if (ilim <= 0 && mode > 2) { | ||
| 2401 | if (ilim < 0 || cmp(b,S = multadd(S,5,0)) <= 0) { | ||
| 2402 | /* no digits, fcvt style */ | ||
| 2403 | no_digits: | ||
| 2404 | k = -1 - ndigits; | ||
| 2405 | goto ret; | ||
| 2406 | } | ||
| 2407 | one_digit: | ||
| 2408 | *s++ = '1'; | ||
| 2409 | k++; | ||
| 2410 | goto ret; | ||
| 2411 | } | ||
| 2412 | if (leftright) { | ||
| 2413 | if (m2 > 0) | ||
| 2414 | mhi = lshift(mhi, m2); | ||
| 2415 | |||
| 2416 | /* Compute mlo -- check for special case | ||
| 2417 | * that d is a normalized power of 2. | ||
| 2418 | */ | ||
| 2419 | |||
| 2420 | mlo = mhi; | ||
| 2421 | if (spec_case) { | ||
| 2422 | mhi = Balloc(mhi->k); | ||
| 2423 | Bcopy(mhi, mlo); | ||
| 2424 | mhi = lshift(mhi, Log2P); | ||
| 2425 | } | ||
| 2426 | |||
| 2427 | for(i = 1;;i++) { | ||
| 2428 | dig = quorem(b,S) + '0'; | ||
| 2429 | /* Do we yet have the shortest decimal string | ||
| 2430 | * that will round to d? | ||
| 2431 | */ | ||
| 2432 | j = cmp(b, mlo); | ||
| 2433 | delta = diff(S, mhi); | ||
| 2434 | j1 = delta->sign ? 1 : cmp(b, delta); | ||
| 2435 | Bfree(delta); | ||
| 2436 | #ifndef ROUND_BIASED | ||
| 2437 | if (j1 == 0 && !mode && !(word1(d) & 1)) { | ||
| 2438 | if (dig == '9') | ||
| 2439 | goto round_9_up; | ||
| 2440 | if (j > 0) | ||
| 2441 | dig++; | ||
| 2442 | *s++ = dig; | ||
| 2443 | goto ret; | ||
| 2444 | } | ||
| 2445 | #endif | ||
| 2446 | if (j < 0 || j == 0 && !mode | ||
| 2447 | #ifndef ROUND_BIASED | ||
| 2448 | && !(word1(d) & 1) | ||
| 2449 | #endif | ||
| 2450 | ) { | ||
| 2451 | if (j1 > 0) { | ||
| 2452 | b = lshift(b, 1); | ||
| 2453 | j1 = cmp(b, S); | ||
| 2454 | if ((j1 > 0 || j1 == 0 && dig & 1) | ||
| 2455 | && dig++ == '9') | ||
| 2456 | goto round_9_up; | ||
| 2457 | } | ||
| 2458 | *s++ = dig; | ||
| 2459 | goto ret; | ||
| 2460 | } | ||
| 2461 | if (j1 > 0) { | ||
| 2462 | if (dig == '9') { /* possible if i == 1 */ | ||
| 2463 | round_9_up: | ||
| 2464 | *s++ = '9'; | ||
| 2465 | goto roundoff; | ||
| 2466 | } | ||
| 2467 | *s++ = dig + 1; | ||
| 2468 | goto ret; | ||
| 2469 | } | ||
| 2470 | *s++ = dig; | ||
| 2471 | if (i == ilim) | ||
| 2472 | break; | ||
| 2473 | b = multadd(b, 10, 0); | ||
| 2474 | if (mlo == mhi) | ||
| 2475 | mlo = mhi = multadd(mhi, 10, 0); | ||
| 2476 | else { | ||
| 2477 | mlo = multadd(mlo, 10, 0); | ||
| 2478 | mhi = multadd(mhi, 10, 0); | ||
| 2479 | } | ||
| 2480 | } | ||
| 2481 | } | ||
| 2482 | else | ||
| 2483 | for(i = 1;; i++) { | ||
| 2484 | *s++ = dig = quorem(b,S) + '0'; | ||
| 2485 | if (i >= ilim) | ||
| 2486 | break; | ||
| 2487 | b = multadd(b, 10, 0); | ||
| 2488 | } | ||
| 2489 | |||
| 2490 | /* Round off last digit */ | ||
| 2491 | |||
| 2492 | b = lshift(b, 1); | ||
| 2493 | j = cmp(b, S); | ||
| 2494 | if (j > 0 || j == 0 && dig & 1) { | ||
| 2495 | roundoff: | ||
| 2496 | while(*--s == '9') | ||
| 2497 | if (s == s0) { | ||
| 2498 | k++; | ||
| 2499 | *s++ = '1'; | ||
| 2500 | goto ret; | ||
| 2501 | } | ||
| 2502 | ++*s++; | ||
| 2503 | } | ||
| 2504 | else { | ||
| 2505 | while(*--s == '0'); | ||
| 2506 | s++; | ||
| 2507 | } | ||
| 2508 | ret: | ||
| 2509 | Bfree(S); | ||
| 2510 | if (mhi) { | ||
| 2511 | if (mlo && mlo != mhi) | ||
| 2512 | Bfree(mlo); | ||
| 2513 | Bfree(mhi); | ||
| 2514 | } | ||
| 2515 | ret1: | ||
| 2516 | Bfree(b); | ||
| 2517 | if (s == s0) { /* don't return empty string */ | ||
| 2518 | *s++ = '0'; | ||
| 2519 | k = 0; | ||
| 2520 | } | ||
| 2521 | *s = 0; | ||
| 2522 | *decpt = k + 1; | ||
| 2523 | if (rve) | ||
| 2524 | *rve = s; | ||
| 2525 | return s0; | ||
| 2526 | } | ||
| 2527 | #ifdef __cplusplus | ||
| 2528 | } | ||
| 2529 | #endif | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/strtol.3 b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/strtol.3 new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..3f5375c5e3 --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/strtol.3 | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,247 @@ | |||
| 1 | .\" Copyright (c) 1990, 1991 The Regents of the University of California. | ||
| 2 | .\" All rights reserved. | ||
| 3 | .\" | ||
| 4 | .\" This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by | ||
| 5 | .\" Chris Torek and the American National Standards Committee X3, | ||
| 6 | .\" on Information Processing Systems. | ||
| 7 | .\" | ||
| 8 | .\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without | ||
| 9 | .\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions | ||
| 10 | .\" are met: | ||
| 11 | .\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright | ||
| 12 | .\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. | ||
| 13 | .\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright | ||
| 14 | .\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the | ||
| 15 | .\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. | ||
| 16 | .\" 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors | ||
| 17 | .\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software | ||
| 18 | .\" without specific prior written permission. | ||
| 19 | .\" | ||
| 20 | .\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND | ||
| 21 | .\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE | ||
| 22 | .\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE | ||
| 23 | .\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE | ||
| 24 | .\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL | ||
| 25 | .\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS | ||
| 26 | .\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) | ||
| 27 | .\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT | ||
| 28 | .\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY | ||
| 29 | .\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF | ||
| 30 | .\" SUCH DAMAGE. | ||
| 31 | .\" | ||
| 32 | .\" $OpenBSD: strtol.3,v 1.13 2003/06/02 20:18:38 millert Exp $ | ||
| 33 | .\" | ||
| 34 | .Dd June 25, 1992 | ||
| 35 | .Dt STRTOL 3 | ||
| 36 | .Os | ||
| 37 | .Sh NAME | ||
| 38 | .Nm strtol , | ||
| 39 | .Nm strtoll , | ||
| 40 | .Nm strtoq | ||
| 41 | .Nd "convert string value to a long or long long integer" | ||
| 42 | .Sh SYNOPSIS | ||
| 43 | .Fd #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 44 | .Fd #include <limits.h> | ||
| 45 | .Ft long | ||
| 46 | .Fn strtol "const char *nptr" "char **endptr" "int base" | ||
| 47 | .Pp | ||
| 48 | .Fd #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 49 | .Fd #include <limits.h> | ||
| 50 | .Ft long long | ||
| 51 | .Fn strtoll "const char *nptr" "char **endptr" "int base" | ||
| 52 | .Pp | ||
| 53 | .Fd #include <sys/types.h> | ||
| 54 | .Fd #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 55 | .Fd #include <limits.h> | ||
| 56 | .Ft quad_t | ||
| 57 | .Fn strtoq "const char *nptr" "char **endptr" "int base" | ||
| 58 | .Sh DESCRIPTION | ||
| 59 | The | ||
| 60 | .Fn strtol | ||
| 61 | function converts the string in | ||
| 62 | .Fa nptr | ||
| 63 | to a | ||
| 64 | .Li long | ||
| 65 | value. | ||
| 66 | The | ||
| 67 | .Fn strtoll | ||
| 68 | function converts the string in | ||
| 69 | .Fa nptr | ||
| 70 | to a | ||
| 71 | .Li long long | ||
| 72 | value. | ||
| 73 | The | ||
| 74 | .Fn strtoq | ||
| 75 | function is a deprecated equivalent of | ||
| 76 | .Fn strtoll | ||
| 77 | and is provided for backwards compatibility with legacy programs. | ||
| 78 | The conversion is done according to the given | ||
| 79 | .Fa base , | ||
| 80 | which must be a number between 2 and 36 inclusive or the special value 0. | ||
| 81 | .Pp | ||
| 82 | The string may begin with an arbitrary amount of whitespace | ||
| 83 | (as determined by | ||
| 84 | .Xr isspace 3 ) | ||
| 85 | followed by a single optional | ||
| 86 | .Ql + | ||
| 87 | or | ||
| 88 | .Ql - | ||
| 89 | sign. | ||
| 90 | If | ||
| 91 | .Fa base | ||
| 92 | is zero or 16, the string may then include a | ||
| 93 | .Ql 0x | ||
| 94 | prefix, and the number will be read in base 16; otherwise, a zero | ||
| 95 | .Fa base | ||
| 96 | is taken as 10 (decimal) unless the next character is | ||
| 97 | .Ql 0 , | ||
| 98 | in which case it is taken as 8 (octal). | ||
| 99 | .Pp | ||
| 100 | The remainder of the string is converted to a | ||
| 101 | .Li long | ||
| 102 | value in the obvious manner, | ||
| 103 | stopping at the first character which is not a valid digit | ||
| 104 | in the given base. | ||
| 105 | (In bases above 10, the letter | ||
| 106 | .Ql A | ||
| 107 | in either upper or lower case represents 10, | ||
| 108 | .Ql B | ||
| 109 | represents 11, and so forth, with | ||
| 110 | .Ql Z | ||
| 111 | representing 35.) | ||
| 112 | .Pp | ||
| 113 | If | ||
| 114 | .Fa endptr | ||
| 115 | is non-null, | ||
| 116 | .Fn strtol | ||
| 117 | stores the address of the first invalid character in | ||
| 118 | .Fa *endptr . | ||
| 119 | If there were no digits at all, however, | ||
| 120 | .Fn strtol | ||
| 121 | stores the original value of | ||
| 122 | .Fa nptr | ||
| 123 | in | ||
| 124 | .Fa *endptr . | ||
| 125 | (Thus, if | ||
| 126 | .Fa *nptr | ||
| 127 | is not | ||
| 128 | .Ql \e0 | ||
| 129 | but | ||
| 130 | .Fa **endptr | ||
| 131 | is | ||
| 132 | .Ql \e0 | ||
| 133 | on return, the entire string was valid.) | ||
| 134 | .Sh RETURN VALUES | ||
| 135 | The | ||
| 136 | .Fn strtol | ||
| 137 | function returns the result of the conversion, | ||
| 138 | unless the value would underflow or overflow. | ||
| 139 | If an underflow occurs, | ||
| 140 | .Fn strtol | ||
| 141 | returns | ||
| 142 | .Dv LONG_MIN . | ||
| 143 | If an overflow occurs, | ||
| 144 | .Fn strtol | ||
| 145 | returns | ||
| 146 | .Dv LONG_MAX . | ||
| 147 | In both cases, | ||
| 148 | .Va errno | ||
| 149 | is set to | ||
| 150 | .Er ERANGE . | ||
| 151 | .Pp | ||
| 152 | The | ||
| 153 | .Fn strtoll | ||
| 154 | function has identical return values except that | ||
| 155 | .Dv LLONG_MIN | ||
| 156 | and | ||
| 157 | .Dv LLONG_MAX | ||
| 158 | are used to indicate underflow and overflow respectively. | ||
| 159 | .Sh EXAMPLES | ||
| 160 | Ensuring that a string is a valid number (i.e., in range and containing no | ||
| 161 | trailing characters) requires clearing | ||
| 162 | .Va errno | ||
| 163 | beforehand explicitly since | ||
| 164 | .Va errno | ||
| 165 | is not changed on a successful call to | ||
| 166 | .Fn strtol , | ||
| 167 | and the return value of | ||
| 168 | .Fn strtol | ||
| 169 | cannot be used unambiguously to signal an error: | ||
| 170 | .Bd -literal -offset indent | ||
| 171 | char *ep; | ||
| 172 | long lval; | ||
| 173 | |||
| 174 | \&... | ||
| 175 | |||
| 176 | errno = 0; | ||
| 177 | lval = strtol(buf, &ep, 10); | ||
| 178 | if (buf[0] == '\e0' || *ep != '\e0') | ||
| 179 | goto not_a_number; | ||
| 180 | if (errno == ERANGE && (lval == LONG_MAX || lval == LONG_MIN)) | ||
| 181 | goto out_of_range; | ||
| 182 | .Ed | ||
| 183 | .Pp | ||
| 184 | This example will accept | ||
| 185 | .Dq 12 | ||
| 186 | but not | ||
| 187 | .Dq 12foo | ||
| 188 | or | ||
| 189 | .Dq 12\en . | ||
| 190 | If trailing whitespace is acceptable, further checks must be done on | ||
| 191 | .Va *ep ; | ||
| 192 | alternately, use | ||
| 193 | .Xr sscanf 3 . | ||
| 194 | .Pp | ||
| 195 | If | ||
| 196 | .Fn strtol | ||
| 197 | is being used instead of | ||
| 198 | .Xr atoi 3 , | ||
| 199 | error checking is further complicated because the desired return value is an | ||
| 200 | .Li int | ||
| 201 | rather than a | ||
| 202 | .Li long ; | ||
| 203 | however, on some architectures integers and long integers are the same size. | ||
| 204 | Thus the following is necessary: | ||
| 205 | .Bd -literal -offset indent | ||
| 206 | char *ep; | ||
| 207 | int ival; | ||
| 208 | long lval; | ||
| 209 | |||
| 210 | \&... | ||
| 211 | |||
| 212 | errno = 0; | ||
| 213 | lval = strtol(buf, &ep, 10); | ||
| 214 | if (buf[0] == '\e0' || *ep != '\e0') | ||
| 215 | goto not_a_number; | ||
| 216 | if ((errno == ERANGE && (lval == LONG_MAX || lval == LONG_MIN)) || | ||
| 217 | (lval > INT_MAX || lval < INT_MIN)) | ||
| 218 | goto out_of_range; | ||
| 219 | ival = lval; | ||
| 220 | .Ed | ||
| 221 | .Sh ERRORS | ||
| 222 | .Bl -tag -width Er | ||
| 223 | .It Bq Er ERANGE | ||
| 224 | The given string was out of range; the value converted has been clamped. | ||
| 225 | .El | ||
| 226 | .Sh SEE ALSO | ||
| 227 | .Xr atof 3 , | ||
| 228 | .Xr atoi 3 , | ||
| 229 | .Xr atol 3 , | ||
| 230 | .Xr atoll 3 , | ||
| 231 | .Xr sscanf 3 , | ||
| 232 | .Xr strtod 3 , | ||
| 233 | .Xr strtoul 3 | ||
| 234 | .Sh STANDARDS | ||
| 235 | The | ||
| 236 | .Fn strtol | ||
| 237 | and | ||
| 238 | .Fn strtoll | ||
| 239 | functions conform to | ||
| 240 | .St -ansiC-99 . | ||
| 241 | The | ||
| 242 | .Fn strtoq | ||
| 243 | function is a | ||
| 244 | .Bx | ||
| 245 | extension and is provided for backwards compatibility with legacy programs. | ||
| 246 | .Sh BUGS | ||
| 247 | Ignores the current locale. | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/strtol.c b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/strtol.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..1c39720794 --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/strtol.c | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,146 @@ | |||
| 1 | /*- | ||
| 2 | * Copyright (c) 1990 The Regents of the University of California. | ||
| 3 | * All rights reserved. | ||
| 4 | * | ||
| 5 | * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without | ||
| 6 | * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions | ||
| 7 | * are met: | ||
| 8 | * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright | ||
| 9 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. | ||
| 10 | * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright | ||
| 11 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the | ||
| 12 | * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. | ||
| 13 | * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors | ||
| 14 | * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software | ||
| 15 | * without specific prior written permission. | ||
| 16 | * | ||
| 17 | * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND | ||
| 18 | * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE | ||
| 19 | * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE | ||
| 20 | * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE | ||
| 21 | * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL | ||
| 22 | * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS | ||
| 23 | * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) | ||
| 24 | * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT | ||
| 25 | * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY | ||
| 26 | * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF | ||
| 27 | * SUCH DAMAGE. | ||
| 28 | */ | ||
| 29 | |||
| 30 | #if defined(LIBC_SCCS) && !defined(lint) | ||
| 31 | static char *rcsid = "$OpenBSD: strtol.c,v 1.5 2003/06/02 20:18:38 millert Exp $"; | ||
| 32 | #endif /* LIBC_SCCS and not lint */ | ||
| 33 | |||
| 34 | #include <ctype.h> | ||
| 35 | #include <errno.h> | ||
| 36 | #include <limits.h> | ||
| 37 | #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 38 | |||
| 39 | |||
| 40 | /* | ||
| 41 | * Convert a string to a long integer. | ||
| 42 | * | ||
| 43 | * Ignores `locale' stuff. Assumes that the upper and lower case | ||
| 44 | * alphabets and digits are each contiguous. | ||
| 45 | */ | ||
| 46 | long | ||
| 47 | strtol(nptr, endptr, base) | ||
| 48 | const char *nptr; | ||
| 49 | char **endptr; | ||
| 50 | register int base; | ||
| 51 | { | ||
| 52 | register const char *s; | ||
| 53 | register long acc, cutoff; | ||
| 54 | register int c; | ||
| 55 | register int neg, any, cutlim; | ||
| 56 | |||
| 57 | /* | ||
| 58 | * Skip white space and pick up leading +/- sign if any. | ||
| 59 | * If base is 0, allow 0x for hex and 0 for octal, else | ||
| 60 | * assume decimal; if base is already 16, allow 0x. | ||
| 61 | */ | ||
| 62 | s = nptr; | ||
| 63 | do { | ||
| 64 | c = (unsigned char) *s++; | ||
| 65 | } while (isspace(c)); | ||
| 66 | if (c == '-') { | ||
| 67 | neg = 1; | ||
| 68 | c = *s++; | ||
| 69 | } else { | ||
| 70 | neg = 0; | ||
| 71 | if (c == '+') | ||
| 72 | c = *s++; | ||
| 73 | } | ||
| 74 | if ((base == 0 || base == 16) && | ||
| 75 | c == '0' && (*s == 'x' || *s == 'X')) { | ||
| 76 | c = s[1]; | ||
| 77 | s += 2; | ||
| 78 | base = 16; | ||
| 79 | } | ||
| 80 | if (base == 0) | ||
| 81 | base = c == '0' ? 8 : 10; | ||
| 82 | |||
| 83 | /* | ||
| 84 | * Compute the cutoff value between legal numbers and illegal | ||
| 85 | * numbers. That is the largest legal value, divided by the | ||
| 86 | * base. An input number that is greater than this value, if | ||
| 87 | * followed by a legal input character, is too big. One that | ||
| 88 | * is equal to this value may be valid or not; the limit | ||
| 89 | * between valid and invalid numbers is then based on the last | ||
| 90 | * digit. For instance, if the range for longs is | ||
| 91 | * [-2147483648..2147483647] and the input base is 10, | ||
| 92 | * cutoff will be set to 214748364 and cutlim to either | ||
| 93 | * 7 (neg==0) or 8 (neg==1), meaning that if we have accumulated | ||
| 94 | * a value > 214748364, or equal but the next digit is > 7 (or 8), | ||
| 95 | * the number is too big, and we will return a range error. | ||
| 96 | * | ||
| 97 | * Set any if any `digits' consumed; make it negative to indicate | ||
| 98 | * overflow. | ||
| 99 | */ | ||
| 100 | cutoff = neg ? LONG_MIN : LONG_MAX; | ||
| 101 | cutlim = cutoff % base; | ||
| 102 | cutoff /= base; | ||
| 103 | if (neg) { | ||
| 104 | if (cutlim > 0) { | ||
| 105 | cutlim -= base; | ||
| 106 | cutoff += 1; | ||
| 107 | } | ||
| 108 | cutlim = -cutlim; | ||
| 109 | } | ||
| 110 | for (acc = 0, any = 0;; c = (unsigned char) *s++) { | ||
| 111 | if (isdigit(c)) | ||
| 112 | c -= '0'; | ||
| 113 | else if (isalpha(c)) | ||
| 114 | c -= isupper(c) ? 'A' - 10 : 'a' - 10; | ||
| 115 | else | ||
| 116 | break; | ||
| 117 | if (c >= base) | ||
| 118 | break; | ||
| 119 | if (any < 0) | ||
| 120 | continue; | ||
| 121 | if (neg) { | ||
| 122 | if (acc < cutoff || acc == cutoff && c > cutlim) { | ||
| 123 | any = -1; | ||
| 124 | acc = LONG_MIN; | ||
| 125 | errno = ERANGE; | ||
| 126 | } else { | ||
| 127 | any = 1; | ||
| 128 | acc *= base; | ||
| 129 | acc -= c; | ||
| 130 | } | ||
| 131 | } else { | ||
| 132 | if (acc > cutoff || acc == cutoff && c > cutlim) { | ||
| 133 | any = -1; | ||
| 134 | acc = LONG_MAX; | ||
| 135 | errno = ERANGE; | ||
| 136 | } else { | ||
| 137 | any = 1; | ||
| 138 | acc *= base; | ||
| 139 | acc += c; | ||
| 140 | } | ||
| 141 | } | ||
| 142 | } | ||
| 143 | if (endptr != 0) | ||
| 144 | *endptr = (char *) (any ? s - 1 : nptr); | ||
| 145 | return (acc); | ||
| 146 | } | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/strtoll.c b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/strtoll.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..ac9353890f --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/strtoll.c | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,162 @@ | |||
| 1 | /*- | ||
| 2 | * Copyright (c) 1992 The Regents of the University of California. | ||
| 3 | * All rights reserved. | ||
| 4 | * | ||
| 5 | * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without | ||
| 6 | * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions | ||
| 7 | * are met: | ||
| 8 | * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright | ||
| 9 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. | ||
| 10 | * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright | ||
| 11 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the | ||
| 12 | * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. | ||
| 13 | * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors | ||
| 14 | * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software | ||
| 15 | * without specific prior written permission. | ||
| 16 | * | ||
| 17 | * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND | ||
| 18 | * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE | ||
| 19 | * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE | ||
| 20 | * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE | ||
| 21 | * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL | ||
| 22 | * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS | ||
| 23 | * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) | ||
| 24 | * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT | ||
| 25 | * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY | ||
| 26 | * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF | ||
| 27 | * SUCH DAMAGE. | ||
| 28 | */ | ||
| 29 | |||
| 30 | #if defined(LIBC_SCCS) && !defined(lint) | ||
| 31 | static const char rcsid[] = "$OpenBSD: strtoll.c,v 1.2 2003/06/02 20:18:38 millert Exp $"; | ||
| 32 | #endif /* LIBC_SCCS and not lint */ | ||
| 33 | |||
| 34 | #include <sys/types.h> | ||
| 35 | |||
| 36 | #include <ctype.h> | ||
| 37 | #include <errno.h> | ||
| 38 | #include <limits.h> | ||
| 39 | #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 40 | |||
| 41 | /* | ||
| 42 | * Convert a string to a long long. | ||
| 43 | * | ||
| 44 | * Ignores `locale' stuff. Assumes that the upper and lower case | ||
| 45 | * alphabets and digits are each contiguous. | ||
| 46 | */ | ||
| 47 | long long | ||
| 48 | strtoll(nptr, endptr, base) | ||
| 49 | const char *nptr; | ||
| 50 | char **endptr; | ||
| 51 | int base; | ||
| 52 | { | ||
| 53 | const char *s; | ||
| 54 | long long acc, cutoff; | ||
| 55 | int c; | ||
| 56 | int neg, any, cutlim; | ||
| 57 | |||
| 58 | /* | ||
| 59 | * Skip white space and pick up leading +/- sign if any. | ||
| 60 | * If base is 0, allow 0x for hex and 0 for octal, else | ||
| 61 | * assume decimal; if base is already 16, allow 0x. | ||
| 62 | */ | ||
| 63 | s = nptr; | ||
| 64 | do { | ||
| 65 | c = (unsigned char) *s++; | ||
| 66 | } while (isspace(c)); | ||
| 67 | if (c == '-') { | ||
| 68 | neg = 1; | ||
| 69 | c = *s++; | ||
| 70 | } else { | ||
| 71 | neg = 0; | ||
| 72 | if (c == '+') | ||
| 73 | c = *s++; | ||
| 74 | } | ||
| 75 | if ((base == 0 || base == 16) && | ||
| 76 | c == '0' && (*s == 'x' || *s == 'X')) { | ||
| 77 | c = s[1]; | ||
| 78 | s += 2; | ||
| 79 | base = 16; | ||
| 80 | } | ||
| 81 | if (base == 0) | ||
| 82 | base = c == '0' ? 8 : 10; | ||
| 83 | |||
| 84 | /* | ||
| 85 | * Compute the cutoff value between legal numbers and illegal | ||
| 86 | * numbers. That is the largest legal value, divided by the | ||
| 87 | * base. An input number that is greater than this value, if | ||
| 88 | * followed by a legal input character, is too big. One that | ||
| 89 | * is equal to this value may be valid or not; the limit | ||
| 90 | * between valid and invalid numbers is then based on the last | ||
| 91 | * digit. For instance, if the range for long longs is | ||
| 92 | * [-9223372036854775808..9223372036854775807] and the input base | ||
| 93 | * is 10, cutoff will be set to 922337203685477580 and cutlim to | ||
| 94 | * either 7 (neg==0) or 8 (neg==1), meaning that if we have | ||
| 95 | * accumulated a value > 922337203685477580, or equal but the | ||
| 96 | * next digit is > 7 (or 8), the number is too big, and we will | ||
| 97 | * return a range error. | ||
| 98 | * | ||
| 99 | * Set any if any `digits' consumed; make it negative to indicate | ||
| 100 | * overflow. | ||
| 101 | */ | ||
| 102 | cutoff = neg ? LLONG_MIN : LLONG_MAX; | ||
| 103 | cutlim = cutoff % base; | ||
| 104 | cutoff /= base; | ||
| 105 | if (neg) { | ||
| 106 | if (cutlim > 0) { | ||
| 107 | cutlim -= base; | ||
| 108 | cutoff += 1; | ||
| 109 | } | ||
| 110 | cutlim = -cutlim; | ||
| 111 | } | ||
| 112 | for (acc = 0, any = 0;; c = (unsigned char) *s++) { | ||
| 113 | if (isdigit(c)) | ||
| 114 | c -= '0'; | ||
| 115 | else if (isalpha(c)) | ||
| 116 | c -= isupper(c) ? 'A' - 10 : 'a' - 10; | ||
| 117 | else | ||
| 118 | break; | ||
| 119 | if (c >= base) | ||
| 120 | break; | ||
| 121 | if (any < 0) | ||
| 122 | continue; | ||
| 123 | if (neg) { | ||
| 124 | if (acc < cutoff || (acc == cutoff && c > cutlim)) { | ||
| 125 | any = -1; | ||
| 126 | acc = LLONG_MIN; | ||
| 127 | errno = ERANGE; | ||
| 128 | } else { | ||
| 129 | any = 1; | ||
| 130 | acc *= base; | ||
| 131 | acc -= c; | ||
| 132 | } | ||
| 133 | } else { | ||
| 134 | if (acc > cutoff || (acc == cutoff && c > cutlim)) { | ||
| 135 | any = -1; | ||
| 136 | acc = LLONG_MAX; | ||
| 137 | errno = ERANGE; | ||
| 138 | } else { | ||
| 139 | any = 1; | ||
| 140 | acc *= base; | ||
| 141 | acc += c; | ||
| 142 | } | ||
| 143 | } | ||
| 144 | } | ||
| 145 | if (endptr != 0) | ||
| 146 | *endptr = (char *) (any ? s - 1 : nptr); | ||
| 147 | return (acc); | ||
| 148 | } | ||
| 149 | |||
| 150 | #ifdef __weak_alias | ||
| 151 | __weak_alias(strtoq, strtoll); | ||
| 152 | #else | ||
| 153 | quad_t | ||
| 154 | strtoq(nptr, endptr, base) | ||
| 155 | const char *nptr; | ||
| 156 | char **endptr; | ||
| 157 | int base; | ||
| 158 | { | ||
| 159 | |||
| 160 | return ((quad_t)strtoll(nptr, endptr, base); | ||
| 161 | } | ||
| 162 | #endif | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/strtoul.3 b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/strtoul.3 new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..4f6d6a51f9 --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/strtoul.3 | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,231 @@ | |||
| 1 | .\" Copyright (c) 1990, 1991 The Regents of the University of California. | ||
| 2 | .\" All rights reserved. | ||
| 3 | .\" | ||
| 4 | .\" This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by | ||
| 5 | .\" Chris Torek and the American National Standards Committee X3, | ||
| 6 | .\" on Information Processing Systems. | ||
| 7 | .\" | ||
| 8 | .\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without | ||
| 9 | .\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions | ||
| 10 | .\" are met: | ||
| 11 | .\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright | ||
| 12 | .\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. | ||
| 13 | .\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright | ||
| 14 | .\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the | ||
| 15 | .\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. | ||
| 16 | .\" 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors | ||
| 17 | .\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software | ||
| 18 | .\" without specific prior written permission. | ||
| 19 | .\" | ||
| 20 | .\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND | ||
| 21 | .\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE | ||
| 22 | .\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE | ||
| 23 | .\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE | ||
| 24 | .\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL | ||
| 25 | .\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS | ||
| 26 | .\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) | ||
| 27 | .\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT | ||
| 28 | .\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY | ||
| 29 | .\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF | ||
| 30 | .\" SUCH DAMAGE. | ||
| 31 | .\" | ||
| 32 | .\" $OpenBSD: strtoul.3,v 1.15 2003/06/02 20:18:38 millert Exp $ | ||
| 33 | .\" | ||
| 34 | .Dd June 25, 1992 | ||
| 35 | .Dt STRTOUL 3 | ||
| 36 | .Os | ||
| 37 | .Sh NAME | ||
| 38 | .Nm strtoul , | ||
| 39 | .Nm strtoull , | ||
| 40 | .Nm strtouq | ||
| 41 | .Nd "convert a string to an unsigned long or unsigned long long integer" | ||
| 42 | .Sh SYNOPSIS | ||
| 43 | .Fd #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 44 | .Fd #include <limits.h> | ||
| 45 | .Ft unsigned long | ||
| 46 | .Fn strtoul "const char *nptr" "char **endptr" "int base" | ||
| 47 | .Pp | ||
| 48 | .Fd #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 49 | .Fd #include <limits.h> | ||
| 50 | .Ft unsigned long long | ||
| 51 | .Fn strtoull "const char *nptr" "char **endptr" "int base" | ||
| 52 | .Pp | ||
| 53 | .Fd #include <sys/types.h> | ||
| 54 | .Fd #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 55 | .Fd #include <limits.h> | ||
| 56 | .Ft u_quad_t | ||
| 57 | .Fn strtouq "const char *nptr" "char **endptr" "int base" | ||
| 58 | .Sh DESCRIPTION | ||
| 59 | The | ||
| 60 | .Fn strtoul | ||
| 61 | function converts the string in | ||
| 62 | .Fa nptr | ||
| 63 | to an | ||
| 64 | .Li unsigned long | ||
| 65 | value. | ||
| 66 | The | ||
| 67 | .Fn strtoull | ||
| 68 | function converts the string in | ||
| 69 | .Fa nptr | ||
| 70 | to an | ||
| 71 | .Li unsigned long long | ||
| 72 | value. | ||
| 73 | The | ||
| 74 | .Fn strtouq | ||
| 75 | function is a deprecated equivalent of | ||
| 76 | .Fn strtoull | ||
| 77 | and is provided for backwards compatibility with legacy programs. | ||
| 78 | The conversion is done according to the given | ||
| 79 | .Fa base , | ||
| 80 | which must be a number between 2 and 36 inclusive | ||
| 81 | or the special value 0. | ||
| 82 | If the string in | ||
| 83 | .Fa nptr | ||
| 84 | represents a negative number, it will be converted to its unsigned equivalent. | ||
| 85 | This behavior is consistent with what happens when a signed integer type is | ||
| 86 | cast to its unsigned counterpart. | ||
| 87 | .Pp | ||
| 88 | The string may begin with an arbitrary amount of whitespace | ||
| 89 | (as determined by | ||
| 90 | .Xr isspace 3 ) | ||
| 91 | followed by a single optional | ||
| 92 | .Ql + | ||
| 93 | or | ||
| 94 | .Ql - | ||
| 95 | sign. | ||
| 96 | If | ||
| 97 | .Fa base | ||
| 98 | is zero or 16, the string may then include a | ||
| 99 | .Ql 0x | ||
| 100 | prefix, and the number will be read in base 16; otherwise, a zero | ||
| 101 | .Fa base | ||
| 102 | is taken as 10 (decimal) unless the next character is | ||
| 103 | .Ql 0 , | ||
| 104 | in which case it is taken as 8 (octal). | ||
| 105 | .Pp | ||
| 106 | The remainder of the string is converted to an | ||
| 107 | .Li unsigned long | ||
| 108 | value in the obvious manner, stopping at the end of the string | ||
| 109 | or at the first character that does not produce a valid digit | ||
| 110 | in the given base. | ||
| 111 | (In bases above 10, the letter | ||
| 112 | .Ql A | ||
| 113 | in either upper or lower case represents 10, | ||
| 114 | .Ql B | ||
| 115 | represents 11, and so forth, with | ||
| 116 | .Ql Z | ||
| 117 | representing 35.) | ||
| 118 | .Pp | ||
| 119 | If | ||
| 120 | .Fa endptr | ||
| 121 | is non-null, | ||
| 122 | .Fn strtoul | ||
| 123 | stores the address of the first invalid character in | ||
| 124 | .Fa *endptr . | ||
| 125 | If there were no digits at all, however, | ||
| 126 | .Fn strtoul | ||
| 127 | stores the original value of | ||
| 128 | .Fa nptr | ||
| 129 | in | ||
| 130 | .Fa *endptr . | ||
| 131 | (Thus, if | ||
| 132 | .Fa *nptr | ||
| 133 | is not | ||
| 134 | .Ql \e0 | ||
| 135 | but | ||
| 136 | .Fa **endptr | ||
| 137 | is | ||
| 138 | .Ql \e0 | ||
| 139 | on return, the entire string was valid.) | ||
| 140 | .Sh RETURN VALUES | ||
| 141 | The | ||
| 142 | .Fn strtoul | ||
| 143 | function returns the result of the conversion, | ||
| 144 | unless the value would overflow, in which case | ||
| 145 | .Dv ULONG_MAX | ||
| 146 | is returned and | ||
| 147 | .Va errno | ||
| 148 | is set to | ||
| 149 | .Er ERANGE . | ||
| 150 | If there was a leading minus sign, | ||
| 151 | .Fn strtoul | ||
| 152 | returns the (unsigned) negation of the absolute value of the number, unless | ||
| 153 | the absolute value would overflow. | ||
| 154 | In this case, | ||
| 155 | .Fn strtoul | ||
| 156 | returns | ||
| 157 | .Dv ULONG_MAX | ||
| 158 | and sets the global variable | ||
| 159 | .Va errno | ||
| 160 | to | ||
| 161 | .Er ERANGE . | ||
| 162 | .Pp | ||
| 163 | The | ||
| 164 | .Fn strtoull | ||
| 165 | function has identical return values except that | ||
| 166 | .Dv ULLONG_MAX | ||
| 167 | is used to indicate overflow. | ||
| 168 | .Pp | ||
| 169 | There is no way to determine if | ||
| 170 | .Fn strtoul | ||
| 171 | has processed a negative number (and returned an unsigned value) short of | ||
| 172 | examining the string in | ||
| 173 | .Fa nptr | ||
| 174 | directly. | ||
| 175 | .Sh EXAMPLES | ||
| 176 | Ensuring that a string is a valid number (i.e., in range and containing no | ||
| 177 | trailing characters) requires clearing | ||
| 178 | .Va errno | ||
| 179 | beforehand explicitly since | ||
| 180 | .Va errno | ||
| 181 | is not changed on a successful call to | ||
| 182 | .Fn strtoul , | ||
| 183 | and the return value of | ||
| 184 | .Fn strtoul | ||
| 185 | cannot be used unambiguously to signal an error: | ||
| 186 | .Bd -literal -offset indent | ||
| 187 | char *ep; | ||
| 188 | unsigned long ulval; | ||
| 189 | |||
| 190 | \&... | ||
| 191 | |||
| 192 | errno = 0; | ||
| 193 | ulval = strtoul(buf, &ep, 10); | ||
| 194 | if (buf[0] == '\e0' || *ep != '\e0') | ||
| 195 | goto not_a_number; | ||
| 196 | if (errno == ERANGE && ulval == ULONG_MAX) | ||
| 197 | goto out_of_range; | ||
| 198 | .Ed | ||
| 199 | .Pp | ||
| 200 | This example will accept | ||
| 201 | .Dq 12 | ||
| 202 | but not | ||
| 203 | .Dq 12foo | ||
| 204 | or | ||
| 205 | .Dq 12\en . | ||
| 206 | If trailing whitespace is acceptable, further checks must be done on | ||
| 207 | .Va *ep ; | ||
| 208 | alternately, use | ||
| 209 | .Xr sscanf 3 . | ||
| 210 | .Sh ERRORS | ||
| 211 | .Bl -tag -width Er | ||
| 212 | .It Bq Er ERANGE | ||
| 213 | The given string was out of range; the value converted has been clamped. | ||
| 214 | .El | ||
| 215 | .Sh SEE ALSO | ||
| 216 | .Xr sscanf 3 , | ||
| 217 | .Xr strtol 3 | ||
| 218 | .Sh STANDARDS | ||
| 219 | The | ||
| 220 | .Fn strtoul | ||
| 221 | and | ||
| 222 | .Fn strtoull | ||
| 223 | functions conform to | ||
| 224 | .St -ansiC-99 . | ||
| 225 | The | ||
| 226 | .Fn strtouq | ||
| 227 | function is a | ||
| 228 | .Bx | ||
| 229 | extension and is provided for backwards compatibility with legacy programs. | ||
| 230 | .Sh BUGS | ||
| 231 | Ignores the current locale. | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/strtoul.c b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/strtoul.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..7d31ce79fb --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/strtoul.c | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,108 @@ | |||
| 1 | /* | ||
| 2 | * Copyright (c) 1990 Regents of the University of California. | ||
| 3 | * All rights reserved. | ||
| 4 | * | ||
| 5 | * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without | ||
| 6 | * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions | ||
| 7 | * are met: | ||
| 8 | * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright | ||
| 9 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. | ||
| 10 | * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright | ||
| 11 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the | ||
| 12 | * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. | ||
| 13 | * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors | ||
| 14 | * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software | ||
| 15 | * without specific prior written permission. | ||
| 16 | * | ||
| 17 | * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND | ||
| 18 | * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE | ||
| 19 | * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE | ||
| 20 | * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE | ||
| 21 | * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL | ||
| 22 | * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS | ||
| 23 | * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) | ||
| 24 | * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT | ||
| 25 | * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY | ||
| 26 | * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF | ||
| 27 | * SUCH DAMAGE. | ||
| 28 | */ | ||
| 29 | |||
| 30 | #if defined(LIBC_SCCS) && !defined(lint) | ||
| 31 | static char *rcsid = "$OpenBSD: strtoul.c,v 1.5 2003/06/02 20:18:38 millert Exp $"; | ||
| 32 | #endif /* LIBC_SCCS and not lint */ | ||
| 33 | |||
| 34 | #include <ctype.h> | ||
| 35 | #include <errno.h> | ||
| 36 | #include <limits.h> | ||
| 37 | #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 38 | |||
| 39 | /* | ||
| 40 | * Convert a string to an unsigned long integer. | ||
| 41 | * | ||
| 42 | * Ignores `locale' stuff. Assumes that the upper and lower case | ||
| 43 | * alphabets and digits are each contiguous. | ||
| 44 | */ | ||
| 45 | unsigned long | ||
| 46 | strtoul(nptr, endptr, base) | ||
| 47 | const char *nptr; | ||
| 48 | char **endptr; | ||
| 49 | register int base; | ||
| 50 | { | ||
| 51 | register const char *s; | ||
| 52 | register unsigned long acc, cutoff; | ||
| 53 | register int c; | ||
| 54 | register int neg, any, cutlim; | ||
| 55 | |||
| 56 | /* | ||
| 57 | * See strtol for comments as to the logic used. | ||
| 58 | */ | ||
| 59 | s = nptr; | ||
| 60 | do { | ||
| 61 | c = (unsigned char) *s++; | ||
| 62 | } while (isspace(c)); | ||
| 63 | if (c == '-') { | ||
| 64 | neg = 1; | ||
| 65 | c = *s++; | ||
| 66 | } else { | ||
| 67 | neg = 0; | ||
| 68 | if (c == '+') | ||
| 69 | c = *s++; | ||
| 70 | } | ||
| 71 | if ((base == 0 || base == 16) && | ||
| 72 | c == '0' && (*s == 'x' || *s == 'X')) { | ||
| 73 | c = s[1]; | ||
| 74 | s += 2; | ||
| 75 | base = 16; | ||
| 76 | } | ||
| 77 | if (base == 0) | ||
| 78 | base = c == '0' ? 8 : 10; | ||
| 79 | |||
| 80 | cutoff = ULONG_MAX / (unsigned long)base; | ||
| 81 | cutlim = ULONG_MAX % (unsigned long)base; | ||
| 82 | for (acc = 0, any = 0;; c = (unsigned char) *s++) { | ||
| 83 | if (isdigit(c)) | ||
| 84 | c -= '0'; | ||
| 85 | else if (isalpha(c)) | ||
| 86 | c -= isupper(c) ? 'A' - 10 : 'a' - 10; | ||
| 87 | else | ||
| 88 | break; | ||
| 89 | if (c >= base) | ||
| 90 | break; | ||
| 91 | if (any < 0) | ||
| 92 | continue; | ||
| 93 | if (acc > cutoff || acc == cutoff && c > cutlim) { | ||
| 94 | any = -1; | ||
| 95 | acc = ULONG_MAX; | ||
| 96 | errno = ERANGE; | ||
| 97 | } else { | ||
| 98 | any = 1; | ||
| 99 | acc *= (unsigned long)base; | ||
| 100 | acc += c; | ||
| 101 | } | ||
| 102 | } | ||
| 103 | if (neg && any > 0) | ||
| 104 | acc = -acc; | ||
| 105 | if (endptr != 0) | ||
| 106 | *endptr = (char *) (any ? s - 1 : nptr); | ||
| 107 | return (acc); | ||
| 108 | } | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/strtoull.c b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/strtoull.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..a0ac9b381f --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/strtoull.c | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,124 @@ | |||
| 1 | /*- | ||
| 2 | * Copyright (c) 1992 The Regents of the University of California. | ||
| 3 | * All rights reserved. | ||
| 4 | * | ||
| 5 | * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without | ||
| 6 | * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions | ||
| 7 | * are met: | ||
| 8 | * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright | ||
| 9 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. | ||
| 10 | * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright | ||
| 11 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the | ||
| 12 | * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. | ||
| 13 | * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors | ||
| 14 | * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software | ||
| 15 | * without specific prior written permission. | ||
| 16 | * | ||
| 17 | * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND | ||
| 18 | * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE | ||
| 19 | * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE | ||
| 20 | * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE | ||
| 21 | * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL | ||
| 22 | * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS | ||
| 23 | * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) | ||
| 24 | * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT | ||
| 25 | * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY | ||
| 26 | * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF | ||
| 27 | * SUCH DAMAGE. | ||
| 28 | */ | ||
| 29 | |||
| 30 | #if defined(LIBC_SCCS) && !defined(lint) | ||
| 31 | static const char rcsid[] = "$OpenBSD: strtoull.c,v 1.2 2003/06/02 20:18:38 millert Exp $"; | ||
| 32 | #endif /* LIBC_SCCS and not lint */ | ||
| 33 | |||
| 34 | #include <sys/types.h> | ||
| 35 | |||
| 36 | #include <ctype.h> | ||
| 37 | #include <errno.h> | ||
| 38 | #include <limits.h> | ||
| 39 | #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 40 | |||
| 41 | /* | ||
| 42 | * Convert a string to an unsigned long long. | ||
| 43 | * | ||
| 44 | * Ignores `locale' stuff. Assumes that the upper and lower case | ||
| 45 | * alphabets and digits are each contiguous. | ||
| 46 | */ | ||
| 47 | unsigned long long | ||
| 48 | strtoull(nptr, endptr, base) | ||
| 49 | const char *nptr; | ||
| 50 | char **endptr; | ||
| 51 | int base; | ||
| 52 | { | ||
| 53 | const char *s; | ||
| 54 | unsigned long long acc, cutoff; | ||
| 55 | int c; | ||
| 56 | int neg, any, cutlim; | ||
| 57 | |||
| 58 | /* | ||
| 59 | * See strtoq for comments as to the logic used. | ||
| 60 | */ | ||
| 61 | s = nptr; | ||
| 62 | do { | ||
| 63 | c = (unsigned char) *s++; | ||
| 64 | } while (isspace(c)); | ||
| 65 | if (c == '-') { | ||
| 66 | neg = 1; | ||
| 67 | c = *s++; | ||
| 68 | } else { | ||
| 69 | neg = 0; | ||
| 70 | if (c == '+') | ||
| 71 | c = *s++; | ||
| 72 | } | ||
| 73 | if ((base == 0 || base == 16) && | ||
| 74 | c == '0' && (*s == 'x' || *s == 'X')) { | ||
| 75 | c = s[1]; | ||
| 76 | s += 2; | ||
| 77 | base = 16; | ||
| 78 | } | ||
| 79 | if (base == 0) | ||
| 80 | base = c == '0' ? 8 : 10; | ||
| 81 | |||
| 82 | cutoff = ULLONG_MAX / (unsigned long long)base; | ||
| 83 | cutlim = ULLONG_MAX % (unsigned long long)base; | ||
| 84 | for (acc = 0, any = 0;; c = (unsigned char) *s++) { | ||
| 85 | if (isdigit(c)) | ||
| 86 | c -= '0'; | ||
| 87 | else if (isalpha(c)) | ||
| 88 | c -= isupper(c) ? 'A' - 10 : 'a' - 10; | ||
| 89 | else | ||
| 90 | break; | ||
| 91 | if (c >= base) | ||
| 92 | break; | ||
| 93 | if (any < 0) | ||
| 94 | continue; | ||
| 95 | if (acc > cutoff || (acc == cutoff && c > cutlim)) { | ||
| 96 | any = -1; | ||
| 97 | acc = ULLONG_MAX; | ||
| 98 | errno = ERANGE; | ||
| 99 | } else { | ||
| 100 | any = 1; | ||
| 101 | acc *= (unsigned long long)base; | ||
| 102 | acc += c; | ||
| 103 | } | ||
| 104 | } | ||
| 105 | if (neg && any > 0) | ||
| 106 | acc = -acc; | ||
| 107 | if (endptr != 0) | ||
| 108 | *endptr = (char *) (any ? s - 1 : nptr); | ||
| 109 | return (acc); | ||
| 110 | } | ||
| 111 | |||
| 112 | #ifdef __weak_alias | ||
| 113 | __weak_alias(strtouq, strtoull); | ||
| 114 | #else | ||
| 115 | u_quad_t | ||
| 116 | strtouq(nptr, endptr, base) | ||
| 117 | const char *nptr; | ||
| 118 | char **endptr; | ||
| 119 | int base; | ||
| 120 | { | ||
| 121 | |||
| 122 | return ((u_quad_t)strtoull(nptr, endptr, base); | ||
| 123 | } | ||
| 124 | #endif | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/system.3 b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/system.3 new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..1034b01066 --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/system.3 | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,99 @@ | |||
| 1 | .\" Copyright (c) 1990, 1991 The Regents of the University of California. | ||
| 2 | .\" All rights reserved. | ||
| 3 | .\" | ||
| 4 | .\" This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by | ||
| 5 | .\" the American National Standards Committee X3, on Information | ||
| 6 | .\" Processing Systems. | ||
| 7 | .\" | ||
| 8 | .\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without | ||
| 9 | .\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions | ||
| 10 | .\" are met: | ||
| 11 | .\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright | ||
| 12 | .\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. | ||
| 13 | .\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright | ||
| 14 | .\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the | ||
| 15 | .\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. | ||
| 16 | .\" 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors | ||
| 17 | .\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software | ||
| 18 | .\" without specific prior written permission. | ||
| 19 | .\" | ||
| 20 | .\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND | ||
| 21 | .\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE | ||
| 22 | .\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE | ||
| 23 | .\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE | ||
| 24 | .\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL | ||
| 25 | .\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS | ||
| 26 | .\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) | ||
| 27 | .\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT | ||
| 28 | .\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY | ||
| 29 | .\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF | ||
| 30 | .\" SUCH DAMAGE. | ||
| 31 | .\" | ||
| 32 | .\" $OpenBSD: system.3,v 1.9 2003/06/02 20:18:38 millert Exp $ | ||
| 33 | .\" | ||
| 34 | .Dd June 29, 1991 | ||
| 35 | .Dt SYSTEM 3 | ||
| 36 | .Os | ||
| 37 | .Sh NAME | ||
| 38 | .Nm system | ||
| 39 | .Nd pass a command to the shell | ||
| 40 | .Sh SYNOPSIS | ||
| 41 | .Fd #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 42 | .Ft int | ||
| 43 | .Fn system "const char *string" | ||
| 44 | .Sh DESCRIPTION | ||
| 45 | The | ||
| 46 | .Fn system | ||
| 47 | function hands the argument | ||
| 48 | .Fa string | ||
| 49 | to the command interpreter | ||
| 50 | .Xr sh 1 . | ||
| 51 | The calling process waits for the shell to finish executing the command, | ||
| 52 | ignoring | ||
| 53 | .Dv SIGINT | ||
| 54 | and | ||
| 55 | .Dv SIGQUIT , | ||
| 56 | and blocking | ||
| 57 | .Dv SIGCHLD . | ||
| 58 | .Pp | ||
| 59 | If | ||
| 60 | .Fa string | ||
| 61 | is | ||
| 62 | .Dv NULL , | ||
| 63 | .Fn system | ||
| 64 | will return non-zero. | ||
| 65 | Otherwise, | ||
| 66 | .Fn system | ||
| 67 | returns the termination status of the shell in the format specified by | ||
| 68 | .Xr waitpid 2 . | ||
| 69 | .Sh RETURN VALUES | ||
| 70 | If a child process cannot be created, or the termination status of | ||
| 71 | the shell cannot be obtained, | ||
| 72 | .Fn system | ||
| 73 | returns \-1 and sets | ||
| 74 | .Va errno | ||
| 75 | to indicate the error. | ||
| 76 | If execution of the shell fails, | ||
| 77 | .Fn system | ||
| 78 | returns the termination status for a program that terminates with a call of | ||
| 79 | .Fn exit 127 . | ||
| 80 | .Sh SEE ALSO | ||
| 81 | .Xr sh 1 , | ||
| 82 | .Xr execve 2 , | ||
| 83 | .Xr waitpid 2 , | ||
| 84 | .Xr popen 3 | ||
| 85 | .Sh STANDARDS | ||
| 86 | The | ||
| 87 | .Fn system | ||
| 88 | function conforms to | ||
| 89 | .St -ansiC | ||
| 90 | and | ||
| 91 | .St -p1003.2-92 . | ||
| 92 | .Sh CAVEATS | ||
| 93 | Never supply the | ||
| 94 | .Fn system | ||
| 95 | function with a command containing any part of an unsanitized user-supplied | ||
| 96 | string. | ||
| 97 | Shell meta-characters present will be honored by the | ||
| 98 | .Xr sh 1 | ||
| 99 | command interpreter. | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/system.c b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/system.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..06b439230b --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/system.c | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,78 @@ | |||
| 1 | /* | ||
| 2 | * Copyright (c) 1988 The Regents of the University of California. | ||
| 3 | * All rights reserved. | ||
| 4 | * | ||
| 5 | * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without | ||
| 6 | * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions | ||
| 7 | * are met: | ||
| 8 | * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright | ||
| 9 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. | ||
| 10 | * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright | ||
| 11 | * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the | ||
| 12 | * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. | ||
| 13 | * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors | ||
| 14 | * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software | ||
| 15 | * without specific prior written permission. | ||
| 16 | * | ||
| 17 | * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND | ||
| 18 | * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE | ||
| 19 | * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE | ||
| 20 | * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE | ||
| 21 | * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL | ||
| 22 | * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS | ||
| 23 | * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) | ||
| 24 | * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT | ||
| 25 | * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY | ||
| 26 | * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF | ||
| 27 | * SUCH DAMAGE. | ||
| 28 | */ | ||
| 29 | |||
| 30 | #if defined(LIBC_SCCS) && !defined(lint) | ||
| 31 | static char *rcsid = "$OpenBSD: system.c,v 1.6 2003/06/02 20:18:38 millert Exp $"; | ||
| 32 | #endif /* LIBC_SCCS and not lint */ | ||
| 33 | |||
| 34 | #include <sys/types.h> | ||
| 35 | #include <sys/wait.h> | ||
| 36 | #include <signal.h> | ||
| 37 | #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 38 | #include <unistd.h> | ||
| 39 | #include <paths.h> | ||
| 40 | |||
| 41 | extern char **environ; | ||
| 42 | |||
| 43 | int | ||
| 44 | system(command) | ||
| 45 | const char *command; | ||
| 46 | { | ||
| 47 | pid_t pid; | ||
| 48 | sig_t intsave, quitsave; | ||
| 49 | sigset_t mask, omask; | ||
| 50 | int pstat; | ||
| 51 | char *argp[] = {"sh", "-c", NULL, NULL}; | ||
| 52 | |||
| 53 | if (!command) /* just checking... */ | ||
| 54 | return(1); | ||
| 55 | |||
| 56 | argp[2] = (char *)command; | ||
| 57 | |||
| 58 | sigemptyset(&mask); | ||
| 59 | sigaddset(&mask, SIGCHLD); | ||
| 60 | sigprocmask(SIG_BLOCK, &mask, &omask); | ||
| 61 | switch (pid = vfork()) { | ||
| 62 | case -1: /* error */ | ||
| 63 | sigprocmask(SIG_SETMASK, &omask, NULL); | ||
| 64 | return(-1); | ||
| 65 | case 0: /* child */ | ||
| 66 | sigprocmask(SIG_SETMASK, &omask, NULL); | ||
| 67 | execve(_PATH_BSHELL, argp, environ); | ||
| 68 | _exit(127); | ||
| 69 | } | ||
| 70 | |||
| 71 | intsave = signal(SIGINT, SIG_IGN); | ||
| 72 | quitsave = signal(SIGQUIT, SIG_IGN); | ||
| 73 | pid = waitpid(pid, (int *)&pstat, 0); | ||
| 74 | sigprocmask(SIG_SETMASK, &omask, NULL); | ||
| 75 | (void)signal(SIGINT, intsave); | ||
| 76 | (void)signal(SIGQUIT, quitsave); | ||
| 77 | return (pid == -1 ? -1 : pstat); | ||
| 78 | } | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/tfind.c b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/tfind.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..5c3b8c17f5 --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/tfind.c | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,41 @@ | |||
| 1 | /* | ||
| 2 | * Tree search generalized from Knuth (6.2.2) Algorithm T just like | ||
| 3 | * the AT&T man page says. | ||
| 4 | * | ||
| 5 | * The node_t structure is for internal use only, lint doesn't grok it. | ||
| 6 | * | ||
| 7 | * Written by reading the System V Interface Definition, not the code. | ||
| 8 | * | ||
| 9 | * Totally public domain. | ||
| 10 | */ | ||
| 11 | /*LINTLIBRARY*/ | ||
| 12 | #include <search.h> | ||
| 13 | |||
| 14 | typedef struct node_t | ||
| 15 | { | ||
| 16 | char *key; | ||
| 17 | struct node_t *llink, *rlink; | ||
| 18 | } node; | ||
| 19 | |||
| 20 | /* find a node, or return 0 */ | ||
| 21 | void * | ||
| 22 | tfind(vkey, vrootp, compar) | ||
| 23 | const void *vkey; /* key to be found */ | ||
| 24 | void *const *vrootp; /* address of the tree root */ | ||
| 25 | int (*compar)(const void *, const void *); | ||
| 26 | { | ||
| 27 | char *key = (char *)vkey; | ||
| 28 | node **rootp = (node **)vrootp; | ||
| 29 | |||
| 30 | if (rootp == (struct node_t **)0) | ||
| 31 | return ((struct node_t *)0); | ||
| 32 | while (*rootp != (struct node_t *)0) { /* T1: */ | ||
| 33 | int r; | ||
| 34 | if ((r = (*compar)(key, (*rootp)->key)) == 0) /* T2: */ | ||
| 35 | return (*rootp); /* key found */ | ||
| 36 | rootp = (r < 0) ? | ||
| 37 | &(*rootp)->llink : /* T3: follow left branch */ | ||
| 38 | &(*rootp)->rlink; /* T4: follow right branch */ | ||
| 39 | } | ||
| 40 | return (node *)0; | ||
| 41 | } | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/tsearch.3 b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/tsearch.3 new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..15d7b84a3a --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/tsearch.3 | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,116 @@ | |||
| 1 | .\" $OpenBSD: tsearch.3,v 1.12 2003/06/17 21:56:24 millert Exp $ | ||
| 2 | .\" | ||
| 3 | .\" Copyright (c) 1997 Todd C. Miller <Todd.Miller@courtesan.com> | ||
| 4 | .\" | ||
| 5 | .\" Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software for any | ||
| 6 | .\" purpose with or without fee is hereby granted, provided that the above | ||
| 7 | .\" copyright notice and this permission notice appear in all copies. | ||
| 8 | .\" | ||
| 9 | .\" THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS" AND THE AUTHOR DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES | ||
| 10 | .\" WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF | ||
| 11 | .\" MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR | ||
| 12 | .\" ANY SPECIAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES | ||
| 13 | .\" WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN AN | ||
| 14 | .\" ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING OUT OF | ||
| 15 | .\" OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE. | ||
| 16 | .\" | ||
| 17 | .Dd June 15, 1997 | ||
| 18 | .Dt TSEARCH 3 | ||
| 19 | .Os | ||
| 20 | .Sh NAME | ||
| 21 | .Nm tsearch , | ||
| 22 | .Nm tfind , | ||
| 23 | .Nm tdelete , | ||
| 24 | .Nm twalk | ||
| 25 | .Nd manipulate binary search trees | ||
| 26 | .Sh SYNOPSIS | ||
| 27 | .Fd #include <search.h> | ||
| 28 | .Ft void * | ||
| 29 | .Fn tdelete "const void *key" "void **rootp" "int (*compar) (const void *, const void *)" | ||
| 30 | .Ft void * | ||
| 31 | .Fn tfind "const void *key" "void * const *rootp" "int (*compar) (const void *, const void *)" | ||
| 32 | .Ft void * | ||
| 33 | .Fn tsearch "const void *key" "void **rootp" "int (*compar) (const void *, const void *)" | ||
| 34 | .Ft void | ||
| 35 | .Fn twalk "const void *root" "void (*action) (const void *, VISIT, int)" | ||
| 36 | .Sh DESCRIPTION | ||
| 37 | The | ||
| 38 | .Fn tdelete , | ||
| 39 | .Fn tfind , | ||
| 40 | .Fn tsearch , | ||
| 41 | and | ||
| 42 | .Fn twalk | ||
| 43 | functions manage binary search trees based on algorithms T and D | ||
| 44 | from Knuth (6.2.2). | ||
| 45 | The comparison function passed in by | ||
| 46 | the user has the same style of return values as | ||
| 47 | .Xr strcmp 3 . | ||
| 48 | .Pp | ||
| 49 | .Fn tfind | ||
| 50 | searches for the datum matched by the argument | ||
| 51 | .Fa key | ||
| 52 | in the binary tree rooted at | ||
| 53 | .Fa rootp , | ||
| 54 | returning a pointer to the datum if it is found and | ||
| 55 | .Dv NULL | ||
| 56 | if it is not. | ||
| 57 | .Pp | ||
| 58 | .Fn tsearch | ||
| 59 | is identical to | ||
| 60 | .Fn tfind | ||
| 61 | except that if no match is found, | ||
| 62 | .Fa key | ||
| 63 | is inserted into the tree and a pointer to it is returned. | ||
| 64 | If | ||
| 65 | .Fa rootp | ||
| 66 | points to a null value a new binary search tree is created. | ||
| 67 | .Pp | ||
| 68 | .Fn tdelete | ||
| 69 | deletes a node from the specified binary search tree and returns | ||
| 70 | a pointer to the parent of the node to be deleted. | ||
| 71 | It takes the same arguments as | ||
| 72 | .Fn tfind | ||
| 73 | and | ||
| 74 | .Fn tsearch . | ||
| 75 | If the node to be deleted is the root of the binary search tree, | ||
| 76 | .Fa rootp | ||
| 77 | will be adjusted. | ||
| 78 | .Pp | ||
| 79 | .Fn twalk | ||
| 80 | walks the binary search tree rooted in | ||
| 81 | .Fa root | ||
| 82 | and calls the function | ||
| 83 | .Fa action | ||
| 84 | on each node. | ||
| 85 | .Fa action | ||
| 86 | is called with three arguments: a pointer to the current node, | ||
| 87 | a value from the enum | ||
| 88 | .Sy "typedef enum { preorder, postorder, endorder, leaf } VISIT;" | ||
| 89 | specifying the traversal type, and a node level (where level | ||
| 90 | zero is the root of the tree). | ||
| 91 | .Sh RETURN VALUES | ||
| 92 | The | ||
| 93 | .Fn tsearch | ||
| 94 | function returns | ||
| 95 | .Dv NULL | ||
| 96 | if allocation of a new node fails (usually | ||
| 97 | due to a lack of free memory). | ||
| 98 | .Pp | ||
| 99 | .Fn tfind , | ||
| 100 | .Fn tsearch , | ||
| 101 | and | ||
| 102 | .Fn tdelete | ||
| 103 | return | ||
| 104 | .Dv NULL | ||
| 105 | if | ||
| 106 | .Fa rootp | ||
| 107 | is | ||
| 108 | .Dv NULL | ||
| 109 | or the datum cannot be found. | ||
| 110 | .Pp | ||
| 111 | The | ||
| 112 | .Fn twalk | ||
| 113 | function returns no value. | ||
| 114 | .Sh SEE ALSO | ||
| 115 | .Xr bsearch 3 , | ||
| 116 | .Xr lsearch 3 | ||
diff --git a/src/lib/libc/stdlib/tsearch.c b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/tsearch.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..0ad5866172 --- /dev/null +++ b/src/lib/libc/stdlib/tsearch.c | |||
| @@ -0,0 +1,126 @@ | |||
| 1 | /* | ||
| 2 | * Tree search generalized from Knuth (6.2.2) Algorithm T just like | ||
| 3 | * the AT&T man page says. | ||
| 4 | * | ||
| 5 | * The node_t structure is for internal use only, lint doesn't grok it. | ||
| 6 | * | ||
| 7 | * Written by reading the System V Interface Definition, not the code. | ||
| 8 | * | ||
| 9 | * Totally public domain. | ||
| 10 | */ | ||
| 11 | /*LINTLIBRARY*/ | ||
| 12 | |||
| 13 | #include <search.h> | ||
| 14 | #include <stdlib.h> | ||
| 15 | |||
| 16 | typedef struct node_t { | ||
| 17 | char *key; | ||
| 18 | struct node_t *left, *right; | ||
| 19 | } node; | ||
| 20 | |||
| 21 | /* find or insert datum into search tree */ | ||
| 22 | void * | ||
| 23 | tsearch(vkey, vrootp, compar) | ||
| 24 | const void *vkey; /* key to be located */ | ||
| 25 | void **vrootp; /* address of tree root */ | ||
| 26 | int (*compar)(const void *, const void *); | ||
| 27 | { | ||
| 28 | register node *q; | ||
| 29 | char *key = (char *)vkey; | ||
| 30 | node **rootp = (node **)vrootp; | ||
| 31 | |||
| 32 | if (rootp == (struct node_t **)0) | ||
| 33 | return ((void *)0); | ||
| 34 | while (*rootp != (struct node_t *)0) { /* Knuth's T1: */ | ||
| 35 | int r; | ||
| 36 | |||
| 37 | if ((r = (*compar)(key, (*rootp)->key)) == 0) /* T2: */ | ||
| 38 | return ((void *)*rootp); /* we found it! */ | ||
| 39 | rootp = (r < 0) ? | ||
| 40 | &(*rootp)->left : /* T3: follow left branch */ | ||
| 41 | &(*rootp)->right; /* T4: follow right branch */ | ||
| 42 | } | ||
| 43 | q = (node *) malloc(sizeof(node)); /* T5: key not found */ | ||
| 44 | if (q != (struct node_t *)0) { /* make new node */ | ||
| 45 | *rootp = q; /* link new node to old */ | ||
| 46 | q->key = key; /* initialize new node */ | ||
| 47 | q->left = q->right = (struct node_t *)0; | ||
| 48 | } | ||
| 49 | return ((void *)q); | ||
| 50 | } | ||
| 51 | |||
| 52 | /* delete node with given key */ | ||
| 53 | void * | ||
| 54 | tdelete(vkey, vrootp, compar) | ||
| 55 | const void *vkey; /* key to be deleted */ | ||
| 56 | void **vrootp; /* address of the root of tree */ | ||
| 57 | int (*compar)(const void *, const void *); | ||
| 58 | { | ||
| 59 | node **rootp = (node **)vrootp; | ||
| 60 | char *key = (char *)vkey; | ||
| 61 | node *p; | ||
| 62 | register node *q; | ||
| 63 | register node *r; | ||
| 64 | int cmp; | ||
| 65 | |||
| 66 | if (rootp == (struct node_t **)0 || (p = *rootp) == (struct node_t *)0) | ||
| 67 | return ((struct node_t *)0); | ||
| 68 | while ((cmp = (*compar)(key, (*rootp)->key)) != 0) { | ||
| 69 | p = *rootp; | ||
| 70 | rootp = (cmp < 0) ? | ||
| 71 | &(*rootp)->left : /* follow left branch */ | ||
| 72 | &(*rootp)->right; /* follow right branch */ | ||
| 73 | if (*rootp == (struct node_t *)0) | ||
| 74 | return ((void *)0); /* key not found */ | ||
| 75 | } | ||
| 76 | r = (*rootp)->right; /* D1: */ | ||
| 77 | if ((q = (*rootp)->left) == (struct node_t *)0) /* Left (struct node_t *)0? */ | ||
| 78 | q = r; | ||
| 79 | else if (r != (struct node_t *)0) { /* Right link is null? */ | ||
| 80 | if (r->left == (struct node_t *)0) { /* D2: Find successor */ | ||
| 81 | r->left = q; | ||
| 82 | q = r; | ||
| 83 | } else { /* D3: Find (struct node_t *)0 link */ | ||
| 84 | for (q = r->left; q->left != (struct node_t *)0; q = r->left) | ||
| 85 | r = q; | ||
| 86 | r->left = q->right; | ||
| 87 | q->left = (*rootp)->left; | ||
| 88 | q->right = (*rootp)->right; | ||
| 89 | } | ||
| 90 | } | ||
| 91 | free((struct node_t *) *rootp); /* D4: Free node */ | ||
| 92 | *rootp = q; /* link parent to new node */ | ||
| 93 | return(p); | ||
| 94 | } | ||
| 95 | |||
| 96 | /* Walk the nodes of a tree */ | ||
| 97 | static void | ||
| 98 | trecurse(root, action, level) | ||
| 99 | register node *root; /* Root of the tree to be walked */ | ||
| 100 | register void (*action)(); /* Function to be called at each node */ | ||
| 101 | register int level; | ||
| 102 | { | ||
| 103 | if (root->left == (struct node_t *)0 && root->right == (struct node_t *)0) | ||
| 104 | (*action)(root, leaf, level); | ||
| 105 | else { | ||
| 106 | (*action)(root, preorder, level); | ||
| 107 | if (root->left != (struct node_t *)0) | ||
| 108 | trecurse(root->left, action, level + 1); | ||
| 109 | (*action)(root, postorder, level); | ||
| 110 | if (root->right != (struct node_t *)0) | ||
| 111 | trecurse(root->right, action, level + 1); | ||
| 112 | (*action)(root, endorder, level); | ||
| 113 | } | ||
| 114 | } | ||
| 115 | |||
| 116 | /* Walk the nodes of a tree */ | ||
| 117 | void | ||
| 118 | twalk(vroot, action) | ||
| 119 | const void *vroot; /* Root of the tree to be walked */ | ||
| 120 | void (*action)(const void *, VISIT, int); | ||
| 121 | { | ||
| 122 | node *root = (node *)vroot; | ||
| 123 | |||
| 124 | if (root != (node *)0 && action != (void(*)())0) | ||
| 125 | trecurse(root, action, 0); | ||
| 126 | } | ||
